Beckwith M 3425A

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 482

Instruction Book

M-3425A Generator Protection

PROTECTION

Generator Protection M3425A


Integrated Protection System for Generators of All Sizes

Unit shown with optional M3925A Target Module and M3931 HMI (HumanMachine Interface) Module

Exceeds IEEE C37.102 and Standard 242 requirements for generator protection Protects generators of any prime mover, grounding and connection type Provides all major protective functions for generator protection including Out-of-Step (78), Split-Phase Differential (50DT), Under Frequency Time Accumulation (81A), Inadvertent Energizing (50/27) and Turn-to-Turn Fault (59X) Expanded IPScom Communications Software provides simple and logical setting and programming, including logic schemes Simple application with Base and Comprehensive protection packages Load encroachment blinders and power swing blocking for system backup protection (21) to enhance security during system abnormal conditions Options: Ethernet Connection, Field Ground/Brush Lift-Off Protection (64F/B), Sync Check (25), 100% Stator Ground Fault Protection by low frequency injection (64S) and Expanded I/O (15 additional Output Contacts and 8 additional Control/Status Inputs)

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Protective Functions
Base Package
Overexcitation (V/Hz) (24) Phase Undervoltage (27) Directional power sensitive triplesetpoint Reverse Power, Low Forward Power or Overpower detection, one of which can be used for sequential tripping (32) Dualzone, offsetmho Loss of Field (40), which may be applied with undervoltage controlled accelerated tripping Sensitive Negative Sequence Overcurrent protection and alarm (46) Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent (50) Inadvertent Energizing (50/27) Generator Breaker Failure (50BF) Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent (50N) Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent (51N) Three-phase Inverse Time Overcurrent (51V) with voltage control and voltage restraint. Phase Overvoltage (59) Neutral Overvoltage (59N) Multi-purpose Overvoltage (59X) VT FuseLoss Detection and blocking (60FL) Residual Directional Overcurrent (67N) Fourstep Over/Underfrequency (81) Phase Differential Current (87) Ground (zero sequence) Differential Current (87GD) IPSlogic takes the contact input status and function status and generates outputs by employing (OR, AND, and NOT) boolean logic and a timer.

Protective Functions
Comprehensive Package
The Comprehensive Package includes all Base Package functions, as well as the following: Threezone Phase Distance protection for phase fault backup protection (21). Zone three can be used for Out-of-Step Blocking. Load encroachment blinders can be applied. 100% Stator Ground Fault protection using Third Harmonic Neutral Undervoltage (27TN) or (59D) Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (ratio) Stator Overload (49) (Positive Sequence Overcurrent) Definite Time Overcurrent (50DT) can be used for split phase differential OutofStep (78) UnderFrequency Accumulation (81A) Rate of Change of Frequency (81R)

Optional Protective Functions


Sync Check with Phase Angle, V and F with dead line/dead bus options (25) Field Ground (64F) and Brush Lift Off (64B) (Includes M-3921 Field Ground Coupler) 100% Stator Ground protection by low frequency injection (64S). The following equipment is required with the 64S option: 20 Hz signal generator (43000426) Band-pass Filter (43000427) 400/5 A 20 Hz CT (43000428)

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Standard Features
Eight programmable outputs and six programmable inputs Oscillographic recording with COMTRADE or BECO format Time-stamped target storage for 32 events Metering of all measured parameters and calculated values Three communications ports (two RS-232 and one RS-485) S3400 IPScom Communications Software Includes MODBUS and BECO 2200 protocols Standard 19" rack-mount design (vertical mounting available) Removable printed circuit board and power supply 50 and 60 Hz models available Both 1A and 5 A rated CT inputs available Additional trip inputs for externally connected devices IRIG-B time synchronization Operating Temperature: 20 C to +70 C Sequence of Events Log Trip Circuit Monitoring Breaker Monitoring Four Setpoint Groups

Optional Features
Redundant power supply M3925A Target Module M3931 Human-Machine Interface (HMI) Module RJ45 Ethernet port utilizing MODBUS over TCP/IP and BECO2200 over TCP/IP protocols RJ45 Ethernet port utilizing IEC 61850 Protocol M3801D IPSplot PLUS Oscillograph Analysis Software Expanded I/O (15 additional outputs and 8 additional inputs) Standard and Expanded I/O Models available in vertical panel mount

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS
Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Phase Distance (three-zone mho characteristic)


Circle Diameter #1,#2,#3 0.1 to 100.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (0.5 to 500.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 100.0 to 100.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (500.0 to 500.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 0 to 90 1 1 1 Cycle 1 Cycle 0.1 A 0.01 A 1 1 1 Cycle or 1% 1 Cycle or 1% 0.1 A or 2% 0.02 A or 2%

Offset #1,#2,#3 21 Impedance Angle #1,#2,#3

Load Encroachment Blinder #1,#2,#3 Angle 1 to 90 R Reach 0.1 to 100 Time Delay #1,#2,#3 Out-of-Step Delay Overcurrent Supervision 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.1 to 20 A (0.02 to 4 A)

When out-of-step blocking on Zone 1 or Zone 2 is enabled, Zone 3 will not trip and it will be used to detect the outof-step condition for blocking Function 21 #1 and/or 21 #2.

Volts / Hz
Definite Time Pickup #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2 100 to 200% 30 to 8160 Cycles 1% 1 Cycle 1% 25 Cycles

24

Inverse Time Pickup Characteristic Curves Time Dial: Curve #1 Time Dial: Curves #2#4 100 to 200% Inverse Time #1#4 1 to 100 0.0 to 9.0 1 to 999 Sec. (from threshold of trip) 1% 1 0.1 1 Sec. 1% 1% 1% 1 Second or 1%

Reset Rate

The percent pickup is based on nominal VT secondary voltage and nominal system frequency settings. The pickup accuracy stated is only applicable from 10 to 80 Hz, 0 to 180 V, 100 to 150% V/Hz and a nominal voltage setting of 120V.

Phase Undervoltage
Pickup #1, #2, #3 5 to 180 V 1 V 27 Time Delay #1, #2, #3 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle * When both RMS and LineGround to LineLine VT connection is selected. **When RMS (total waveform) is selected, timing accuracy is O20 cycles or 1%. 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.8 V or 0.75%* 1 Cycle or 0.5%**

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
4

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Third-Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral


Pickup #1, #2 Positive Sequence Voltage Block 0.10 to 14.00 V 5 to 180 V 0.01 V 1 V 0.01 PU 0.01 PU 0.01 PU 0.01 PU 0.01 0.01 0.01 PU 0.01 PU 1 Cycle 0.1 V or 1% 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.01 PU or 2% 0.01 PU or 2% 0.01 PU or 2% 0.01 PU or 2% 0.03 PU or 3% 0.03 PU or 3% 0.01 PU or 2% 0.01 PU or 2% 1 to +5 Cycles or 1%

Forward Under Power Block 0.01 to 1.00 PU Reverse Under Power Block 1.00 to 0.01 PU Lead Under VAr Block Lag Under VAr Block Lead Power Factor Block Lag Power Factor Block High Band Forward Power Block Low Band Forward Power Block Time Delay #1, #2 1.00 to 0.01 PU 0.01 to 1.00 PU 0.01 to 1.00 0.01 to 1.00 0.01 to 1.00 PU 0.01 to 1.00 PU 1 to 8160 Cycles

27 TN

Directional Power
Pickup #1, #2, #3 3.000 to +3.000 PU 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.001 PU 1 Cycle 0.002 PU or 2% +16 Cycles or 1%

32

Time Delay #1, #2, #3

The minimum Pickup limits are .002 and +.002 respectively. The per-unit pickup is based on nominal VT secondary voltage and nominal CT secondary current settings. This function can be selected as either overpower or underpower in the forward direction (positive setting) or reverse direction (negative setting). Element #3 can be set as real power or reactive power. This function includes a pro grammable target LED that may be disabled.

Loss of Field (dual-zone offset-mho characteristic)


Circle Diameter #1, #2 0.1 to 100.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (0.5 to 500.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 50.0 to 50.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (250.0 to 250.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 to 8160 Cycles 5 to 180 V 0 to 20 1 Cycle 1 Cycle 1 V 1 1 Cycle or 1% 1 Cycle or 1% 0.5 V or 0.5%

40 Offset #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2 Time Delay with Voltage Control #1, #2 Voltage Control (positive sequence) Directional Element

Time delay with voltage control for each zone can be individually enabled.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
5

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Negative Sequence Overcurrent


Definite Time Pickup 3 to 100% 1% Time Delay 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle Inverse Time Pickup 3 to 100% 1% 46 Time Dial Setting (K= I22t) Definite Maximum Time to Trip Definite Minimum Time 1 to 95 1 0.5% of 5 A (0.5% of 1 A) 1 Cycle or 1% 0.5 % of 5 A (0.5% of 1 A) 3 Cycles or 3%

600 to 65,500 Cycles 12 Cycles

1 Cycle

1 Cycle or 1% fixed 1 Second or 1%

Reset Time (Linear)

1 to 600 Seconds 1 Second (from threshold of trip)

Pickup is based on the generator nominal current setting.

Stator Overload Protection


Time Constant #1, #2 1.0 to 999.9 minutes 0.1 minutes 0.01 A 0.1 A or 2%

49

Maximum Overload Current 1.00 to 10.00 A (0.20 to 2.00 A)

Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent


50

Pickup #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2

0.1 to 240.0 A (0.1 to 48.0 A) 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.1 A 1 Cycle

0.1 A or 3% (0.02 A or 3%) 1 Cycle or 1%

5 ) Hz add an additional time of (1.5/f + 0.033) sec to the time delay accuracy. When frequency f is < (fnom

Breaker Failure

50 BF-Ph

50 BF

Pickup Phase Current Neutral Current Time Delay

0.10 to 10.00 A (0.02 to 2.00 A) 0.10 to 10.00 A (0.02 to 2.00 A) 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.01 A 0.01 A 1 Cycle

0.1 A or 2% (0.02 A or 2%) 0.1 A or 2% (0.02 A or 2%) 1 Cycle or 1%

50 BF-N

50BF can be initiated from designated M3425A output contacts or programmable control/status inputs.

Definite Time Overcurrent


50 DT

Pickup Phase A #1, #2 Pickup Phase B #1, #2 Pickup Phase C #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2

0.20 A to 240.00 A (0.04 A to 48.00 A) (same as above) (same as above) 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.01 A

0.1 A or 3% (0.02 A or 3%)

1 Cycle

1 Cycle or 1%

This function uses generator line-side currents. When 50DT function is used for split-phase differential protection, 50BF, 87, and 87GD functions should not be used, and the IA, IB and IC inputs must be connected to the split phase differential currents.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
6

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent



50N

Pickup Time Delay

0.1 to 240.0 A (0.1 to 48.0 A) 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.1 A 1 Cycle

0.1 A or 3% (0.02 A or 3%) 1 Cycle or 1%

5) Hz add an additional time of (1.5/f + 0.033) sec to the time delay accuracy. When the frequency f is < (fnom

Inadvertent Energizing

50 Overcurrent

50/ 27

Pickup Pickup

0.5 to 15.00 A (0.1 to 3.00 A) 5 to 130 V 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.01 A 0.1 A or 2% (0.02 A or 2%) 1 V 1 Cycle 1 Cycle 0.5 V 1 Cycle or 1% 1 Cycle or 1%

27 Undervoltage
Pick-up Time Delay Drop-out Time Delay

When RMS (total Waveform) is selected, timing accuracy is O20 cycles or 1%.

Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent


Pickup Characteristic Curve Time Dial 0.25 to 12.00 A (0.05 to 2.40 A) 0.01 A 0.1 A or 1% (0.02 A or 1%)

51N

Definite Time/Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEC Curves Moderately Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEEE Curves 0.5 to 11.0 0.05 to 1.10 (IEC curves) 0.5 to 15.0 (IEEE curves) 0.1 0.01 0.01 3 Cycles or 3%*

* For IEC Curves the timing accuracy is 5%. 5 )Hz add an additional time of (1.5/f + 0.033) sec to the time delay accuracy. When the frequency f is < (fnom

Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent, with Voltage Control or Voltage Restraint


Pickup Characteristic Curve Time Dial 0.50 to 12.00 A (0.10 to 2.40 A) 0.01 A 0.1 A or 1% (0.02 A or 1%)

51V

Definite Time/Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEC Curves Moderately Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEEE Curves 0.5 to 11.0 0.05 to 1.10 (IEC curves) 0.5 to 15.0 (IEEE curves) 5 to 180 V Linear Restraint 0.1 0.01 0.01 1 V 3 Cycles or 3%*

Voltage Control (VC) or Voltage Restraint (VR)

0.5 V or 0.5%

* For IEC Curves the timing accuracy is 5%.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
7

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Phase Overvoltage
Pickup #1, #2, #3 5 to 180 V 1 V 59 Time Delay #1, #2, #3 Input Voltage Select 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle Phase, Positive or Negative Sequence*** 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.8 V or 0.75%* 1 Cycle or 1%**

* When both RMS and LineGround to LineLine is selected.

** When RMS (total waveform) is selected, timing accuracy is O20 cycles or 1%.

*** When positive or negative sequence voltage is selected, the 59 Function uses the discrete Fourier transform (DFT) for magnitude calculation, irrespective of the RMS/DFT selection, and timing accuracy is 1 Cycle or 1%. Positive and negative sequence voltages are calculated in terms of line-to-line voltage when Line to Line is selected for V.T. Configuration.

Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential Ratio


Ratio (Vx/VN) 0.1 to 5.0 1 to 8160 Cycles 5 to 180 V VX or 3V0 (calculated) 0.1 1 Cycle 1 V 1 Cycle or 1% 0.5 V or 0.5%

59D

Time Delay Positive Seq Voltage Block Line Side Voltage

The 59D function has a cutoff voltage of 0.5 V for 3rd harmonic VX voltage. If the 180 Hz component of VN is expected to be less than 0.5 V the 59D function can not be used. The 59D function with VX cannot be enabled if the 25 function is enabled. The line side voltage can be selected as the third harmonic of 3V0 (equivalent to VA + VB + VC) or VX. 3V0 selection for line side voltage can only be used with line-ground VT configuration.

Neutral Overvoltage

59N

Pickup #1, #2, #3 Time Delay #1, #2, #3

5.0 to 180.0 V 1 to 8160 Cycles

0.1 V 1 Cycle

0.5 V or 0.5% 1 Cycle or 1%

When 64S is purchased, the 59N Time Delay Accuracy is 1 to +5 cycles.

Multi-purpose Overvoltage
Pickup #1, #2 5.0 to 180.0 V 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.1 V 1 Cycle

59X

0.5 V or 0.5% 1 Cycle or 1%

Time Delay #1, #2

Multi-purpose input that may be used for turn-to-turn stator ground protection, bus ground protection, or as an extra Phase-Phase, or Phase-Ground voltage input. When 64S is purchased, the 59N Time Delay accuracy is 1 to +5 cycles.

VT Fuse-Loss Detection
A VT fuse-loss condition is detected by using the positive and negative sequence components of the voltages and currents. VT fuse-loss output can be initiated from internally generated logic, and/or from input contacts.

60 FL

Alarm Time Delay

1 to 8160 Cycles

1 Cycle

1 Cycle or 1%

Three Phase VT Fuse Loss Detection Enable/Disable Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
8

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Residual Directional Overcurrent


67N Definite Time* Pickup Time Delay Inverse Time* Pickup Characteristic Curve Time Dial 0.5 to 240.0 A (0.1 to 48.0 A) 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.25 to 12.00 A (0.05 to 2.40 A) 0.1 A 1 Cycle 0.01 A 0.1 A or 3% (0.02 A or 3%) 1 to +3 Cycles or 1% 0.1 A or 3% (0.02 A or 3%)

Definite Time/Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEC Curves Moderately Inverse/Very Inverse/Extremely Inverse/IEEE Curves 0.5 to 11.0 0.05 to 1.10 (IEC Curves) 0.5 to 15.0 (IEEE curves) 0.1 0.01 0.01 3 Cycles or 5%

Directional Element Max Sensitivity Angle (MSA) Polarizing Quantity

0 to 359

3Vo (calculated), VN or VX

*Directional control for 67NDT or 67NIT may be disabled. VX polarization cannot be used if 25 function is enabled. 3Vo polarization can only be used with line-ground VT configuration. Operating current for 67N can be selected as 3Io (calculated) or IN (Residual CT). If 87GD is enabled, 67N with IN (Residual CT) operating current will not be available.

Out of Step (mho characteristic)


Circle Diameter Offset 0.1 to 100.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (0.5 to 500.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 100.0 to 100.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (500.0 to 500.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 0 to 90 1 1 0.1 to 50.0 0.1 0.1 or 5% (0.5 to 250.0 ) (0.5 or 5%) 1 to 8160 Cycles Enable/Disable 1 to 20 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 1 Cycle 1 Cycle or 1% 1 Cycle 1 Cycle or 1%

78

Impedance Angle Blinder Time Delay Trip on mho Exit Pole Slip Counter Pole Slip Reset

Frequency

81

Pickup #1,#2,#3,#4 Time Delay #1#4

50.00 to 67.00 Hz 40.00 to 57.00 Hz* 3 to 65,500 Cycles

0.01 Hz 1 Cycle

0.02 Hz 2 Cycles or 1%

The pickup accuracy applies to 60 Hz models at a range of 57 to 63 Hz, and to 50 Hz models at a range of 47 to 53 Hz. Beyond these ranges, the accuracy is 0.1 Hz. * This range applies to 50 Hz nominal frequency models.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
9

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

Frequency Accumulation
Bands #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 High Band #1 50.00 to 67.00 Hz 40.00 to 57.00 Hz* Low Band #1#6 50.00 to 67.00 Hz 40.00 to 57.00 Hz* Delay #1#6 3 to 360,000 Cycles 0.01 Hz 0.01 Hz 1 Cycle 0.02 Hz 0.02 Hz 2 Cycles or 1%

81A

When using multiple frequency bands, the lower limit of the previous band becomes the upper limit for the next band, i.e., Low Band #2 is the upper limit for Band #3, and so forth. Frequency bands must be used in sequential order, 1 to 6. Band #1 must be enabled to use Bands #2#6. If any band is disabled, all following bands are disabled. When frequency is within an enabled band limit, accumulation time starts (there is an internal ten cycle delay prior to accumulation) and allows the underfrequency blade resonance to be established to avoid unnecessary accumulation of time. When duration is greater than set delay, the alarm asserts and a target log entry is made. The pickup accuracy applies to 60 Hz models at a range of 57 to 63 Hz, and 50 Hz models at a range of 47 to 53 Hz. Beyond these ranges, the accuracy is 0.1 Hz. * This range applies to 50 Hz nominal frequency models.

Rate of Change of Frequency


81R

Pickup #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2 Negative Sequence Voltage Inhibit

0.10 to 20.00 Hz/Sec. 3 to 8160 Cycles 0 to 99%

0.01 Hz/Sec. 1 Cycle 1%

0.05 Hz/Sec. or 5% + 20 Cycles 0.5%

Phase Differential Current


87

Pickup #1, #2 Percent Slope #1, #2 Time Delay* #1, #2 CT Correction**

0.20 A to 3.00 A 0.01 A 0.1 A or 5% (0.04 to 0.60 A) (0.02 A or 5%) 1 to 100% 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.50 to 2.00 1% 1 Cycle 0.01 2% 1 Cycle or 1%

*When a time delay of 1 cycle is selected, the response time is less than 11/2 cycles. **The CT Correction factor is multiplied by IA,IB,IC.

Ground (zero sequence) Differential Current


87 GD

Pickup Time Delay CT Ratio Correction (RC)

0.20 to 10.00 A (0.04 to 2.00 A) 1 to 8160 Cycles* 0.10 to 7.99

0.01 A 1 Cycle 0.01

0.1 A or 5% (0.02 A or 5%) +1 to -2 Cycles or 1%

*The Time Delay Setting should not be less than 2 Cycles. The 87GD function is provided primarily for low-impedance grounded generator applications. This function oper ates as a directional differential. If 3I0 or In is extremely small (less than 0.2 secondary Amps), the element be comes non-directional. If 67N function with IN (Residual) operating current is enabled, 87GD will not be available. Also, if 50DT is used for split-phase differential, 87GD function will not be available.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating.
10

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS (cont.)


Device Number Function Setpoint Ranges Increment Accuracy

IPSlogicTM
IPS IPSlogic uses element pickups, element trip commands, control/status input state changes, output contact close signals to develop 6 programmable logic schemes. Time Delay #1#6 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle 1 Cycle or 1%

Breaker Monitoring
BM Pickup Time Delay Timing Method Preset Accumulators Phase A, B, C 0 to 50,000 kA Cycles or kA2 Cycles 0.1 to 4095.9 Cycles IT or I T
2

1 kA Cycles or kA2 Cycles 0.1 Cycles 1 kA Cycle

1 kACycles or kA2 Cycles 1 Cycle or 1%

0 to 50,000 kA Cycles

The Breaker Monitor feature calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the current (or current squared) through the breaker contacts as an arc. The per-phase values are added to an accumulated total for each phase, and then compared to a user-pro grammed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay can set a programmable output contact. The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed. The Breaker Monitoring feature requires an initiating contact to begin accumulation, and the accumulation begins after the set time delay.

Trip Circuit Monitoring


TC Time Delay 1 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle 1 Cycle or 1%

The AUX input is provided for monitoring the integrity of the trip circuit. This input can be used for nominal trip coil voltages of 24 V dc, 48 V dc, 125 V dc and 250 V dc.

Nominal Settings
Nominal Voltage Nominal Current VT Configuration Delta/Wye Unit Transformer Seal-In Delay 50.0 to 140.0 V 0.50 to 6.00 A Line-Line/Line-Ground/ Line-Ground to Line-Line* Disable/Delta AB/Delta AC 2 to 8160 Cycles 1 Cycle 1 Cycle or 1% 0.1 V 0.01 A

*When Line-Ground to Line-Line is selected, the relay internally calculates the line-line voltages from the lineground voltages for all voltage-sensitive functions. This Line-Ground to Line-Line selection should only be used for a VT connected Line-Ground with a secondary voltage of 69 V (not 120 V).

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating. 11

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

OPTIONAL PROTECTIVE FUNCTIONS


Device Number Function

Setpoint Ranges Increment

Accuracy

Sync Check

25D Dead Check

Dead Voltage Limit Dead Time Delay


25S Sync Check

0 to 60 V 1 to 8160 Cycles 0 to 90 60 to 140 V 40 to 120 V 1.0 to 50.0 V 0.001 to 0.500 Hz 1 to 8160 Cycles

1 V 1 Cycle 1 1 V 1 V 0.1 V 0.001 Hz 1 Cycle

0.5 V or 0.5% 1 to +3 Cycles or 1% 1 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.5 V or 0.5% 0.0007 Hz or 5% 1 to +3 Cycles or 1%

25

Phase Angle Limit Upper Voltage Limit Lower Voltage Limit Delta Voltage Limit Delta Frequency Limit Sync Check Time Delay

Various combinations of input supervised hot/dead closing schemes may be selected. The 25 function cannot be enabled if the 59D function with VX or 67N function with VX is enabled.

Field Ground Protection


64F Pickup #1, #2 Time Delay #1, #2 Injection Frequency (IF) 5 to 100 K 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.10 to 1.00 Hz 1 K 1 Cycle 0.01 Hz 1 mV 1 Cycle
2 ( IF +1) Sec.

10% or 1K 2 ( IF +1) Sec.

64B

Brush Lift-Off Detection (measuring control circuit) Pickup 0 to 5000 mV Time Delay 1 to 8160 Cycles

When 64F is purchased, an external Coupler Module (M3921) is provided for isolation from dc field voltages. Figure 10, Field Ground Protection Block Diagram, illustrates a typical connection utilizing the M3921 Field Ground Coupler. Hardware dimensional and mounting information is shown in Figure 11, M3921 Field Ground Coupler Mounting Dimensions.

100% Stator Ground Protection by low frequency injection


64S Total Current Pickup Real Component of Total Current Pickup** Time Delay 2 to 75 mA 2 to 75 mA 1 to 8160 Cycles 0.1 mA 0.1 mA 1 Cycle 2 mA or 10% 2 mA or 10% 1 Cycle* or 1%

An external Low Frequency Generator, Band Pass Filter and Current Transformer are required for this function. Figure 13, 64S Function Component Connection Diagram, illustrates a typical 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Injection application. Hardware dimensional and mounting information is illustrated in Figures 14 and 15. 59D is automatically disabled when the 64S function is purchased. 59N may be applied when this function is enabled. * Time Delay accuracy in cycles is based on 20 Hz frequency. ** Operation of the real component requires voltage applied to VN input to be > 0.5 Volts at 20 Hz.

Select the greater of these accuracy values. Values in parentheses apply to 1 A CT secondary rating. 12

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Description
The M3425A Generator Protection Relay is suitable for all generator ratings and prime movers. Typical connection diagrams are illustrated in Figure 4, M3425A One-Line Functional Diagram (configured for phase differential), and Figure 5, One-Line Functional Diagram (configured for split-phase differential).

Configuration Options
The M3425A Generator Protection Relay is available in either a Base or Comprehensive package of protective functions. This provides the user with flexibility in selecting a protective system to best suit the application. Additional Optional Protective Functions may be added at the time of purchase at per-function pricing. The Human-Machine Interface (HMI) Module, Target Module, or redundant power supply can be selected at time of purchase. When the Field Ground (64F) Premium Protective Function is purchased, an external coupler module (M3921) is provided for isolation from the dc field voltages. When 100% Stator Ground (64S) protection using low-frequency injection is purchased, an external band pass filter and frequency generator is provided.

Multiple Setpoint Profiles (Groups)


The relay supports four setpoint profiles. This feature allows multiple setpoint profiles to be defined for different power system configurations or generator operating modes. Profiles can be switched either manually using the Human-Machine Interface (HMI), by communications, programmable logic or by control/status inputs. NOTE: During profile switching, relay operation is disabled for approximately 1 second.

Metering
The relay provides metering of voltages (phase, neutral and sequence quantities), currents (phase, neutral and sequence quantities), real power, reactive power, power factor and impedance measurements. Metering accuracies are: Voltage: 0.5 V or 0.5%, whichever is greater 0.8 V or 0.75%, whichever is greater (when both RMS and LineGround to LineLine are selected) Current: Power: Frequency: Volts/Hz: 5 A rating, 0.1 A or 3%, whichever is greater 1 A rating, 0.02 A or 3%, whichever is greater 0.01 PU or 2% of VA applied, whichever is greater 0.02 Hz (from 57 to 63 Hz for 60 Hz models; from 47 to 53 Hz for 50 Hz models) 0.1 Hz beyond 63 Hz for 60 Hz models, and beyond 53 Hz for 50 Hz models 1%

Oscillographic Recorder
The oscillographic recorder provides comprehensive data recording of all monitored waveforms, storing up to 416 cycles of data. The total record length is user-configurable from 1 to 16 partitions. The sampling rate is 16 times the power system nominal frequency (50 or 60 Hz). The recorder may be triggered using either the designated control/status inputs, trip outputs, or using serial communications. When untriggered, the recorder continuously stores waveform data, thereby keeping the most recent data in memory. When triggered, the recorder stores pre-trigger data, then continues to store data in memory for a user-defined, post-trigger delay period. The data records can be stored in either Beckwith Electric format or COMTRADE format. Oscillograph records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted.

Target Storage
Information associated with the last 32 trips is stored. The information includes the function(s) operated, the functions picked up, input/output status, time stamp, and phase and neutral currents at the time of trip.

13

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Sequence of Events Log


The Sequence of Events Log records relay element status, I/O status, measured values and calculated values time stamped with 1 ms resolution at user-defined events. The Sequence of Events Log includes 512 of the most recently recorded relay events. The events and the associated data is available for viewing utilizing the S 3400 IPScom Communications Software. Sequence of Events records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted.

Calculations
Current and Voltage RMS Values: Uses Discrete Fourier Transform algorithm on sampled voltage and current signals to extract fundamental frequency phasors for relay calculations. RMS calculation for the 50, 51N, 59 and 27 functions, and the 24 function are obtained using the time domain approach to obtain accuracy over a wide frequency band. When the RMS option is selected, the magnitude calculation for 59 and 27 functions is accurate over a wide frequency range (10 to 80 Hz). When the DFT option is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate near nominal frequency (50 Hz/60 Hz) but will degrade outside the nominal frequency. For 50 and 51N functions the DFT is used when the frequency is 55 Hz to 65 Hz for 60 Hz (nominal) and 45 Hz to 55Hz for 50 Hz (nominal), outside of this range RMS calculation is used.

Power Input Options


Nominal 110/120/230/240 V ac, 50/60 Hz, or nominal 110/125/220/250 V dc. Operates properly from 85 V ac to 265 V ac and from 80 V dc to 312.5 V dc. Withstands 300 V ac or 315 V dc for 1 second. Nominal burden 40 VA at 120 V ac/125 V dc. Nominal 24/48 V dc, operates properly from 18 V dc to 56 V dc, withstands 65 V dc for 1 second. Burden 25 VA at 24 V dc and 30 VA at 48 V dc. An optional redundant power supply is available for units that are purchased without the expanded I/O. For those units purchased with the expanded I/O, the unit includes two power supplies which are required to power the relay. Burden (nominal) 46 VA @120 V ac.

Sensing Inputs
Five Voltage Inputs: Rated for a nominal voltage of 50 V ac to 140 V ac at 60 Hz or 50 Hz. Will withstand 240 V continuous voltage and 360 V for 10 seconds. Source voltages may be line-to-ground or line-to-line connected. Phase sequence ABC or ACB is software selectable. Voltage transformer burden less than 0.2 VA at 120 V ac. Seven Current Inputs: Rated nominal current (IR) of 5.0 A or 1.0 A at 60 Hz or 50 Hz. Will withstand 3IR continuous current and 100IR for 1 second. Current transformer burden is less than 0.5 VA at 5 A, or 0.3VA at 1A.

Control/Status Inputs
The control/status inputs, INPUT1 through INPUT6, can be programmed to block any relay protective function, to trigger the oscillograph recorder, to operate one or more outputs or can be an input into IPSlogic. To provide breaker status LED indication on the front panel, the INPUT1 control/status input contact must be connected to the 52b breaker status contact. The minimum current value to initiate/pickup an Input is > 25 mA. The optional expanded I/O includes an additional 8 programmable control/status inputs (INPUT7 through INPUT14). CAUTION: The control/status inputs should be connected to dry contacts only, and are internally connected (wetted) with a 24 V dc power supply.

Output Contacts
Any of the functions can be individually programmed to activate any one or more of the eight programmable output contacts OUTPUT1 through OUTPUT8. Any output contact can also be selected as pulsed or latched. IPSlogic can also be used to activate an output contact. The optional expanded I/O includes an additional 15 programmable output contacts (OUTPUT9 through OUTPUT23). These contacts are configurable only using IPScom software. The eight output contacts (six form a and two form c), the power supply alarm output contact (form b), the self-test alarm output contact (form c) and the optional 15 expanded I/O output contacts (form 'a') are all rated per ANSI/IEEE C37.901989 for tripping. Make 30 A for 0.2 seconds, carry 8A, break 6A at 120 V ac, break 0.5A at 48 V dc; 0.3 A, 125 V dc; 0.2 A, 250 V dc with L/R=40 mSec.
14

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

IPSlogic
This feature can be programmed utilizing the IPScom Communications Software. IPSlogic takes the contact input status and function status, and by employing (OR, AND, and NOT) boolean logic and a timer, can activate an output or change setting profiles.

Target/Status Indicators and Controls


The RELAY OK LED reveals proper cycling of the microcomputer. The BRKR CLOSED LED will illuminate when the breaker is closed (when the 52b contact input is open). The OSC TRIG LED indicates that oscillographic data has been recorded in the unit's memory. The TARGET LED will illuminate when any of the relay functions operate. Pressing and releasing the TARGET RESET button resets the target LED if the conditions causing the operation have been removed. Holding the TARGET RESET push button displays the present pickup status of the relay functions. The PS1 and PS2 LEDs will remain illuminated as long as power is applied to the unit and the power supply is operating properly. TIME SYNC LED illuminates when valid IRIGB signal is applied and time synchronization has been established.

Communication
Communications ports include rear panel RS232 and RS-485 ports, a front panel RS-232 port, a rear-panel IRIGB port and an Ethernet port (optional). The communications protocol implements serial, byte-oriented, asynchronous communication, providing the following functions when used with the Windows-compatible S3400 IPScom Communications Software. MODBUS and BECO 2200 protocols are supported providing: Interrogation and modification of setpoints Time-stamped information for the 32 most recent trips Real-time metering of all quantities measured Downloading of recorded oscillographic data and Sequence of Events Recorder data.

The optional Ethernet port can be purchased with MODBUS over TCP/IP and BECO2200 over TCP/IP protocols or with the IEC 61850 protocol.

IRIG-B
The M3425A Generator Protection Relay can accept either modulated or demodulated IRIGB time clock synchronization signal. The IRIGB time synchronization information is used to correct the hour, minutes, seconds, and milliseconds information.

HMI Module (optional)


Local access to the relay is provided through an optional M-3931 HMI (Human-Machine Interface) Module, allowing for easy-to-use, menu-driven access to all functions utilizing six pushbuttons and a 2-line by 24 character alphanumeric vacuum florescent display. Features of the HMI Module include : User-definable access codes that allow three levels of security Interrogation and modification of setpoints Time-stamped information for the 32 most recent trips Real-time metering of all quantities measured

Target Module (optional)


An optional M-3925A Target Module provides 24 target and 8 output LEDs. Appropriate target LEDs will illuminate when the corresponding function operates. The targets can be reset with the TARGET RESET pushbutton. The OUTPUT LEDs indicate the status of the programmable output relays.

15

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Temperature Controller Monitoring


Any Temperature Controller equipped with a contact output may be connected to the M-3425A and controlled by the relay's programmable IPSlogic function. Figure 1 is an example of a typical Temperature Controller Monitoring application. The Omron E5C2 Temperature Controller is a DIN rail mounted RTD interface to the M-3425A Generator Protection relay. The E5C2 accepts type J or K thermocouples, platinum RTDs or thermistors as its input. Supply voltage for the E5C2 accepts 110/120 V ac, 50/60 Hz, or 220/240 V ac 50/60 Hz or 24 V dc.

Temperature Controller R1 C R2 Omron E5C2 P.D. 750 or equivalent IN X

M-3425A

Alarm/Trip IN RTN

IPSlogic

Figure 1 Typical Temperature Controller Monitoring Application

I/O Expansion (optional)


Optional I/O Expansion provides an additional 15 form 'a' output contacts and an additional 8 control/status inputs. Output LEDs indicate the status of the output relays.

Tests and Standards


The relay complies with the following type tests and standards:

Voltage Withstand
Dielectric Withstand
IEC 60255-5 3,500 V dc for 1 minute applied to each independent circuit to earth 3,500 V dc for 1 minute applied between each independent circuit 1,500 V dc for 1 minute applied to IRIG-B circuit to earth 1,500 V dc for 1 minute applied between IRIG-B to each independent circuit 1,500 V dc for 1 minute applied between RS-485 to each independent circuit

Impulse Voltage
IEC 60255-5 5,000 V pk, +/- polarity applied to each independent circuit to earth 5,000 V pk, +/- polarity applied between each independent circuit 1.2 by 50 s, 500 ohms impedance, three surges at 1 every 5 seconds

Insulation Resistance
IEC 60255-5 > 100 Megaohms

16

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Electrical Environment
Electrostatic Discharge Test
EN 60255-22-2 Class 4 (8 kV)point contact discharge EN 60255-22-2 Class 4 (15kV)air discharge

Fast Transient Disturbance Test


EN 60255-22-4 Class A (4 kV, 2.5 kHz)

Surge Withstand Capability


ANSI/IEEE C37.90.1- 1989 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied to each independent circuit to earth 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied between each independent circuit 5,000 V pk Fast Transient applied to each independent circuit to earth 5,000 V pk Fast Transient applied between each independent circuit

ANSI/IEEE 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied to each independent circuit to earth C37.90.1- 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied between each independent circuit 2002 4,000 V pk Fast Transient burst applied to each independent circuit to earth 4,000 V pk Fast Transient burst applied between each independent circuit NOTE: The signal is applied to the digital data circuits (RS-232, RS485, IRIG-B, Ethernet communication port and field ground coupling port) through capacitive coupling clamp.

Radiated Susceptibility
ANSI/IEEE C37.90.2 25-1000 Mhz @ 35 V/m

Output Contacts
ANSI/IEEE C37.90.0 Make 30 A for 0.2 seconds, off for 15 seconds for 2,000 operations, per Section 6.7.1, Tripping Output Performance Requirements

Atmospheric Environment
Temperature
IEC60068-2-1 Cold, 20 C IEC60068-2-2 Dry Heat, +70 C IEC60068-2-3 Damp Heat, +40 C @ 93% RH

Mechanical Environment
Vibration
IEC60255-21-1 Vibration response Class 1, 0.5 g Vibration endurance Class 1, 1.0 g IEC60255-21-2 Shock Response Class 1, 5.0 g Shock Withstand Class 1, 15.0 g Bump Endurance Class 1, 10.0 g

17

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Compliance
UL-Listed per 508 Industrial Control Equipment UL-Listed Component per 508A Table SA1.1 Industrial Control Panels CSA-Certified per C22.2 No. 14-95 Industrial Control Equipment CE Safety Directive EN61010-1:2001, CAT II, Pollution Degree 2

Physical
Without Optional Expanded I/O Size: 19.00" wide x 5.21" high x 10.20" deep (48.3 cm x 13.2 cm x 25.9 cm) Mounting: The unit is a standard 19", semiflush, three-unit high, rack-mount panel design, conforming to ANSI/ EIA RS-310C and DIN 41494 Part 5 specifications. Vertical or horizontal panel-mount options are available. Approximate Weight: 17 lbs (7.7 kg) Approximate Shipping Weight: 25 lbs (11.3 kg) With Optional Expanded I/O Size: 19.00" wide x 6.96" high x 10.2" deep (48.3 cm x 17.7 cm x 25.9 cm) Mounting: The unit is a standard 19", semiflush, four-unit high, rack-mount panel design, conforming to ANSI/ EIA RS-310C and DIN 41494 Part 5 specifications. Vertical or horizontal panel-mount options are available. Approximate Weight: 19 lbs (8.6 kg) Approximate Shipping Weight: 26 lbs (11.8 kg)

Recommended Storage Parameters


Temperature: 5 C to 40 C Humidity: Maximum relative humidity 80% for temperatures up to 31 C, decreasing to 31 C linearly to 50% relative humidity at 40 C. Environment: Storage area to be free of dust, corrosive gases, flammable materials, dew, percolating water, rain and solar radiation. See M-3425A Instruction Book, Appendix E, Layup and Storage for additional information.

Patent & Warranty


The M3425A Generator Protection Relay is covered by U.S. Patents 5,592,393 and 5,224,011. The M3425A Generator Protection Relay is covered by a five year warranty from date of shipment. Specification subject to change without notice.

External Connections
M3425A external connection points are illustrated in Figures 2 and 3.

18

2
BECKW IT H ELECT RIC CO . INC.
MODEL: M-3425A 5 0 Hz 20 21 23 29 30 31 32 27 22 24 28 25 26 33 6 0 Hz S ERIA L NO . 34 FIRMWARE: D-0150

US

8 3 F4 L IS T ED IND.CO NT .EQ

NRT L / C LR 8 9 4 6 4

6 19 0 118 t h AV E NO . 727- 5 4 4 - 23 26 L A RGO , FL 3 3 7 7 3


7 8 9 19 12 13 18 14 17 10 11 15 16

W A RNING! CO NT A CT W IT H T ERMINA L S MA Y CA US E EL ECT RIC S HO CK FO R CO NT A CT RA T INGS S EE INS T RUCT IO N MA NUA L U. S. PATENTS 5,592,393, 5,224,011

1 2 3 4

5 6

IRIG- B COM2 ETHERNET

COM 2 RS 2 3 2

!
A UX RS 4 8 5 COM 3

1
VA B VB C VC A

24 48 125 250

+
IN 6 IN 4 IN 5 IN 3 IN 2

+ INPUTS
VN IA IN Ib Ic Ia IB IC

IN 1 (5 2 b)

!
P/ S

IN RT N

A LA RMS

S ELF- T EST 8

OUT PUTS

F IE L D G N D COUPLER

V V C B V

+
59 60
18 - 5 6 85 265

PS 2

PS 1

62 63

PS2 F1 F2

PS1

4
39 49
0 .0 1A NO M

35 40 42 43 64 44 48 64S 47 41

36 53

37

38

45 46 50 52 56 58 65

64F
RA T ED V O L T A GE 6 0 - 14 0 V A C,5 0 / 6 0 Hz 1A ,NO M RAT ED CURRENT 5 A ,NO M

VX

51

54

55

57

61

3 A MP,2 5 0 V ( 3 A B)
18 - 5 6 85 265

F3

F4

19

Figure 2 External Connections (Without Optional Expanded I/O)

NOTES: 1. See M3425A Instruction Book Section 2.3, Setpoints and Time Settings, subsection for 64B/F Field Ground Protection. 2. Before making connections to the Trip Circuit Monitoring input, see M3425A Instruction Book Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers, for the information regarding setting Trip Circuit Monitoring input voltage. Connecting a voltage other than the voltage that the unit is configured to may result in mis-operation or permanent damage to the unit. 3. 8WARNING: ONLY DRY CONTACTS must be connected to inputs (terminals 5 through 10 with 11 common) because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units. 4. 8 WARNING: The protective grounding terminal must be connected to an earthed ground any time external connections have been made to the unit.

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

BECKW IT H ELECT RIC CO . INC.


MODEL: M-3425A 5 0 Hz 6 0 Hz S ERIA L NO . W A RNING! CO NT A CT W IT H T ERMINA L S MA Y CA US E EL ECT RIC S HO CK FO R CO NT A CT RA T INGS S EE INS T RUCT IO N MA NUA L U. S. PATENTS 5,592,393, 5,224,011 FIRMWARE: D-0150

6 19 0 118 t h AV E NO . 727- 5 4 4 - 23 26 L A RGO , FL 3 3 7 7 3


76 77 78 84 94 95 96 97 98 99 88 89 92 83 86 87 93 85 79 80 81 82 91 101 90 100 102

66 70 71 72 73 74 75

67

68

69

103

104

105

IN RT N

IN 14

IN 13

IN 12

IN 11

IN 10

IN 9

IN 8

IN 7

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

US

2
1 2 9 13 18 3 4 7 8 21 23 24 10 11 17 14 19 5 6 20 22 16 25 26 12 15 27

83F4 LIST ED IND. CONT . EQ .

INPUTS OUT PUTS

23 21 19 13 17 15

22

20 18

16 14

12
28 29

11
30 31

10
32 33

9
34

IRIG- B

1
24 48 125 250

COM 2 RS 2 3 2

COM 2 ETHERNET A UX VB C VC A RS 4 8 5 COM 3

!
A IN Ia Ib V C VN IA IB IC B V

+
IN 6 IN 5 IN 4 IN 3 IN 2

+ INPUTS
IN 1 (5 2 b)

!
P/ S

IN RT N

F IE L D G N D COUPLER

VA B

A LA RMS

S ELF- T EST 8

7
Ic

OUT PUTS

4
PS 2 PS 1

2 PS2

1 PS1

20
39 64
0 .0 1A NO M

+
57 58 59

60
18 - 5 6 85 265

+
61

62 63
18 - 5 6 85 265

F1

F2
3 A MP,2 5 0 V ( 3 A B)

35 40 42 43 49 64S 48 41 44 47

36 53

37

38

45 46 50 52 65

64F

VX

51 54

55

56

F3
5 A ,NO M

F4

4
RA T ED V O L T A GE 6 0 - 14 0 V A C,5 0 / 6 0 Hz 1A ,NO M

RAT ED CURRENT

Figure 3 External Connections (With Optional Expanded I/O)

NOTES: 1. See M3425A Instruction Book Section 2.3, Setpoints and Time Settings, subsection for 64B/F Field Ground Protection. 2. Before making connections to the Trip Circuit Monitoring input, see M3425A Instruction Book Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers, for the information regarding setting Trip Circuit Monitoring input voltage. Connecting a voltage other than the voltage that the unit is configured to may result in mis-operation or permanent damage to the unit. 3. 8WARNING: ONLY DRY CONTACTS must be connected to inputs (terminals 5 through 10 with 11 common and terminals 68 through 75 with 66 and 67 common) because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units. 4. 8 WARNING: The protective grounding terminal must be connected to an earthed ground any time external connections have been made to the unit.

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

M-3425A Typical Connection Diagram

These functions are available in the Comprehensive Package. A subset of these functions are also available in a Base Package. This function is available as a optional protective function. This function provides control for the function to which it points.

Utility System
52 Unit

M-3425A
Targets (Optional) Integral HMI (Optional) Metering Waveform Capture IRIG-B Front RS232 Communication Rear RS232 Communication Rear Ethernet Port (Optional) Rear RS-485 Communication Multiple Setting Groups 81R 81A 81 87

BFPh

50

50 DT

CT

VT (Note 1)

CT (Residual) (Note 4)

25
VT

52 Gen

27

59

24

M
(Metering) VT (Note 1)

(Note 3)

59X

M-3921
+

Programmable I/O
27

64F

64B

Self Diagnostics Dual Power Supply (Optional) Breaker Monitoring Trip Circuit Monitoring Event Log
3VO (Calculated) 59D Line Side Voltage (Software Select) VX VN 67N Polarization (Software Select)

78

60 FL

51V

50/27

40

32

21

50

49

46

M
(Metering)

CT

3VO (Calculated)

67N Operating Current (Software Select) IN

67N
3 IO

50 BFN

50N

51N

(Note 5) VX

27

59D
32

27 TN

64S

59N

87 GD
R

50 BFN

50N

51N
R

CT (Neutral) (Notes 2 & 5)

High-impedance Grounding with Third Harmonic 100% Ground Fault Protection

Low-impedance Grounding with Ground Differential and Overcurrent Stator Ground Fault Protection

NOTES: 1. When 25 function is enabled, 59X, 59D with VX and 67N with VX are not available, and vice versa. 2. When 67N function with IN (Residual) operating current is enabled, 87GD is not available, and vice versa. 3. When VT source is used as a turn-to-turn fault protection device (See M-3425A Instruction Book, Chapter 2, Application, for additional 59X applications.) 4. The current input IN can be connected either from neutral current or residual current. 5. The 50BFN, 50N, 51N, 59D, 67N (with IN or VN) and 87GD functions are unavailable when the 64S function has been purchased. See the M-3425A Instruction Book for connection details.

Figure 4 OneLine Functional Diagram (Configured with Phase Differential)

21

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

M-3425A Typical Connection Diagram


(Configured for Split-Phase Differential)

These functions are available in the Comprehensive Package. A subset of these functions are also available in a Base Package. This function is available as a optional protective function. This function provides control for the function to which it points.

Utility System
52 Unit

M-3425A
Targets (Optional) Integral HMI (Optional) Metering Waveform Capture 81R IRIG-B
(Metering)

VT (Note 1) CT (Residual) (Note 5)

25
VT

52 Gen

81A

81

59

27

24

M 50 DT
CT (Note 3)

Front RS232 Communication Rear RS232 Communication Rear Ethernet Port (Optional) Rear RS-485 Communication Multiple Setting Groups Programmable I/O Self Diagnostics Dual Power Supply (Optional) Breaker Monitoring Trip Circuit Monitoring Event Log
3VO (Calculated) VX VN 67N Polarization (Software Select) 27 (Note 2)

VT (Note 1)

59X

M-3921
+

64F

64B

78

60FL

51V

50/27

40

32

21

50

49

46

M
(Metering)

CT

(Note 4)

67N

VX 59D Line Side Voltage (Software Select)

3VO (Calculated)

27

50N 27 TN 64S 59N


R

51N

CT

CT (Neutral) (Note 5) R

59D
32

High-impedance Grounding with Third Harmonic 100% Ground Fault Protection

Low-impedance Grounding with Overcurrent Stator Ground Fault Protection

NOTES: 1. When 25 function is enabled, 59X, 59D with VX and 67N with VX are not available, and vice versa. 2. When used as a turn-turn fault protection device. 3. CTs are connected for split-phase differential current. 4. 67N operating current can only be selected to IN (Residual) for this configuration. 5. The current input (IN) can be connected either from neutral current or residual current. 6. The 50BFN, 50N, 51N, 59D, 67N (with IN or VN) and 87GD functions are unavailable when the 64S function has been purchased. See the M-3425A Instruction Book for connection details.

Figure 5 OneLine Functional Diagram (configured for split-phase differential)


22

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

17.50 [44.45] ACTUAL

5.21 [13.23] ACTUAL

17.50 [44.45]

10.20 [25.91]

19.00 [48.26]

19.00 [48.26] 18.31 [46.51] 0.35 [0.89] 0.40 [1.02] X 0.27 [0.68] Slot (4X) 2.25 [5.72] 1.48 [3.76]

Standard 19" Horizontal Mount Chassis NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

NOTES: 1. Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters. 2. See Instruction Book Chapter 5 for Mounting and Cutout information.

Figure 6 Horizontal Unit Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H1)

23

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

5.65 [14.40] 5.59 [14.20] Actual 2.25 [5.72] 0.03 [0.076] 1.67 [4.24]

0.35 [0.89]

2.25 [5.72]

1.67 [4.24] 0.28 [0.71] Dia. (4X)

TARGETS

19.00 [48.26]

OUTPUTS
OUT 1 OUT 3 OUT 5 OUT 7

18.31 [46.51]

OUT 2

OUT 4

OUT 6

OUT 8

17.5 [44.45] ACTUAL 17.68 [44.91]


EXIT ENTER

TARGET RESET

PS 2

PS 1

TARGET

DIAG

BRKR CLOSED RELAY OK

OSC. TRIG

TIME SYNC

COM 1

Recommended cutout when relay is not used as standard rack mount and is panel cut out mounted.
17.50 [44.45]

10.20 [25.91]

19.00 [48.26]

NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

NOTES: 1. Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters. 2. See Instruction Book Chapter 5 for Mounting and Cutout information.

Figure 7 Vertical Unit Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H2)


24

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

!
35 64F

COM 2 E T HE RNE T

IRIG - B

TARGETS

36

FIELD GROUND COUPLER


R

37

COM 2 RS 2 3 2

38
RA T E D V O L T A G E 6 0 - 14 0 V A C ,5 0 / 6 0 Hz

NRTL /C LR 89464

B EC K W IT H E L ECT R IC C O . INC .

6 19 0 118 t h AV E NO . 727- 54 4 - 23 26 L A RG O , F L 3 3 7 7 3

VA B 39
24 48 125 250

40

VB C 41

A UX

2 3 4
5

42

VC A

RS 4 8 5 COM 3

OUTPUTS
OUT 1 OUT 2 OUT 3 OUT 4 OUT 5 OUT 6 OUT 7 OUT 8
64

43

44

IN6 IN5

6 7 8 9 10

VX

VN INPUT S

IN4 IN3

W A RNING ! C O NT A C T W IT H T E RM INA L S M A Y C A US E E L E C T RIC S HO C K F O R C O NT A C T RA T ING S S E E INS T RUC T IO N M A NUA L U.S. PATENT 5,592,393, 5,224,011

65 45

IN2 IN1
46

(5 2 b)

IA
47

!
IN RT N
P/ S
11 12 13

48

IB
49
1A ,NO M RAT E D C URRE NT
0 .0 1A NO M

50

I C A LA RMS
51 14

52
64S

SELFT EST

15 16 17

IN
53

EXIT

ENTER

54

Ia
55
5 A ,NO M

18 19 20

56

Ib
57

MODEL: M-3425A

21
5 0 Hz

22

TARGET RESET PS 2 PS 1

58

Ic
59

OUT PUT S
23

6
6 0 Hz

24 60

18 - 5 6 8 5 -2 6 5

TARGET

DIAG

61

PS 2

25

5
26 27

FIRMWARE: D-0150

BRKR CLOSED RELAY OK

OSC. TRIG TIME SYNC

62

18 - 5 6 8 5- 265

PS 1
63

4
28 29

S E RIA L NO .

30

F3
COM 1

F1
31

PS 2

2
32 33

M-3425A GENERATOR PROTECTION


R

F4

3 A MP, 250V, (3A B)

F2 PS 1

1
34

Figure 8 M-3425A Vertical Unit Layout


25

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

0.35 [0.89]

18.31 [46.51]

NOTES: 1. Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters. 2. See Instruction Book Chapter 5 for Mounting and Cutout information.

Figure 9 Horizontal and Vertical Unit Dimensions With Expanded I/O (H5 and H6)

26

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

! IRIG-B 35 64F
F I E L D

B E C K W IT H E L E C T R IC C O . INC . 72 7 - 5 4 4 - 2 3 2 6

TARGETS
23

36 37 38

C O U P L GE N R D

COM 2 ETHERNET

IN RTN COM 2 RS232 IN 14 IN 13 I IN 12 N P IN 11 U T IN 10 S IN 9 IN 8 IN 7

66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74

US

22
RATED VOLTAGE 60-140VAC 50/60Hz U.S. PATENT 5,592,393 5,224,011

39 40 41 42 43 44 64 VX 65

V A VA B

LIST ED IND. CONT . EQ . 83F4 24 48 125 250

21

V B V BC

AUX

+ +

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10

20

RS485 V COM 3 C V CA

6 19 0 118 t h AVE NO. LA RGO, FL 3 3 77 3

OUTPUTS
19
OUT 1 OUT 2 OUT 3 OUT 4 OUT 5 OUT 6 OUT 7 OUT 8

75 76

IN 6 IN 5 IN 4

23
77 78

18

17

45 46 IA 47 48

I N P U T S

IN 3 IN 2 IN 1 (52b) ! IN RT N

22
79 80

21
81

WARNING!CONTACTWITHTERMINALSMAYCAUSEELECTRICSHOCK FOR CONTACT RATINGS SEE INSTRUCTIONAL MANUAL

82

20
83

O U T P U T S

IB 49 50 IC 51 52 I N

11 19 12

84 85 86

64S 0.01A NOM

P/S A L A R S T M E E S L S F T

13 18 14 15 17 16 17 O U T P U T S 16

87 88 89

53 54 EXIT 16 ENTER Ia
RATED CURRENT 1A ,N O M 5 A, N O M

18 19 20

55 56 Ib 57 58 7

90 91

21 22 15
93 92 94

15 TARGET RESET PS 1
18 - 5 6 8 5 - 26 5

MODEL: M-3425A 50Hz 60Hz

Ic 59 60 61 62 6

23 24 14

14

PS 2 13 TARGET 12

95 96

+
PS2

DIAG
18 - 5 6 8 5 - 26 5

+
PS1

BRKR CLOSED RELAY OK

OSC. TRIG TIME SYNC

63

O U T P U T S

25 5 26 27 4 28 29 3 12 13

97 98

FIRMWARE: D-0150 SERIAL NO.

99 100

11

F3 10

F1 PS 2 3AMP 250V (3AB) 2

30 31

11
101 102

COM 1 9

M-3425A GENERATOR PROTECTION


. R

32 33 1 34

10
103 104

F4

F2 PS 1

9
105

BECKWITH CO. INC ELECTRIC Made in U.S.A.

NOTES: 1. The M-3425A Expanded I/O vertical panel is the same physical size as the M-3425A Expanded I/O horizontal panel. See Figure 7 for dimennsions. 2. See Instruction Book Section 5 for Mounting and Cutout information.

Figure 10 M-3425A Expanded I/O Vertical Unit Layout

27

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

M3921 Field Ground Coupler


PROTECTION RELAY M-3425A

PROCESSOR

Excitation System Field Ground Detection Squarewave Generator

Brushes

Gen. Rotor

Signal Measurement and Processing

COUPLING NETWORK (M-3921)


Shaft Ground Brush

Ground/Machine Frame

Figure 11 Field Ground Protection Block Diagram


NOTES: 1. The above circuit measures insulation resistance (Rf) between rotor field winding and ground (64F). 2. Relay injects 15 V squarewave (Vout) and measures return signal (Vf) to calculate Rf. 3. The injection frequency can be set (0.1 to 1.0 Hz) based on the rotor capacitance, in order to improve accuracy. 4. The signal rise time is analyzed to determine if shaft brushes are lifting or open (64B). 5. May also be applied on generators with brushless excitation with a grounding brush and pilot ground fault detection brush.

Function Specification
Field/Exciter Supply Voltage Rating (Terminal (3) to (2)): 60 to 1200 V dc, continuous 1500 V dc, 1 minute Operating Temperature: 20 to +70, Centigrade

Patent & Warranty


The M3921 Field Ground Coupler is covered by a five-year warranty from date of shipment.

28

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Tests and Standards


M3921 Field Ground Coupler complies with the following tests and standards:

Voltage Withstand
Isolation
5 kV ac for 1 minute, all terminals to case

Impulse Voltage
IEC 602555, 5,000 V pk, 1.2 by 50 s, 0.5 J, 3 positive and 3 negative impulses at 5 second intervals per minute

Electrical Interference
Electrostatic Discharge Test
EN 60255-22-2 Class 4 (8 kV) point contact discharge Class 4 (15 kV) air discharge

Fast Transient Disturbance Tests


IEC 61000-4-4 Class 4 (4 kV, 2.5 kHz)

Surge Withstand Capability


ANSI/IEEE C37.90.1- 1989 ANSI/IEEE C37.90.1- 2002 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied to each independent circuit to earth 2,500 V pk-pk applied between each independent circuit 5,000 V pk Fast Transient applied to each independent circuit to earth 5,000 V pk Fast Transient applied between each independent circuit 2,500 V pk-pk oscillatory applied to each independent circuit to earth 2,500 V pk-pk applied between each independent circuit 4,000 V pk Fast Transient applied to each independent circuit to earth 4,000 V pk Fast Transient applied between each independent circuit

NOTE: The signal is applied to the digital data circuits (RS-232, RS-485, IRIG-B, Ethernet communication port and field ground coupling port) through capacitive coupling clamp.

Radiated Susceptibility
ANSI/IEEE C37.90.2 25-1000 Mhz @ 35 V/m

Atmospheric Environment
IEC 6006821 Cold, 20 C IEC 6006822 Dry Heat, +70 C IEC 6006823 Damp Heat, +40 C @ 93% RH

Enclosure Protection
NEMA I3, IP65C

29

7.87 [19.99] 2.96 REF [7.52]

3.54 [9.0]

M-3921
Field Ground Coupler
BECKWIT H EL ECT RIC CO. INC.

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

4.72 [11.99]

Made in U.S.A.

Figure 12 M3921 Field Ground Coupler Mounting Dimensions


9.06 [23.01]

30
.18 DIA [0.46] 4 X .18 DIA [0.46] 4 HOLES 3.54 [9.0] nNOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

7.40 [18.79]

MOUNTING PATTERN WITHOUT TABS

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Signal Injection


NOTE: The Stator Ground Protection function (64S) must be selected when the M3425A is initially ordered. The 100% stator ground fault protection is provided by injecting an external 20 Hz signal into the neutral of the generator. The protection is provided when the machine is on-line as well as off-line (provided that the 20 Hz generator and relay are powered on.) This scheme requires the following external components in addition to M-3425A protection system: 20 Hz Signal-generator (BECO Surface Mount/Flush Part No. 43000426)(Siemens 7XT33) Band-pass filter (BECO Surface Mount/Flush Part No. 43000427)(Siemens 7XT34) 20 Hz Measuring Current Transfor mer, 400/5 A CT (BECO Par t No. 43000428) (ITI-CTW3-60-T50-401)

The voltage signal generated by the 20 Hz signal-generator is injected into the secondary of the generator neutral grounding transformer through a band-pass filter. The band-pass filter passes the 20 Hz signal and rejects outofband signals. The output of the 20 Hz band-pass filter is connected to the VN input of the M-3425A relay through a suitable voltage divider, that limits the M3425A to O 200 V ac (the voltage generator may be bypassed if the expected 50/60 Hz voltage during a phase-to-ground fault of the generator is O200 V.) The 20Hz current is also connected to the IN input of the M3425A, through the 20Hz current transformer. When the generator is operating normally (no ground fault) only a small amount of 20 Hz current will flow as a result of the stator capacitance to ground. When a ground fault occurs anywhere on the generator stator windings the 20 Hz current will increase. The 64S function will issue a trip signal after a set time delay when the measured 20 Hz current exceeds the pickup current. For cases where the Load Resistor (RN) is small, the Undervoltage Inhibit should not be enabled, as the voltage will be small. The 59N function (90 to 95%) should also be used in conjunction with 64S protection to provide backup.

31

20 Hz Generator
DC 1 2 11 3 6 Neutral Grounding Transformer 1A1 1A3 1A4 1A2 Bl 8 7 RN K 12 k 400/5 A 20 Hz CT High* Voltage Max. 200 V 44
59N

Supply Voltage 100-230 VAC** L1 L2

Connection terminals for Model A00/EE shown.


UH+ UH-

20 Hz Band Pass Filter


1B1 1B4

L3

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

+ _
External Block Error 9 5 4 Device Operative L+

400A 5A L l Wiring Shielded

Figure 13 64S Function Component Connection Diagram (Model A00/EE 20 Hz Signal Generator)

32

M-3425A 45

VN
52 53

IN

* For applications with a transformer secondary rating that will result in 50/60 Hz phase ground fault voltages >200 V ac, use the "High Voltage" connection for the 59N Function. ** If 20 Hz Signal Generator is prior to Model EE a step down transformer is necessary for voltages >120 VAC.

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

20 Hz Signal Generator Function Specifications


Auxiliary Voltage
Rated auxiliary voltage UH ac Permissible variations ac OR Rated auxiliary voltage UH dc Permissible Variations dc 110 to 220 V dc 88 to 250 V dc 3x (100/120 V ac), 50/60 Hz 1x (100 to 120 V ac), 50/60 Hz 88 to 230 V ac

Permissible consumption at 8 Ohm impendance O100 VA NOTE: 230 VAC is permissible for commissioning only, which is limited in time.

20 Hz Output Voltage
Connections (11 and 12) Output Voltage Power Output, permanently approx. 26 V 10 %, rectangular; 20 Hz 0.1 Hz 100 VA over all ranges

NOTE: Output is not resistant to short-circuits.

Binary Input for Blocking


Connections (6 and 8) Switching Threshold 24 V 48 V 60 V Adjustable voltage range with jumper DC 19 V: Uhigh P DC 19 V, Ulow O DC 10 V For control voltages For control voltages

110 V 125 V 220 V 250 V

DC 88 V: Uhigh P DC 88 V, Ulow O DC 44 V

Permissible voltage, continuous

300 V dc

Life Contact
Connections (5, 7 and 9) Switching capacity MAKE BREAK Switching voltage Permissible current 30W/VA 20 VA 30 W resistance load 25 W @ L/R O 50 ms DC 24 V to DC 250 V AC 24 to AC 230 V 1 A permanent

Permissible Ambient Temperatures


RL describes the load resistance at the Band Pass output. with RL <5 Ohm with RL >5 Ohm O550C or O1310F O700C or O1580F

NOTE: With maximum power output, the device has a power loss of approximately 24 W. To ensure unhindered heat dissipation through the vent holes, the distance to other devices located at the top and bottom must be at least 100 mm. This device must therefore always be mounted in the bottom part of the cabinet.
33

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Dimensions in mm

NOTE: Detailed Mounting information is contained in the M-3425A Instruction Book Chapter 5, Installation Section 5.6.

Figure 14 20Hz Signal Generator Dimensions

34

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

Band-pass Filter Specifications


Load Capacity of the 20 Hz Band-pass Filter
Connections (1B1-1B4) Permissible voltage, continuous Permissible voltage for O30 s 55 V ac 550 V ac

Frequency of superimposed ac voltage P 45 Hz Overload capability, continuous Test Voltage

3.25 A ac 2.8 kV dc

Load Capability of the Voltage Divider Circuit


Connections (1A1-1A4): Permissible voltage, continuous Permissible voltage for O30 s Test Voltage 55 V ac 50 V ac 2.8 kV dc

Permissible Ambient Temperatures


with RL <5 burden with RL >5 burden

O400C or O 1040F O550C or O 1310F

NOTE: The device may produce up to 75 W power losses during service. In order to prevent heat pockets, the dissipation of the losses must not be restricted. The minimum clearance above and below the device to other units or walls is 100 mm or 4 inches. In cubicles, the device shall be installed in the bottom area.

35

M3425A Generator Protection Relay

NOTE: Detailed Mounting information is contained in the M-3425A Instruction Book Chapter 5, Installation Section 5.

Figure 15 Band-pass Filter Dimensions

Figure 16 20 Hz Measuring Current Transformer 400-5 A CT


36

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

2001 Beckwith Electric Co. All Rights Reserved. Printed in U.S.A. (#01-67) (04.25.03)

800-3425A-SP-10MC207/12

injury, are present on the external terminals and inside the equipment. Use extreme caution and follow all safety rules when handling, testing or adjusting the equipment. However, these internal voltage levels are no greater than the voltages applied to the external terminals.

DANGEROUS VOLTAGES, capable of causing death or serious

WARNING

DANGER! HIGH VOLTAGE


This sign warns that the area is connected to a dangerous high voltage, and you must never touch it.

PERSONNEL SAFETY PRECAUTIONS


The following general rules and other specific warnings throughout the manual must be followed during application, test or repair of this equipment. Failure to do so will violate standards for safety in the design, manufacture, and intended use of the product. Qualified personnel should be the only ones who operate and maintain this equipment. Beckwith Electric Co., Inc. assumes no liability for the customers failure to comply with these requirements.

This sign means that you should refer to the corresponding section of the operation manual for important information before proceeding.

Always Ground the Equipment


To avoid possible shock hazard, the chassis must be connected to an electrical ground. When servicing equipment in a test area, the Protective Earth Terminal must be attached to a separate ground securely by use of a tool, since it is not grounded by external connectors.

Do NOT operate in an explosive environment


Do not operate this equipment in the presence of flammable or explosive gases or fumes. To do so would risk a possible fire or explosion.

Keep away from live circuits


Operating personnel must not remove the cover or expose the printed circuit board while power is applied. In no case may components be replaced with power applied. In some instances, dangerous voltages may exist even when power is disconnected. To avoid electrical shock, always disconnect power and discharge circuits before working on the unit.

Exercise care during installation, operation, & maintenance procedures


The equipment described in this manual contains voltages high enough to cause serious injury or death. Only qualified personnel should install, operate, test, and maintain this equipment. Be sure that all personnel safety procedures are carefully followed. Exercise due care when operating or servicing alone.

Do not modify equipment


Do not perform any unauthorized modifications on this instrument. Return of the unit to a Beckwith Electric repair facility is preferred. If authorized modifications are to be attempted, be sure to follow replacement procedures carefully to assure that safety features are maintained.

PRODUCT CAUTIONS
Before attempting any test, calibration, or maintenance procedure, personnel must be completely familiar with the particular circuitry of this unit, and have an adequate understanding of field effect devices. If a component is found to be defective, always follow replacement procedures carefully to that assure safety features are maintained. Always replace components with those of equal or better quality as shown in the Parts List of the Instruction Book.

Avoid static charge


This unit contains MOS circuitry, which can be damaged by improper test or rework procedures. Care should be taken to avoid static charge on work surfaces and service personnel.

Use caution when measuring resistances


Any attempt to measure resistances between points on the printed circuit board, unless otherwise noted in the Instruction Book, is likely to cause damage to the unit.

NOTE
The following features, described in this Instruction Book, are only available for firmware version D-0150-V01.00.34 and later: 59N 20 Hz Injection Mode (Page 2-58) IEEE curves for 51N, 51V, and 67N functions (Appendix D) Sequence of Events Recorder (Page 4-18) Dropout/Reset Time Delay added to IPSlogic (Page 2-91) Response Time Delay for Communications (Page 4-3) 25 Function (does not produce a target) (Page 2-21)

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS
M-3425A Generator Protection Instruction Book

Chapter 1 Introduction
1.1 Instruction Book Contents.............................................................................11 M-3425A Generator Protection Relay............................................................12 Communication Ports....................................................................................13 S-3400 IPScom Communications Software...................................................14 1.2

1.3 Accessories...................................................................................................14 M3925A Target Module................................................................................14 M3931 HumanMachine Interface (HMI) Module..........................................15 M3801D IPSplot Plus Oscillograph Analysis Software...............................15 M3933/M0423 Serial Communications Cable.............................................15 M3949 Redundant Low Voltage Power Supply.............................................15 M3948 Redundant High Voltage Power Supply............................................15

Chapter 2 Operation
2.1 2.2 Front Panel Controls and Indicators................................................................... 23 Alphanumeric Display......................................................................................... 23 Screen Blanking................................................................................................. 23 Arrow Pushbuttons............................................................................................. 23 EXIT Pushbutton................................................................................................ 23 ENTER Pushbutton............................................................................................ 23 RELAY OK LED.................................................................................................. 23 Time Sync LED................................................................................................... 23 Breaker Closed (BRKR CLOSED) LED.............................................................. 23 Diagnostic LED (DIAG)....................................................................................... 23 Oscillograph Triggered LED................................................................................ 23 Power Supply (PS1) and (PS2) LEDs................................................................ 24 Target LED.......................................................................................................... 24 M-3925A Target Module and Target Reset Pushbutton...................................... 24 Operation (HMI/PC)............................................................................................ 25 System Priority................................................................................................... 25 HMI Operation Overview.................................................................................... 25 Default Message Screens................................................................................... 25 HMI Security....................................................................................................... 26 Status Monitoring (From Relay Front Panel)....................................................... 28 Status Monitoring (From IPScom).................................................................... 29 PRIMARY METERING & STATUS...................................................................... 29 SECONDARY METERING & STATUS............................................................. 211 Monitor/Secondary Metering and Status.......................................................... 211 VIEW TARGET HISTORY................................................................................. 213 Time and Date Stamping.................................................................................. 213 View Target History (From IPScom)............................................................... 215 View Targets..................................................................................................... 215

M-3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 2 Operation (Cont.'d)


Clear Targets.................................................................................................... 216 Oscillograph Recorder Data............................................................................. 216 Oscillograph Recorder (From IPScom)............................................................. 219 Retrieve Oscillograph Records......................................................................... 219 Trigger Oscillograph.......................................................................................... 220 Clear Oscillograph Records.............................................................................. 220 Software Version (Relay Front Panel only)....................................................... 221 Serial Number (Relay Front Panel only)........................................................... 221 Alter Access Codes (From Relay Front Panel)................................................. 222 Alter User Access Codes (From IPScom)...................................................... 224 Comm Access Codes....................................................................................... 224 User Access Codes.......................................................................................... 225 User Access Codes.......................................................................................... 225 System Error Codes, Output and Alarm Counters........................................... 226 Clear Output Counters (Relay Front Panel)...................................................... 226 Clear Alarm Counters (Relay Front Panel)....................................................... 227 Clear Error Codes (Relay Front Panel)............................................................. 228 Resetting Counters (From IPScom).................................................................. 229 Tools/Counters and Error Codes...................................................................... 229 Relay/Sequence of Events/Retrieve................................................................. 230 Time and Date Stamping.................................................................................. 230 Relay/Sequence of Events/View....................................................................... 231 Relay/Sequence of Events/Clear...................................................................... 231

Chapter 3 IPScom
3.1 IPScom Functional Description.......................................................................... 31 IPScom Main Screen Menu Bar......................................................................... 31 Shortcut Command Buttons............................................................................... 31 IPScom Main Screen Status Line....................................................................... 31 File Menu............................................................................................................ 34 File/New Command............................................................................................ 34 File/Save and Save As Command...................................................................... 34 File/Open Command.......................................................................................... 34 File/Close Command.......................................................................................... 34 File/Exit Command............................................................................................. 34 Connect\Communication Menu.......................................................................... 35 Communication\Open Terminal Window............................................................. 36 Monitor Menu...................................................................................................... 37 Monitor/Primary Metering & Status.................................................................... 37 Monitor/Secondary Metering & Status................................................................ 39 Monitor/Accumulator Status............................................................................. 311 Monitor/Phasor Diagram................................................................................... 312 Monitor/Phase Distance Diagram..................................................................... 313 Monitor/Loss of Field........................................................................................ 314 Monitor/Out of Step.......................................................................................... 315 Monitor/Sync Scope......................................................................................... 316 Monitor/Function Status.................................................................................... 317 Monitor/87 Dual Slope...................................................................................... 318 Relay Menu....................................................................................................... 319

ii

Table of Contents

Chapter 3 IPScom (Cont.'d)


Relay/Setup...................................................................................................... 319 Relay/Setup/Setup System............................................................................... 319 Relay/Setup/Relay Setpoints............................................................................ 321 Relay/Setup/Set Date & Time........................................................................... 323 Relay/Setup/Display/I/O Map............................................................................ 324 Relay/Setup/Display All Setpoints.................................................................... 325 Relay/Targets.................................................................................................... 326 Relay/Sequence of Events............................................................................... 327 Relay/Oscillograph............................................................................................ 329 Relay/Profile..................................................................................................... 330 Relay/Write File to Relay.................................................................................. 331 Relay/Read Data From Relay........................................................................... 331 Tools Menu....................................................................................................... 331 Tools/Security................................................................................................... 331 Tools/Security/ Change Comm Access Code................................................... 331 Tools/Security/Change User Access Code....................................................... 332 Tools/User Information...................................................................................... 332 Tools/User Information/User Logo Line............................................................ 332 User Control Number........................................................................................ 332 System OK LED............................................................................................... 332 Tools/Relay Communication............................................................................. 333 Tools/Output Test.............................................................................................. 333 Tools/Counters and Error Codes...................................................................... 334 Tools/Firmware Update..................................................................................... 335 Tools/Calibration Data...................................................................................... 335 Window Menu................................................................................................... 335 Help Menu........................................................................................................ 335

Chapter 4 System Setup and Setpoints


4.1 4.2 4.3 Unit Setup........................................................................................................... 41 Direct Connection............................................................................................. 414 COM Port Security............................................................................................ 417 Disabling COM Ports........................................................................................ 417 IPScom Ethernet Port Setup with DHCP.......................................................... 418 HMI Ethernet Port Setup.................................................................................. 419 Manual Configuration of Ethernet Board.......................................................... 420 IPScom Setup Sequence of Events Recorder.................................................. 427 Setup System................................................................................................... 428 System Diagrams............................................................................................. 433

4.4 System Setpoints.............................................................................................. 439 Setpoint Profiles (Setting Groups).................................................................... 439 Configure Relay Data....................................................................................... 439 Functions.......................................................................................................... 440 Special Considerations..................................................................................... 441 21 Phase Distance........................................................................................... 446 24 Overexcitation Volts/Hz................................................................................ 450 M3425A Firmware Versions D0114VXX.XX.XX and Earlier.......................... 451

iii

M-3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 4 System Setup and Setpoints (Cont.'d)


M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.00.34................................................ 451 M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.04.00................................................ 451 25 Sync Check................................................................................................. 453 Phase Angle Check.......................................................................................... 453 Delta Voltage and Delta Frequency Check....................................................... 453 27 Phase Undervoltage.................................................................................... 457 27TN #2 Screens are identical to 27TN #1....................................................... 460 32 Directional Power......................................................................................... 461 Protection from Generator Motoring................................................................. 461 Protection from Generator Overload................................................................ 461 Protection from Excessive Reactive Power...................................................... 461 40 Loss of Field................................................................................................ 465 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent................................................................. 468 49 Stator Overload Protection.......................................................................... 470 50/50N Instantaneous Overcurrent, Phase and Neutral Circuits...................... 473 50BF Generator Breaker Failure/HV Breaker Flashover.................................. 475 50DT Definite Time Overcurrent (for split-phase differential)............................ 477 50/27 Inadvertent Energizing............................................................................ 478 51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent............................................................. 480 51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Restraint............... 481 59 Phase Overvoltage...................................................................................... 483 59D Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (Ratio)............................................... 485 59N Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence........................................ 487 59X Multipurpose Overvoltage (Turn-to-Turn Stator Fault Protection or Bus Ground Protection)................................................................................ 489 60FL VT Fuse Loss.......................................................................................... 491 Internal Fuse Loss Detection Logic.................................................................. 491 External Fuse-Loss Function............................................................................ 491 60FL VT Fuse Loss Alarm Function................................................................. 491 64B/F Field Ground Protection......................................................................... 493 64F Field Ground Detection............................................................................. 493 Factors Affecting 64F Performance.................................................................. 493 64B Brush Lift-Off Detection............................................................................. 495 64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Signal Injection......... 497 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent............................................................ 4103 78 Out-of-Step................................................................................................ 4106 81 Frequency.................................................................................................. 4109 81A Frequency Accumulator.......................................................................... 4112 81R Rate of Change of Frequency................................................................. 4114 87 Phase Differential...................................................................................... 4115 87GD Ground (Zero Sequence) Differential................................................... 4117 Breaker Monitoring......................................................................................... 4118 Trip Circuit Monitoring..................................................................................... 4119 IPSlogic....................................................................................................... 4120 Settings and Logic Applicable when IPSlogic Function(s) programmed using IPScom............................................................................................... 4122 DO/RST (Dropout/Reset) Timer Feature........................................................ 4124 Dropout Delay Timer....................................................................................... 4124 Reset Delay Timer.......................................................................................... 4124

iv

Table of Contents

Chapter 5 Installation
5.1 5.2 General Information............................................................................................ 51 Service Conditions and Conformity to CE Standard........................................... 51 Mechanical/Physical Dimensions....................................................................... 52 External Connections......................................................................................... 58 Power Supply...................................................................................................... 58 Grounding Requirements................................................................................... 58 Unit Isolation....................................................................................................... 58 Insulation Coordination....................................................................................... 58 Torque Requirements......................................................................................... 58 Relay Outputs..................................................................................................... 58 Replacement Fuses............................................................................................ 58 Commissioning Checkout................................................................................. 514 Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers................................................................ 520 Accessing Switches and Jumpers.................................................................... 520 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment...................................................... 524

5.3 5.4

5.5 5.6

5.7 IPScom Communications and Analysis Software Installation........................ 530 IPScom Installation and Setup......................................................................... 530 Hardware Requirements................................................................................... 530 Installing IPScom.............................................................................................. 530 5.8 5.9 Activating Initial Local Communications........................................................... 530 Initial Setup Procedure..................................................................................... 531

Chapter 6Testing
6.1 Equipment/Test Setup........................................................................................ 62 Equipment Required........................................................................................... 62 Setup.................................................................................................................. 62 6.2 Functional Test Procedures................................................................................ 66

6.3 Diagnostic Test Procedures.............................................................................. 668 Overview........................................................................................................... 668 Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode...................................................................... 668 Output Relay Test (Output Relays 123 and 25).............................................. 669 Output Relay Test (Power Supply Relay 24)..................................................... 670 Input Test (Control/Status)................................................................................ 670 Status LED Test................................................................................................ 671 Target LED Test................................................................................................ 672 Button Test........................................................................................................ 673 Display Test....................................................................................................... 674 COM1/COM2 Loopback Test............................................................................ 674 COM3 Test (2Wire).......................................................................................... 675 Clock ON/OFF.................................................................................................. 676 Relay OK LED Flash/Illuminated...................................................................... 677 Auto Calibration................................................................................................ 677 Factory Use Only.............................................................................................. 677

M-3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 6Testing (Cont.'d)


6.4 Auto Calibration................................................................................................ 678 Phase and Neutral Fundamental Calibration.................................................... 678 Third Harmonic Calibration............................................................................... 679 64S 100% Stator Ground by Low Frequency Injection Calibration................... 680 Field Ground Calibration................................................................................... 681

Appendices
Figures Appendix Appendix Appendix Appendix Appendix Appendix Appendix Appendix A: Configuration Record Forms.................................................... A1 B: Communications....................................................................... B1 C: SelfTest Error Codes............................................................... C1 D: Inverse Time Curves................................................................ D1 E: Layup and Storage................................................................... E1 F: HMI Menu Flow.........................................................................F1 G: Index........................................................................................ G1 H: Declaration of Conformity........................................................ H1 Page

Chapter 1
11 M3925A Target Module........................................................................14 12 M3931 HumanMachine Interface (HMI) Module................................ 15

Chapter 2
21 M-3425A Front Panel............................................................................24 22 Screen Message Menu Flow................................................................26 23 Main HMI Menu Flow............................................................................27 2-4 Primary Metering & Status Screen.....................................................210 2-5 Secondary Metering & Status Screen.................................................212 2-6 View Targets Screen...........................................................................215 2-7 Clear Targets Confirmation Dialog Screen..........................................216 2-8 Clear Targets Dialog Screen...............................................................216 2-9 Retrieve Oscillograph Record Dialog Screen......................................219 2-10 Oscillograph Record Download Dialog Screen.................................219 2-11 Oscillograph Download Successful Confirmation Screen.................219 2-12 Trigger Oscillograph Confirmation Screen.........................................220 2-13 Oscillograph Successfully Triggered Dialog Screen..........................220 2-14 Clear Oscillograph Records Confirmation Screen.............................220 2-15 Oscillograph Records Successfully Cleared Dialog Screen..............220 2-16 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen....................................224 2-17 Access Code Change Confirmation Screen......................................224 2-18 Access Code Changed Confirmation Screen....................................224 2-19 Access Level Code Dialog Screen....................................................225 2-20 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen.......................................225 2-21 Counters and Error Codes Dialog Screen........................................229 2-22 Sequence of Events Retrieve Download Screen..............................230 2-23 View Sequence of Events Record Screen........................................230 2-24 Clear Sequence of Events Record Command Confirmation Screen...231 2-25 Sequence of Events Record Cleared Confirmation Screen..............231

vi

Table of Contents

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 3
3-1 IPScom Program Icon................................................................................ 31 3-2 IPScom Main Screen................................................................................. 32 3-3 S-3400 IPScom Menu Selection................................................................ 33 3-4 New System Dialog Screen....................................................................... 34 3-5 IPScom Serial Communication Dialog Screen.......................................... 35 3-6 IPScom TCP/IP Ethernet Communication Dialog Screen.......................... 35 3-7 IPScom Modem Communication Dialog Screen........................................ 36 3-8 Terminal Window........................................................................................ 36 3-9 Primary Metering Status Screen................................................................ 38 3-10 Secondary Metering Status Screen....................................................... 310 3-11 Monitor Frequency Accumulator Status................................................. 311 3-12 Phasor Diagram..................................................................................... 312 3-13 Phase Distance Diagram....................................................................... 313 3-14 Loss of Field Diagram............................................................................ 314 3-15 Out of Step Diagram.............................................................................. 315 3-16 Sync Scope............................................................................................ 316 3-17 Function Status...................................................................................... 317 3-18 87 Function Dual Slope Display............................................................. 318 3-19 Setup System/System Dialog Screen.................................................... 319 3-20 Setup System/System/I/O Setup Dialog Screen.................................... 320 3-21 Setup System/Output Seal-in Time Dialog Screen................................ 320 3-22 Relay Setpoints Dialog Screen.............................................................. 321 3-23 Example Function Dialog Screen.......................................................... 322 3-24 Date/Time Dialog Screen....................................................................... 323 3-25 I/O Map Screen...................................................................................... 324 3-26 Display All Setpoints Screen.................................................................. 325 3-27 View Targets Dialog Screen................................................................... 326 3-28 Sequence of Events Recorder Setup Screen........................................ 327 3-29 Sequence of Events Recorder Retrieve Screen.................................... 327 3-30 View Sequence of Events Recorder Screen.......................................... 328 3-31 Setup Oscillograph Recorder Dialog Screen......................................... 329 3-32 Oscillograph Recorder Retrieve Dialog Screen..................................... 329 3-33 Profile Switching Method Dialog Screen................................................ 330 3-34 Select Profile Dialog Screen.................................................................. 330 3-35 Copy Active Profile Dialog Screen......................................................... 330 3-36 Download Profiles Status Dialog Screen............................................... 330 3-37 Upload Profiles Status Dialog Screen.................................................... 330 3-38 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen......................................... 331 3-39 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen............................................ 332 3-40 User Information Screen........................................................................ 332 3-41 Change Relay Communication Address Dialog Screen........................ 333 3-42 Setup Relay Comm Port Dialog Screen................................................. 333 3-43 Setup Relay Ethernet Port Dialog Screen............................................. 333 3-44 Output Test Dialog Screen..................................................................... 333 3-45 Output Test Warning Dialog Screen....................................................... 333 3-46 Counters and Error Codes Dialog Screen............................................. 334 3-47 Firmware Update Warning Dialog Screen............................................. 335 3-48 Calibration Data Restore Dialog Screen................................................ 335 3-49 Calibration Data Retrieve Dialog Screen............................................... 335
vii

M-3425A Instruction Book

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 4
4-1 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen.........................................44 4-2 Access Code Change Confirmation Screen...........................................44 4-3 Access Code Changed Confirmation Screen.........................................44 4-4 Access Level Code Dialog Screen.........................................................46 4-5 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen............................................46 4-6 User Information Dialog Screen.............................................................48 4-7 Setup Date/Time Dialog Screen..........................................................412 4-9 Setup Comm Port Dialog Screen.........................................................415 4-8 Setup Comm Port Dialog Screen.........................................................415 4-10 Setup Ethernet Screen......................................................................418 4-11 Modem Dialog Screen.......................................................................422 4-12 Terminal Window................................................................................423 4-13 Setup Oscillograph Recorder.............................................................425 4-14 Setup Sequence of Events Recorder Dialog Screen.........................427 415 IPScom Relay Setup System Dialog Screen....................................431 416 IPScom Selection Screen for I/O Setup.............................................432 417 IPScom Selection Screen for Output Seal-in Time............................432 418 One-Line Functional Diagram............................................................433 4-19 Alternative One-Line Functional Diagram (configured for split-phase differential).......................................................................434 420 Three-Line Connection Diagram........................................................435 4-21 Function 25 Sync Check Three-Line Connection Diagram.................436 4-22 Function 59X Turn to Turn Fault Protection Three-Line Connection Diagram...........................................................................437 4-23 Function 67N, 59D, 59X (Bus Ground) Three-Line Connection Diagram...........................................................................438 424 Relay Setpoints Dialog Screen..........................................................442 425 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Setpoint Dialog Screen...................443 426 All Setpoints Table Dialog Screen......................................................444 4-28 Phase Distance (21) Coverage..........................................................448 4-29 Phase Distance (21) Function Applied for System Backup................448 4-30 Phase Distance (21) Setpoint Ranges...............................................449 4-31 Example of Capability and Protection Curves (24)............................451 4-32 Volts-Per-Hertz (24) Setpoint Ranges................................................452 4-33 Sync Check Logic Diagrams..............................................................455 4-34 Sync Check (25) Setpoint Ranges.....................................................456 4-35 Phase Undervoltage (27) Setpoint Ranges........................................457 4-36 Third Harmonic Undervoltage (27TN) Protection Characteristics.......458 4-37 27TN Blocking Regions.....................................................................459 4-38 Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral Circuit (27TN) Setpoint Ranges.................................................................................459 4-39 Tripping on Reverse Power Flow (Over Power with Negative Pickup).......................................................................461 4-40 Tripping on Low Forward Power (Under Power with Positive Pickup).........................................................................463 4-41 Tripping on Overpower (Over Power with Positive Pickup).................463 4-42 Tripping on Over Reactive Power with Element #3 (Over Power, Positive Pickup and Directional Power Sensing Set to Reactive).......464

viii

Table of Contents

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 4 (Cont.'d)
4-43 4-44 4-45 4-46 4-47 4-48 4-49 4-50 4-51 4-52 4-53 4-54 4-55 4-56 4-57 4-58 4-59 4-60 4-61 4-62 4-63 4-64 4-65 4-66 4-67 4-68 4-69 4-70 4-71 4-72 4-73 4-74 4-75 4-76 4-77 4-78 4-79 4-80 4-81 4-82 4-83 4-84 Directional Power, 3-Phase (32) Setpoint Ranges.............................464 Loss of Field (40)Protective Approach 1........................................466 Loss of Field (40)Protective Approach 2........................................467 Loss-of-Field (40) Setpoint Ranges...................................................467 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time Curves......................469 Negative Sequence Overcurrent (46) Setpoint Ranges.....................469 Time Constant, Function 49...............................................................470 49 Function Overload Curves............................................................471 Stator Thermal Protection (49) Setpoint Ranges...............................472 Instantaneous Overcurrent (50) Setpoint Ranges..............................474 Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent (50N) Setpoint Ranges...............474 Breaker Failure Logic Diagram...........................................................475 Breaker Failure (50BF) Setpoint Ranges...........................................476 Definite Time Overcurrent (50DT) Setpoint Ranges...........................477 Inadvertent Energizing Function Logic Diagram................................479 Inadvertent Energizing (50/27) Setpoint Ranges...............................479 Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent (51N) Setpoint Ranges.................480 Voltage Restraint (51VR) Characteristic.............................................482 Inverse Time Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Voltage Restraint (51VC/VR) Setpoint Ranges..............................................................482 Phase Overvoltage (59) Setpoint Ranges..........................................484 Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (Ratio) Scheme for Generator Ground Fault Protection.....................................................................486 Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (59D) Setpoint Ranges..............486 Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence (59N) Setpoint Ranges.................................................................................488 Turn-to-Turn Stator Winding Fault Protection.....................................490 (59X) Multi-purpose Overvoltage Setpoint Ranges............................490 Fuse Loss (60FL) Function Logic......................................................492 Fuse Loss (60FL) Setpoint Ranges...................................................492 M3921 Field Ground Coupler...........................................................494 Field Ground Protection (64B/F) Setpoint Ranges.............................495 64S Function Component Connection Diagram (Model A00/EE 20 Hz Signal Generator)....................................................................499 Primary Transferred To Transformer Secondary...............................4100 Voltage Restraint Characteristic.......................................................4102 100% Stator Ground Protection (64S) Setpoint Ranges..................4102 Residual Directional Overcurrent (67N) Trip Characteristics............4103 Residual Directional Overcurrent (67N) Setpoint Ranges................4105 Out-of-Step Relay Characteristics....................................................4107 Out-of-Step Protection Settings.......................................................4107 Out-of-Step (78) Setpoint Ranges....................................................4108 Example of Frequency (81) Trip Characteristics..............................4110 Frequency (81) Setpoint Ranges.....................................................4111 Frequency Accumulator (81A) Example Bands................................4113 Frequency Accumulator (81A) Setpoint Ranges..............................4113

ix

M-3425A Instruction Book

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 4 (Cont.'d)
4-85 4-86 4-87 4-88 4-89 4-90 4-91 4-92 4-93 4-94 4-95 4-96 4-97 Rate of Change of Frequency (81R) Setpoint Ranges.....................4114 Differential Relay (87) Operating Characteristics.............................4116 Phase Differential (87) Setpoint Ranges..........................................4116 Ground Differential (87GD) Setpoint Ranges...................................4117 Breaker Monitor (BM) Setpoint Ranges...........................................4118 Trip Circuit Monitoring Input.............................................................4119 Trip Circuit Monitor (TC) Setpoint Ranges.......................................4119 IPSlogic Function Setup...............................................................4121 IPSlogic Function Programming.......................................................4122 Selection Screen for Initiating Function Pickup................................4123 Selection Screen for Initiating Function Timeout..............................4123 Dropout Delay Timer Logic Diagram................................................4124 Reset Delay Timer Logic Diagram...................................................4124

Chapter 5
51 M-3425A Horizontal Chassis Mounting Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H1)...................................................................52 52 M-3425A Vertical Chassis Mounting Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H2)...................................................................53 53 M-3425A Mounting Dimensions Horizontal and Vertical Chassis With Expanded I/O................................................................................54 54 M-3425A Panel Mount Cutout Dimensions............................................55 55 Mounting Dimensions for GE L-2 Cabinet H3 and H4...........................56 56 (H5) Mounting Dimensions....................................................................57 57 Optional Dual Power Supply..................................................................58 58 Expanded I/O Power Supply..................................................................58 59 External Connections.............................................................................59 510 Three-Line Connection Diagram........................................................510 511 Function 25 Sync Check Three-Line Connection Diagram.................511 512 Function 59X Turn to Turn Fault Protection Three-Line Connection Diagram...........................................................................512 513 Function 67N, 59D, 59X (Bus Ground) Three-Line Connection Diagram...........................................................................513 5-14 M-3425A Circuit Board.......................................................................522 5-15 M-3425A Circuit Board (Expanded I/O).............................................523 5-16 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment Typical Connections.......524 5-17 20 Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Surface Mount..............525 5-18 20 Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Flush Mount..................526 5-19 20 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Surface Mount......................527 5-20 20 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Flush Mount.........................528 5-21 20 Hz Measuring Current Transformer 400-5 A CT............................529 5-22 IPScom Program Icon........................................................................530

Table of Contents

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 6
6-1 Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1............................................................63 6-2 Voltage Inputs: Configuration V2............................................................63 6-3 Current Inputs: Configuration C1...........................................................64 6-4 Current Inputs: Configuration C2...........................................................64 65 Current Configuration C3.......................................................................65 66 64S Test Configuration...........................................................................65 67 Field Ground Coupler..........................................................................645 68 Status LED Panel.................................................................................671 69 M3925A Target Module Panel.............................................................672 6-10 M3931 Human-Machine Interface Module........................................673 611 COM1/COM2 Loopback Plug.............................................................674 612 RS485 2Wire Testing.......................................................................675 613 Current Input Configuration................................................................681 6-14 Voltage Input Configuration................................................................682 615 Voltage Input Configuration................................................................682 616 Voltage Input Configuration................................................................682

Appendix A
A-1 System Communication Setup............................................................ A4 A-2 Setup System (page 1 of 2)................................................................ A5 A-3System Setpoints and Settings (page 1 of 38).................................... A7

Appendix B
B1 B2 B3 B4 Null Modem Cable: M0423................................................................. B2 RS232 Fiber Optic Network............................................................... B3 RS-485 Network........................................................................................B4 COM2 Pinout for Demodulated TTL Level Signal................................ B4

Appendix D
D1 Volts/Hz (24) Inverse Time Curve Family #1 (Inverse Square)............ D2 D2 Volts/Hz (24) Inverse Time Family Curve #2....................................... D3 D3 Volts/Hz (24IT) Inverse Time Curve Family #3.................................... D4 D4 Volts/Hz (24IT) Inverse Time Curve Family #4.................................... D5 D5 BECO Definite Time Overcurrent Curve.............................................. D8 D6 BECO Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve.............................................. D9 D7 BECO Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve.................................... D10 D8 BECO Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve........................... D11 D9 IEC Curve #1 Inverse................................................................... D12 D10 IEC Curve #2 Very Inverse......................................................... D13 D11 IEC Curve #3 Extremely Inverse................................................. D14 D12 IEC Curve #4 Long Time Inverse..................................................... D15 D13 IEEE Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves............................................... D16 D14 IEEE Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves....................................... D17 D15 IEEE Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves.............................. D18

xi

M-3425A Instruction Book

Figures (Cont.'d)

Page

Appendix F
F-1 F-2 F3 F4 F5 F6 M-3931 Human-Machine Interface Module...........................................F4 HMI Menu Flow Overview.....................................................................F5 Voltage Relay Menu Flow.....................................................................F6 Current Relay Menu Flow (Page 1 of 2)..............................................F7 Frequency Relay, Volts Per Hertz Relay Menu Flow.............................F9 Power Relay, Loss of Field Relay and V.T. Fuse Loss Relay Menu Flow.........................................................................................F10 F7 Phase Distance and Field Ground Relay Menu Flow.........................F11 F8 Sync Check Relay and Breaker Monitor Menu Flow...........................F12 F9 ConRelay Menu Flow (1 of 5).............................................................F13 F10 Setup System (1 of 2)......................................................................F18 F11 Status (1 of 3)..................................................................................F20 F12 View Target History and Oscillograph Explorer.................................F23 F13 Communication (1 of 2)....................................................................F24 F14 Setup Unit (1 of 2)............................................................................F26 F15 Diagnostic Mode (1 of 2)..................................................................F28 Page

Tables

Chapter 1
11 M3425A Device Functions...................................................................13

Chapter 2
21 Recorder Partitions.................................................................................. 216

Chapter 4
4-1 Dead-Sync Time...................................................................................... 415 4-2 Recorder Partitions.................................................................................. 424 43 Input Activated Profile Logic.................................................................... 428 4-4 Available Functions.................................................................................. 441 4-5 Impedance Calculation............................................................................ 449 4-6 Voltage Control Time Settings.................................................................. 466 4-7 Delta/Wye Transformer Voltage-Current Pairs......................................... 482 4-8 Typical Frequency Settings...................................................................... 495 4-9 Typical Brush Lift-Off Pickup Setting........................................................ 496 4-10 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment Part Number Cross Reference.................................................................................. 4103

Chapter 5
51Jumpers................................................................................................... 520 52 Dip Switch SW-1...................................................................................... 521 53 Trip Circuit Monitor Input Voltage Select Jumper Configuration.............. 521

xii

Table of Contents

Tables (Cont.'d)

Page

Chapter 6
61 Output Contacts....................................................................................... 669 62 Input Contacts.......................................................................................... 670

Appendix A
A1 Relay Configuration Table..........................................................................A2

Appendix B
B1 Communication Port Signals.....................................................................B2

Appendix C
C1 Self-Test Error Codes............................................................................... C1 C2 IPScom Error Messages........................................................................ C2

Appendix D
D1A M3425A Inverse Time Overcurrent Relay Characteristic Curves......... D6

Appendix H
H1 Declaration of Conformity......................................................................... H2

1998 Beckwith Electric Co. All Rights Reserved. Printed in U.S.A. (9.21.01)

8003425AIB0907/12

xiii

M-3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

xiv

Introduction 1

1
1.1 1.2

Introduction

Instruction Book Contents........................................................ 11 M3425A Generator Protection Relay...................................... 12

1.3 Accessories.............................................................................. 14

1.1

Instruction Book Contents

This instruction book includes six Chapters and seven Appendices. Chapter 1: Introduction Chapter One summarizes the devices capabilities, introduces the instruction book contents and describes the application of an M-3425A. Chapter 2: Operation Chapter Two provides the necessary instructions regarding operation of the M-3425A. Manual operation of the M-3425A is accomplished by utilizing either the units front panel controls and indicators, which include the M3931 Human Machine Interface (HMI) and M3925A Status Module or through the S-3400 IPScom Communications and Oscillographic Analysis Software. Chapter 3: IPScom Chapter 3 provides a description of each element of the S-3400 IPScom Communications Software. The IPScom menu structure and commands are described in detail for each feature and function. Chapter 4: System Setup and Setpoints Chapter Four is designed for the person(s) responsible for the direct setting and configuration of the system. It describes the procedures for entering all required data into the M-3425A. Included in this chapter are functional and connection diagrams for a typical application for the system; and describes the configuration process for the unit (choosing active functions), output contact assignment and input blocking designation. It also illustrates the definition of system quantities and equipment characteristics required by the M-3425A, and describes the individual function settings. Chapter 5: Installation The person or group responsible for the installation of the M-3425A will find herein all mechanical information required for physical installation, equipment ratings, and all external connections in this chapter. For reference, the ThreeLine Connection Diagrams are repeated from Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints. Further, a commissioning checkout procedure is outlined to check the external CT and VT connections. Additional tests which may be desirable at the time of installation are described in Chapter 6, Testing.

11

M3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 6: Testing This chapter provides step-by-step test procedures for each function, as well as diagnostic mode and auto-calibration procedures. Appendix A: Configuration Record Forms This Appendix supplies a set of forms to record and document the settings required for the proper operation of the M-3425A. Appendix B: Communications This Appendix describes communication port signals and various topologies and equipment required for remote communication. Appendix C: SelfTest Error Codes This Appendix lists all the error codes and their definitions. Appendix D: Inverse Time Curves This appendix contains a graph of the four families of Inverse Time Curves for V/Hz applications, the four standard and the four IEC overcurrent curves. Also included are three IEEE inverse time curves. Appendix E: Layup and Storage This Appendix provides the recommended storage parameters, periodic surveillance activities and layup configuration. Appendix F: HMI Menu Flow This Appendix includes the M-3425A HMI Flow diagrams to aide the user in navigating the menu system. Appendix G: Index This Appendix includes the Index for the M-3425A Instruction Book. Appendix H: Declaration of Conformity This Appendix contains the Beckwith Electric Co.s Declaration of Conformity required by ISO/IEC 17050-1:2004.

1.2

M-3425A Generator Protection Relay

The M3425A Generator Protection Relay is a microprocessor-based unit that uses digital signal processing technology to provide up to thirty-four protective relaying functions for generator protection. The relay can protect a generator from internal winding faults, system faults, and other abnormal conditions. The available M-3425A Generator Protective Functions are listed in Table 1-1. The nomenclature follows the standards of ANSI/IEEE Std. C37.2, Standard Electric Power Systems Device Function Numbers where applicable. The control/status inputs can be programmed to block and/or to trigger the oscillograph recorder. Any of the functions or the control/status inputs can be individually programmed to activate any one or more of the programmable outputs, each with a contact. The M3931 Human Machine Interface (HMI) Module allows the user to access the following features and functions from the M-3425A front panel using a menudriven, 2 line by 24 character alphanumeric display: Settings Enter Comm settings Set Access Codes Set User Control Number Set display User Lines 1 and 2 Set Date/Time Clear Alarm Counter Enter Diagnostic Mode Clear Error Codes Metering of various quantities, including voltage, current, frequency and phase-angle I/O Status Alarm Counter M-3425A Unit Last Power Up Date and Time M-3425A Unit Firmware Version and Serial Number Error Codes Checksums

Functions

Status

12

Introduction 1

FUNCTION Protective Functions 21 24 27 27TN 32 40 46 49 50 50BF 50DT 50N 50/27 51N 51V 59 59D 59N 59X 60FL 67N 78 81 81A 81R 87 87GD IPS BM TC 25 64F/64B 64S

DESCRIPTION Phase Distance (three-zone mho characteristic) Volts/Hz (Inverse & Definite Time) Phase Undervoltage Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral Directional Power Loss of Field (dual-zone offset-mho characteristic) Negative Sequence Overcurrent Stator Overload Protection (Positive Sequence Overcurrent) Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent Breaker Failure Definite Time Overcurrent Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent Inadvertent Energizing Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent Inverse Time Overcurrent, with Voltage Control or Restraint Phase Overvoltage Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential Neutral Overvoltage Milti-purpose Overvoltage VT Fuse-Loss Detection Residual Directional Overcurrent Out of Step (mho characteristic) Frequency Frequency Accumulation Rate of Change of Frequency Phase Differential Current Ground (zero sequence) Differential IPSlogic Breaker Monitor Trip Circuit Monitoring Sync Check Field Ground Protection/Brush Lift-Off Detection 100% Stator Ground Protection by Injection

The relay provides storage of time-tagged target information for the 8 most recent trip events. Also included are self-test, self-calibration and diagnostic capabilities. The M3925A Target Module LEDs are used to provide a detailed visual indication of function operation for the most recent event. The M-3425A retains up to 416 cycles of oscillograph waveform data assignable to up to 24 events with selectable post-trigger delay. This data can be downloaded and analyzed using the M3801D IPSplot PLUS Oscillograph Analysis Software. The unit is powered from a wide range switch mode power supply. An optional redundant power supply is available for units without the Expanded I/O. When expanded I/O option is selected, the unit includes the second power supply. The M-3425A includes self-test, auto calibration, and diagnostic capabilities, in addition to IRIG-B timesync capability for accurate time-tagging of events. Communication Ports The M-3425A includes three physical communication ports. If the optional RJ45 Ethernet port is purchased, then COM2 is not available: COM1, located on the relay front panel, is a standard 9-pin RS232 DTE-configured port. COM1 is used to locally set and interrogate the relay using a portable computer. COM2, located on the rear of the relay, is a standard 9-pin RS232 DTE-configured port. When the optional RJ45 Ethernet Port is enabled, COM2 port is disabled for communications. The demodulated IRIG-B may still be used via the COM2 Port when ethernet is enabled.

Optional Protective Functions

The RJ45 Ethernet port uses a 10Base-T type connection that accepts an RJ45 connector using CAT5 twisted pair cable. The Ethernet port can support MODBUS over TCP/IP, BECO2200 over TCP/IP, DNP 3.0 or IEC 61850. The IP address can be obtained automatically when using the DHCP protocol if enabled, or a static IP address can be manually entered, using the HMI. COM3, located on the rear terminal block of the relay, is an RS485 communications port.

Table 11 M-3425A Device Functions

13

M3425A Instruction Book

NOTE: COM1, COM2 and COM3 can be disabled for security purposes from the Communications HMI menu. A Level 2 Access Code is required. The relay may be remotely set and interrogated utilizing either a hard-wired RS232 serial connection or modem (COM2 when activated as RS232, or COM3), or when purchased, the ethernet connection (RJ45 activated). Detailed information regarding the use of the relay communications ports is provided in Appendix B, Communications, as well as Chapter 3, IPScom. S-3400 IPScom Communications Software Each M-3425A unit includes the S-3400 IPScom Communications Software. The IPScom communications software runs on an IBM PC compatible computer running under Windows 2000 or later, providing remote access to the relay using either direct serial connection or modem. IPScom provides the following communication functions: Setpoint interrogation and modification Real-time metering and I/O status monitoring Stored target interrogation Recorded oscillographic data downloading Real time Phasor display

1.3 Accessories
M3925A Target Module The optional target modules shown in Figures 11 and 1-2 include 24 individually labeled TARGET LEDs to target the operation of the functions on the front panel. Eight individually labeled OUTPUT LEDs will be illuminated as long as any output is picked up.

TARGETS
24 VOLTS/Hz PHASE OVERCURRENT NEUTRAL O/C SPLIT PHASE DIFF STATOR OVERLOAD 50 27 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE 59 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND 59N/59X NEUT/GND OVERVOLT 32 21 40 78 50BF 60FL DIRECTIONAL POWER PHASE DISTANCE LOSS OF FIELD OUT OF STEP BREAKER FAILURE V.T. FUSE LOSS PHASE OVERCURRENT 51V 50N/51N 50DT 49

NEG SEQ OVERCURRENT46 FIELD GND/BRUSH LIFT64F/B FREQUENCY 81/81R/81A 87 PHASE DIFF CURRENT

GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR TC IPS LOGIC LOGIC

50/27INADVERTENT ENRGNG

OUTPUTS
OUT 1 OUT 2 OUT 3 OUT 4 OUT 5 OUT 6 OUT 7 OUT 8

Figure 11 M3925A Target Module

See Chapter 3, IPScom for an overview of IPScom features.

14

Introduction 1

M3931 HumanMachine Interface (HMI) Module The optional HMI module shown in Figure 12, provides a means to interrogate the relay and to input settings, access data, etc. directly from the front of the relay. Operation of the module is described in detail in Section 2.1, Front Panel Controls and Indicators.

M3801D IPSplot Plus Oscillograph Analysis Software The IPSplotPlus Oscillograph Analysis Software runs in conjunction with IPScom software on any Windows compatible computer running Windows 2000 or later, to enable the plotting and printing of waveform data downloaded from the M-3425A Generator Protection Relay. M3933/M0423 Serial Communications Cable The M3933 cable is a 10foot straight-through RS232 modem cable for use between the relays rear-panel (COM2) port and a modem. This cable has a DB25 (25pin) connector (modem) and a DB9 (9pin) at the M-3425A end. The M0423 cable is a 10foot null-modem RS232 cable for direct connection between a PC and the relays front-panel COM1 port or the rear COM2 port. This cable has DB9 (9pin) connectors at each end. M3949 Redundant Low Voltage Power Supply Redundant 24/48 V dc supply (For Non-Expanded I/O units). M3948 Redundant High Voltage Power Supply Redundant 110/250 V dc supply (For Non-Expanded I/O units).

BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO. M-3425A

a
a
ENTER

EXIT

Figure 12 M3931 Human-Machine Interface (HMI) Module

15

M3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

16

Operation 2

2
2.1 2.2

Operation

Front Panel Controls and Indicators......................................... 23 Operation (HMI/PC)................................................................. 25

This chapter contains information that describes the operation of the M-3425A Generator Protection Relay. See Chapter 4 for System Setup, Configuration and Setpoint information. M-3425A operation from either IPScom or HMI includes the following: Front Panel Controls and Indicators Miscellaneous Software Version Serial Number Alter User Access Codes Clear Output Counters Clear Alarm Counters Reset Counters Clear Error Codes Sequence of Events Recorder Retrieve Records View Records Clear Records

Status Monitoring Voltage, Current, Frequency and Volts/Hz Monitoring Input/Output Status Timer Status Counter Status (Input, Output, Alarm) Time of Last Power Up Error Codes Checksum Target History View Target History Clear Target History Oscillograph Recorder View Recorder Status Retrieve Records Trigger Oscillograph Clear Records

21

M3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 2 - Operation
2.1 Front Panel Controls and Indicators..........3 Alphanumeric Display......................................3 Screen Blanking...............................................3 Arrow Pushbuttons...........................................3 EXIT Pushbutton..............................................3 ENTER Pushbutton..........................................3 RELAY OK LED...............................................3 Time Sync LED................................................3 Breaker Closed (BRKR CLOSED) LED...........3 Diagnostic LED (DIAG)....................................3 Oscillograph Triggered LED.............................3 Power Supply (PS1) and (PS2) LEDs..............4 Target LED.......................................................4 M-3925A Target Module and Target Reset Pushbutton.......................................................4 2.2 Operation (HMI/PC).......................................5 System Priority.................................................5 HMI Operation Overview..................................5 Default Message Screens................................5 HMI Security.....................................................6 Status Monitoring (From Relay Front Panel)....8 Status Monitoring (From IPScom)..................9 PRIMARY METERING & STATUS..................9 SECONDARY METERING & STATUS..........11 Monitor/Secondary Metering and Status........11 VIEW TARGET HISTORY.............................13 Time and Date Stamping...............................13
View Target History (From IPScom )............15

View Targets..................................................15 Clear Targets.................................................16 Oscillograph Recorder Data...........................16 Oscillograph Recorder (From IPScom)..........19 Retrieve Oscillograph Records......................19 Trigger Oscillograph.......................................20 Clear Oscillograph Records...........................20 Software Version (Relay Front Panel only)....21 Serial Number (Relay Front Panel only)........21 Alter Access Codes (From Relay Front Panel)...................................................22 Alter User Access Codes (From IPScom)....24 Comm Access Codes.....................................24 User Access Codes........................................25 User Access Codes........................................25 System Error Codes, Output and Alarm Counters.........................................................26 Clear Output Counters (Relay Front Panel)...26 Clear Alarm Counters (Relay Front Panel)....27 Clear Error Codes (Relay Front Panel)..........28 Resetting Counters (From IPScom)...............29 Tools/Counters and Error Codes...................29 Relay/Sequence of Events/Retrieve..............30 Time and Date Stamping...............................30 Relay/Sequence of Events/View....................31 Relay/Sequence of Events/Clear...................31

22

Operation 2

2.1

Front Panel Controls and Indicators

This section describes the operation of the M-3425A as a function of the M3931 Human Machine Interface Module (HMI) and the M-3925A Target Module. The M-3425A can be interrogated locally with the HMI panel. An integral part of the design is the layout and function of the front panel indicators and controls, illustrated in Figure 21. Alphanumeric Display The HMI module consists of a 2 x 24character alphanumeric display. To assist the operator in operating and interrogating the relay locally, the HMI displays menus which guide the operator to the desired function or status value. These menus consist of two lines. The bottom line lists lower case abbreviations of each menu selection with the chosen menu selection shown in uppercase. The top menu line provides a description of the chosen menu selection. Screen Blanking The display will automatically blank after exiting from the Main Menu, or from any screen after five (5) minutes of unattended operation. To wake up the display, the user must press any key except EXIT. Arrow Pushbuttons The left and right arrow pushbuttons are used to choose among the displayed menu selections. When entering values, the left and right arrow pushbuttons are used to select the digit (by moving the cursor) of the displayed setpoint that will be increased or decreased by the use of the up and down pushbuttons. The up and down arrow pushbuttons increase or decrease input values or change between upper and lower case inputs. If the up or down pushbutton is pressed and held when adjusting numerical values, the speed of increment or decrement is increased. If the up or down arrow pushbutton is held in the depressed position when adjusting numerical values, the speed of the increment or decrement is increased, after a small delay.

EXIT Pushbutton The EXIT pushbutton is used to exit from a displayed screen and move up the menu tree. Any changed setpoint in the displayed screen will not be saved if the selection is aborted using the EXIT pushbutton. ENTER Pushbutton The ENTER pushbutton is used to choose a highlighted menu selection, to replace a setting or other programmable value with the currently displayed value, or to move down within the menu tree. RELAY OK LED The Green RELAY OK LED is controlled by the unit's microprocessor. A flashing RELAY OK LED indicates proper program cycling. The LED can also be programmed to be continuously illuminated to indicate proper program cycling. Time Sync LED The green TIME SYNC LED illuminates to indicate that the IRIGB time signal is being received and the internal clock is synchronized with the IRIG-B time signal. IRIG-B time information is used to accurately tag target and oscillograph events. Breaker Closed (BRKR CLOSED) LED The red BRKR CLOSED LED illuminates when the breaker status input (52b) is open. Diagnostic LED (DIAG) The diagnostic LED flashes upon the occurrence of a detectable self-test error. The LED will flash the Error Code Number. For example, for error code 32, the LED will flash 3 times, followed by a short pause, and then 2 flashes, followed by a long pause, and then repeat. For units equipped with the HMI, the Error Code Number is also displayed on the screen. Oscillograph Triggered LED The red OSC TRIG LED will illuminate to indicate that oscillograph data has been recorded in the unit's memory and is available for download.

23

M3425A Instruction Book

Power Supply (PS1) and (PS2) LEDs The green power LED indicator (for the appropriate power supply) will be illuminated whenever power is applied to the unit and the power supply is functioning properly. Power supply PS2 is available as an option, for units without expanded I/O. Target LED When a condition exists that causes the operation of Outputs 1 through 8 (1 through 23 for units with expanded I/O), the TARGET LED will illuminate, indicating a relay operation. The TARGET LED will remain illuminated until the condition causing the trip is cleared, and the operator presses the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Detailed information about the cause of the last 8 operations is retained in the units memory for access through the alphanumeric display from the VIEW TARGET HISTORY menu.

M-3925A Target Module and Target Reset Pushbutton For units equipped with the optional M-3925A Target Module, additional targeting information is available. The Target module includes an additional 24 target LEDs, and 8 output status LEDs. LEDs corresponding to the particular operated function as well as the present state of the outputs are available. Pressing and holding the TARGET RESET pushbutton will display the present pickup status of all functions available on the target module. This is a valuable diagnostic tool which may be used during commissioning and testing.

Figure 21 M-3425A Front Panel

24

Operation 2

2.2

Operation (HMI/PC)

The purpose of this section is to describe the steps that are necessary to interrogate the M-3425A utilizing either the optional M-3931 HMI or a PC running S-3400 IPScom Communications software through COM1 the front RS-232 serial port. These instructions assume that the following conditions exist: The unit is energized from an appropriate power supply.

HMI Operation Overview Whenever power is applied to the unit the Power On Self Test sequence is initiated (Figure 2-2). Default Message Screens When power is applied to the unit, the relay performs a number of self-tests to ensure that it is operating correctly. During the self-tests, the screen displays an x for each test successfully executed. If all self-tests are executed successfully, the relay will briefly display the word PASS and then a series of status screens that include: Model Number Software Version Number Serial Number Date and time as set in the system clock User Logo Screen

See Chapter 5, Installation, Section 5.3, External Connections, for power supply connection details. For PC communications, IPScom is installed on the host PC.

See Chapter 5, Installation, Section 5.6, IPScom Communications Software Installation, if IPScom is not installed. For PC communication, initial PC communication has been established with the unit.

If this is the first attempt to establish communications with the unit, then see Chapter 5, Installation , Section 5.7, Activating Initial Local Communications. System Priority System conflicts will not occur, as local commands initiated from the front panel receive priority recognition. When the unit is in local mode, communication using the serial ports is suspended. IPScom displays an error message to indicate this fact.

If a test fails, an error code will be displayed and the relay will not allow operation to proceed. In such a case, the error code should be noted and the factory contacted. A list of error codes and their descriptions are provided in Appendix C, Self-Test Error Codes. When the M-3425A is energized and unattended, the user logo lines are blank. If a protective function has operated and has not been reset, the HMI will display the target(s) with the time and date of the operation and automatically cycle through target screen for each applicable target. This sequence is illustrated in Figure 2-2. In either case, pressing the ENTER pushbutton will begin local mode operation by displaying the access code entry screen, or if access codes are disabled, the first level menu will be displayed (Figure 2-3). Figure 23 presents the software menu flow map for HMIequipped units. This map can be used as a quick reference guide to aid in navigating the relay's menus.

25

M3425A Instruction Book

HMI Security To prevent unauthorized access to the relay functions, the relay includes the provision for assigning access codes. If access codes have been assigned, the access code entry screen will be displayed after ENTER is pressed from the default message screen. The relay is shipped with the access code feature disabled. The relay includes three levels of access codes. Depending on the access code each level holds, users have varying levels of access to the relay functions. Level 3 Access: provides access to all M-3425A configuration functions and settings. Level 2 Access: provides access to read & change setpoints, monitor status and view target history. Level 1 Access: provides access to read setpoints, monitor status and view target history.

Each access code is a user defined 1 to 4 digit number. If the level 3 access code is set to 9999, the access code feature is disabled. When access codes are disabled, the access screens are bypassed. Access codes are altered by choosing the ALTER ACCESS CODES menu under SETUP UNIT menu. (These codes can only be altered by a level 3 user).

M-3425A

M-3425A

27 #1 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE

D - 0150VXX.XX.XX

M-3425A

Figure 22 Screen Message Menu Flow

26

Operation 2

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz


27 Phase Undervoltage 59 Phase Overvoltage 27TN Neutrl Undervolt 59X Overvoltage 59N Neutral Overvoltage 59D Volt. Diff. 3rd Har.

SYNC CHECK RELAY field stator SYNC


25S Sync Check 25D Dead Volt

STATUS config sys STAT


Voltage Status Current Status Frequency Status V/Hz Status Power Status Impedance Status Sync Check Status Breaker Mon Acc Status 81A Accumulators Status In/Out Status Timer Status Relay Temperature Counters Time of Last Power Up Error Codes Checksums

BREAKER MONITOR BRKR trpckt ipslog


Set Breaker Monitoring Preset Accumulators Clear Accumulators

CURRENT RELAY volt CURR freq v/hz


46 Neg Seq Overcurrent 50 Inst Overcurrent 50/27 Inadvertent Energing 50BF Breaker Failure 50DT Def. Time Overcurr 50N Inst Overcurrent 51N Inv Time Overcurrent 49 Stator Overload 51V Inv Time Overcurrent 87 Differential Overcurr 87GD Gnd Diff Overcurr 67N Res Dir Overcurr

TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR brkr TRPCKT ipslog


Trip Circuit Monitoring

IPS LOGIC brkr trpckt IPSLOG


IPS Logic

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TARGETS osc_rec comm


View Target History Clear Target History

FREQUENCY RELAY volt curr FREQ v/hz


81 Frequency 81R Rate of Change Freq 81A Frequency Accum.

CONFIGURE RELAY CONFIG sys stat


Voltage Relay Current Relay Frequency Relay Volts per Hertz Relay Power Relay Loss of Field Relay V.T. Fuse Loss Relay Phase Distance Relay Field Gnd Relay Stator Gnd Relay Sync Check Relay Breaker Mon Relay Trip Ckt Mon Relay IPSLogic Relay

OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER targets OSC_REC comm


View Record Status Clear Records Recorder Setup

VOLTS PER HERTZ RELAY volt curr freq V/HZ


24 Definite Time Volts/Hertz 24 Inverse Time Volts/Hertz

COMMUNICATION targets osc_rec COMM


COM1 Setup COM2 Setup COM3 Setup Communication Address Response Time Delay Communication Access Code Ethernet Setup Ethernet IP Address

POWER RELAY PWR lof fuse dist


32 Directional Power

LOSS OF FIELD RELAY pwr LOF fuse dist


40 Loss of Field

SETUP SYSTEM config SYS stat


Input Activated Profiles Active Setpoint Profile Copy Active Profile Nominal Voltage Nominal Current V. T. Configuration Delta-Y Transform Phase Rotation 59/27 Magnitude Select 50DT Split-phase Diff. Pulse Relay Latched Outputs Relay Seal-in Time Active Input State V.T. Phase Ratio V.T. Neutral Ratio V.T. VX Ratio C.T. Phase Ratio C.T. Neutral Ratio

SETUP UNIT SETUP exit


Software Version Serial Number Alter Access Codes User Control Number User Logo Line 1 User Logo Line 2 Clear Output Counters Clear Alarm Counter Date & Time Clear Error Codes Ethernet Firmware Ver. Diagnostic Mode

V. T. FUSE LOSS RELAY pwr lof FUSE dist


60 FL V.T. Fuse Loss

PHASE DISTANCE RELAY pwr lof fuse DIST


21 Phase Distance 78 Out of Step

FIELD GROUND RELAY FIELD stator sync


64B/F Field Ground

EXIT LOCAL MODE setup EXIT

STATOR GROUND RELAY field STATOR sync


64S Stator Ground

Note: Depending on which functions are purchased, some menus may not be displayed.

NOTE: See Appendix F, HMI Menu Flow for menu item details. Figure 23 Main HMI Menu Flow

27

M3425A Instruction Book

Status Monitoring (From Relay Front Panel) The menu categories for monitored values are: Voltage Status: phase voltages, neutral voltage, positive sequence voltage, negative sequence voltage, zero sequence voltage, third harmonic neutral voltage, field ground measurement circuit, stator low frequency injection voltage Current Status: phase currents (ABC/ab-c), differential current, neutral current, ground differential current, positive sequence current, negative sequence current, zero sequence current, stator low frequency injection current Frequency Status: frequency, rate of change of frequency Volts/Hz Status: volts per hertz Power Status: real power, reactive power, apparent power, power factor Impedance Status: impedance (Zab, Zbc, Zca), positive sequence impedance, field ground resistance Sync Check Status: 25S Sync Check and 25D Dead Volt BRKR Monitor 81A Accum. Status IN/OUT Status: Status of input and output contacts Timer: 51V Delay Timer, 51N Delay Timer, 46IT Delay Timer, 24IT Delay Timer Relay Temperature Counters: output, alarm counter Time of Last Power up Error Codes Checksums: setpoints, calibration, ROM

To access the STATUS menu and begin monitoring, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

v/hz V

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

STATUS config sys STAT 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

VOLTAGE STATUS VOLT curr freq v/hz V 6. Press the Right or Left arrow pushbutton until the desired parameter is selected (upper case), then press ENTER. The HMI will display the selected parameter. Press the ENTER pushbutton to move down within the STATUS menu to the desired category. To exit a specific category and continue to the next menu category, press the EXIT pushbutton.

7.

28

Operation 2

Status Monitoring (From IPScom) PRIMARY METERING & STATUS To access the PRIMARY METERING & STATUS parameters utilizing IPScom, select Monitor/Primary Metering & Status from the IPScom Main Screen drop down menu. IPScom will display the Primary Metering dialog screen (Figure 24) which includes the following PRIMARY parameters: Voltage (V) VAB VBC VCA Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence Neutral VX 3rd Harmonic VN 3rd Harmonic VX Frequency

Also included on the Primary Metering & Status screen are: Inputs Outputs Breaker Status OSC Triggered Status Targets IRIG-B Sync

Hz V/Hz (%) ROCOF (Hz/s) Currents (A)

Phase A Phase B Phase C Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence Phase a Phase b Phase c Neutral Power

Real (W) Reactive (Var) Apparent (Va) Power Factor

29

M3425A Instruction Book

Path: Monitor / Primary Metering & Status

Figure 2-4 Primary Metering & Status Screen

210

Operation 2

SECONDARY METERING & STATUS To access the SECONDARY METERING & STATUS parameters utilizing IPScom, select Monitor/Secondary Metering & Status from the IPScom Main Screen drop down menu. Monitor/Secondary Metering and Status The Secondary Metering & Status screen (Figure 2-5) includes the following SECONDARY parameters: Voltages VAB VBC VCA Neutral Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence VX Frequency

Low Frequency Injection

VN (V) IN (mA) Real (mA) 3rd Harmonic

VN (V) VX (V) VX/VN Power (P.U.)

Real Reactive Apparent Miscellaneous

Power Factor Brush V. (mV) Field Insulation (Ohm) Impedance

Hz V/Hz (%) ROCOF (Hz/s) Currents AB R AB X BC R BC X CA R CA X Positive Sequence R Positive Sequence X Also included on the Primary Metering & Status screen are: Inputs Outputs Breaker Status OSC Triggered Status Targets IRIG-B Sync

Phase A Phase B Phase C Neutral Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence 49 #1 49 #2 Phase a Phase b Phase c I diff G A-a diff B-b diff C-c diff

211

M3425A Instruction Book

Path: Monitor / Secondary Metering & Status

Figure 2-5 Secondary Metering & Status Screen

212

Operation 2

VIEW TARGET HISTORY The M3425A Generator Protection Relay includes the ability to store the last 32 target conditions in a nonvolatile memory. A target is triggered whenever an output is operated. A second function attempting to operate an output (which is already operated) will not trigger a new target, since no new output has been operated or closed. If the second function operation closes a different, unoperated output, a new target will be triggered. A target includes: An indication of which function(s) have operated, and timers expired (operated) Status information which identifies any function that is timing (picked up) Individual phase element information at the time of the trigger, if the operating function was a three phase function Phase currents at the time of operation Neutral current at the time of operation Input and output status, and a date/time tag

b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq

v/hz V

3.

c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

Time and Date Stamping Time and date stamping of events is only as useful as the validity of the unit's internal clock when no IRIG-B signal is present. Under the Relay menu, the Set Date/Time command allows the user to manually set the unit's clock. When a target is triggered, the front panel TARGET LED will light, indicating a recent event. If the optional M3925A Target Module is present, the corresponding function LED will be lit. If the optional M3931 HMI module is available, a series of screens will be presented, describing the most recent operation. This information is also available remotely by using the IPScom Communication Software. To access the VIEW TARGET HISTORY feature, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

VIEW TARGET HISTORY W TARGETS osc_rec comm V 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TRGT clear 6. Press ENTER. The HMI will display the following:. VIEW TARGET HISTORY X Target Number 7. Pressing the Up or Down arrow pushbutton moves to the next target. Detailed target information will then be automatically displayed until the next target is selected. TARGET 1 01-JAN-200112:27:35.125 This screen gives the date and time tag of the selected target.

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER.

TARGET 1 08 05

01

213

M3425A Instruction Book

This screen displays operated outputs.

This screen displays the phase current at the time the target operated.

Target 1 I3

I1

TARGET 1 N=0.50 AMPS 8. This screen displays the neutral current at the time the target operated. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton. The display will return to the following:

This screen displays operated inputs at time of trip.

TARGET 1 -OPERATE TARGETS The following screens display the timed out or operate functions.

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TRGT clear To access the CLEAR TARGET HISTORY feature, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

TARGET 1 27#1PHASEUNDERVOLTAGE This screen displays the specific function which timed out and triggered the target.

TARGET 1 PHASE A=X B= C= This screen displays the phase information for the displayed function at time out.

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. Go to Step 4. 3. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

Target 1 -PICKUP TARGETS The following screens display the timing on picked up functions when the target was recorded.

TARGET 1 27#1 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE TARGET 1 PHASE A=X B=X C=X This display gives the phase pickup information for the specific function.

v/hz

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz

TARGET 1 -CURRENT STATUSTARGET 1 a=0.02 b=0.03 c=0.04

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TARGETS osc_rec comm

214

Operation 2

5.

Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TRGT clear 6. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

View Target History (From IPScom) View Targets To View Targets select Relay/Targets/View . IPScom will display the View Targets screen (Figure 26). The View Targets screen includes the following target information: Target Number Target Date/Time Phase a, b, c and Neutral Currents Active Functions Function Status (Picked up/Operated) Active Inputs and Outputs

VIEW TARGET HISTORY trgt CLEAR 7. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

CLEAR TARGET HISTORY TARGETS CLEARED 8. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton.

The View Targets screen also includes the ability to Save the target information to file and Print the target information.

Path: Relay / Targets / View

Figure 2-6 View Targets Screen

215

M3425A Instruction Book

Clear Targets To Clear Targets perform the following: 1. Select Relay/Targets/Clear. IPScom will display the Clear Targets confirmation dialog screen (Figure 27).

When triggered, the time stamp is recorded, and the recorder continues recording for a user-defined period. The snapshot of the waveform is stored in memory for later retrieval using IPScom Communications Software. The OSC TRIG LED on the front panel will indicate a recorder operation (data is available for downloading).

Trigger Inputs and Outputs: The recorder can be triggered remotely through serial communications using IPScom, or automatically using programmed status inputs or outputs. Post-Trigger Delay: A post-trigger delay of 5% to 95% must be specified. After triggering, the recorder will continue to store data for the programmed portion of the total record before re-arming for the next record. For example, a setting of 80% will result in a record with 20% pre-trigger data, and 80% post-trigger data.

Figure 2-7 Clear Targets Confirmation Dialog Screen 2. Select Yes. IPScom will display the Clear Targets dialog screen (Figure 2-8).

NOTE: Oscillograph recorder settings are not considered part of the Setpoint Profile. Recorder settings are common to all profiles. NOTE: Oscillograph Recorder Setup (See Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints). Number of Partitions 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Number of Cycles per Each Partition 416 Cycles 280 Cycles 208 Cycles 168 Cycles 136 Cycles 120 Cycles 104 Cycles 88 Cycles 80 Cycles 72 Cycles 64 Cycles 64 Cycles 56 Cycles 56 Cycles 48 Cycles 48 Cycles

Figure 2-8 Clear Targets Dialog Screen 3. Select OK. IPScom will return to the Main screen. Oscillograph Recorder Data The Oscillograph Recorder provides comprehensive data recording (voltage, current, and status input/ output signals) for all monitored waveforms (at 16 samples per cycle). Oscillograph data can be downloaded using the communications ports to any IBM compatible personal computer running the S-3400 IPScom Communications Software. Once downloaded, the waveform data can be examined and printed using the optional M3801D IPSplot PLUS Oscillograph Data Analysis Software. CAUTION: Oscillograph records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted. The general information required to complete the input data of this section includes: Recorder Partitions: When untriggered, the recorder continuously records waveform data, keeping the data in a buffer memory. The recorder's memory may be partitioned into 1 to 16 partitions.

Table 21 Recorder Partitions

216

Operation 2

To access the Oscillograph Recorder VIEW RECORDER STATUS feature, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

VIEW RECORDER STATUS STAT clear setup 6. Press ENTER. The HMI will cycle through and display the following for each active record : RECORD #1 ACTIVE dd-mmm-yyyy hh:mm:ss:ms For those records that are not active the following will be displayed:

v/hz V

RECORD #1 RECORD CLEARED 7. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton. The display will return to the following:

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

VIEW RECORDER STATUS STAT clear setup

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER W targets OSC_REC comm V

217

M3425A Instruction Book

To access the Oscillograph Recorder CLEAR RECORDS feature, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

VIEW RECORDER STATUS STAT clear setup 6. Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

CLEAR RECORDS stat CLEAR setup 7. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

CLEAR RECORDS -RECORDS CLEAREDv/hz V 8. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton. The display will return to the following:

CLEAR RECORDERS stat CLEAR setup

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER W targets OSC_REC comm V

218

Operation 2

Oscillograph Recorder (From IPScom) NOTE: Oscillograph Recorder Setup (See Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints) Retrieve Oscillograph Records To retrieve Oscillograph Records perform the following: 1. Select Relay/Oscillograph/Retrieve . IPScom will display the Retrieve Oscillograph Record dialog screen (Figure 29). 2. 3. Select the desired oscillograph record. Select the desired File Format, then select Retrieve, IPScom will display the Save As dialog screen. Input the desired File Name and location, then select Save. IPScom will display the Download Status screen (Figure 210).

5. Upon completion of the oscillograph file download, IPScom will display the Download Successful Confirmation screen (Figure 2-11).

Figure 2-11 Oscillograph Download Successful Confirmation Screen 6. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main screen.

4.

Figure 2-10 Oscillograph Record Download Dialog Screen

Path: Relay / Oscillograph / Retrieve

Figure 2-9 Retrieve Oscillograph Record Dialog Screen

219

M3425A Instruction Book

Trigger Oscillograph To manually Trigger the Oscillograph perform the following: 1. Select Relay/Oscillograph/Trigger . IPScom will display the Trigger Oscillograph confir mation screen (Figure 212).

Clear Oscillograph Records To Clear Oscillograph Records perform the following: 1. Select Relay/Oscillograph/Clear . I P S c o m w i l l d i s p l ay t h e C l e a r Oscillograph Records confirmation screen (Figure 214).

Figure 2-12 Trigger Oscillograph Confirmation Screen 2. Select Yes, IPScom will display the Oscillograph Successfully Triggered Dialog Screen. (Figure 213)

Figure 2-14 Clear Oscillograph Records Confirmation Screen 2. Select Yes, IPScom will display the Clear Oscillograph Records Successful Dialog Screen. (Figure 215)

Figure 2-13 Oscillograph Successfully Triggered Dialog Screen 3. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main screen.

Figure 2-15 Oscillograph Records Successfully Cleared Dialog Screen 3. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main screen.

220

Operation 2

Software Version (Relay Front Panel only) To determine the software version installed on the relay, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

Serial Number (Relay Front Panel only) To determine the serial number of the relay, proceed as follows: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not Active, then the following will be displayed:

v/hz V

v/hz V

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP exit 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP exit 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V 6. Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V 6. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SOFTWARE VERSION D-0150VXX.YY.ZZ AAAA 7. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton.

SERIAL NUMBER vers eth SN access number V

221

M3425A Instruction Book

7.

Press the ENTER pushbutton , the following will be displayed:

Alter Access Codes (From Relay Front Panel) 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed:

SERIAL NUMBER XXXXXXXXXX 8. To exit press the EXIT pushbutton.

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed:

v/hz

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP exit 5. Press the ENTER pushbutton, the following will be displayed:

SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V 6. If User Access Codes are to be set, then use the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select ALTER ACCESS CODES. The following will be displayed:

ALTER ACCESS CODES vers eth sn ACCESS number

222

Operation 2

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE LEVEL#1 level#2 level#3 8. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: LEVEL #1 9999 9. Input the desired User Access Code as follows: a. Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. b. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Access Code. c. When the desired Access Code has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE LEVEL#1 level#2 level#3 10. To set User Access Code Level #2 press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select LEVEL #2, then press ENTER the following will be displayed:

11. 12.

Repeat Step 9 to enter the desired Level #2 User Access Code. To set User Access Code Level #3 press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select LEVEL #3, then press ENTER the following will be displayed:

LEVEL #3 9999 13. 14. Repeat Step 9 to enter the desired Level #3 User Access Code. Press the EXIT pushbutton will return to the previous selection screen:

ALTER ACCESS CODES vers sn ACCESS number V

LEVEL #2 9999

223

M3425A Instruction Book

Alter User Access Codes (From IPScom) Comm Access Codes To set the relay Comm Access Code perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Security/Change Comm Access Code. IPScom will display the Change Comm Access Code dialog screen (Figure 2-16).

4. Select Yes , IPScom will display an Access Code Was Changed Successfully Confirmation Screen (Figure 2-18).

Figure 2-18 Access Code Changed Confirmation Screen 5. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main Screen. The new Comm Access Code will not be in affect until communications have been closed with the relay for approximately 2.5 minutes.

Figure 2-16 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen 2. Enter the desired New Comm Access Code (1-9999), then re-enter (confirmation) the New Access Code.

3. Select Save, IPScom will display a Access Code change Confirmation Screen (Figure 2-17).

Figure 2-17 Access Code Change Confirmation Screen

224

Operation 2

User Access Codes The relay includes three levels of access codes. Depending on their assigned code, users have varying levels of access to the installed functions. 1. Level1Access = Read setpoints, monitor status, view status history. Level2Access = All of level 1 privileges, plus read & change setpoints, target history, set time clock.

User Access Codes To change the relay User Access Codes perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Security/Change User Access Code . IPScom will display the Access Level Code dialog screen (Figure 2-19).

2.

3. Level3Access = All of level 2 privileges, plus access to all configuration functions and settings.

Each access code is a userdefined one-to fourdigit number. Access codes can only be altered by a level 3 user. If the level 3 access code is set to 9999, the access code feature is disabled. When access codes are disabled, the access screens are bypassed, and all users have full access to all the relay menus. The device is shipped from the factory with the access code feature disabled. Figure 2-19 Access Level Code Dialog Screen 2. Enter a valid Access Code, then select OK. IPScom will display the Change User Access Code dialog screen (Figure 2-20).

Figure 2-20 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen 3. Enter the desired New User Access Code (1-9999), then re-enter (confirmation) the New User Access Code.

4. Select Save, IPScom will display an Access Code change Confirmation Screen (Figure 2-17). 5. Select Yes , IPScom will display an Access Code Was Changed Successfully Confirmation Screen (Figure 2-18). 6. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.
225

M3425A Instruction Book

System Error Codes, Output and Alarm Counters The System Error Codes, Output and Alarm Counters feature provides the user with the ability to view and clear system Error Codes, Processor Resets, Alarm Counters, Power Loss Counter and Output Counters. Also, Checksums can be viewed (IPScom) for Calibration and Setpoints. Clear Output Counters (Relay Front Panel) To clear Output Counters from the Front Panel perform the following: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: 5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: SOFTWARE VERSION VERS eth sn access V 6. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed:

CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS logo1 logo2 OUT alrm V 7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR

v/hz

8. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS -OUT COUNTERS CLEARED 9. Press EXIT as necessary to return to the main menu.

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP

226

Operation 2

Clear Alarm Counters (Relay Front Panel) To clear Alarm Counters from the Front Panel perform the following: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: 6. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed:

CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS logo1 logo2 out ALRM V 7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR ALARM COUNTERS PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR 8. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR ALARM COUNTER -ALARM COUNTER CLEARED-

v/hz 9. Press EXIT as necessary to return to the main menu.

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP 5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V

227

M3425A Instruction Book

Clear Error Codes (Relay Front Panel) To clear Error Codes from the Front Panel perform the following: 1. 2. Press the ENTER pushbutton. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: 5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) Access Granted! VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 3. c. Go to Step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: 6. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

ENTER ACCESS CODE 0

CLEAR ERROR CODES time ERROR eth_ver V 7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR ERROR CODES PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR

v/hz 8. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: CLEAR ERROR CODES -ERROR CODES CLEARED 9. Press EXIT as necessary to return to the main menu.

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4.

v/hz

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

SETUP UNIT SETUP

228

Operation 2

Resetting Counters (From IPScom) Tools/Counters and Error Codes To view and/or Reset System Error Codes and Output Counters utilizing IPScom perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu bar select Tools/Counters and Error Codes. IPScom will display the Counters and Error Codes dialog screen (Figure 2-21). Select the desired Error Code, Alarm Counter, Power Loss Counter to be reset, then select OK. IPScom will return to the Main Menu.

2.

Figure 2-21 Counters and Error Codes Dialog Screen

229

M3425A Instruction Book

Relay/Sequence of Events/Retrieve The Retrieve selection downloads the events from the currently connected relay (events must be retrieved from the relay and stored in a file in order to view them). CAUTION: Sequence of Events Records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted. Time and Date Stamping Time and date stamping of events is only as useful as the validity of the unit's internal clock when no IRIG-B signal is present. Under the Relay menu, the Set Date/Time command allows the user to manually set the unit's clock.

To download available Sequence of Events perform the following: 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Sequence of Events/ Retrieve . IPScom will display the Sequence of Events Recorder Download screen (Figure 2-22) and indicate the number of Sequence of Events Recorder Events being downloaded.

Figure 2-22 Sequence of Events Retrieve Download Screen 2. When the download is complete the Save As screen will be displayed with a default .evt file extension. Select the destination folder and name the file, then select Save to save the Sequence of Events Record or Cancel.

3.

Figure 2-23 View Sequence of Events Record Screen

230

Operation 2

Relay/Sequence of Events/View The Sequence of Events viewer screen includes the commands Open, Close, Print Summary, and Print. Open opens a saved sequence of events file. Close closes the print file. Print Summary prints an event summary, and Print prints the event report. Clear deletes event history from the control. To view available Sequence of Events Records perform the following: 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Sequence of Events/View. IPScom will display the View Sequence of Events Record screen (Figure 2-23).

Relay/Sequence of Events/Clear The Clear feature clears all Sequence of Events Records stored on the relay. To Clear all Sequence of Events Records perform the following: 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Sequence of Events/Clear. IPScom will display the Clear Sequence of Events Records confirmation screen (Figure 2-24).

2. Select Open. IPScom will display the Open screen with a default .evt file extension. 3. Select the location of the .evt files, then select the file to be viewed. Figure 2-24 Clear Sequence of Events Record Command Confirmation Screen 2. Select YES, IPScom will respond with the Sequence of Events Records Cleared confirmation Screen (Figure 2-25).

4. Select Open. IPScom will Open the target file in the View Sequence of Events Record screen (Figure 2-23).

Figure 2-25 Sequence of Events Record Cleared Confirmation Screen 3. Select OK, IPScom will return to the IPScom Main Screen.

231

M3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

232

IPScom3

3
3.1

IPScom

IPScom Functional Description................................................ 31

This chapter is designed for the person or group responsible for the operation and setup of the M-3425A. The S-3400 IPScom Communications Software can be used to successfully communicate system settings and operational commands to the M-3425A as well as access the extensive monitoring and status reporting features. Figure 3-3, represents the IPScom Main Screen menu structure. This chapter provides a general overview of each IPScom menu selection and command in the same order as they are displayed in the software program. Those IPScom features and functions that are covered in other sections of this Instruction Book will be noted and referenced.

IPScom Main Screen Menu Bar The IPScom Main Screen Menu Bar includes (when the program is initially opened) the File, Connect and Help menu selections. This menu bar includes the additional selections; Communication, Monitor, System, Tools and Windows when IPScom is in either the file mode or has open communications established with a relay. Shortcut Command Buttons Before IPScom has entered either the file mode or communications have been opened, the new and open shortcut commands are available. When IPScom is in the New File, Existing File, or Communication Mode, the main screen includes the Save, Secondary Metering, Phasor Diagram and Setpoints shortcut command buttons. These shortcuts allow direct access to these functions. IPScom Main Screen Status Line The IPScom status line indicates the source of the information that is displayed. Sources include New File, Existing File, Serial Port, TCP/IP or Modem. Also included on the IPScom Main Screen at the bottom, are the Type of Unit IPScom is connected to, the Firmware Version of the unit and Status of the Communication connection, or if not connected, it will indicate that IPScom is in the File Mode.

3.1

IPScom Functional Description

The IPScom installation and establishing initial local communications are covered in Section 5.7, IPScom Communications Software Installation, and Section 5.8, Activating Initial Local Communications. Selecting the IPScom Program from the Becoware Folder or selecting the IPScom Program Icon (Figure 3-1) from the Desktop will open the program and display the IPScom Main Screen (Figure 3-2).

Figure 3-1 IPScom Program Icon

31

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 3-2 IPScom Main Screen

32

File Windows
Unconnected

Connected

Monitor

Cascade

Help
Contents About... Ctrl + F1

All Setpoints I/O Map

All Setpoints I/O Map

Open New Save Open Save as Compare Close Print Print Preview

Tools
Security User Information Relay Communication Output Test Counter & Error Codes Firmware Update Calibration Data Change Comm Access Code Change User Access Code

EXIT

Primary Metering & Status Secondary Metering & Status Accumulator Status Phasor Diagram Phase Distance Loss of Field Out of Step Sync Scope Function Status 87T Dual Slope

Connect/Communication

Change Communication Address Setup Comm Port Setup Ethernet Retrieve Restore

Communication Connect

Figure 3-3 S-3400 IPScom Menu Selection


Disconnect Open Terminal Window Setup Retrieve Trigger Clear Serial Port TCP/IP Modem

Relay
Setup Targets Sequence of Events Oscillograph Profile Write File to Relay Read Data from Relay Setup System Relay Setpoints Setup Date & Time Display I/O Map Display All Setpoints View Clear Reset LED Switching Method Select Profile Copy Active Profile Download from Relay Upload to Relay Setup Retrieve View Clear

IPScom3

33

M3425A Instruction Book

File Menu

COMMAND BUTTONS OK Cancel Allows the file to be created using the currently displayed information. Returns to the IPScom main screen; any changes to the displayed information are lost.

Initial File Menu

File/Save and Save As Command The Save and Save As... commands allow saving a file or renaming a file, respectively. File/Open Command The open command allows opening a previously created data file. IPScom will open and automatically convert files created in non S-3400 versions of IPScom. The converted file must be saved before it can be uploaded to the relay. With an opened data file, use the System... Setup... menu items to access the setpoint windows. File Menu Dropdown When Connected and File Mode The File menu enables the user to create a New data file, Open a previously created data file, Close, Save, Save as and Exit the IPScom program. The user can also perform Print and Print Preview of the open file. File/New Command When not connected to a M-3425A, using the New command, a new file is established with the New System dialog screen (Figure 3-4). Selecting Save allows the new data file to be named by using the Save or Save as... commands. NOTE: By choosing the NEW command, unit and setpoint configuration values are based on factory settings for the selected firmware version. If communication can be established with a relay, it is always preferred to use the Read Data From Relay command in the Relay menu to update the PCs data file with the relay data. This file now contains the proper system type information, eliminating the need to set the information manually. File/Close Command Closes the open file without saving. File/Exit Command The Exit command quits the IPScom program.

Path:

File menu / New command

Figure 3-4 New System Dialog Screen

34

IPScom3

Connect\Communication Menu

The Connect dialog screens allow selection of the IPScom communication parameters to coordinate with the relay. Selecting Serial Port displays the PC Comm Port and device Settings (Figure 3-5). CAUTION: The Echo Cancel check box should only be used when several relays are connected using a fiber optic loop network. Otherwise, echo cancel must not be selected or communication will be prevented. CAUTION: If the serial port is connected to something other than a modem, and an IPScom modem command is executed, the results are unpredictable. In some cases, the computer may have to be reset. Selecting TCP/IP displays the PC TCP/IP and device Settings (Figure 3-6) for Ethernet communication. Selecting Modem displays a modem Dialog screen (Figure 37), to establish contact with remote locations. The Modem Dialog screen also includes a Bring up terminal window after dialing option. When selected, IPScom will open a terminal window (Figure 3-8) to allow modem commands to be sent to the target modem. When communicating by way of a fiber optic loop network, echo cancelling is available by checking the Echo Cancel box. This command masks the senders returned echo.

If the modem was not used to establish communication (direct connection), select Connect to start. If the relay has a default communication access code of 9999, a message window will be displayed showing Access Level #3 was granted. Otherwise, another dialog screen will be displayed to prompt the user to enter the access code in order to establish communication. Communication/ Disconnect discontinues communication.

Figure 3-5 IPScom Serial Communication Dialog Screen

Figure 3-6 IPScom TCP/IP Ethernet Communication Dialog Screen

35

M3425A Instruction Book

Communication\Open Terminal Window Opens the IPScom Terminal Window (Figure 3-8).

Figure 3-7 IPScom Modem Communication Dialog Screen

Figure 3-8 Terminal Window

36

IPScom3

Monitor Menu The Monitor Menu provides access to the screens used to monitor relay parameters. Seven submenus are provided: Primary Metering and Status, Secondary Metering and Status, Accumulator Status, Phasor Diagram, Phase Distance, Loss of Field, Out of Step, Sync Scope, Function Status, and 87T Dual Scope.

Frequency

Hz V/Hz (%) ROCOF (Hz/s) Currents (A)

Phase A Phase B Phase C Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence Phase a Phase b Phase c Neutral

Monitor/Primary Metering & Status The Primary Metering screen (Figure 3-9) allows the user to review the following PRIMARY parameters: Voltage (V) VAB VBC VCA Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence Neutral VX 3rd Harmonic VN 3rd Harmonic VX

Power

Real (W) Reactive (Var) Apparent (Va) Power Factor Also included on the Primary Metering & Status screen are: Inputs Outputs Breaker Status OSC Triggered Status Targets IRIG-B Sync

37

M3425A Instruction Book

Path: Monitor / Primary Metering and Status

Figure 3-9 Primary Metering Status Screen

38

IPScom3

Monitor/Secondary Metering & Status The Secondary Metering and Status screen (Figure 3-10) allows the user to review the following SECONDARY parameters: Voltages 3rd Harmonic

VAB VBC VCA


VN (V) VX (V) VX/VN Power

Neutral Real Reactive Apparent Miscellaneous

Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence VX Frequency

Hz V/Hz (%) ROCOF (Hz/s) Currents

Power Factor Brush V. (mV) Field Insulation (Ohm) Impedance

Phase A Phase B Phase C Neutral Positive Sequence Negative Sequence Zero Sequence 49 #1 49 #2 Phase a Phase b Phase c I diff G A-a diff B-b diff C-c diff Low Frequency Injection

AB R AB X BC R BC X CA R CA X Positive Sequence R Positive Sequence X Also included on the Primary Metering & Status screen are: Inputs Outputs Breaker Status OSC Triggered Status Targets IRIG-B Sync

VN (V) IN (mA) Real (mA)

39

M3425A Instruction Book

Path: Monitor / Secondary Metering and Status

Figure 3-10 Secondary Metering Status Screen

310

IPScom3

Monitor/Accumulator Status Frequency Accumulation feature provides an indication of the amount of off frequency operation accumulated. Turbine blades are designed and tuned to operate at rated frequencies, operating at frequencies different than rated can result in blade resonance and fatigue damage. In 60 Hz machines, the typical operating frequency range for 18 to 25 inch blades is 58.5 to 61.5 Hz and for 25 to 44 inch blades is between 59.5 and 60.5 Hz. Accumulated operation, for the life of the machine, of not more than 10 minutes for frequencies between 56 and 58.5 Hz and not more than 60 minutes for frequencies between 58.5 and 59.5 Hz is acceptable on typical machines. The 81A function can be configured to track off nominal frequency operation by either set point or when the frequency is within a frequency band. When using multiple frequency bands, the lower limit of the previous band becomes the upper limit

for the next band, i.e., Low Band #2 is the upper limit for Band #3, and so forth. Frequency bands must be used in sequential order, 1 to 6. Band #1 must be enabled to use Bands #2#6. If any band is disabled, all following bands are disabled. When frequency is within an enabled band limit, accumulation time starts (there is an internal ten cycle delay prior to accumulation), this allows the underfrequency blade resonance to be established to avoid unnecessary accumulation of time. When accumulated duration is greater than set delay, then the 81A function operated the programmed output contact. The contact can be used to alert the operator or trip the machine. The accumulator status can be set to preserve the accumulated information from previous devices. This allows the relay to begin accumulating information at a pre-defined value. This setpoint is only available through IPScom Communications Software.

Path: Monitor / Accumulator Status

Figure 3-11 Monitor Frequency Accumulator Status

311

M3425A Instruction Book

Monitor/Phasor Diagram The Phasor Diagram (Figure 3-12) provides the user with the ability to evaluate a reference Phase Angle to Phase Angle data from other windings. The Phasor Diagram also includes a menu that allows the user to select/deselect sources to be displayed and Freeze capability to freeze the data displayed on the Phasor Diagram.

Path:

Monitor / Phasor Diagram

NOTE: When connections specifying delta-connected CTs are used, Functions 87T and 87H use the Phasor Diagram values (currents actually entering the relay) and not the calculated values displayed on the Secondary Metering and status screen.

Figure 3-12 Phasor Diagram

312

IPScom3

Monitor/Phase Distance Diagram The Phase Distance Diagram (Figure 3-13) provides the user with a graphic representation to evaluate Phase Distance settings for all three phases. See Function 21, Phase Distance in Chapter 4 for additional information.

Path:

Monitor / Phase Distance Diagram

NOTE: When connections specifying delta-connected CTs are used, Functions 87T and 87H use the Phasor Diagram values (currents actually entering the relay) and not the calculated values displayed on the Secondary Metering and status screen.

Figure 3-13 Phase Distance Diagram

313

M3425A Instruction Book

Monitor/Loss of Field The Loss of Field Diagram (Figure 3-14) displays a graphic representation of Loss of settings, and also displays the Positive Sequence Impedance. See Function 40, Loss of Field in Chapter 4 for additional information.

Path:

Monitor / Loss of Field

Figure 3-14 Loss of Field Diagram

314

IPScom3

Monitor/Out of Step The Out of Step graphic representation provides the user with the ability to evaluate Out of Step settings. See Function 78, Out of Step in Chapter 4 for additional information.

Path:

Monitor / Out of Step

Figure 3-15 Out of Step Diagram

315

M3425A Instruction Book

Monitor/Sync Scope The Sync Scope graphic representation provides the phase difference between the measured quantities. See Function 25, Sync Check in Chapter 4 for additional information.

Path:

Monitor / Sync Scope

Figure 3-16 Sync Scope


sCAUTION: The M-3425A Sync Scope should not be used to determine phase conditions for manual synchronizing because of possible communications time delay.

316

IPScom3

Monitor/Function Status The Function Status screen displays the status of various functions, with a red circle indicating functions that have tripped, and a green circle for those functions that have picked up and are timing. Also displayed are Active Inputs and Outputs.

Path:

Monitor / Function Status

Figure 3-17 Function Status

317

M3425A Instruction Book

Monitor/87 Dual Slope The 87 Dual Slope display allows the user to display a graphical representation of the 87 programmable Dual Slope Percentage Restraint Characteristic. See Function 87, Phase Differential Current in Chapter 4 for additional information.

Path:

Monitor / 87Dual Slope

Figure 3-18 87 Function Dual Slope Display

318

IPScom3

Relay Menu

The Setup submenu includes the Setup System, Relay Setpoints, Set Date &Time, Display I/O Map and Display All Setpoints selections. Relay/Setup/Setup System The Setup System selection displays the Setup System dialog screen (Figures 3-19, 3-20 and 3-21) allowing the user to input the pertinent information regarding the system on which the relay is applied (see Section 4.2, Setup System, for detailed information regarding the specific elements of the Setup System dialog screen). NOTE: Checking the inputs for the Input Active State Open parameter designates the operated state established by an opening rather than a closing external contact.
COMMAND BUTTONS Save When connected to a relay, sends the currently displayed information to the unit. Otherwise, saves the currently displayed information to file and returns to the IPScom Main screen. Returns to the IPScom Main screen; any changes to the displayed information are lost.

The Relay menu provides access to the screens used to set, monitor, or interrogate the relay. Six submenus are provided: Setup, Targets, Sequence of Events, Oscillograph and Profile as well as two commands, Write File to Relay, and Read Data From Relay. Relay/Setup

Cancel

Path:

Relay / Setup / Setup System

Figure 3-19 Setup System/System Dialog Screen

319

M3425A Instruction Book

Path:

Relay / Setup / Setup System

Figure 3-20 Setup System/System/I/O Setup Dialog Screen

Path:

Relay / Setup / Setup System

Figure 3-21 Setup System/Output Seal-in Time Dialog Screen

320

IPScom3

Relay/Setup/Relay Setpoints The Relay Setpoints menu selection displays the Relay Setpoints dialog screen (Figure 3-22) from which the individual Function Setting dialog screens can be accessed. Selecting a Function Setting button will display the corresponding function dialog screen (See Figure 3-23 as an example).

Figure 3-22 Relay Setpoints Dialog Screen


COMMAND BUTTONS Display All Setpoints Display I/O Map OK Opens the All Setpoints Table dialog screen for the specified range of functions. Opens the I/O Map dialog screen (Figure 3-25) Exits the screen and returns to the IPScom main screen.

321

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 3-23 Example Function Dialog Screen


COMMAND BUTTONS Save Cancel When connected to a relay, sends the currently displayed information to the unit. Otherwise, saves the currently displayed information and returns to the System Setpoints screen or All Setpoints Table. Returns to the System Setpoints screen or All Setpoints Table; any changes to the displayed information are lost.

322

IPScom3

Relay/Setup/Set Date & Time The Setup Date & Time command (Figure 3-24) allows the system date and time to be set, or system clock to be stopped. The system clock is used for Time and Date Stamping when the Time Sync is not available. This dialog screen also displays an LED mimic to identify when the Time Sync is in use (preventing date/time from being changed by user). The time field in the dialog box is not updated continuously. The time at which the dialog box was opened is the time that is displayed and remains as such. This is true whether the relay is synchronized with the IRIG-B signal or not. There is a green Time Sync LED mimic in this dialog box (the LED is displayed as different shading on a monochrome monitor). When this LED is green, the relay is synchronized with the IRIG-B signal and the Time field is grayed out, indicating that this field cant be changed. But the Date field can be changed (by editing and selecting Save). When the LED is not blue, the relay is not timesynchronized and therefore, both the Date and Time fields can be changed.
Path: Relay/ Setup Date & Time

Figure 3-24 Date/Time Dialog Screen


SETUP DATE AND TIME COMMAND BUTTONS Start/Stop Clock Save Cancel This toggles between start/stop, the relay clock. Stop pauses, Start resumes. Saves Time and Date settings to the relay when applicable. Returns to the IPScom main window. Any changes to the displayed information is lost.

323

M3425A Instruction Book

Relay/Setup/Display/I/O Map Selecting the I/O Map button displays the I/O Map dialog screen (Figure 3-25), which containsa chart of programmed input and output contacts, in order to allow scrolling through all relay output and blocking input configurations.

Both the Relay Setpoints dialog screen and the I/O Map screen include the Display All Setpoints feature and Jump Command Buttons which allow the user to jump from a scrolling dialog screen to an individual relay function dialog screen and return to the scrolling dialog screen. All available parameters can be reviewed or changed when jumping to a relay I/O Map screen from either scrolling dialog screen.

Figure 3-25 I/O Map Screen

324

IPScom3

Relay/Setup/Display All Setpoints Selecting the Display All Setpoints button displays the All Setpoints dialog screen (Figures 3-26). This dialog screen containsthe settings for each relay function within a single window to allow scrolling through all relay setpoint and configuration values. The individual Feature and Function selection buttons are described in the applicable sections.

The All Setpoint Table includes Jump Command Buttons which allow the user to jump from a scrolling dialog screen to an individual relay function dialog screen and return to the scrolling dialog screen. All available parameters can be reviewed or changed when jumping to a configuration dialog screen.

Figure 3-26 Display All Setpoints Screen

325

M3425A Instruction Book

Relay/Targets

The Targets submenu provides three command options: View, Clear and Reset LED. The View command displays the View Targets Dialog Screen (see Figure 3-27). This dialog screen provides detailed data on target events including time, date, function status, phase current values, and IN/ OUT contact status at the time of trip. Individually recorded events may be selected and saved to a text file, or be printed out with optional added comments. The Reset LED selection is similar to pressing the Target Reset button on the relay Front Panel. This command resets current targets displayed on the relay. This command does not reset any target history. The Clear command clears all stored target history. See Chapter 2, Operation for detailed information.

Figure 3-27 View Targets Dialog Screen

326

IPScom3

Relay/Sequence of Events

The Sequence of Events submenu allows the user to Setup, Retrieve, View and Clear Sequence of Events records. The Setup command displays the Setup Sequence of Events Recorder dialog screen (Figure 3-28). Function Pickup, Trip and Dropout can be selected to initiate the recorder as well as Input Pickup, Output Pickup, Inputs Drop and Outputs Drop. The Retrieve command downloads and saves the record to file (Figure 3-29). The View command displays the View Sequence of Events Record screen (Figure 3-30) which allows the user to open and print Sequence of Events files. The Clear command clears all Sequence of Events records in the relay. See Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints and Chapter 2, Operation, for detailed information.

Figure 3-28 Sequence of Events Recorder Setup Screen

Figure 3-29 Sequence of Events Recorder Retrieve Screen

327

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 3-30 View Sequence of Events Recorder Screen

328

IPScom3

Relay/Oscillograph

The Oscillograph submenu allows setting and control over the relays oscillograph recorder. The Setup command allows the user to set the number of partitions and triggering designations to be made (Figure 3-31), Retrieve downloads and save data to a file (Figure 3-32). Trigger sends a command to the relay to capture a waveform. This is the same as issuing a manual oscillograph trigger. Clear erases all existing records. The optional M-3801D IPSplotPLUS Oscillograph Analysis Software program is required to view the downloaded oscillograph files or the files can be converted to ComTrade format. See Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints and Chapter 2, Operation, for detailed information.

Figure 3-31 Setup Oscillograph Recorder Dialog Screen

Figure 3-32 Oscillograph Recorder Retrieve Dialog Screen

329

M3425A Instruction Book

Relay/Profile

The Profile submenu provides three command options: Switching Method, Select Profile, and Copy Active Profile. The Switching Method command allows selection of either Manual or Input contact (Figure 3-33). Select Profile allows the user to designate the active profile (Figure 3-34). Copy Active Profile copies the active profile to one of four profiles (user should allow approximately 15 seconds for copying) (Figure 3-35). The Profile submenu also provides the means to download and upload to the relay profiles.

p CAUTION: If relay is online, be sure to switch the active profile. If the wrong profile is selected, it may cause unexpected operation.

See Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints for detailed information.

Figure 3-33 Profile Switching Method Dialog Screen

Figure 3-36 Download Profiles Status Dialog Screen

Figure 3-37 Upload Profiles Status Dialog Screen Figure 3-34 Select Profile Dialog Screen

Figure 3-35 Copy Active Profile Dialog Screen

330

IPScom3

Relay/Write File to Relay

Tools/Security The Security menu item includes the Change Comm Access Code and Change User Access Code submenus. Tools/Security/ Change Comm Access Code The Change Comm Access code selection displays the Change Comm Access Code screen (Figure 3-38) which allows the user to change the Comm Access Code. See Section 4.1, Unit Setup for detailed setup instructions. If additional link security is desired, a communication access code can be programmed. Like the user access codes, if the communication access code is set to 9999 (default), communication security is disabled.

The Write File to Relay command sends a predefined setpoint data file to the Relay. Relay/Read Data From Relay The Read Data from Relay command updates the PC data image with the relays latest data. Tools Menu

Figure 3-38 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen

The Tools menu provides the user with access to IPScom relay support features and functions.

331

M3425A Instruction Book

Tools/Security/Change User Access Code The Change User Access Code selection displays the Change User Access Code screen (Figure 3-39) which allows the user to change the relay User Access Code. See Section 4.1, Unit Setup for detailed setup instructions. The relay includes three levels of access codes. Depending on their assigned code, users have varying levels of access to the installed functions. 1. Level1Access = Read setpoints, monitor status, view status history. Level2Access = All of level 1 privileges, plus read & change setpoints, target history, set time clock.

Tools/User Information The User Information menu selection displays the User Information screen (Figure 3-40) which provides the user with the ability to edit/input the User Logo lines of the HMI display, enter/edit the User Control Number and set the operating mode of the System OK LED. See Section 4.1, Unit Setup for detailed setup instructions.

2.

3. Level3Access = All of level 2 privileges, plus access to all configuration functions and settings.

Each access code is a userdefined one-to fourdigit number. Access codes can only be altered by a Level 3 user. If the Level 3 access code is set to 9999, the access code feature is disabled. When access codes are disabled, the access screens are bypassed, and all users have full access to all the relay menus. The device is shipped from the factory with the access code feature disabled.

Figure 3-40 User Information Screen


Tools/User Information/User Logo Line The user logo is a programmable, two-line by 24character string, which can be used to identify the relay, and which is displayed locally during power up after Self Test completion. This information is also available in IPScom. User Control Number The User Control Number is a user-defined value which can be used for inventory or identification. The unit does not use this value, but it can be accessed through the HMI or the communications interface, and can be read remotely. System OK LED The green SYSTEM OK LED is controlled by the units microprocessor. A flashing SYSTEM OK LED indicates proper program cycling. The LED can also be programmed to be continuously illuminated.

Figure 3-39 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen

332

IPScom3

Tools/Relay Communication The Relay Communication menu selection provides the user with the ability to change the relay Communication Address (Figure 3-41), set the relays COM Port communication parameters (Figure 3-42) and setup the Ethernet Port (Figure 3-43). See Section 4.1, Unit Setup for detailed communication setup instructions.

Figure 3-41 Change Relay Communication Address Dialog Screen

Figure 3-43 Setup Relay Ethernet Port Dialog Screen


Tools/Output Test The Output Test menu selection displays the Output Test screens (Figures 3-44 and 3-45) which provides the user with the ability to test each output relay. See Section 6, Testing for detailed testing instructions.

Figure 3-44 Output Test Dialog Screen Figure 3-42 Setup Relay Comm Port Dialog Screen

Figure 3-45 Output Test Warning Dialog Screen

333

M3425A Instruction Book

Tools/Counters and Error Codes The Counters and Error Codes menu selection displays the Counters and Error Codes screen (Figure 3-46) which provides the user with the ability to view and clear system Error Codes, Alarm Counters, Power Loss Counter and Output Counters. Also, Checksums can be viewed for Calibration and Setpoints. See Chapter 2, Manual Operation for detailed instructions.

Figure 3-46 Counters and Error Codes Dialog Screen

334

IPScom3

Tools/Firmware Update p CAUTION: M-3425A Fir mware Version D0114CXX.XX.XX cannot be updated with this firmware update tool. The Firmware Update feature allows the user to perform M-3425A Firmware updates. Firmware update files and instructions are provided by Beckwith Electric.

Window Menu

The Window menu enables positioning and arrangement of IPScom windows so that there is better access to available functions. This feature allows the display of several windows at the same time. Clicking on an inactive yet displayed window activates that window. Help Menu

Figure 3-47 Firmware Update Warning Dialog Screen


Tools/Calibration Data The Calibration Data feature allows the user to retrieve calibration data from M-3425A relays. It also allows relay calibration data to be restored to the relay.

The Help menu provides two selections. The Contents selection initiates a link to a PDF (Portable Document File) version of this instruction book for easy reference. An Adobe Acrobat reader is required to view this document. The M-3425A Instruction Book has been indexed to its table of contents. By selecting the Navigator pane in Adobe Acrobat Reader, the user can directly access selected topics. The About command displays the IPScom version and relay firmware version.

Figure 3-49 Calibration Data Retrieve Dialog Screen

Figure 3-48 Calibration Data Restore Dialog Screen

335

M3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

336

System Setup and Setpoints 4

4
4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4

System Setup and Setpoints

Unit Setup................................................................................ 41 Setup System......................................................................... 428 System Diagrams................................................................... 433 System Setpoints................................................................... 439

Chapter four is designed for the person or group responsible for the Unit Setup, Configuration and System Setpoints of the M-3425A Generator Protection Relay. Chapter 4 consists of: Functional and connection diagrams for a typical application of the relay. The Unit Setup Section, which consists of general unit setup information, Communications setup, Oscillograph and Sequence of Events setup. The Configuration Section provides the definitions of system quantities and equipment characteristics required by the relay which include CT, VT configuration selection and Input and Output assignments. A System Setpoints Section which describes the enabling of functions and setpoints, output contact assignments and digital input assignments.

4.1 Unit Setup


NOTE: Setup Record Forms are contained in Appendix A. The Setup Record Form tables list the relay parameter settings choices for each feature and function. GENERAL UNIT SETUP The General Unit setup consists of the setup of the following features and functions: Comm Access Code User Access Codes User Logo Lines User Control Number OK LED Flash Time and Date

COMM ACCESS CODE If additional link security is desired, a communication access code can be programmed. Like the user access codes, if the communication access code is set to 9999 (default), communication security is disabled.

The selection of the M-3425A System Setup parameters and Setpoints can be performed using either the S-3400 IPScom Communications Software or from the units M3931 Front Panel Human Machine Interface (HMI), and will be included where applicable.

41

M3425A Instruction Book

Chapter 4 - System Setup and Setpoints


4.1 Unit Setup......................................................1 General Unit Setup...........................................1 Comm Access Code........................................1 IPScom Comm Access Code Setup................4 HMI Comm Access Code Setup......................5 IPScom User Access Code Setup...................6 HMI User Access Codes Setup........................7 User Logo Line.................................................8 User Control Number.......................................8 System OK LED...............................................8 IPScom User Logo Line, User Control Number, System OK LED Setup and HMI Blanking.............................................8 HMI User Logo Line Setup...............................8 HMI User Control Number Setup...................10 HMI System OK LED Setup...........................11 System Clock.................................................12 IPScom Set Date/Time...................................12 HMI SET DATE and TIME.............................12 Communication Setup....................................14 Serial Ports (RS-232).....................................14 Serial Port (RS-485).......................................14 Direct Connection...........................................14 Device Address..............................................14 IPScom COM Port Definitions and Systems Communication Address................14 HMI COM Port Definitions and Device Address..........................................................16 COM Port Security.........................................17 Disabling COM Ports......................................17 Ethernet Communication Settings..................18 DHCP Protocol...............................................18 ETHERNET Protocols....................................18 IPScom Ethernet Port Setup with DHCP.......18

IPScom Ethernet Port Setup without DHCP.............................................................18 HMI Ethernet Port Setup................................19 Manual Configuration of Ethernet Board........20 Installing the Modems....................................21 Connecting the PC Modem............................21 Initializing the PC Modem..............................22 Connecting the Local Modem to the Relay....23 Oscillograph Setup.........................................24 IPScom Setup Oscillograph Recorder...........25 HMI Setup Oscillograph Recorder.................26 IPScom Setup Sequence of Events Recorder........................................................27 4.2 Setup System..............................................28 4.3 System Diagrams.......................................33 4.4 System Setpoints.......................................39 Setpoint Profiles (Setting Groups)..................39 Configure Relay Data.....................................39 Functions........................................................40 Special Considerations..................................41 21 Phase Distance.........................................46 24 Overexcitation Volts/Hz.............................50 M3425A Firmware Versions D0114VXX.XX.XX and Earlier......................51 M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.00.34..........................................51 M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.04.00..........................................51 25 Sync Check...............................................53 Phase Angle Check........................................53 Delta Voltage and Delta Frequency Check....53 27 Phase Undervoltage..................................57 27TN #2 Screens are identical to 27TN #1....60 32 Directional Power......................................61 Protection from Generator Motoring...............61 Protection from Generator Overload..............61

42

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Protection from Excessive Reactive Power...61 40 Loss of Field..............................................65 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent...............68 49 Stator Overload Protection .......................70 50/50N Instantaneous Overcurrent, Phase and Neutral Circuits............................73 50BF Generator Breaker Failure/HV Breaker Flashover..........................................75 50DT Definite Time Overcurrent (for split-phase differential).............................77 50/27 Inadvertent Energizing.........................78 51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent..........80 51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Restraint...............................81 59 Phase Overvoltage....................................83 59D Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (Ratio)............................................................85 59N Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence.......................................................87 59X Multipurpose Overvoltage (Turn-toTurn Stator Fault Protection or Bus Ground Protection)......................................................89 60FL VT Fuse Loss........................................91 Internal Fuse Loss Detection Logic................91 External Fuse-Loss Function.........................91 60FL VT Fuse Loss Alarm Function...............91 64B/F Field Ground Protection.......................93 64F Field Ground Detection...........................93 Factors Affecting 64F Performance...............93 64B Brush Lift-Off Detection..........................95 64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Signal Injection.....................97 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent..........103 78 Out-of-Step..............................................106 81 Frequency...............................................109 81A Frequency Accumulator........................112 81R Rate of Change of Frequency..............114 87 Phase Differential....................................115

87GD Ground (Zero Sequence) Differential....................................................117 Breaker Monitoring.......................................118 Trip Circuit Monitoring..................................119 IPSlogic....................................................120 Settings and Logic Applicable when IPSlogic Function(s) programmed using IPScom............................................122 DO/RST (Dropout/Reset) Timer Feature.....124 Dropout Delay Timer....................................124 Reset Delay Timer.......................................124

43

M3425A Instruction Book

IPScom Comm Access Code Setup To set the relay Comm Access Code perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Security/Change Comm Access Code. IPScom will display the Change Comm Access Code dialog screen (Figure 4-1).

4. Select Yes, IPScom will display an Access Code Was Changed Successfully Confirmation Screen (Figure 4-3).

Figure 4-3 Access Code Changed Confirmation Screen


5. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main Screen. The new Comm Access Code will not be in affect until communications have been closed with the relay for approximately 2.5 minutes.

Figure 4-1 Change Comm Access Code Dialog Screen


2. E n t e r t h e d e s i r e d N ew C o m m Access Code (1-9999), then re-enter (confirmation) the New Access Code.

3. Select Save, IPScom will display an Access Code change Confirmation Screen (Figure 4-2).

Figure 4-2 Access Code Change Confirmation Screen

44

System Setup and Setpoints 4

HMI Comm Access Code Setup 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted!

6.

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: COMM ACCESS CODE dly ACCSS eth eth_ip

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: COMM ACCESS CODE 8. a. 9999 Input the desired Comm Access Code as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Comm Access Code digits. When the desired Comm Access Code has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz c. v/hz b.

COMM ACCESS CODE ACCESS eth eth_ip 9. Press Exit.

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: C OMMUNICATION W targets osc_rec COMM V

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C OM1 SETUP COM1 com2 com3 com_adr

45

M3425A Instruction Book

IPScom User Access Code Setup The relay includes three levels of access codes. Depending on their assigned code, users have varying levels of access to the relay features and functions. 1. Level1Access = Read setpoints, monitor status, view status history. Level2Access = All of level 1 privileges, plus read & change setpoints, target history, set time clock.

2.

Enter a valid Access Code, then select OK. IPScom will display the Change User Access Code dialog screen (Figure 4-5).

2.

3. Level3Access = All of level 2 privileges, plus access to all configuration functions and settings.

Each access code is a userdefined one-to-four digit number. Access codes can only be altered by a Level 3 user. If the Level 3 Access Code is set to 9999, the access code feature is disabled. When access codes are disabled, the access screens are bypassed, and all users have full access to all the relay menus. The device is shipped from the factory with the access code feature disabled. To setup the relay User Access Codes perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Security/Change User Access Code. IPScom will display the Access Level Code dialog screen (Figure 4-4).

Figure 4-5 Change User Access Code Dialog Screen


3. Enter the desired User Access Code(s) (1-9999), then re-enter (confirmation) the desired User Access Code(s).

4. Select Save, IPScom will display an Access Code change Confirmation Screen (Figure 4-2). 5. Select Yes, IPScom will display an Access Code Was Changed Successfully Confirmation Screen (Figure 4-3). 6. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.

Figure 4-4 Access Level Code Dialog Screen

46

System Setup and Setpoints 4

HMI User Access Codes Setup 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz 10. v/hz

ENTER ACCESS CODE LEVEL#1 level#2 level#3 8. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: L EVEL #1 9999 9. a. Input the desired User Access Code as follows:

Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. b. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Access Code. c. When the desired Access Code has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE LEVEL#1 level#2 level#3 To set User Access Code Level #2 press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select LEVEL #2, then press ENTER the following will be displayed: L EVEL #2 9999

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT SETUP 11. 12.

Repeat Step 9 to enter the desired Level #2 User Access Code. To set User Access Code Level #3 press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select LEVEL #3, then press ENTER the following will be displayed: L EVEL #3 9999

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: S OFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V 6. If User Access Codes are to be set, then use the RIGHT arrow pushbutton to select ALTER ACCESS CODES. The following will be displayed:

13. 14.

Repeat Step 9 to enter the desired Level #3 User Access Code. Press the EXIT pushbutton will return to the previous selection screen: ALTER ACCESS CODES

ALTER ACCESS CODES vers sn ACCESS number V 7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed:

vers eth sn ACCESS

47

M3425A Instruction Book

USER LOGO LINE The user logo is a programmable, two-line by 24character string, which can be used to identify the relay, and which is displayed locally when the unit is idle. This information is also available in IPScom. USER CONTROL NUMBER The User Control Number is a user-defined value which can be used for inventory or identification. The unit does not use this value, however, it can be accessed through the HMI or the communications interface, and can also be read remotely. SYSTEM OK LED The green SYSTEM OK LED is controlled by the units microprocessor. A flashing SYSTEM OK LED indicates proper program cycling. The LED can also be programmed to be continuously illuminated indicating proper program cycling. IPScom User Logo Line, User Control Number, System OK LED Setup and HMI Blanking To set the relay User Logo Lines, User Control Number, System OK LED and HMI Blanking perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/User Information. IPScom will display the User Information dialog screen (Figure 4-6).

HMI User Logo Line Setup 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz V v/hz V

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT SETUP

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: S OFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V

Figure 4-6 User Information Dialog Screen


2. 3. 4. If entering/editing the User Logo lines, then enter the desired User Logo Lines. If changing the User Control Number, then enter the desired User Control Number. If enabling/disabling the System OK LED Flash operation, then select either Enable or Disable.

6.

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: USER LOGO LINE 1 LOGO 1 logo 2 alrm V

5. Select Save, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.


48

System Setup and Setpoints 4

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: USER LOGO LINE 1 _BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO. 8. a. Input the desired User Logo Line 1 as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first letter/symbol/digit/blank space. Press the Right arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired User Logo Line 1. When the desired User Logo Line 1 has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

10. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: USER LOGO LINE 2 _ 11. a. M-3425A

Input the desired User Logo Line 2 as follows:

b.

c.

Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first letter/symbol/digit/blank space. b. Press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired User Logo Line 2. c. When the desired User Logo Line 2 has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: USER LOGO LINE 2 WAIT USER LOGO LINE 2 logo 1 LOGO 2 alrm

USER LOGO LINE 1 WAIT USER LOGO LINE 1 LOGO 1 logo 2 alrm 9. To enter a User Logo Line 2 press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton once, the following will be displayed: USER LOGO LINE 2 logo 1 LOGO 2 alrm

12. Press Exit.

49

M3425A Instruction Book

HMI User Control Number Setup 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz V v/hz V

6.

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: USER CONTROL NUMBER vers sn access NUMBER V

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: USER CONTROL NUMBER 1 8. a. Input the desired User Control Number as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired User Control Number. When the desired User Control Number has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

b.

c.

USER CONTROL NUMBER vers sn access NUMBER V 9. Press Exit.

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT SETUP

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: S OFTWARE VERSION vers sn ACCESS number V

410

System Setup and Setpoints 4

HMI System OK LED Setup 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz V v/hz V

7. Press ENTER, the following warning will be displayed: PROCESSOR WILL RESET! ENTER KEY TO CONTINUE CAUTION: Do not enter DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service. Entering DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service removes all protective functions of the relay. 8. Press ENTER, the relay will reset and DIAGNOSTIC MODE will be temporarily displayed followed by: OUTPUT TEST (RELAY) OUTPUT input led target V 9. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: FLASH SYS OK LED com3 clock LED cal V

10. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: FLASH SYS OK LED off ON

CAUTION: Do not enter DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service. Entering DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service removes all protective functions of the relay. 4. Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT W stat comm SETUP V

11.

Utilizing the Right or Left arrow pushbuttons select either ON or OFF.

12. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: FLASH SYS OK LED DONE 13. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: FLASH SYS OK LED W com3 clock LED cal V

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: S OFTWARE VERSION VERS eth sn access 6. V

14. Press EXIT , the following will be displayed: PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE 15. Press EXIT, the unit will cycle through the Power Self Tests.
411

Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: D IAGNOSTIC MODE W DIAG

M3425A Instruction Book

SYSTEM CLOCK This feature allows the user to set the relay internal clock. The clock is used to time stamp system events and oscillograph operations. The clock is disabled when shipped from the factory (indicated by 80 seconds appearing on the clock) to preserve battery life. If the relay is to be unpowered for an extended length of time, the clock should be stopped (from Diagnostic Mode or IPScom Figure 4-7). If the IRIGB interface is used, the hours, minutes, and seconds information in the clock will be synchronized with IRIGB time information every hour. The relay can accept a modulated IRIGB signal using the rear panel BNC connector, or a demodulated TTL level signal using extra pins on the rear panel COM2 RS232 interface connector (see Figure B4 for COM2 pinout.) If the TTL signal is to be used, then Jumper 5 will be required to be positioned (see Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers).

HMI SET DATE and TIME 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz v/hz

IPScom Set Date/Time To set the relay Date/Time perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Setup/Setup Date & Time. IPScom will display the Setup Date/Time dialog screen (Figure 4-7).

4.

Press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT stat comm SETUP

5. Press ENTER, then press the RIGHT arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: DATE & TIME

Figure 4-7 Setup Date/Time Dialog Screen


2. Enter the desired Date and/or Time. 3. Select SAVE, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.

W TIME error eth_ver diag 6. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: DATE & TIME 0 8-Jan-2001 00:00:80

412

System Setup and Setpoints 4

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: DATE & TIME 8. a. 01 Year Input the desired Year as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Year. When the desired Year has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

b. When the desired Day has been selected, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: DATE & TIME 01 Hour Input the desired Hour as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Hour. When the desired Hour has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

12. a.

b.

b.

c.

c.

DATE & TIME J AN feb mar apr may V 9. a. Input the desired Month as follows: 13. a. DATE & TIME 13 Minutes Input the desired Minutes as follows:

Utilizing the Right or Left arrow pushbuttons select the desired Month. b. When the desired Month has been selected, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: DATE & TIME 8 Date

10. a.

Input the desired Date as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired Date first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired date. When the desired Date has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. b. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Minute(s). c. When the desired Minutes have been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: DATE & TIME 16 Seconds Input the desired Seconds as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Seconds. When the desired Seconds have been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed:

b.

14. a. b.

c.

DATE & TIME SUN mon tue wed thu V 11. a. Input the desired Day as follows: Utilizing the Right or Left arrow pushbuttons select the desired Day. c.

DATE & TIME W TIME error eth_ver diag


413

M3425A Instruction Book

COMMUNICATION SETUP Communication setup can be accomplished utilizing either IPScom or the HMI. The Communication setup consists of the setup of the following features and functions: COM Port definitions and Device Address Ethernet Port Settings Installing Modems

Other communication topologies are possible using the M-3425A Transformer Protection System. An Application Note, Serial Communication with Beckwith Electrics Integrated Protection System Relays is available from the factory or from our website at www.beckwithelectric.com. CAUTION: The Echo Cancel check box should only be used when several relays are connected using a fiber optic loop network. Otherwise, echo cancel must not be selected or communication will be prevented. CAUTION: If the serial port is connected to something other than a modem, and an IPScom modem command is executed, the results are unpredictable. In some cases, the computer may have to be reset. Device Address Individual relay Device Addresses should be between 1 and 255. The default Device Address is 1. IPScom COM Port Definitions and Systems Communication Address To setup the COM Ports and Communication Addresses perform the following: NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. The IPSCom installation and establishing initial Local communications are covered in Section 5.6, IPScom Communications Software Installation, and Section 5.7, Activating Initial Local Communications.

Serial Ports (RS-232) Two serial interface ports, COM1 and COM2, are standard 9-pin, RS-232, DTE-configured ports. The front-panel port, COM1, can be used to locally set and interrogate the relay using a temporary connection to a PC or laptop computer. The second RS-232 port, COM2, is provided at the rear of the unit. COM2 is unavailable for communications when the optional ethernet port is enabled. However, the Demodulated IRIG-B may still be used through the COM2 Port when Ethernet is enabled. Serial Port (RS-485) COM3 located on the rear terminal block of the M-3425A is an RS-485, 2-wire connection. Appendix B, Figure B-3 illustrates a 2-wire RS485 network. Individual remote addressing also allows for communications through a serial multidrop network. Up to 32 relays can be connected using the same 2 wire RS-485 communications line. Direct Connection In order for IPScom to communicate with the relay using direct serial connection, a serial null modem cable is required, with a 9-pin connector (DB9P) for the system, and an applicable connector for the computer (usually DB9S or DB25S). Pin-outs for a null modem adapter are provided in Appendix B, Communications. An optional 10 foot null modem cable (M-0423) is available from the factory, for direct connection between a PC and the relays front panel COM port, or the rear COM2 port. When fabricating communication cables, every effort should be made to keep cabling as short as possible. Low capacitance cable is recommended. The RS232 standard specifies a maximum cable length of 50 feet for RS-232 connections. If over 50 feet of cable length is required, other technologies should be investigated.

414

System Setup and Setpoints 4

1.

From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Relay Communication/ Setup Comm Port. IPScom will display the Setup Comm Port dialog screen (Figure 4-8). The System COM Port that is in use will be indicated at the top of the display.

6. Enter the desired communications Protocol (MODBUS, DNP3.0). 7. Enter the desired Systems Communication Address (1 to 255). The individual addressing capability of IPScom and the relay allows multiple systems to share a direct or modem connection when connected through COM2 using a communications-line splitter (Figure 4-9). One such device enables 2 to 6 units to share one communications line. Appendix B, Figure B2 illustrates a setup of RS-232 Fiber Optic network. Enter the desired Dead Sync Time (2 to 3000 msec). This delay establishes the line idle time to re-sync packet communication. Dead sync time should be programmed based on the channels baud rate. Baud Rate 9600 4800 Dead-Sync Time 4 ms 8 ms 16 ms 32 ms

8.

Figure 4-8 Setup Comm Port Dialog Screen


2. 3. Select the desired COM Port to be setup (1, 2 or 3). Enter the desired Baud Rate (1200 to 9600). COM2 and COM3 share the same baud rate (see Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers). Enter the desired Parity (None, odd or even). Enter the desired Stop Bits value (1 or 2). 9.

2400 1200

Table 4-1 Dead-Sync Time


When the COM Port settings have been entered, then select Save. IPScom will display the COM Port Settings Warning Screen (Figure 4-2).

4. 5.

10. Select OK, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.

WindowsTM based computer

Figure 4-9 Setup Comm Port Dialog Screen


415

M3425A Instruction Book

HMI COM Port Definitions and Device Address 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0

8. Press ENTER. If setting up COM1, the screen will return to the beginning of the Comm menu. If setting up COM2 or 3, the following will be displayed: COM2 DEAD SYNC TIME 50 ms 9. a. b. Input the desired Dead Sync Time as follows: Utilizing the Up and Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired first digit. Press the Left arrow pushbutton once, then repeat the previous step as necessary to input the desired Dead Sync Time. When the desired Dead Sync Time has been input, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: PROTOCOL

a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted!

V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz V v/hz V

c.

COM2

beco 2200 modbus dnp3 10. Utilizing the Left and Right arrow pushbuttons, select the desired protocol, then press ENTER. The following will be displayed: COM2 PARITY

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: C ommunication W targets osc-rec COMM V 11.

NONE odd even Press the Left or Right arrow pushbutton as necessary to select the desired Parity setting.

5.

Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C OM1 SETUP COM1 com2 com3 com_adr V

12. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: COM2 STOP BITS 1 13. Utilizing the Up or Down arrow pushbuttons select the desired Stop Bits.

6. Press ENTER and the following is displayed: COM1 BAUD RATE b aud_4800 BAUD_9600 7. Press the Left or Right arrow pushbutton as necessary to select the desired baud rate.

14. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C OM1 SETUP com1 COM2 com3 com_adr 15. Selecting COM 3 will activate the same menu choices as displayed with the selection of COM1/2. Repeat as necessary to setup the remaining COM Ports.

416

System Setup and Setpoints 4

COM Port Security COM1, COM2 and COM3 may be disabled for security purposes from the unit HMI. A Level 2 Access Code is required. Disabling COM Ports 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0 a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted! I NIT TRANSFER INIT rmte_lcal c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: I NIT TRANSFER INIT rmte_lcal 4. Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: C ommunication stat COMM setup 9. 5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C OM1 SETUP COM1 com2 com3 com_adr 6. Press ENTER and the following is displayed: P ORT ACCESS enable 7. DISABLE

Press the Left or Right Arrow pushbutton as necessary to enable or disable the COM port.

8. Press ENTER and the following is displayed: COM1 BAUD RATE b aud_4800 BAUD_9600 Repeat Steps 5 through 8 as necessary for additional COM Ports.

417

M3425A Instruction Book

ETHERNET COMMUNICATION SETTINGS The optional RJ45 Ethernet port can be enabled utilizing either IPScom from the Ethernet Settings menu or from the HMI Communication menu. When the ethernet port is enabled the COM2 Serial Port is not available for communications. The demodulated IRIG-B may still be used via the COM2 Port when ethernet is enabled. Although the ethernet connection speed is faster than the RS-232 port (can be up to 10 Mbps), the ethernet module connects internally through the COM2 serial connection and is therefore limited to connection speeds up to 9600 bps The following parameters must be set for proper ethernet communication: DHCP PROTOCOL ENABLE: If the network server supports the DHCP protocol the network server will assign the IP Address, Net Mask and Gateway Address. DISABLE: If the network server does not support the DHCP protocol or the user chooses to manually input ethernet settings, then obtain the IP Address, Net Mask and Gateway address from the Network Administrator and enter the settings. ETHERNET PROTOCOLS SERCONV: To utilize the BECO2200 protocol over a TCP/IP connection select the SERCONV (BECO2200 TCP/IP) protocol. The IP Address of the relay must be entered in the IPScom Communication screen. Also, ensure that the COM2 protocol is selected to BECO2200 and the baud rate is set to 9600 bps. The Standard Port Number for the BECO2200 over TCP/IP protocol is 8800. The master device may require the entry of the Standard Port Number. MODBUS: To utilize the MODBUS protocol over a TCP/IP connection select the MODBUS (MODBUS over TCP/IP) protocol. The IP Address of the relay must be entered in the IPScom Communication screen. Also, ensure that the COM2 protocol is selected to MODBUS, baud rate is set to 9600 bps, 1 stop bit and no parity selected. The Standard Port Number for the MODBUS over TCP/IP protocol is 502. The master device may require the entry of the Standard Port Number. IEC 61850: When the Ethernet option is purchased with the IEC 61850 protocol, no other protocol may be selected.

Protocol documents are available directly from Beckwith Electric or from our website www.beckwithelectric.com. IPScom Ethernet Port Setup with DHCP NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Ethernet Setup/Setup Ethernet. IPScom will display the Setup Ethernet screen (Figure 4-10).

Figure 4-10 Setup Ethernet Screen


2. 3. 4. Select Ethernet Board Enable. Select DHCP Protocol Enable. Select the desired protocol.

5. Select Save. The ethernet board is now configured for use and may be accessed through a network. IPScom Ethernet Port Setup without DHCP NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Tools/Ethernet Setup. IPScom will display the Ethernet Setup screen (Figure 4-10). Select Ethernet Enable. Select DHCP Protocol Disable. Enter values for IP Address, Net Mask and Gateway. Select the desired protocol.

2. 3. 4. 5.

6. Select Save. The ethernet board is now configured for use and may be accessed through a network.

418

System Setup and Setpoints 4

HMI Ethernet Port Setup 1. Ensure that the Communication Menu is selected to COMM (upper case). C OMMUNICATION targets osc_rec COMM If COMM is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select COMM.

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: D HCP PROTOCOL D ISABLE enable 8. If the network does not support the DHCP protocol, then go to Manual Configuration of Ethernet Board (following page) to manually configure the ethernet board. If the DHCP Protocol is to be enabled, then use the Right/Left arrow pushbutton to select ENABLE (Upper Case), then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: T CP/IP SETTINGS T CP prot

2. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C OM1 SETUP C OM1 com2 com3 com_adr 3. Use the Right arrow pushbutton to select ETH (Upper Case). E THERNET SETUP W dly accss ETH eth_ip 10. 9.

Ensure that PROT is selected (Upper Case). If PROT is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right arrow pushbutton to select PROT.

4. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: E THERNET D ISABLE enable 5. Use the Right arrow pushbutton to select ENABLE (Upper Case), then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: T CP/IP SETTINGS T CP prot 6. Ensure that TCP is selected (Upper Case). If TCP is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select TCP.

11. Press ENTER , depending on the Ethernet board that is installed one of the following screens will be displayed: S ELECT PROTOCOL modbus serconv

S ELECT PROTOCOL IEC 61850

419

M3425A Instruction Book

12.

Use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select the desired protocol (Upper Case), then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: E THERNET PROTOCOL t cp PROT

Manual Configuration of Ethernet Board 1. Ensure that DISABLE is selected (Upper Case). If DISABLE is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Left arrow pushbutton to select DISABLE.

13. Press EXIT, the ethernet board will reconfigure and the following will be displayed: C ONFIGURING ETH...

2. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: I P ADDRESS X X.XX.XX.XX 3. Enter the desired IP Address, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: N ET MASK X X.XX.XX.XX 4. Enter the desired Net Mask, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: G ATEWAY X X.XX.XX.XX 5. Enter the desired Gateway, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: T CP/IP SETTINGS

If the ethernet board successfully obtains an IP Address the following will be displayed for approximately 2 seconds: ETHERNET IP ADDRESS XX.XX.XX.XX

The ethernet board is now configured for use and may be accessed through a network. Then the display will return to the following: E THERNET SETUP W dly accss ETH eth_ip 6.

t cp prot Ensure that PROT is selected (Upper Case). If PROT is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right arrow pushbutton to select PROT.

If the ethernet board fails to obtain an IP Address within 15 seconds the following will be displayed (for approximately 2 seconds): C ONFIGURING ETH... ETH BOARD ERROR

7. Press ENTER , depending on the Ethernet board that is installed one of the following screens will be displayed: S ELECT PROTOCOL modbus serconv

Contact the Network Administrator to determine the cause of the configuration failure.

S ELECT PROTOCOL IEC 61850

420

System Setup and Setpoints 4

8.

Use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select the desired protocol (Upper Case), then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: T CP/IP SETTINGS t cp PROT

INSTALLING THE MODEMS Using IPScom to interrogate, set or monitor the relay using a modem requires both a remote modem connected at the relays location and a local modem connected to the computer with IPScom installed. NOTE: Any compatible modem may be used; however, the unit only communicates at 1200 to 9600 baud. In order to use IPScom to communicate with the relay using a modem, the following must be provided with the relay: An external modem (1200 baud or higher), capable of understanding standard AT commands. Serial modem cable with 9-pin connector for the relay and the applicable connector for the modem.

9. Press EXIT, the ethernet board will reconfigure and the following will be displayed: C ONFIGURING ETH...

If the ethernet board is successfully configured, then the entered IP Address will be displayed for approximately 2 seconds: ETHERNET IP ADDRESS XX.XX.XX.XX

Similarly, the computer running IPScom must also have access to a compatible internal or external modem. Connecting the PC Modem 1. If the computer has an external modem, then use a standard straight-through RS232 modem cable (M-3933) to connect the computer to the modem. 2. If the computer has an internal modem, then refer to the modems instruction book to determine which communications port should be selected. Verify that the modem is attached to (if external) or assigned to (if internal) the same serial port as assigned in IPScom. While IPScom can use any of the 255 serial ports (COM1 through COM255), most computers support only COM1 and COM2. Connect the modem to a telephone line, then energize the modem.

The ethernet board is now configured for use and may be accessed through a network.

3.

4.

421

M3425A Instruction Book

Initializing the PC Modem 1. Verify that the modem is connected as described in Connecting the PC Modem. 2. 3. 4. Open IPScom, then select the Connect/ Modem menu item. IPScom will display the Modem Dialog screen (Figure 4-11). Enter the required information in the Modem Settings section of the screen, then select Connect.

COMMAND BUTTONS Add Allows you to review and change the user lines (unit identifier), phone number, and communication address of a selected entry. Deletes a selected entry. Saves any changes to the displayed information Dials the entry selected from the directory. Ends modem communication, allowing the user to dial again.

Remove Save Connect Cancel

Figure 4-11 Modem Dialog Screen

422

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Connecting the Local Modem to the Relay Setup of the modem attached to the relay may be slightly complicated. It involves programming parameters (using the AT command set), and storing this profile in the modems nonvolatile memory. After programming, the modem will power up in the proper state for communicating with the relay. Programming may be accomplished by using the Bring Up Terminal Window after dialing selection (Figure 4-12). Refer to your modem manual for further information.

Connect the Modem to the relay as follows: 1. Connect the unit to an external modem by attaching a standard RS-232 modem cable to the appropriate serial communications port on both the unit and the modem. 2. Connect the modem to a telephone line, then energize the modem.

The modem attached to the relay must have the following AT command configuration: E0 Q1 &D3 &S0 &C1 No Echo Dont return result code On to OFF DTR, hangup and reset DSR always on DCD ON when detected

S0=2 Answer on second ring

The following commands may also be required at the modem: &Q6 N0 W \Q3 &B1 S37 Constant DTE to DCE Answer only at specified speed Disable serial data rate adjust Bidirectional RTS/CTS relay Fixed serial port rate Desired line connection speed

Figure 4-12 Terminal Window


NOTE: The relay does not issue or understand any modem commands. It will not adjust the baud rate and should be considered a dumb peripheral. It communicates with 1 start, 8 data, and 0, 1 or 2 stop bits.

When connected to another terminal device, the Terminal Window allows the user to send messages or commands. Outgoing communications are displayed in the top pane and incoming messages are displayed in the bottom two panes, in ASCII text and HEX format. There are some variations in the AT commands supported by modem manufacturers. Refer to the hardware user documentation for a list of supported AT commands and direction on issuing these commands.

423

M3425A Instruction Book

OSCILLOGRAPH SETUP The Oscillograph Recorder provides comprehensive data recording (voltage, current, and status input/ output signals) for all monitored waveforms (at 16 samples per cycle). Oscillograph data can be downloaded using the communications ports to any personal computer running the S-3400 IPScom Communications Software. Once downloaded, the waveform data can be examined and printed using the optional M3801D IPSplot PLUS Oscillograph Data Analysis Software and are also available in COMTRADE file format. CAUTION: Oscillograph records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted. The general information required to complete the input data of this section includes: Recorder Partitions: When untriggered, the recorder continuously records waveform data, keeping the data in a buffer memory. The recorders memory may be partitioned into 1 to 24 partitions. Table 4-2 illustrates the number of cycles of waveform data per partition with various numbers of windings

NOTE: Oscillograph recorder settings are not considered part of the Setpoint Profile. Recorder settings are common to all profiles. Number of Partitions 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 Number of Cycles per Each Partition 416 Cycles 280 Cycles 208 Cycles 168 Cycles 136 Cycles 120 Cycles 104 Cycles 88 Cycles 80 Cycles 72 Cycles 64 Cycles 64 Cycles 56 Cycles 56 Cycles 48 Cycles 48 Cycles

When triggered, the time stamp is recorded, and the recorder continues recording for a user-defined period. The snapshot of the waveform is stored in memory for later retrieval using IPScom Communications Software. The OSC TRIG LED on the front panel will indicate a recorder operation (data is available for downloading). Trigger Inputs and Outputs: The recorder can be triggered remotely through serial communications using IPScom, or automatically using programmed status inputs or outputs. Post-Trigger Delay: A post-trigger delay of 5% to 95% must be specified. After triggering, the recorder will continue to store data for the programmed portion of the total record before re-arming for the next record. For example, a setting of 80% will result in a record with 20% pretrigger data, and 80% post-trigger data.

Table 4-2 Recorder Partitions

424

System Setup and Setpoints 4

IPScom Setup Oscillograph Recorder NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. When not connected to the relay the Save selection does not save the Oscillograph Recorder settings to an open file. To setup the Oscillograph Recorder perform the following: 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Oscillograph/ Setup. IPScom will display the Setup Oscillograph Recorder dialog screen (Figure 4-13).

2.

Select the Number of Partitions. The recorders memory may be partitioned into 1 to 24 partitions. The relay Oscillograph Recorder memory buffer is fixed and contains room for a finite number of cycles of recorded data. Consider Table 4-2 when determining the number of Oscillograph records, The number of cycles of recorded data is directly related to the number of records selected. Select the desired Trigger Inputs and Trigger Outputs. The recorder can be triggered remotely through serial communications using IPScom, or automatically using programmed status inputs or outputs. Select the Post Trigger Delay. A post-trigger delay of 5% to 95% must be specified. After triggering, the recorder will continue to store data for the programmed portion of the total record before re-arming for the next record. For example, a setting of 80% will result in a record with 20% pre-trigger data, and 80% post-trigger data.

3.

4.

Figure 4-13 Setup Oscillograph Recorder

5. Select Save, IPScom will display a save to device Confirmation Screen (Figure 4-2). 6. Select YES, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.

425

M3425A Instruction Book

HMI Setup Oscillograph Recorder 1. Press the ENTER pushbutton. 2. If Level Access is active, the following is displayed: ENTER ACCESS CODE 0

7. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: R ECORDER PARTITIONS 1 8. Input the desired number of Recorder Partitions.

a. Input the required Access Code, then press ENTER. b. If the proper Access Code has been entered, the HMI will return: LEVEL #(1,2 or 3) A ccess Granted!

9. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: TRIGGER INPUTS I6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 10. Press the Right or Left arrow pushbutton as necessary to select the desired Trigger Input, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: T rigger outputs o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 11. Press the Right or Left arrow pushbutton as necessary to select the desired Trigger Output, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: post trigger delay 5 % 12. Press the Right or Left arrow pushbutton as necessary to select the desired digit and the Up or Down arrow pushbutton to increment the Post Trigger Relay, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: R ECORDER SETUP stat clear SETUP

V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq c. 3. Go to step 4. If Level Access is not active, then the following is displayed: V OLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq 4. v/hz V v/hz

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: O SCILLOGRAPH RECORDER W targets OSC_REC comm V

5. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: VIEW RECORD STATUS STAT 6. clear setup

Press the Right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: R ECORDER SETUP stat clear SETUP

13. Press Exit.

426

System Setup and Setpoints 4

IPScom Setup Sequence of Events Recorder Protective function Pickup, Trip, Dropout and/or Output/Input Pickup or Dropout are selected to trigger the Sequence of Events Recorder. CAUTION: Sequence of Events Records are not retained if power to the relay is interrupted. NOTE: Communication must be established with the target relay for this procedure. When not connected to the relay the Save selection does not save the Sequence of Event settings to the open file.

To setup the Sequence of Events Recorder perform the following: 1. From the IPScom Main Screen menu select Relay/Sequence of Events/ Setup. IPScom will display the Setup Sequence of Events Recorder dialog screen (Figure 4-14). Select the desired Inputs and Outputs, then select Save. IPScom will display a save to device confirmation (Figure 4-2).

2.

3. Select YES, IPScom will return to the Main Screen.

Figure 4-14 Setup Sequence of Events Recorder Dialog Screen

427

M3425A Instruction Book

4.2

Setup System

NOTE: Table 43 assumes ACTIVE INPUT STATE set to default setting (close circuit = TRUE). Input 5 Open Closed Open Closed Input 6 Open Open Closed Closed Selection Profile 1 Profile 2 Profile 3 Profile 4

System setup data is required for proper operation of the relay. The Setup System consists of defining common information like CT and VT ratios, nominal voltage rating, nominal current rating and which profile is the Active Profile, etc. Values are entered similar to other setpoints. Configuration information is common to all profiles, and should be entered before setpoint and time settings.

Table 43 Input Activated Profile Logic

INPUTACTIVATEDPROFILES disableenable

When Input Activated Profiles is disabled, the Active Profile can be selected using HMI or remote communication. When enabled, the Active Profile is selected by the state of Input 5 and 6 (see Table 4-4). This screen sets the active setpoint profile.

ACTIVESETPOINTPROFILE

COPY ACTIVE PROFILE To_Profile_1 NOMINAL VOLTAGE Volts NOMINAL CURRENT Amps VT CONFIGURATION line-line line-ground line-gnd_to_line-line

This screen initiates a copy of the Active Profile to any one of the other profiles.

The secondary VT voltage when primary voltage is equal to the rated generator voltage. Vnominal=( V gen rated I VT ratio) for LL VT connections. Vnominal=(Vgen rated I (S 3 VT ratio)) for LG VT connections. The secondary CT current of the phase CTs with rated generator current. I nom = (VA I (Vgen rated(S3) )(CT ratio) ) Indicates VT connection. (See Figure 4-20, Three-Line Connection Diagram.) When lineground voltages are used, functions 24, 27, and 59 may operate for lineground faults. If this is not desired, the linegnd-to-lineline selection should be used to prevent operation of these functions for lineground faults. When linegnd-to-lineline is selected, the relay internally calculates lineline voltages from lineground voltages for all voltage-sensitive functions. This linegnd-tolineline selection should be used only for a VT linetoground nominal secondary voltage of 69V (not for 120 V). For this selection, the nominal voltage setting entered should be lineline nominal voltage, which is S 3 times lineground nominal voltage, and voltage function pickup setpoints calculation should be made using linetoline voltage.

428

System Setup and Setpoints 4

DELTA-Y TRANSFORM dis delta_ab delta_ac

When the generator is connected through a DeltaY (delta ab or delta ac) unit transformer, the relay will internally consider the 30 phase shift for 51V and 21 functions. It defines the connection of the Delta windings of the Delta /Y transformer. If the polarity of the A winding is connected to the non-polarity of the C winding, it is defined as Delta-AC and if the polarity of the A winding is connected to the non-polarity of the B winding, then it is defined as Delta-AB. In the ABC phase rotation, delta lags Y by 30 degrees in Delta-AC and delta leads Y by 30 degrees in Delta-AB. This screen allows the user to select the phase rotation of the M3425A to match the generator.

PHASE ROTATION a-c-ba-b-c 59/27 MAGNITUDE SELECT rms dft

This screen allows the selection of RMS or DFT for the 59 and 27 functions. The magnitude can be selected as the RMS of the total waveform (including harmonics) or the RMS of the 60/50 Hz fundamental component of the waveform using the Discrete Fourier Transform (DFT). When the RMS option is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate over a wide frequency range (10 to 80 Hz) and the accuracy of the time delay is +20 cycles. When the DFT option is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate near 50 or 60 Hz and the timer accuracy is K1 cycle. When a wider frequency response is needed, select RMS. For generator protection applications, it is recommended to use the RMS selection. RMS is the default when shipped from the factory. For 59 function when positive sequence voltage is selected, the calculation uses DFT irrespective of DFT/RMS selection.
NOTE: If neither pulsed or latched output is enabled, then

the output contact will default to the Normal Mode. Normal Mode maintains the output contact energized as long as the condition that caused it to operate exists. After the actuating condition is cleared, the contact will reset after the programmed seal-in time has elapsed. If the 50DT function is to be used for split-phase differential protection, this selection should be enabled. If the 50DT function is to be used as a definite time overcurrent function, or if 50DT is not enabled, this selection should be disabled. If pulse relay operation is selected, output will dropout after the seal-in delay expires, even if the condition which caused the relay to pick up is still out of band. When selected, latching outputs are not available. *

50DTSPLIT-PHASEDIFF disable enable

PULSE RELAY o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1

429

M3425A Instruction Book

LATCHED OUTPUTS o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1

If any of the outputs are selected as latched, then after tripping, this output will stay activated, even when the tripping condition is removed. The Latched Output can be reset using the TARGET RESET pushbutton. When selected, Pulse Relay is not available.* Minimum time the output contact will remain picked up to ensure proper seal-in, regardless of the subsequent state of the initiating function. Individual Seal-In settings are available for all outputs.* This designates the active state for the individual status input. Programming uppercase (see I6) causes the active or operated condition to be initiated by the external contact opening. Otherwise, external contact closure will activate the input.* * NOTE: Settings for expanded I/O must be made through IPScom. Ratio of the phase VTs. Example: 13,800 V : 120 V =13,800/120=115:1

RELAY SEAL-IN TIME OUT1 Cycles

ACTIVEINPUTOPEN/close I6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1

V.T. PHASE RATIO :1

V.T. NEUTRAL RATIO V.T. VX RATIO C.T. PHASE RATIO :1 :1 :1

Ratio of the neutral VT. Example: 13,800 V : 120 V =13,800/120=115:1

Ratio of auxiliar y VT. Example: 13,800 V : 120 V =13,800/120=115:1

Ratio of phase CTs. Example: 3,000:5 = 3000/5=600:1

C.T. NEUTRAL RATIO :1

Ratio of neutral CT. Example: 3,000:5 = 3000/5=600:1

430

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 415 IPScom Relay Setup System Dialog Screen

431

M3425A Instruction Book

If neither Pulsed or Latched Output is enabled, the output contact will default to the normal mode. In this mode, the output contact will stay energized as long as the abnormal condition which caused it to operate persists. After the abnormal condition is cleared, the contact will reset after the programmed seal-in time has elapsed.

Figure 416 IPScom Selection Screen for I/O Setup

Figure 417 IPScom Selection Screen for Output Seal-in Time

432

System Setup and Setpoints 4

4.3

System Diagrams
M-3425A Typical Connection Diagram
These functions are available in the Comprehensive Package. A subset of these functions are also available in a Base Package. This function is available as a optional protective function. M-3425A
Targets (Optional) Integral HMI (Optional) Metering Waveform Capture IRIG-B Front RS232 Communication Rear RS232 Communication Rear Ethernet Port (Optional) Rear RS-485 Communication Multiple Setting Groups Programmable I/O
27 (Note 3)

Utility System
52 Unit

This function provides control for the function to which it points.


50 50 DT
CT

BFPh

VT (Note 1) CT (Residual) (Note 4)

87

25
VT

52 Gen

81R

81A

81

27

59

24

M
(Metering) VT (Note 1)

59X

M-3921

64F

64B

Self Diagnostics Dual Power Supply (Optional) Breaker Monitoring Trip Circuit Monitoring Event Log
3VO (Calculated) 59D Line Side Voltage (Software Select) VX

78

60 FL

51V

50/27

40

32

21

50

49

46

M
(Metering)

CT

VX

3VO (Calculated) 67N Polarization (Software Select)

67N Operating Current (Software Select) IN

VN

67N
3IO

50 BFN

50N

51N

(Note 5)

59D

27 32

27 TN

64S

59N

87 GD

50 BFN

50N

51N
R

CT (Neutral) (Notes 2 & 5)

High-impedance Grounding with Third Harmonic 100% Ground Fault Protection

Low-impedance Grounding with Ground Differential and Overcurrent Stator Ground Fault Protection

NOTES: 1. When 25 function is enabled, 59X, 59D with VX and 67N with VX are not available, and vice versa. 2. When 67N function with IN (Residual) operating current is enabled, 87GD is not available, and vice versa. 3. The 50BFN, 50N, and 51N may utilize either the neutral current or the residual current. 4. When used as a turn-to-turn fault protection device. 5. The current input IN can be either from neutral current or residual current. 6. The 50BFN, 50N, 51N, 59D, 67N (with IN or VN) and 87GD functions are unavailable when the 64S function has been purchased. See the M-3425A Instruction Book for connection details.

Figure 418 One-Line Functional Diagram

433

M3425A Instruction Book

M-3425A Typical Connection Diagram


(Configured for Split-Phase Differential)

These functions are available in the Comprehensive Package. A subset of these functions are also available in a Base Package. This function is available as a optional protective function. This function provides control for the function to which it points.

Utility System
52 Unit

M-3425A
Targets (Optional) Integral HMI (Optional) Metering Waveform Capture IRIG-B Front RS232 Communication Rear RS232 Communication Rear Ethernet Port (Optional) Rear RS-485 Communication Multiple Setting Groups Programmable I/O Self Diagnostics Dual Power Supply (Optional) Breaker Monitoring Trip Circuit Monitoring Event Log
3VO (Calculated) VX VN 67N Polarization (Software Select) (Note 4) 27 (Note 2)

VT (Note 1) CT (Residual) (Note 5)

25
VT

52 Gen

81R

81A

81

59

27

24

M
(Metering)

50 DT

CT (Note 3)

VT (Note 1)

59X

M-3921
+

64F

64B

78

60FL

51V

50/27

40

32

21

50

49

46

M
(Metering)

CT

67N

VX 59D Line Side Voltage (Software Select)

3VO (Calculated) 27 32

59D

27 TN

64S

59N

50N
R

51N

CT

CT (Neutral) (Note 5) R

High-impedance Grounding with Third Harmonic 100% Ground Fault Protection

Low-impedance Grounding with Overcurrent Stator Ground Fault Protection

NOTES: 1. When 25 function is enabled, 59, 59X, 59D with VX and 67N with VX are not available, and vice versa. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. When used as a turn-to-turn fault protection device. CTs are connected as split-phase differential current. 67N operating current can only be selected to IN (Residual) for this configuration. The current input (IN) can be either from neutral current or residual current. The 50BFN, 50N, 51N, 59D, 67N (with IN or VN) and 87GD functions are unavailable when the 64S function has been purchased. See the M-3425A Instruction Book for connection details.

Figure 4-19 Alternative One-Line Functional Diagram (configured for split-phase differential)

434

System Setup and Setpoints 4

1 A B C Other Relays M-3425A 1 50 51 3 1 48 49 2

Wire to split phase differential CTs for use with 50DT split phase function. Required generator breaker status input (52b). Contact is closed when generator breaker is open. Use unit breaker contact if no generator breaker present. Output contact pairs designated by user.
M-3425A

4 5 6

Alarm output can be grouped to a single alarm at the discretion of user. Available control output to service other relays for VT Fuse Loss can be designated. Input contact number is designated by user.

46

47

39

38

41

40

43

42

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11 A B C

52 Gen

Three VT Wye-Wye Alternate Connection

WARNING: ONLY dry contact inputs must be connected because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units. NOTE: M-3425A current terminal polarity marks ( . ) indicate "entering" current direction when primary current is "from" the generator to the system. If CT connections differ from those shown, adjust input terminals.
A B C

42

43

40

41

38

39 Three VT Wye-Wye Connection

42

43

40

41

38

39 Two Vt Open-Delta Connection

M-3425A Generator M-3921 Field Ground Coupler Module a b c Other Relays M-3425A 58 59

M-3425A

c Other Relays M-3425A

c Other Relays M-3425A

59

58

59

58

56

57

OR

57

56

OR

57

56

55
54 55

54

55

54

M-3425A

M-3425A 44

45

OR
R

52

53

High Impedance Grounding

Low Impedance Grounding

Example of Control/Output Connections


+ DC: 24V 48V OR DC: 110V 125V 220V 250V AC: 110V 120V 230V 240V M-3425A + 60 62 Power Supply - 61 63 11 6 10 2 52b BREAKER FAILURE INITIATE 60FL OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER INITIATE EXTERNAL INPUTS TRIP ALARM SELFTEST FAILURE ALARM ALARM OUTPUTS 4 POWER OK STATUS ALARM 3 16 15 12 13 5 VT FUSE LOSS 3 3

52G

52Ga

CONTROL TRIP OUTPUTS OUTPUT

Figure 420 Three-Line Connection Diagram

435

M3425A Instruction Book

M-3425A 65
VX

Used when Generator Side VTs are connected Line-Ground.

64

OR
M-3425A 65 VX 64

VX Used for Sync Check (25)


Used when Generator Side VTs are connected Line-Line

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen
A B C

M-3425A 39 38 41 40 43 42 Three VT Wye-Wye Connection

OR
M-3425A A B C 42 43 Two VT Open-Delta Connection

40 41

38 39

Generator

NOTE: When VX is connected for Sync Check function (25), turn-to-turn fault protection (59X) is not available.

Figure 4-21 Function 25 Sync Check Three-Line Connection Diagram

436

System Setup and Setpoints 4

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen

A M-3425A VX 65 64 VX used for turn-to-turn fault protection (59X)

Generator

a Line to Neutral Voltage Rated Cable

M-3425A 52 53

OR

M-3425A R 45 44

Low Impedance Grounding

High Impedance Grounding

NOTE: When VX is connected for turn-to-turn faults 59X must use 3V0 for the line side voltage (i.e. setting selection) and the V.T. configuration must be Line to Ground. The 25 function is not available.

Figure 4-22 Function 59X Turn to Turn Fault Protection Three-Line Connection Diagram

437

M3425A Instruction Book

Bus Section

A B C M-3425A 53 52 67N Connection

R M-3425A 65 64

Residual CT

I N input can be connected either at Neutral or as Residual.

59X Bus Ground

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen
A B C

M-3425A VX 65 64 67N, 59D Connection VX can be used for both 67N and 59D if connected in this manner. Generator

c M-3425A 52 53

I N input can be connected either at Neutral or as Residual.

Low Impedance Grounding

OR
M-3425A R 45 44

High Impedance Grounding

NOTE: When VX is connected for bus ground protection (59X, 67N, or 59D), 25 function is not available.

Figure 4-23 Function 67N, 59D, 59X (Bus Ground) Three-Line Connection Diagram

438

System Setup and Setpoints 4

4.4

System Setpoints

The individual protective functions, along with their magnitude and timing settings are described in the following pages. Settings for disabled functions do not apply. Some menu and setting screens do not appear for functions that are disabled or not purchased. Menu screens are as they would appear on units equipped with the M3931 HMI Module. The same setting may be entered using M3400 IPScom Communications Software. The general information required to complete the input data in this section includes individual relay function: pickup settings (converted to relay quantities) time delay settings frequency settings time dials power level settings (in percent rated) impedance diameter in relay ohms for distance and offset settings

Profile 2 will be identical to the In Service profile, with the exception of the overcurrent settings. Profile 1 is set to be the Active profile, and all setpoints entered. An image of Profile 1 will then be copied to Profile 2 with the Copy Active Profile command. Profile 2 is then selected as the Active Profile and the overcurrent setpoints modified. CAUTION: During profile switching, relay operation is disabled for approximately 1 second. Utilizing the above feature not only accelerates the configuration process, but also removes the possibility of errors if all setpoints are reentered manually. Configure Relay Data The relay is shipped with a certain group of standard functions, including other optional functions, as purchased. Both of these groups define a configurable set of functions. Only members of this set may be enabled/disabled by the end user. (Optional functions not purchased cannot be enabled.) Functions designated as DISABLED are inactive and will not be available for tripping. All menus associated with inactive functions will be unavailable. The general information required to complete the input data on this section includes: enable/disable output choices (OUT1OUT8; for units with expanded I/O, OUT9OUT23 may only be set through IPScom) input blocking choices (IN1IN6; for units with expanded I/O, IN7IN14 may only be set through IPScom), plus fuse loss blocking

Setpoint Profiles (Setting Groups) Up to four setpoint profiles may be used. Each profile contains a function configuration and associated settings. One of the four profiles may be designated as the Active Profile which will contain the parameters that the relay will actively use. Only the Active Profile may be edited. The Active Profile may be chosen manually or by contact input. When the profile Switching Method is set to Manual, the HMI, remote communications or one of the IPSlogic elements will select the Active Profile. When the Switching Method is set to Input Contact, the profile is selected by the input contacts. When Input Contact is selected, only the input contacts can switch the relays profile, and none of the Manual methods will switch the profile. A Copy Profile feature is available that copies an image of the Active Profile to any one of the other three profiles. This feature can speed up the configuration process. Consider, for example, a situation where a breaker will be removed from service. Two profiles will be used: an In Service profile (Profile 1) and an Out of Service profile (Profile 2).

439

M3425A Instruction Book

Functions Configuration of the relay consists of enabling the functions for use in a particular application, designating the output contacts each function will operate, and which control/status inputs will block the function. The choices include eight programmable output contacts (OUT1OUT8) and six control/status inputs (IN1IN6), or OUT923 and IN714 for units purchased with expanded I/O, plus a block choice for fuse loss logic operation (see 60FL Fuse Loss subsection for details). The blocking control/status inputs and output contact assignments must be chosen before entering the settings for the individual functions. Both may be recorded on the Relay Configuration Table in Appendix A, Configuration Record Forms. NOTE: Uppercase text indicates selection. 27#1 phase undervoltage disable ENABLE 27#1 block input fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 I1 27#1 relay output o8o7o6o5o4o3o2O1

Control/status input IN1 is preassigned to be the 52b breaker status contact. If a multiple breaker scheme is used, the control/status input IN1 must be the series combination of the 52b breaker contacts. Additional user-chosen control/status inputs may initiate actions such as breaker failure, initiate external fuse loss detection, or trigger the oscillograph recorder. The relay allows the user to designate up to six logic functions which perform similarly to internal relay functions, using IPSlogicTM. These external functions may be enabled or disabled, and output contacts and blocking control/status inputs are chosen the same as for the internal functions. The external functions are described in further detail later in this section.

This menu designation is required for each relay function. After enabling the function, the user is presented with the two following screens: This submenu item assigns the blocking designations (up to six, plus fuse-loss logic) for the enabled function. OR logic is used if more than one input is selected. This submenu item assigns the output contacts (up to eight) for the particular relay function. If no output contacts are assigned, the function will not generate any output or targets even though the function is enabled.

NOTE: Units with expanded I/O can only set OUT9OUT23 and IN7IN14 using IPScom.

440

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Special Considerations Status input IN1 is preassigned to be the 52b breaker contact. IN5 and IN6 may be used to select setpoint profiles (with input activated profiles enabled). Outputs 16 and 923 are form a contacts (normally open), and outputs 7 and 8 are form c contacts (center tapped a and b normally closed) contacts. Output contacts 14 contain special circuitry for high-speed operation and pick up 4 ms faster than outputs 58. Function 87 outputs are recommended to be directed to OUT1 through OUT4 contacts. The following functions can be configured using enable/disable output, and status input blocking designations:

FUNCTION Protective Functions 21 24 27 27TN 32 40 46 49 50 50BF 50DT 50N 50/27 51N 51V 59 59D 59N 59X 60FL 67N 78 81 81A 81R 87 87GD IPS BM TC 25 64F/64B 64S

DESCRIPTION Phase Distance (three-zone mho characteristic) Volts/Hz (Inverse & Definite Time) Phase Undervoltage Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral Directional Power Loss of Field (dual-zone offset-mho characteristic) Negative Sequence Overcurrent Stator Overload Protection (Positive Sequence Overcurrent) Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent Breaker Failure Definite Time Overcurrent Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent Inadvertent Energizing Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent Inverse Time Overcurrent, with Voltage Control or Restraint Phase Overvoltage Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential Neutral Overvoltage Milti-purpose Overvoltage VT Fuse-Loss Detection Residual Directional Overcurrent Out of Step (mho characteristic) Frequency Frequency Accumulation Rate of Change of Frequency Phase Differential Current Ground (zero sequence) Differential IPSlogic Breaker Monitor Trip Circuit Monitoring Sync Check Field Ground Protection/Brush Lift-Off Detection 100% Stator Ground Protection by Injection

Optional Protective Functions

Table 4-4 Available Functions

441

M3425A Instruction Book

The Relay Setpoints command displays the Relay Setpoints dialog box (see Figure 424 from which the individual relay function dialog boxes can be accessed. Choosing a Relay function button will display the corresponding function dialog box (see Figure 425 for example). The Relay Setpoints dialog screen provides access to two additional dialog screens: All Setpoints Table and I/O Map. Choosing the Display All command button displays the All Setpoints Table dialog screen (Figure 4-26). This screen contains a list of settings for each relay

within a single window to allow scrolling through all relay setpoint configuration values. Choosing the I/O Map command button displays the I/O Map dialog screen (Figure 427), which contains a chart of programmed input and output contacts, in order to allow scrolling through all relay output and blocking input configurations. Both dialog screens (All Setpoint Table and I/O Map), feature hotspots which allow the user to jump from a scrolling dialog screen to an individual relay function dialog screen and return to the scrolling dialog screen again. All available parameters can be reviewed or changed when jumping to a relay configuration dialog screen from either scrolling dialog screen.

Figure 424 Relay Setpoints Dialog Screen


Path: Relay menu / Setup submenu / RelaySetpoints

COMMAND BUTTONS Display All Setpoints Display I/O Map Exit Opens the All Setpoints Table dialog box for the specified range of functions. Opens the I/O Map display. Returns the user to the IPScom main screen.

442

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 425 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Setpoint Dialog Screen


Path: Relay menu / Setup submenu / Setpoints window/ 46 command button OR 46 jump hotspot within All Setpoints Table or Configure dialog screen

COMMAND BUTTONS Save When connected to a protection system, sends the currently displayed information to the unit. Otherwise, saves the currently displayed information and returns to the Relay Setpoints, All Setpoints Table, or Configure dialog screen. Returns the user to the Relay Setpoints, All Setpoints Table, or Configure dialog screen; any changes to the displayed information are lost.

Cancel

443

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 426 All Setpoints Table Dialog Screen


Path: Relay menu / Setup submenu / Setpoints window/ Display All command button

JUMP HOTSPOTS This window provides you with jump hotspots, identified by the hand icon, that take you to each relay dialog screen and the Setup Relay dialog screen. Exiting any of these dialog screens will return the user to the All Setpoints Table dialog screen. Print Prints the All Setpoints dialog screen. Print Preview Provides a pre-display of the All Setpoints dialog screen for printing.

444

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 427 I/O Map Screen


Path: Relay menu / Setup submenu / Setpoints window/ I/O Map command button

JUMP HOTSPOTS This window provides jump hotspots, identified by the hand icon, that take the user to each relay dialog screen and the Setup Relay dialog screen. Exiting any of these dialog screens will return the user to the I/O Map screen. Print Prints the All Setpoints dialog screen. Print Preview Provides a pre-display of the All Setpoints dialog screen for printing.

445

M3425A Instruction Book

21 Phase Distance The Phase Distance function (21) is designed for system phase fault backup protection and is implemented as a three-zone mho characteristic. Three separate distance elements are used to detect AB, BC, and CA fault types. The ranges and increments are shown in Figure 4-25. The diameter, offset, system impedance angle (relay characteristic angle), and definite time delay need to be selected for each zone for coordination with the system relaying in the specific application. Zone 1, Zone 2 and Zone 3 may be used for backup protection for unit transformer and transmission faults. Zone 3 in conjunction with Zone 2 can be used to detect an Out of Step condition and it can be programmed to block Function 21 #1 and/or 21 #2. If Zone 3 is being used for out-of-step blocking, it does not trip. If Zone 1 is not set to see the transmission system, out-of-step blocking is not recommended. When Zone 3 is used for Out-of-step blocking, the out of step delay is used for the detection of the transit time of the swing between Zone 3 and Zone 2 impedances. The load encroachment blinder function can be set with a reach and an angle as shown in Figure 4-29. When enabled, this feature will block the 21 Function from misoperating during high load conditions.

When the generator is connected to the system through a delta/wye transformer, proper voltages and currents (equivalent to the high side of the transformer) must be used in order for the relay to see correct impedances for system faults. By enabling the Delta-Y Transform feature (see Section 4.2 Setup System), the relay can internally consider the 30 phase shift (30 lead delta-ab or 30 lag delta-ac) through the delta/wye transformer, saving auxiliary VTs. Impedance calculations for various VT connections are shown in Table 4-5. All impedance settings are secondary relay quantities and can be derived from the following formula: Z SEC = ZPRI x (RC RV) where ZSEC = secondary reflected impedance, ZPRI = primary impedance, RC = current transformer ratio, and RV = voltage transformer ratio. The minimum current sensitivity depends on the programmed reach (diameter and offset). If the current is below the minimum sensitivity current, the impedance calculated will saturate, and not be accurate. This will not cause any relay misoperation. An overcurrent supervision feature can be enabled, which will block the 21 function when all three phase currents are below the pickup value.

446

System Setup and Setpoints 4

21 #1 DIAMETER Ohms

Typically the first zone of protection is set to an impedance value enough in excess of the first external protective section (typically the unit transformer) to assure operation for faults within that protective zone. See Figure 4-28, Phase Distance (21) Coverage. A negative or positive offset can be specified to offset the mho circle from the origin. This offset is usually set at zero. See Figure 4-29, Phase Distance (21) Function Applied For System Backup. The impedance angle should be set as closely as possible to the actual impedance angle of the zone being protected. When enabled the 21 Function is blocked when the impedance falls within the zone but above the R Reach and below the Load Encroachment angle.

21 #1 OFFSET Ohms 21 #1 IMPEDANCE ANGLE Degrees 21#1 LOAD ENCROACHMENT disable ENABLE 21 #1 LOAD ENCR ANGLE Degrees 21 #1 LOAD ENCR R REACH Ohms 21 #1 OC SUPERVISION disableenable 21 #1 OC SUPERVISION Amps 21 #1 OUT OF STEP BLOCK disableenable 21 #1 Delay Cycles 21 #3 OUT OF STEP DELAY Cycles

NOTE: The 21 #2 and #3 zone settings can be set for an additional external section of protection on the system (typically transmission Zone 1 distance relays) plus adequate overreach. #2 and #3 screens are identical to those in #1. Element #3 also includes out-of-step time delay when out-ofstep blocking is enabled for Zone #1 and/or Zone #2.

When enabled, the overcurrent supervision blocks the 21 Function when all three phase currents are below the pickup.

When enabled the 21 Function is blocked on the detection of an out-of-step condition.

The time delays are set to coordinate with the primary protection of those overreached zones and, when applicable, with the breaker failure schemes associated with those protective zones. In Zone #3 when out-of-step blocking is enabled for Zone #1 or #2.

447

M3425A Instruction Book

Protected Range Zone 3


+X

Protected Range Zone 2

Protected Range Zone 1


R X +R

52

52

52

Bus M-3425A
21

Figure 4-28 Phase Distance (21) Coverage


NOTE: The reach settings of the distance elements (21) should not include generator impedance since the distance measurement starts at the VT location. However, since the neutral side CTs are used for this function, backup protection for generator Phase-to-Phase faults is also provided.

+jX

ZONE 3

Transmission Line Circle Diameters Unit Transformer


R2

ZONE 2

ZONE 1

Block Block

R1

d2 d1

+R

jX
R1 Zone 1 Load Encroachment Blinder R Reach R2 Zone 2 Load Encroachment Blinder R Reach 1 Zone 1 Load Encroachment Blinder Angle 2 Zone 2 Load Encroachment Blinder Angle Impedance Angle Setting NOTE: Zone #3 is used for power swing detection in this example.

Figure 4-29 Phase Distance (21) Function Applied for System Backup
448

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 4-30 Phase Distance (21) Setpoint Ranges

Transformer Direct Connected VT Connection L-L or L-G to L-L AB Fault L-G

Transformer Delta-AC Connected VT Connection L-L or L-G to L-L L-G

Transformer Delta-AB Connected VT Connection L-L or L-G to L-L L-G

VAB I a Ib VBC IbIc VCA Ic Ia

VA VB I a Ib VB VC IbIc VC VA I c Ia

VBC V AB (3)I b VCAVBC (3)Ic VABVCA (3)Ia

VBV0 Ib VCV0 Ic VAV0 Ia

VAB V CA (3)I a VBC VAB (3)Ib VCA VBC (3)Ic

VaV0 Ia VbV0 Ib VcV0 Ic

BC Fault

CA Fault

Table 4-5 Impedance Calculation

449

M3425A Instruction Book

24 Overexcitation Volts/Hz The Volts-Per-Hertz function (24) provides overexcitation protection for the generator and unitconnected transformers. This function incorporates two definite time elements which can be used to realize traditional two-step overexcitation protection. In addition, the relay includes an inverse time element that provides superior protection by closely approximating the combined generator/unit transformer overexcitation curve. Industry standard inverse time curves may be selected along with a linear reset rate which may be programmed to match specific machine cooling characteristics. The percent pickup is based on the Nominal Voltage setting and the nominal frequency. The V/Hz function provides reliable measurements of V/Hz up to 200% for a frequency range of 280 Hz. The ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-32. 24DT #1 PICKUP % 24DT #1 DELAY Cycles 24DT #2 PICKUP % 24DT #2 DELAY 24IT PICKUP % 24IT CURVE crv#1 crv#2 crv#3 crv#4 24IT TIME DIAL Cycles

Setting this relay function involves determining the desired protection levels and operating times. The first step is to plot the combined generator and associated unit transformer overexcitation capability limits. This data is typically available from the manufacturer and should be plotted on the same voltage base. Depending on the resulting characteristic, one of the four families of inverse time curves (as shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves) can be matched to provide the protection. The two definite time elements can be used to further shape the protection curve or provide an alarm. Figure 4-31 illustrates a composite graph of generator and transformer limits, a chosen inverse time curve and pickup, and a definite time pickup and delay.

Definite time setpoint #1 establishes the V/Hz level above which the protection operating time will be fixed at the definite time delay #1. Delay time #1 establishes the operation time of the protection for all V/Hz values above the level set by definite time setpoint #1. Definite time setpoint #2 could be programmed to alarm, alerting the operator to take proper control action to possibly avoid tripping. Time to operation at any V/Hz value exceeding Definite time setting #2.

The pickup value is the V/Hz value at which the chosen inverse curve begins protective operation. Typical value is 105%. Allows the user to designate the appropriate curve family for this protection application. These curves are shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. The appropriate curve in the family is designated by the associated K value of the curve.

24IT RESET RATE Seconds

The value entered here should be the time needed for the unit to cool to normal operating temperature if the V/Hz excursion time was just under the trip time.

450

System Setup and Setpoints 4

M3425A Firmware Versions D0114VXX.XX.XX and Earlier NOTE: When the inverse time element is enabled, the definite time element #1 must be enabled which will provide definite minimum time setting for the inverse time curve. The following steps must be followed when setting the inverse time element and definite time element #1: 1. The pickup of the inverse time element must be less than the pickup of the definite time element #1 2. The operating time of the inverse time element at the definite time element #1 pickup should be greater than the definite time element #1 time delay setting (A2>A1 in Figure 4-31). When the inverse time element is enabled, definite time element #1 should not be used for alarm. Only definite time element #2 can be used for alarm.

be subjected to high V/Hz before it has cooled to normal operating levels, damage could be caused before the V/Hz trip point is reached. For this reason, a linear reset characteristic, adjustable to take into account the cooling rate of the unit, is provided. If a subsequent V/Hz excursion occurs before the reset characteristic has timed out, the time delay will pick up from the equivalent point (as a %) on the curve. The Reset Rate setting entered should be time needed for the unit to cool to normal operating temperature if the V/Hz excursion time was just under the trip point. M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.00.34 The inverse time element has a definite minimum time of 30 cycles. Definite Time Element #1 is independent, and has no effect on inverse time elements. M3425A Firmware Version D0150V 01.04.00 The inverse time element has a definite minimum time of 60 cycles. Definite Time Element #1 is independent, and has no effect on inverse time elements.

3.

After any V/Hz excursion, cooling time must also be taken into account. If the unit should again
1000

Generator Limit Curve


100

Transformer Limit Curve on Generator Base Inverse Square Curve K=5 Inverse Time Delay at Definite Time Pickup #1 (A2) Combined Protection Curve

Time in Minutes

10

A2
0.1

Definite Time Delay (A1) Definite Time Pickup


Inverse Time Pickup

A1

0.01

100

105

110

115

120

125

130

135

140

145

150

Percentage Volts/Hz

Figure 4-31 Example of Capability and Protection Curves (24)

451

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-32 Volts-Per-Hertz (24) Setpoint Ranges

452

System Setup and Setpoints 4

25 Sync Check NOTE: The 25 function cannot be enabled under any one of the following conditions: 67N (Residual Directional Overcurrent) is enabled and the polarizing quantity has been set to VX. 59D is enabled and the line side voltage is set to VX. 59X is connected for turn-to-turn fault protection or bus ground protection.

The Synchronism (Sync) Check function (25) is used to ensure that the voltage magnitude, phase angle and frequency of the generator (V1) and the utility system (VX) are within acceptable limits before the generator is synchronized with the system. Generator voltage (V1) can be selected as A, B, or C (linetoground and line-ground to line-line) or AB, BC, or CA (line-to-line). The sync check function includes phase angle, delta frequency, and delta voltage checks. Phase Angle Check The phase angle is considered acceptable when the selected sync phase voltage (V1) and system voltage (VX) are within the Upper Volt Limit and Lower Volt Limit window and the measured phase angle is within the phase angle window. Phase Angle Window is defined as twice the Phase Angle Limit setting. For example, if the Phase Angle Limit is set at 10 degrees, a phase angle window of 20 degrees exists between 10 degrees and +10 degrees. The logic diagram of the phase angle check is shown in Figure 4-33. Delta Voltage and Delta Frequency Check Delta Voltage and Delta Frequency elements may be individually enabled or disabled, as desired. The Delta Voltage check will compare the absolute difference between the selected sync phase voltage (V1) and the measured system voltage (VX) with the Delta Voltage Limit setting. Likewise, the Delta Frequency measures the frequency difference between V1 and VX voltage signals. The Phase Angle Check, Delta Voltage and Delta Frequency Check all combine through an appropriate timer with the output directed to the programmed 25S output contact. A logic diagram representing this logic is presented in Figure 4-33.

Dead Line/Dead Bus Check The Dead Volt Limit defines the Hot/Dead voltage level used in Deadline/Dead Bus closing schemes. When the measured VX voltage is equal to or below the Dead Volt Limit, VX is considered dead. When the measured VX is above the Dead Volt Limit, VX is considered hot. The opposite side of the breaker uses the positive sequence voltage measurement (V1) for 3-phase consideration in determining hot/ dead detection. Different combinations of hot line/ dead bus closings may be selected, depending on how the buses are referenced. A logic diagram of the Deadline/Dead Bus scheme is presented in Figure 4-33. The Dead V1, Dead VX, and Dead V1 & VX enable are software switches used to enable the dead line/dead bus logic. Further conditioning can be performed on the dead detection logic by selecting one or more input contacts (Dead Input Enable) to control the enabled dead detection element. For example, if INPUT2 (I2) is selected under the Dead Input Enable screen, and both the Dead V1 and Dead VX elements are enabled, the dead check timer will start when INPUT2 is activated, and either V1 dead/VX hot or V1 hot/VX dead. This allows for external control of the desired dead closing scheme. Dead Input Enable selections are common to all dead detection elements. If no inputs are selected under the Dead Input Enable screen, and any dead element is enabled, the dead check timer will start immediately when the dead condition exists. The 25S and 25D can be programmed to be sent to two different contacts, if desired. NOTE: The 25 function does not produce a target or LED and is accompanied by the HMI message F25 Function Operated.

453

M3425A Instruction Book

If this function is enabled, the following settings are applicable: 25S PHASE LIMIT Degrees 25S UPPER VOLT LIMIT Volts 25S LOWER VOLT LIMIT Volts 25S SYNC CHECK DELAY Cycles 25S DELTA VOLT disable ENABLE 25S DELTA VOLT LIMIT Volts 25S DELTA FREQUENCY disableENABLE 25S DELTA FREQ LIMIT Hz 25S SYNC-CHECK PHASE abc Phase angle setting.

Upper voltage limit for voltage acceptance.

Lower voltage limit for voltage acceptance.

Sync check time delay.

Delta voltage element.

Delta voltage setting.

Delta frequency element.

Delta frequency setting.

Selects the phase voltage on the generator side for SyncCheck functions (A, B, or C for line-to-ground and line-ground to lineline, and AB, BC, CA for line-to-line) Voltage less than this setting is defined as DEAD; above this setting as HOT. Enables Dead V1/Hot VX setting.

25D DEAD VOLT LIMIT Volts 25D DEAD V1 HOT VX disableENABLE 25D DEAD VX HOT V1 disableENABLE 25D DEAD V1 & VX DISABLE enable 25D DEAD INPUT ENABLE i6 i5 i4 I3 i2 i1 25D DEAD DELAY Cycles

Enables Hot V1/Dead VX setting.

Enables Dead V1/Dead VX closing.

Externally controlled dead closing. Inputs IN7IN14 must be set using IPScom. Dead delay timer setting.

454

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Delta V and Delta F Check Logic With Delta V AND


|V1 - V X | < Delta V Limit AND Delta V Is Enabled |F1 - F X | < Delta F Limit AND V1 < Upper Voltage Limit VX > Lower Voltage Limit AND VX < Upper Voltage Limit AND Phase Angle OK Delta F Is Enabled

Delta F Enabled

Phase Angle Check Logic


V1 > Lower Voltage Limit

Only one Delta V and Delta F Check Scheme may be active at a time.
AND

AND

AND

Sync Check Timer Output Seal-in Timer


0 Sync Check Relay

Delta V and Delta F Check Logic


Phase Angle < Phase Limit

With Delta V OR Delta F Enabled


|V 1 - VX | < Delta V Limit Delta V Is Enabled |F 1 - F X | < Delta F Limit Delta F Is Enabled AND OR AND

25S Output Contact

AND

Only one Delta V and Delta F Check Scheme may be active at a time.

Dead Line/ Dead Bus Check Logic


V1pos < Dead Limit VX > Dead Limit Dead V1 Hot VX Enabled V1pos > Dead Limit VX < Dead Limit Dead VX Hot V1 Enabled V1pos < Dead Limit VX < Dead Limit Dead V1 VX Enabled AND OR AND OR AND

Dead Check Timer Output Seal-in Timer


0 Dead Time Relay

Dead Line/ Dead Bus Check Input Initiate Logic


V1pos < Dead Limit Dead V1 Hot VX Enabled VX > Dead Limit AND V1pos > Dead Limit VX < Dead Limit AND AND AND OR

25D Output Contact

Dead Input Enable


Selected INPUT Is Activated Dead VX Hot V1 Enabled

User Software Setting Measured Variable

Figure 4-33 Sync Check Logic Diagrams

455

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-34 Sync Check (25) Setpoint Ranges

456

System Setup and Setpoints 4

27 Phase Undervoltage The Phase Undervoltage function (27) may be used to detect any condition causing long- or short-term undervoltage. This is a true three-phase function in that each phase has an independent timing element. The ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-35.

Magnitude measurement depends on the 59/27 Magnitude Select setting (See Section 4.2, Setup System). When the RMS calculation is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate over a wide frequency range (10 to 80 Hz) and the accuracy of the time delay is +20 cycles. If DFT calculation is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate near 50 or 60 Hz, and the timer accuracy is +1 cycle. 27 #2 and 27 #3 Screens are identical to 27 #1.

27 #1 PICKUP 27 #1 DELAY C ycles Volts

Figure 4-35 Phase Undervoltage (27) Setpoint Ranges

457

M3425A Instruction Book

27TN Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral For ground faults near the stator neutral, the Third Harmonic (180/150 Hz) Neutral undervoltage function (27TN) provides stator ground-fault protection for high-impedance-grounded generator applications (See Figure 4-36). When used in conjunction with the fundamental neutral overvoltage (60/50Hz) function (59N), 100% stator ground-fault protection can be provided. This is illustrated in Figure 4-36. The 27TN function can be supervised by the positive-sequence undervoltage element. Undervoltage supervision can prevent tripping when the generator field is not energized or the unit is not yet synchronized. In some generators, the third harmonic voltage can be very low, especially during light load conditions. It is also observed in some generator installations that the third harmonic voltage is considerably reduced for a specific range of power output (band). To prevent mis-operation during these conditions, the 27TN function can be programmed to be supervised (blocked) by low forward power, low reverse power, low Vars (lead and lag), low power factor (lead/lag), and when the forward power is inside a band. To properly handle pump storage operations, the M3425A forward power blocking algorithm is enable from zero per unit to the forward power setpoint. During plant startup, after the field is flashed and before the unit synchronized, small

current measurement errors cause the measured power to fluctuate (typically <0.2%.) This may result in a measured power value that is negative (i.e., 0.001 pu.) If the reverse power blocking is not enabled, the 27TN may be momentarily unblocked, resulting in a relay operation and nuisance generator trip. It is highly recommended that if the Forward Power Blocking is used, both the Forward Power Blocking and Reverse Power Blocking be enabled and set. In the majority of the cases, these blocking functions will be disabled, except for those operating cases where the third harmonic neutral voltage magnitude is less than 0.5 V. The settings for the blocking functions should be set based on field measurements. Blocking regions are illustrated in Figure 4-37. The 27TN setting depends on the actual thirdharmonic neutral voltage level seen during normal operation of the generator. The setting should be about 50% of the minimum third-harmonic voltage observed during various loading conditions. This can be most conveniently measured during commissioning of the relay. Since the relay measures the third harmonic voltage levels and will display those values directly, no additional equipment is required. The undervoltage inhibit setting should be about 80% to 90% of the nominal voltage. The ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-38.

Neutral Voltage

Fundamental (60/50 Hz) neutral voltage during ground fault Third Harmonic (180/150 Hz) neutral voltage during ground fault

Pre-fault third harmonic voltage level

27TN Setpoint Pre-fault fundamental neutral voltage level

Neutral End of Generator

59N Setpoint (typically 5V)

0%

Protection provided by:

27TN

50% Fault Position (% of stator winding measured from neutral end of generator)
59N

100%

Terminal End of Generator

5% - 10%

0-30%

Figure 4-36 Third Harmonic Undervoltage (27TN) Protection Characteristics

458

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Lag VAr Block

+Q

Low Band Forward Power Block

-P
Reverse Power Block Lead VAr Block

+P
Block
Forward Power Block

Block

High Band Forward Power Block

-Q
Figure 4-37 27TN Blocking Regions

Figure 4-38 Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral Circuit (27TN) Setpoint Ranges

459

M3425A Instruction Book

27TN #2 Screens are identical to 27TN #1. Relay volts are equal to the primary neutral voltage divided by the grounding transformer ratio. Generally set for approximately 50% of the minimum third harmonic voltage observed during various loading conditions. 27TN #1 PICKUP Volts 27TN #1 POS SEQ VOLT BLK disableENABLE 27TN #1 POS SEQ VOLT BLK Volts 27TN #1 FWD POWER BLK disableENABLE 27TN #1 FWD POWER BLK PU 27TH #1 REV POWER BLK disableENABLE 27TN #1 REV POWER BLK PU 27TN #1 LEAD VAR BLK disableENABLE 27TN #1 LEAD VAR BLK PU 27TN #1 LAG VAR BLK disableENABLE 27TN #1 DELAY Cycles 27TN #1 LAG VAR BLK PU 27TN #1 LEAD PF BLK disableenable 27TN #1 LEAD PF BLK LEAD 27TN #1 LAG PF BLK disableenable 27TN #1 LAG PF BLK LAG 27TN #1 BAND FWD PWR BLK disableenable 27TN #1 LO B FWD PWR BLK PU 27TN #1 HI B FWD PWR BLK PU

460

System Setup and Setpoints 4

32 Directional Power The Directional Power function (32) can provide protection against both generator motoring and overload. It provides three power setpoints, each with a magnitude setting and a time delay. The Forward Power direction (power flow to system) is automatically chosen when the pickup setting is positive and the Reverse Power direction (power flow to generator) is automatically chosen when the pickup setting is negative. The range, as shown is from 3.000 PU to 3.000 PU where 1.0 PU is equal to the generator MVA rating. Normalized PU power flow measurements are based on Nominal Voltage and Nominal Current setting, as shown in Section 4.2 Setup System. Protection from Generator Motoring Protection against motoring is provided by selecting a negative pickup with Over/Under power set to Over. The relay will operate when the measured real power is greater (more negative) than the pickup setting in the reverse direction. In some steam generator applications it is desirable to trip the generator when the forward power is less than a small value. This is due to the fact that the trapped steam will cause the generator to supply a small amount of power even though the steam valves are closed. In this case the Over/Under

power setting is set to Under and a positive pickup setting is chosen. The relay will trip when the measured forward power is less than the pickup value. The function should be blocked when the generator breaker is open (using contact input blocking) otherwise the function will trip and prevent the generator from being brought online. Protection from Generator Overload Protection from generator overload is provided by selecting a positive pickup setting with Over/Under Power setting set to Over. The relay will operate when the measured real power is greater than the pickup setting. Protection from Excessive Reactive Power The directional power element #3 can be set to operate on either real power or reactive power. When protection from excessive reactive power is required the element #3 can be set to operate on reactive power. The relay will operate when the measured reactive power exceeds the pickup setting. Figures 4-39 through 4-42 show reverse power, low forward power, over power, and over reactive power applications.

Reverse Power Flow

Forward Power Flow PU


1.0 PU

-1.0 PU

TRIP
Pickup

Figure 4-39 Tripping on Reverse Power Flow (Over Power with Negative Pickup)

461

M3425A Instruction Book

32 #1 PICKUP 32 #1 DELAY Cycles PU

The reverse power pickup setting should be based on the type of prime mover and the losses when the generator is motoring. Reverse power relays should always be applied with a time delay in order to prevent mis-operation during power swing conditions. Typical time delay settings are 20 to 30 seconds.

32 #1 TARGET LED disableenable

Target LED for the 32 Function elements can be individually enabled or disabled.

32 #1 UNDER/OVER POWER over under

When Low Forward Power protection is desired, set this to Under with a positive pickup setting. The relay will trip when the real power measurement is less than or equal to the pickup setpoint. If used, positive direction power settings can be used for overload protection, providing either alarm or tripping or both, when power equals or exceeds the setting. The pickup and time delay settings should be based on the capability limit of the generator. A second reverse power setting can be used for sequential tripping of the generator in which case the associated time delay will be in the range of 2 to 3 seconds.

32 #2 PICKUP 32 #2 DELAY Cycles PU

32 #2 TARGET LED disableenable 32 #2 UNDER/OVER POWER over under 32 #3 PICKUP 32 #3 DELAY Cycles PU

32 #3 TARGET LED disableenable 32 #3 UNDER/OVER POWER over under 32 #3 DIR POWER SENSING realreactive Directional Power Sensing for Element #3 can be selected as Real or Reactive.

462

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Reverse Power Flow

Forward Power Flow PU

-1.0 PU

1.0 PU

TRIP
Pickup

Figure 4-40 Tripping on Low Forward Power (Under Power with Positive Pickup)

Reverse Power Flow

Forward Power Flow PU

-1.0 PU

1.0 PU

TRIP
Pickup

Figure 4-41 Tripping on Overpower (Over Power with Positive Pickup)

463

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-42 Tripping on Over Reactive Power with Element #3 (Over Power, Positive Pickup and Directional Power Sensing Set to Reactive)

Figure 4-43 Directional Power, 3-Phase (32) Setpoint Ranges

464

System Setup and Setpoints 4

40 Loss of Field The Loss-of-Field function (40) provides protection for a partial or complete loss of field. A variety of possible settings make the M3425A Generator Protection Relay very flexible when applied to loss-of-field protection. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-46. The loss-of-field function is implemented with two offset mho elements, an undervoltage element, and a directional element. The setting for each mho element, diameter, offset, and time delay, are adjusted individually. Each element has two time delay settings. The second time delay (delay with VC) is applicable with voltage control, and the timer only starts if the positive sequence voltage is below the voltage control setting. The function with voltage control and without voltage control can be programmed to send to two different output contacts, if desired. The delay with voltage control may be enabled on each element but the voltage level setting is common. The voltage control allows for faster tripping when low voltage may be caused by the VAr intake by the machine with loss of excitation. A common directional unit is provided to block the relay operation during slightly underexcited conditions (since approach #1 with negative offset is inherently directional, the directional element is not required). The directional units angle setting (QD) can be set from 0 to 20. The settings of the offset mho elements should be such that the relay detects the loss-of-field condition for any loading while not mis-operating during power swings and fault conditions. Two approaches are widely used in the industry, both of which are supported by the M3425A relay. Both approaches require knowledge of the reactances and other parameters of the generator. They are described in Figure 4-44, Loss of Field (40) Protective Approach I and Figure 4-45, Loss of Field (40) Protective Approach II. Positive sequence impedance measurements are used for the loss of field functions. All impedance settings are secondary relay quantities and can be derived from the following formula: Z SEC = ZPRI x (RC RV) where ZSEC = secondary reflected impedance, ZPRI = primary impedance, RC = current transformer ratio, and RV = voltage transformer ratio.

The first approach is shown in Figure 4-44, Loss of Field (40) Protective Approach I. Here, both of the offset mho elements (#1 and #2) are set with an offset of Xld2, where Xld is the (saturated) direct axis transient reactance of the generator. The diameter of the smaller circle (#1) is set at 1.0 pu impedance on the machine base. This mho element detects loss-of-field from full load to about 30% load. A small time delay provides fast protection. The diameter of the larger circle (#2) is set equal to Xd, where Xd is the (unsaturated) direct axis synchronous reactance of the machine. This mho element can detect a loss-of-field condition from almost no load to full load. A time delay of 30 to 60 cycles (#2) should be used in order to prevent possible incorrect operation on stable swings. The time delay with voltage control is typically set shorter than the other time delay. The second approach is shown in Figure 4-45, Loss of Field (40) Protective Approach II. In this approach, one of the mho elements is set with an offset of Xld 2, a diameter of 1.1Xd(Xld 2), and a time delay of 10 to 30 cycles. The second element is set to coordinate with the generator minimum excitation limit and steady-state stability limit. In order to obtain proper coordination, the offset of this element must be adjusted to be positive. Typically, the offset is set equal to the unit transformer reactance (XT). The diameter is approximately equal to (1.1 Xd + XT). A time delay of 30 to 60 cycles would prevent mis-operation on stable swings. The following table provides suggested time settings when time delay with VC is used in addition to standard time delay. Typical setting is 13 (0.974 power factor). This setting is common to both element #1 and #2. Approach #1 can also be used for Zone #1, and approach #2 for Zone #2, where better coordination with AVR limiters, machine capability limits, and steady state stability limits can be obtained.

465

M3425A Instruction Book

40 #1 DIAMETER 40 #1 OFFSET 40 #1 DELAY Cycles Ohms Ohms

40 #2 OFFSET 40 #2 DELAY Cycles Ohms

40VC #2 DELAY WITH VC Cycles

40VC #1 DELAY WITH VC Cycles

40 VOLTAGE CONTROL Volts

40 #2 DIAMETER Ohms Zone 1 Voltage Control Setting Delay Delay with VC N/A 15 Cycles Disable

40 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT Zone 2 80 to 90% of Nominal Voltage 3,600 Cycles 60 Cycles Degrees

Table 4-6 Voltage Control Time Settings


+X

Heavy Load

X'd 2

Light Load

QD

+R

1.0 pu Xd Loss of Excitation Final Impedance Locus

Underexcited

Steady-State Stability Limit Machine Capability Minimum Exciter Limit

Figure 4-44 Loss of Field (40)Protective Approach 1

466

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Directional Element

+X

Block Direction Trip Direction Heavy Load QD X'd 2 Underexcited 1.1 Xd Loss of Excitation Final Impedance Locus Steady-State Stability Limit Machine Capability Minimum Exciter Limit Light Load XT

R
Directional Element Angle Setting

+R

Figure 4-45 Loss of Field (40)Protective Approach 2

Figure 4-46 Loss-of-Field (40) Setpoint Ranges

467

M3425A Instruction Book

46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent The Negative Sequence Overcurrent function (46) provides protection against possible rotor overheating and damage due to unbalanced faults or other system conditions which can cause unbalanced three phase currents in the generator. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-48. This function has a definite time element and an inverse time element. The definite time pickup value and definite operating time are normally associated with an alarm function. The inverse time element is usually associated with a trip function and has a pickup and an operating time defined by an (I2)2t = K, where K is the Time Dial Setting and I2 is the per unit negative sequence current. The minimum delay for the inverse time function is factory set at 12 cycles to avoid nuisance tripping. A maximum time to trip can be set to reduce the operating times for modest imbalances. An important feature that helps protect the generator from damage due to recurring imbalances is a linear reset characteristic. When I2 decreases below the pickup value, the trip timer takes the reset time setting from its 100% trip level. Figure 4-47, Negative Sequence

Overcurrent Inverse Time Curves, illustrates the inverse time characteristic of the negative sequence overcurrent function. Operating times are slower than shown in Figure 4-47 when measured current values are greater than 15 A (3 A for 1 A rated circuit). The first task of setting this function is to determine the capabilities of the associated machine. As established by ANSI standards, the machine limits are expressed as (I2)2t = K. The value of K is established by the machine design and is generally provided on test sheets of the machine. The relay can accommodate any generator size because of the wide range of K settings from 1 to 95. Typical values can be found in ANSI C50.131977. The negative sequence pickup range is from 3% to 100% of the Nominal Current value input during system setup (see Section 4.2 Setup System). This protection must not operate for system faults that will be cleared by system relaying. This requires consideration of line protection, bus differential and breaker failure backup protections.

46DT PICKUP 46DT DELAY 46IT PICKUP % Cycles %

The pickup setting is usually quite low (35%) and the output of this function is usually connected to alarm only. Time delay should be set high enough to avoid alarms on transients.

The 46 Inverse Time pickup setting should coincide with the continuous negative sequence current capability of the generator operating at full output. The maximum trip time is used to reduce the longer trip times associated with low to moderate imbalances to a preset time. Emulates generator cool down time.

46IT MAX DELAY Cycles

46IT RESET TIME Seconds

46IT TIME DIAL

The time dial setting corresponds to the K provided by the generator manufacturer for the specific unit being protected. See Figure 447 for the negative sequence overcurrent inverse time curves.

468

System Setup and Setpoints 4

1000 800 600 400

Pickup Setting Range

To 65,500 cycles

200

100 80 60 40

Definite Maximum Time Setting Range

Time (Seconds)

20

10 8 6 4

I22t=K

1 0.6 0.4

25 10 2 5

50

95

0.2

Definite Minimum Time


4 5 6 8 10 20 40 60 80 100

0.1
150 200 300 400 500 600 800 1000 1000 2000 3000 4000

Negative Sequence Current (% of Nominal Value)

NOTE: When the phase current exceeds 3X I nominal, the operating times will be greater than those shown. * 0.24 seconds for 50 Hz units.

Figure 4-47 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time Curves

Figure 4-48 Negative Sequence Overcurrent (46) Setpoint Ranges

469

M3425A Instruction Book

49 Stator Overload Protection The Stator Thermal Overload function (49) provides protection against possible damage during overload conditions. The characteristic curves are based on IEC-255-8 standard, and represent both cold and hot curves. The function uses the thermal time constant of the generator and stator maximum allowable continuous overload current (Imax) in implementing the inverse time characteristic.

Example: If we consider that the generator was loaded with 80% of its rating power prior to overload, then the current goes up to 2.0 times the maximum current ((IL/Imax)=2.0). Selecting the curve P=0.8 (see Figure 250), we have t/=0.1133. If =30 minutes, then the time delay for this condition would be: t=0.1133 x 30=3.3999 minutes. The 49 function has two elements, one of which can be used for trip and the other for alarm.

t = t x In

IL2 w Imax2

IL2 w IPL2

Where: t = time to trip = thermal time constant IL = load current IPL = pre-load current Imax = maximum allowed continuous overload current

Current-Square

I L2 I 2PL I max2 I L2 I L2 I 2PL t


Tripped Not Tripped

Figure 4-49 Time Constant, Function 49

49 #1 TIME CONSTANT Min 49#1 MAX OVERLOAD CURR Amps

Selects the time constant,

Selects the maximum allowed continuous overload current. 49#2 Screens are identical to those for 49#1.

470

System Setup and Setpoints 4

49 - Overload Curves
10

t/t

0.1

P=0.0 P=0.5 P=0.6 P=0.7 P=0.8 P=0.9

0.01

P=0.99 1 2 3 4

0.001 7 8 9

IL/Imax
IPL

where: P=

Imax

Figure 4-50 49 Function Overload Curves

471

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-51 Stator Thermal Protection (49) Setpoint Ranges

472

System Setup and Setpoints 4

50/50N Instantaneous Overcurrent, Phase and Neutral Circuits The Instantaneous Phase (50) and Instantaneous Neutral (50N) overcurrent functions provide fast tripping for high fault currents. The settings of both functions must be set such that they will not pickup for fault or conditions outside the immediate protective zone. If the neutral current input is connected to a step-up transformers neutral CT, the 50N function can be used as a breaker flashover protection when used in conjunction with external breaker failure protection. Ranges and Increments are presented in Figures 4-52 and 4-53. The function automatically selects fundamental RMS or total RMS calculation based on the input frequency. When the generator frequency is within 5 Hz from the nominal frequency, it uses fundamental RMS calculation. Outside of this range, it uses total RMS calculation, which will provide protection during offline down to a frequency of 8 Hz. For providing off-line protection, one of the elements can be supervised by a breaker b contact, and the element blocked when the breaker is closed. This allows the function to be set sensitively (below full load current).

50#1 PICKUP 50#1 DELAY 50N PICKUP 50N DELAY Cycles Amps Cycles Amps

The relay current (IR) is equal to the primary current (Ip) divided by the appropriate CT ratio. These screens are repeated for 50#2 element.

473

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-52 Instantaneous Overcurrent (50) Setpoint Ranges

Figure 4-53 Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent (50N) Setpoint Ranges

474

System Setup and Setpoints 4

50BF Generator Breaker Failure/HV Breaker Flashover The Generator Breaker Failure/HV Breaker Flashover function (50BF) is applicable when a generator breaker is present and line side generator CTs are being used. The 50BFPh phase detector element (if enabled) is used for breaker failure and the 50BFN (if enabled) provides breaker flashover protection by providing an additional breaker failure initiate which is only active when the breaker is open. For high impedance grounded applications, the 50BFN function is inapplicable and must be disabled. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-55. 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure: When the M3425A Generator Protection Relay detects an internal fault or an abnormal operating condition, it closes an output contact to trip the generator breaker or the unit HV breaker. When a generator breaker is used, protection is available for the instance where it fails to clear the fault or abnormal condition. Such generator breaker failure protection output contacts must be connected to trip the additional necessary breakers to isolate the generator from the system. The breaker-failure condition is usually detected by the continued presence of current in any one or more of the phases after a trip has been sent to the breaker. However, the current detector (50BFPh) may not always give the correct status of the breaker, especially for generator breakers. This is because faults and abnormal operating conditions such as ground faults, overexcitation, over/under frequency, and reverse power may not produce enough current to operate the current detectors. For this reason, the breaker status input 52b contact must be used, in addition to the 50BFPh, to provide adequate breaker status indication.

Implementation of the generator breaker failure function is illustrated in Figure 4-54. The breaker failure timer will be started whenever any one of the designated output contacts or the external programmed breaker failure initiate status input are operated. The timer continues to time if any one of the phase currents are above the 50BF-Ph pickup setting or if the 52b contact indicates the breaker is still closed; otherwise, the timer is reset. Since current in the generator high side CT which energizes the 50BF protection (IA, IB, IC) might not extinguish concurrently with the breaker opening for faults between the CT location and the generator breaker, a possible area of mis-operation exists. Usually the risk of faults in this limited area is small enough to be ignored but should be considered. 50BF-Neutral Element : This instantaneous overcurrent relay is energized from the generator neutral CT (See Figure 4-18, One-Line Functional Diagram). This function is internally in series with a breaker b contact (IN1) to provide logic for the breaker flashover protection (see Figure 4-54). HV Breaker Failure (limited) The breaker failure function may be used for a unit breaker rather than a generator breaker. It is limited in that it has no fault detector associated with the unit breaker. Output contact operation would occur if any of the initiate contacts close and the 52b contact indicated a closed breaker after the set time delay. This operation is chosen by disabling the neutral element, disabling the phase element, and designating initiating inputs and outputs and a time delay setting.

Overcurrent

50BF-Ph I>P.U.

AND

Phase Initiate Enable IN1 (52b)


Logic high when breaker open NOT

OR

Logic high when breaker closed

Overcurrent

50BF-N I>P.U.

AND
OR

Neutral Initiate Enable Output Initiate Input Initiate

AND

DELAY

TIME

Programmed Output Contacts

Figure 4-54 Breaker Failure Logic Diagram

475

M3425A Instruction Book

50BF PHASE ELEMENT disable enable 50BF PICKUP PHASE Amps

If generator breaker failure function is used in this application, ENABLE here.

Set phase pickup amps.

50BF NEUTRAL ELEMENT disable enable 50BF PICKUP NEUTRAL Amps

If the breaker flashover protection is to be used with the generator breaker failure function of the relay, set ENABLE (enable phase element also for this application.) Set the neutral pickup amps.

50BF INPUT INITIATE i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 50BF OUTPUT INITIATE o8o7o6o5o4o3o2o1 50BF DELAY Cycles

Designate the status inputs which will initiate the breaker failure timer. Inputs IN7IN14 must be set using IPScom.

Designate the outputs that will initiate the breaker failure timer. Outputs OUT9OUT23 must be set using IPScom.

For generator breaker failure protection, the time delay should be set to allow for breaker operating time plus margin.

Figure 4-55 Breaker Failure (50BF) Setpoint Ranges

476

System Setup and Setpoints 4

50DT Definite Time Overcurrent (for splitphase differential) The Definite Time Overcurrent (50DT) function can be applied in two different configurations based on the CT connections. When CT configuration shown in Figure 4-18, One Line Functional Diagram is used, the 50DT function is used as a definite time phase overcurrent function to provide protection for external and internal faults in the generator. When the CTs are connected to measure the split phase differential current (shown in Figure 4-19, Alternative One Line Functional Diagram), the 50DT function can be used as a split-phase differential relay. 50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE A Amps 50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE B Amps 50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE C Amps 50DT #1 DELAY Cycles

NOTE: When 50DT function is used for splitphase differential, 50BF, 87 and 87GD functions must be disabled. Refer to Section 4.2 Setup System for a description of the 50DT Split-Phase Operate setting, and Section 4.3, System Diagrams. In some cases, the generators may be run with a faulted turn shorted until the generator winding is repaired. To prevent mis-operation under these conditions, the pickup setting of the faulted phase should be set higher than the other phases. To accommodate this function, individual pickup settings are available for each phase. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-56.

50DT #2 screens are identical to 50DT #1.

Figure 4-56 Definite Time Overcurrent (50DT) Setpoint Ranges

477

M3425A Instruction Book

50/27 Inadvertent Energizing The Inadvertent Energizing function (50/27) of the relay is an overcurrent function supervised by generator terminal bus voltage. Inadvertent or accidental energizing of off-line generators has occurred frequently enough to warrant the use of dedicated protection logic to detect this condition. Operating errors, breaker flashovers, control circuit malfunctions or a combination of these causes have resulted in generators being accidentally energized while off-line. The problem is particularly prevalent on large generators connected through a high voltage disconnect switch to either a ring bus or breaker-and-a-half bus configuration. When a generator is accidentally energized from the power system, it will accelerate like an induction

motor. While the machine is accelerating, high currents induced into the rotor can cause significant damage in a matter of seconds. Voltage supervised overcurrent logic is designed to provide this protection. (See Figure 4-57, Inadvertent Energizing Function Logic Diagram) An undervoltage element (all three phase voltages must be below pickup) with adjustable pickup and dropout time delay supervises instantaneous overcurrent tripping. The undervoltage detectors automatically arm the overcurrent tripping when the generator is taken off-line. This undervoltage detector will disable or disarm the overcurrent operation when the machine is put back in service. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-58.

50/27 PICKUP Amps 50/27 VOLTAGE CONTROL Volts

Typical pickup setting is 0.5 amps. No coordination is required with other protection since this function is only operational when the generator is off-line. The purpose of the undervoltage detector is to determine whether the unit is connected to the system. The voltage level during this accidental energization depends on the system strength. Typical setting is 50%70% of rated voltage (in some cases, it may be set as low as 20%.) The pickup time delay is the time for the undervoltage unit to operate to arm the protection. It must coordinate with other protection for conditions which cause low voltages (typically longer than 21 and 51V time delay settings.)

50/27 PICKUP DELAY Cycles

50/27 DROPOUT DELAY Cycles

The dropout time delay is the time for the unit to operate to disarm the protection when the voltage is increased above the pickup value or the generator is brought on-line.

478

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Overcurrent

50

I>PU

Timer
Undervoltage*

AND

27

Pickup Delay Dropout Delay

Programmed Output Contacts

V<PU

* On All Three Phases Simultaneously

Figure 4-57 Inadvertent Energizing Function Logic Diagram

Figure 4-58 Inadvertent Energizing (50/27) Setpoint Ranges

479

M3425A Instruction Book

51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent The Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent function (51N) provides protection against ground faults. Since no zero sequence or ground current is usually present during normal operation, this function can be set for greater sensitivity than the phase overcurrent protection. If the 51N and 50N functions are not used at the generator neutral, they can be used to detect system ground faults by being energized by the step-up transformer neutral CTs. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-59. The curves available for use are shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. They cover a range from 51N PICKUP Amps 51N CURVE bedefbeinvbevinv V 51N TIME DIAL

1.5 to 20 times the pickup setting. An additional one cycle time delay should be added to these curves in order to obtain the relay operating time. Inverse time curves saturate beyond 20 times pickup. For currents in excess of 20 times pickup, operating times are fixed at the 20 times pickup level. The function automatically selects fundamental RMS or total RMS calculation based on the input frequency. When the generator frequency is within 5 Hz from the nominal frequency, it uses fundamental RMS calculation. Outside of this range, it uses total RMS calculation, which will provide protection during offline down to a frequency of 8 Hz.

The relay current (IR) is equal to the primary current (IP) divided by the appropriate CT ratio. IR = IP CT ratio Select one of the time curves shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. The appropriate curve in the selected family is designated here. Appropriate Time Dial for coordination with downstream relay protection chosen from the time curve above.

Figure 4-59 Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent (51N) Setpoint Ranges

480

System Setup and Setpoints 4

51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Restraint Time-overcurrent relays, one per phase, are used to trip circuits selectively and to time-coordinate with other up- or downstream relays. For this function, eight complete series of inverse time tripping characteristics are included. The same descriptions and nomenclature which are traditionally used with electromechanical relays are used in the relay. Thus, user may choose from four BECO curves (BEDEF, BEINV, BEVINV, and BEEINV), four IEC curves (IECI, IECVI, IECEI, and IECLT), and three IEEE curves (MINV, VINV, EINV.) Within each family, the operator selects time dial setting and pickup (tap) setting, just as with electromechanical relays. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-61. The curves available for use are shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. They cover a range from 1.5 to 20 times the pickup setting. An additional one cycle time delay should be added to these curves in order to obtain the relay operating time. Inverse time curves saturate beyond 20 times pickup. For currents in excess of 20 times pickup, operating times are fixed at the 20 time pickup level. The particular settings will be made by information from short-circuit fault studies and knowledge of the coordination requirements with other devices in the system that respond to time overcurrent.

51V is a true three-phase function, in that the relay incorporates separate integrating timers on each phase. The inverse time overcurrent function can be voltage controlled (VC), voltage restrained (VR), or neither. For voltagecontrolled operation, the function is not active unless the voltage is below the voltage control setpoint. This philosophy is used to confirm that the overcurrent is due to system fault. When applied, most users will set voltage control limits in the range of 0.7 to 0.9 per unit RMS voltage. When voltage restraint is selected (See Figure 4-60, Voltage Restraint (51VR) Characteristic), the pickup setting is continuously modified in proportion to the collapsing terminal voltage. The voltage restraint function is well-suited to small generators with relatively short time constants. NOTE: The 51V function should be blocked by fuse loss if in the voltage control mode only. Fuse loss blocking is not desirable for voltage restraint mode because the pickup is automatically held at 100% pickup during fuse loss conditions, and operation will continue as normal. The internally derived voltage used to realize the voltage control or restraint feature depends on the configured VT configuration and the DeltaY Transform setting (see Section 4.2 Setup System). Table 4-7, Delta/Wye Transformer Voltage-Current Pairs describes the calculation for the various system VT configurations.

51V PICKUP 51V CURVE bedefbeinvbevinv 51V TIME DIAL Amps

The pickup of the 51V is set in relay amps. (Relay amps = primary amps CT ratio)

Selects one of the time curves as shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. The appropriate curve in the selected family of curves is designated here.

51V VOLTAGE CONTROL disableV_CNTLv_rstrnt 51V VOLTAGE CONTROL Volts

Disable if neither voltage control nor voltage restraint is desired. If voltage restraint is designated, the tap setting is modified as shown in Figure 4-60. If voltage control is designated, the 51V will only operate when the voltage is less than the 51V voltage control setting specified below. When applied, the voltage control is usually set in the range of 70% to 90% of the nominal voltage.

481

M3425A Instruction Book

100

75

Tap Setting as % of Tap Setting at Rated Voltage

50

25

25

50

75

100

Input Voltage (% of rated voltage)

Figure 4-60 Voltage Restraint (51VR) Characteristic


Generator Directly Connected Current Ia Ib Ic Voltage Control or Restraint (VA VC)/S 3 (VB VA)/S3 (VC VB)/S3 L-G L-L or L-G to L-L VAB VBC VCA Generator Connected Through Delta AB/Wye or Delta AC/Wye Transformer Current Ia Ib Ic Voltage Control or Restraint L-G VA VB VC L-L or L-G to L-L (VAB VCA)/S3 (VBC VAB)/S3

(VCA VBC)/S3

Table 4-7 Delta/Wye Transformer Voltage-Current Pairs

Figure 4-61 Inverse Time Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Voltage Restraint (51VC/VR) Setpoint Ranges

482

System Setup and Setpoints 4

59 Phase Overvoltage The Phase Overvoltage function (59) may be used to provide overvoltage protection for the generator. The relay provides overvoltage protection functions with three voltage levels and three definite-time setpoints, any one or more of which can be programmed to trip the unit or send an alarm. This is a true 3phase function in that each phase has an independent timing element. The 59 function can be programmed to use phase voltage (any one of the three phases) or positive sequence voltage as input. Positive and negative sequence voltages are calculated in terms of line-to-line voltage when Line to Line is selected for V.T. Configuration.

V1 = 1/3 (Vab +aVbc + a2Vca) V2 = 1/3 (Vab +a2Vbc + aVca)


Magnitude measurement depends on the 59/27 Magnitude Select setting (See Section 4.2 Setup System). When the RMS option is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate over a wide frequency range (10 to 80 Hz) and the accuracy of the time delay is +20 cycles. If DFT option is selected, the magnitude calculation is accurate near 50 or 60 Hz, and the timer accuracy is +1 cycle. When the input voltage select is set to positive sequence voltage, the 59 functions uses DFT to measure the positive sequence voltage, irrespective of DFT/RMS selection. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-62.

59 #1 INPUT VOLTAGE SEL. phase_volt pos_seq_volt 59 #1 PICKUP Volts 59 #1 DELAY Cycles

Generator capability is generally 105% of rated voltage. 59 #2 and 59 #3 screens are identical to 59 #1.

483

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-62 Phase Overvoltage (59) Setpoint Ranges

484

System Setup and Setpoints 4

59D Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (Ratio) This scheme, when used in conjunction with 59N function may provide 100% Stator Ground fault protection. NOTE: The 59D function has a cutoff voltage of
0.5 V for 3rd harmonic VX voltage. If the 180 Hz component of VN is expected to be less than 0.5 V the 59D function can not be used.

Figure 4-63 illustrates a third harmonic voltage differential scheme. This scheme compares the

third harmonic voltage appearing at the neutral to that which appears at the generator terminals. The ratio of these third harmonic voltages is relatively constant for all load conditions. A stator phaseto-ground fault will disrupt this balance, causing operation of the differential relay (see Figure 4-36). The generator terminal voltage (Line Side Voltage) can be selected as 3V0 (Calculated by the relay from VA, VB and VC) or VX (broken delta VT input connected at the VX input.) Positive sequence undervoltage blocking will prevent the function from misoperating when the generator is offline (the terminal voltage is below the set value).

59D RATIO ______________

The ratio (or third harmonic) voltage measured at the generator terminals to the third harmonic voltage measured at neutral. The 59D Ratio Pickup Setting can be calculated using field measurement of Third Harmonic Voltages as follows: 59D Ratio Pickup = 1.5 x

( )

VX3rd 3VO3rd OR 3rd VN VN3rd

) (

59D LINE SIDE VOLTAGE 3v0VX

Where:

3VOM V3XM OR V3NM V3NM

) (

is the maximum measured Ratio of the Third Harmonic Voltages at various loading conditions of the generator. Selection of VX will give better accuracy and sensitivity than 3V0. If 3V0 is selected, VT configuration must be set to LineGround. If the nominal third harmonic voltage is <1 V, 3V0 line side voltage selection is not recommended because noise in 3V0 and VN can cause 59D misoperation.

59D POS SEQ VOLT BLK disable ENABLE 59D POS SEQ VOLT BLK ____________ Volts 59D DELAY ____________ Cycles

This setting is typically enabled.

485

M3425A Instruction Book

M-3425A V3N V3X

The ratio

Vx3rd VN3rd

) (
OR

3VO3rd VN3rd

)>

Pickup

Where: Vx3RD is the Third Harmonic Triple Zero Sequence voltage measured at the generator terminals.

VN3RD is the Third Harmonic voltage measure at the neutral.

Figure 4-63 Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (Ratio) Scheme for Generator Ground Fault Protection

Figure 4-64 Third Harmonic Voltage Differential (59D) Setpoint Ranges

486

System Setup and Setpoints 4

59N Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence The Neutral Overvoltage function (59N) provides stator ground fault protection for high impedance grounded generators. The 59N function can provide ground fault protection for 9095% of the stator winding (measured from the terminal end). The 59N function provides three setpoints, and responds only to the fundamental frequency component, rejecting all other harmonic components. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-65.

59N #1 PICKUP Volts

With typical grounding transformer ratios and a typical minimum setting of 5 volts, this protection is capable of detecting ground faults in about 95% of the generator stator winding from the terminal end. If groundedwye/groundedwye VTs are connected at the machine terminals, the voltage relay must be time coordinated with VT fuses for faults on the transformer secondary winding. If relay time delay for coordination is not acceptable, the coordination problem can be alleviated by grounding one of the secondary phase conductors instead of the secondary neutral. When this technique is used, the coordination problem still exists for ground faults on the secondary neutral conductor. Thus, its usefulness is limited to those applications where the exposure to ground faults on the secondary neutral is small. Since system ground faults can induce zero sequence voltages at the generator due to transformer capacitance coupling, this relay must coordinate with the system ground fault relaying. It is possible to set 59N#1, 59N#2, and 59N#3 to coordinate with the PT secondary fuses, and also coordinate with worst case capacitive coupling interference voltage from system ground faults (high side of the GSU). For applications where the M3425A relay (where the 64S function is purchased or not) is used with 100% Stator Ground protection with 20 Hz injection schemes, the 59N 20 Hz injection mode must be enabled in order to calculate the voltage magnitude accurately for the 59N function, due to the 20 Hz injection voltage. The time delay accuracy of the function is 1 to +5 cycles when the 20 Hz injection mode is enabled.

59N #1 DELAY Cycles

59N 20HZ INJECTION MODE disable ENABLE 59N #2 and 59N #3 screens are identical to 59N #1.

487

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-65 Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence (59N) Setpoint Ranges

488

System Setup and Setpoints 4

59X Multipurpose Overvoltage (Turn-to-Turn Stator Fault Protection or Bus Ground Protection) For generators where the stator-winding configuration does not allow the application of split-phase differential, a neutral voltage method can be used to detect turn-to-turn stator winding faults. Figure 4-66 illustrates this method. Three VTs are connected in wye and the primary ground lead is tied to the generator neutral. The secondary is connected in a broken delta with an overvoltage relay connected across its open delta to measure 3V0 voltage. In High Impedance grounded generators, connecting the primary ground lead to the generator neutral, makes this element insensitive to stator ground faults. The relay will, however, operate for turn-to-turn faults, which increase the 3V0 voltage above low normal levels. Installation requires the cable from the neutral of the VT to generator neutral be insulated for the system line-to-ground voltage and the relay to be tuned to fundamental (60/50 Hz) frequency components of the voltage since some third-harmonic frequency component of the voltage will be present across the broken delta VT input. Alternatively, this function can be used to detect bus ground faults, when connected as shown in Figure 4-23.

59X #1 PICKUP Volts

When used for Turn-to-Turn fault protection the pickup should be set above the normal zero sequence voltage level. Typically the pickup is set to 5 V. When used for Bus Ground protection it is again set above the normal zero sequence voltage seen at the bus. Typical setting is between 10 and 20 Volts to provide sensitive protection.

59X #1 DELAY Cycles

The Time Delay for Turn-to-Turn faults should be set to approximately 5 cycles. For bus ground fault protection application the time delay should coordinate with other ground fault relaying and VT fuses. 59X #2 screens are identical to 59X #1.

489

M3425A Instruction Book

GENERATOR

See Note Below

VT

R R 3V0 59X

NOTE: Installation requires the cable from the neutral of the VT to generator neutral be insulated for the system line-to-ground voltage.

Figure 4-66 Turn-to-Turn Stator Winding Fault Protection

Figure 4-67 (59X) Multi-purpose Overvoltage Setpoint Ranges

490

System Setup and Setpoints 4

60FL VT Fuse Loss Some functions may operate inadvertently when a VT fuse is blown or an event causes a loss of one, two, or all three potentials to the relay. Provisions are incorporated for both internal and external potential loss detection and blocking of user defined functions. The logic scheme and options are illustrated in Figure 4-68. Internal Fuse Loss Detection Logic The internal logic scheme available will detect a loss of one, two, and all three potentials. For the loss of one or two potentials, positive and negative sequence quantities are compared. The presence of negative sequence voltage in the absence of negative sequence current is considered to be a fuse loss condition. An additional supervising condition includes a minimum positive sequence voltage to assure voltage is being applied to the relay. For the loss of all three phase potentials, a comparison of the three phase voltages is made to the three phase currents. If all three potentials are under 0.05 Vnom, and all three currents are below 1.25 Inom combined with I1 > 0.33A, a three phase potential loss is declared. A seal in circuit is provided to ensure a three phase fuse loss condition is not declared during a three phase fault if the fault current decays below the 1.25 Inom pickup setting. Protection functions in the relay may be blocked by an assertion of the fuse failure logic (FL), in each functions respective setting screen. Typical functions to block on a loss of potential event are 21, 27, 32, 40, 51V (for Voltage Control only), 67, 67N, 78 and 81. The 60FL function does not have to be enabled in order to use the FL as a blocking input in the relay configuration menu. 60FL INPUT INITIATE FL i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 60FL 3 PHASE DETECT disableenable 60FL DELAY Cycles

A frequency check element is included in the fuse loss detection logic to avoid erroneous alarms when the generator is in a start up condition. For a 50Hz system, the 60FL alarm will be inhibited if the measured frequency is greater than 55.12 Hz FU or less than 44.88 Hz FL. For a 60 Hz system, the 60FL alarm will be inhibited if the measured frequency is greater than 65.12 Hz FU or less than 54.88 Hz FL. The Frequency Band Detector does not inhibit the 60FL three-phase loss of potential logic. External Fuse-Loss Function For the specific application where the preceding logic cannot be considered reliable (such as when current inputs to the relay are not connected, or sustained positive sequence current during fault conditions is minimal), an external fuse failure function can be used as an input to the relay. The external 60 FL Function contact is connected across any control/status input. The relay protection functions are then blocked by an assertion of the control/status input (INx), as a blocking function in each functions respective setting screen. 60FL VT Fuse Loss Alarm Function The 60FL alarm function is enabled by the internal logic by selecting the FL option in the 60 FL function setup screen. It is enable by the external logic by selecting the appropriate control/status input (INx) in the 60FL function setup screen. A timer associated with the fuse loss alarm logic is available. This timer is to assure proper coordination for conditions that may appear as a fuse loss, such as secondary VT circuit faults that will be cleared by local low voltage circuit action (fuses or circuit breakers). Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-69.

The initiating control/status inputs are user-designated. The closing of any of the externally connected contacts (across these inputs) will start the associated time delay to the 60FL function operation. In order to use internal fuse loss logic for 60FL function, FL must be checked. Externally initiated fuse loss detection may be input to other status inputs. Inputs IN7IN14 must be set using IPScom. The time delay is set to coordinate for conditions which may appear as a fuse loss but will be corrected by other protection (such as a secondary VT circuit fault which will be cleared by local low voltage circuit action). This delay does not affect internal FL blocking option.

491

M3425A Instruction Book

Frequency Checking

External "FL" Function

INx

External Fuse Loss Function 60FL Alarm Function initiate by internal "FL" or Status Input Contact INx
AND

F < FU
AND

Protection Function Block Signal by INx from External FL


T
Delay

60FL Alarm Signal Protection Function Block Signal by Internal FL Logic

F > FL
Internal 60FL Logic: 1 & 2 Phase Loss of Potential

FL

OR

V1 > 12.8 V
AND

V1 Verifies VT voltage is applied. V2 Provides indication of blown fuse.


AND

V2 > 0.33 V1 I2 > 0.167 I1


OR

I2 Prevents operation during phase-phase faults. I1 Prevents output contacts from chattering where a fuse blows during no load operation.

I1 > 0.33 A (.067 A)*

* Values in parentheses apply to a 1 A CT secondary rating.

Enable Disable AND

IA > 1.25 IN IB > 1.25 IN IC > 1.25 IN VA < 0.05 VN VB < 0.05 VN VC < 0.05 VN
AND OR OR AND

Software Select Enable/Disable 3 Phase Fuse Loss Detection

I1 VA,B,C IA,B,C

Verifies On-Line condition Indication of 3-phase loss of potential Prevents operation during faults

Seal-in circuit ensures logic doesn't produce an output during 3-phase fault when current decays below 1.25 IN

Internal 60FL Logic: 3 Phase Loss of Potential

Figure 4-68 Fuse Loss (60FL) Function Logic

Figure 4-69 Fuse Loss (60FL) Setpoint Ranges

492

System Setup and Setpoints 4

64B/F Field Ground Protection 64F Field Ground Detection Typical connections for Field Ground Protection applications (including hydro turbine-generator and brushless generators) is given in Figure 4-70. This function requires the connection of an external coupler (M3921). To improve accuracy and minimize the effects of stray capacitance, the M3921 Field Ground Coupler should be mounted close to the exciter. Connections from the coupler to the relay should use low capacitance shielded cable, and be as short as possible. Cable shield should be terminated at the relay end to the Relay Ground Stud (See Figure 59, External Connections). If cabling between the coupler and relay exceeds 100 feet, provisions should be made for in circuit calibration to nullify the effects of cabling capacitance. See Section 6.4, Auto Calibration, for calibration procedure. The Field Ground function provides detection of insulation breakdown between the excitation field winding and the ground. There are two pickup and time delay settings, and one adjustable injection frequency setting for the 64F function. The adjustable frequency is provided to compensate for the amount of capacitance across the field winding and the ground so that the function accuracy is improved. The minimum time delay should be set greater than (2/IF + 1) seconds. Where IF = Injection frequency. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-71. Table 4-8 gives typical frequency settings based on the rotor capacitance. The rotor capacitance can be measured with a capacitance meter by connecting the meter across the field winding to ground.

Factors Affecting 64F Performance Some excitation systems include shaft voltage suppressors which include capacitors that are installed between the +/- field and ground. The effect of these capacitors is given by the following equation:

R J___1___ (2 IF C)

where: R = Parallel winding-ground resistance IF = Injection frequency setting C = Capacitance value

To minimize this effect the following my be implemented: The injection frequency setting can be reduced, however accuracy decreases as a result. With the concurrence of the exciter manufacturer, surge capacitors rated at a lower value may be installed.

64F #1 PICKUP 64F #1 DELAY 64F #2 PICKUP 64F #2 DELAY Cycles kOhm Cycles kOhm

This setting should not exceed 80% of the ungrounded resistance value to prevent nuisance tripping. Typical setting for the 64F #1 pickup element for alarming is 20 Kohms. Typical delay setting for tripping is 800 cycles.

Typical setting for 64F #2 pickup element for tripping is 5 Kohms.

Typical delay setting for alarming is 180 cycles.

493

M3425A Instruction Book

PROTECTION RELAY M-3425A


PROCESSOR

Shielded Cable Belden 3104A or equivalent is recommended for connection between M-3425A and M-3921 Rear Terminal Block Pin No.

Detail A

Typical Field Ground Protection


Excitation System
Brushes

Field Ground Detection Squarewave Generator

37 35

Vout

TB5

TB3

TB4

Signal Measurement and Processing

Vf
36
TB1

Coupling TB2 Network M-3921


TB1

Gen. Rotor

Rf.Cf

Shaft Ground Brush Ground/Generator Frame

Relay Ground Stud Shield

Detail B
Francis or Kaplan Turbine-Generator Application
Excitation System
TB3

64F Application for Hydro Turbine-Generators The application of the 64F Function requires a ground return path, either through a shaft ground brush (Detail A) or though an alternate ground path (i.e. water for some hydro machines.) Hydro Turbine-Generator unit shafts that extend into the water with no electrical isolation between the turbine shaft and the generator shaft can use the water as the alternate ground path (Detail B). In this application, the water provides the alternate ground path and a shaft grounding brush is not required. Francis and Kaplan Turbine Generators usually meet this application requirement. If the unit can experience a low water condition, the low water may not provide a reliable ground return. For this condition, a shaft ground brush may be required. A shaft ground brush must be utilized for the 64F Function on Pelton Hydro Turbine-Generator applications. 64F Application for Brushless Generators The 64F Function can be implemented on brushless generators that employ a "measurement" brush (Detail C) to verify the integrity of field. In this configuration generally only one field polarity is available. Therefore, a suitably sized jumper must be installed from TB2 to TB3 (Coupling Network box M-2931) and then to the positive or negative field lead. In some configurations the measurement brush is continuously applied. In others the measurement brush is applied periodically. In configurations that automatically lift the measurement brush, the 64B Function must be blocked by an input to the relay to prevent an alarm when the measurement brush is lifted. If the 64B Function is not desired, then the 64B Function should be disabled. The 64F Function can not be used on brushless generators utilizing LED coupling.

Brushes

Gen. Rotor
TB2

Rf.Cf
TB1 Ground/Generator Frame Water provides alternate ground path.

Detail C
Brushless Generator Application
Jumper TB2 to TB3 if only one brush is used TB3 Measurement Brush

Gen. Rotor
TB2

Rf.Cf
TB1

Shaft Ground Brush Ground/Generator Frame

Figure 4-70 M3921 Field Ground Coupler

494

System Setup and Setpoints 4

8 WARNING: Machine should be off-line and field excitation should be off during the capacitance measurement. NOTE: Field breaker should be closed for the capacitance measurements.

64B Brush Lift-Off Detection Brush Lift-Off Detection (64B) provides detection of open brushes of the rotor shaft. This function works in conjunction with the 64F Field Ground Detection function, and requires the M3921 Field Ground Coupler. Typical Frequency Setting 0.52 Hz 0.49 Hz 0.46 Hz 0.43 Hz 0.39 Hz 0.35 Hz 0.32 Hz 0.30 Hz 0.28 Hz 0.26 Hz

Field Winding to Ground Capacitance 1 to 2 mF 2 to 3 mF 3 to 4 mF 4 to 5 mF 5 to 6 mF 6 to 7 mF 7 to 8 mF 8 to 9 mF 9 to 10 mF >10 mF

Table 4-8 Typical Frequency Settings

Figure 4-71 Field Ground Protection (64B/F) Setpoint Ranges

495

M3425A Instruction Book

When 64B operates, indicating open brush conditions, the 64F Function cannot detect a field ground. For most generators, when the brushes of the rotor shaft are lifted, the capacitance across the field winding and the ground significantly reduces to less than 0.15 F. The 64B Function analyzes this capacitance-related signal, and initiates an output contact when it detects an open brush condition. Typically, this output is used to alert operating personnel of an open brush condition. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-71. The typical pickup setting is listed in Table 4-9, Typical Brush Lift-Off Pickup Settings. In order to assure correct setting, it is recommended that the actual operating value be predetermined during the final stage of the relay installation. By introducing a brush-open condition, the actual value can be easily obtained from the relay. The following procedure can be used to obtain the actual operating value of the 64B during an open brush condition: 8 WARNING: Machine should be off-line and field excitation should be off during the capacitance measurement. 64B PICKUP 64B DELAY cycles mV

NOTE: Field breaker should be closed for the capacitance measurements. 1. After installation has been completed, determine the rotor capacitance, as outlined for the 64F function. With the machine still off-line, apply power to the relay and set the 64B/F operating frequency in accordance with the value listed in Table 4-8, Typical Frequency Settings. Introduce a brush-open condition by disconnecting the rotor brushes or lifting the brushes from their ground. Observe the 64B voltage value displayed by IPScom or the relay. The displayed value is the actual measured operating value of the 64B function. To ensure correct operation and prevent erroneous trips, the Pickup Setting for the 64B Lift-off condition should be set at 8090% of the actual operating value.

2.

3.

4.

The 64B/F Frequency is a shared setting common to both the 64B and 64F Functions. If either function is enabled, this setpoint is available, and should be set to compensate for the amount of capacitance across the field winding and ground, so that the measurement accuracy is improved.

64B/F FREQUENCY Hz

To minimize measurement errors, the 64B/F frequency should be set according to the amount of capacitance across the field winding and the ground. Table 4-8 includes typical settings of the frequency for capacitance, ranging from 1 F to 10 F. Typical Brush Lift-Off Pickup Setting 2500 mV

Equivalent Brush Lift-Off Capacitance 0.05~0.25 mF

Table 4-9 Typical Brush Lift-Off Pickup Setting

496

System Setup and Setpoints 4

64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Signal Injection NOTE: The Stator Ground Protection function (64S) must be selected when the M3425A is initially ordered. The 100% stator ground fault protection is provided by injecting an external 20 Hz signal into the neutral of the generator. The protection is provided when the machine is on-line as well as off-line (provided that the 20 Hz generator and relay are powered on). The injected 20 Hz signal will produce a voltage that appears on the primary side of the grounding transformer when the machine is online as well as offline. This scheme requires the following external components in addition to M-3425A protection system: 20 Hz Signal-generator (BECO Part No. 43000426) (Siemens 7XT33) Band-pass filter. (BECO Par t No. 43000427) (Siemens 7XT34) 20 Hz Measuring Current Transformer, 400/5 A CT (BECO Part No. 43000428) (ITI CTW3-60-T50--401)

Where V20 is the 20 Hz voltage measured across the neutral resistor RN and XCS is the capacitive reactance of the generator stator winding and unit transformer referred to the grounding transformer secondary. N is the turn ratio of the grounding transformer. There are two overcurrent pickup settings. One operates on the magnitude of total 20 Hz neutral current measured by the relay. The other pickup setting operates on the real component of the 20 Hz neutral current where V20 is the reference. V20 is the 20 Hz voltage measured across the neutral resistor RN. The real component of the 20 Hz current increases in magnitude during a ground fault on the generator stator since the insulation resistance decreases. The real component of current pickup is disabled when VN is less than 0.1 V @ 20 Hz. Set the two pickups utilizing the equations illustrated in Figure 4-73. The 20 Hz signal generator has an output of 25 volts and the band pass filter is eight ohms purely resistive. Only a small amount of 20 Hz current flows when the generator is operating normally (that is, no ground fault) as a result of the stator capacitance to ground. The magnitude of 20 Hz current increases when there is a ground fault anywhere along the stator windings. The 64S function issues a trip signal after a set time delay when the measured 20 Hz current exceeds a pickup as illustrated in Figure 4-74. The 59N Function (90 to 95%) should also be used in conjunction with 64S protection to provide backup. CAUTION: Dangerous high voltages may be present at the generator terminals if the 20 Hz injection voltage is not removed when the generator is taken out of service. If the 20 Hz injection voltage generator receives power from the generator terminal voltage, then the 20 Hz injection voltage generator will be automatically switched off whenever the generator terminal voltage is not present.

NOTE: Chapter 5, Installation contains low frequency signal injection equipment installation information. The voltage signal generated by the 20 Hz signalgenerator is injected into the secondary of the generator neutral grounding transformer through a band-pass filter. The band-pass filter passes the 20 Hz signal and rejects outofband signals. The output of the 20 Hz band-pass filter is connected to the VN input of the M-3425A relay through a suitable voltage divider, that limits the M3425A to < 200 V ac (the voltage generator may be bypassed if the expected 50/60 Hz voltage during a phaseto-ground fault of the generator is >200 V). The 20Hz current is also connected to the IN input of the M3425A, through the 20Hz current transformer. The expected 20 Hz current during no fault condition is given by: INF = V20 XCS XCS = XC (Primary) N2

497

M3425A Instruction Book

64S TOTAL CURRENT disable ENABLE 64S TOTAL CURR PU mAmps

Pickup setting for the overcurrent element that operates on the 20 Hz neutral current measured by the relay (IN). This setting ranges from 2 to 75 mA and is for the total current, which includes both the real and imaginary components.

64S REAL COMP CURRENT disable ENABLE 64S REAL COMP CURR PU mAmps This is the pickup setting for the overcurrent element that operates on the real component of the 20 Hz neutral current measured by the relay (Re(IN)). The 20 Hz neutral voltage measured by the relay is the reference used to calculate the real component. This setting is in milli-amps and ranges from 2 to 75 mA. This is the time delay on pickup for both overcurrent elements described above.

64S DELAY Cycles

64S VOLT RESTRAINT disable ENABLE

If voltage restraint is enabled the overcurrent pickup settings described above are varied depending on the magnitude of 20 Hz neutral voltage measured by the relay. The pickup settings are more sensitive for neutral voltage less than or equal to 25 volts. The pickup settings are de-sensitized for neutral voltage greater than 25 volts. Refer to Figure 4-75. Voltage restraint is typically disabled since the measured neutral voltage is most often approximately one volt, or less. If 64S is purchased without Real Component, then Voltage Restraint is always enabled and cannot be disabled.

64S UNDERFREQ INHIBIT disable ENABLE

Enable this setting to block F64S when the system voltage measured by the relay is 40 Hz or less such as during startup. This can prevent nuisance tripping during startup and shutdown when the generator is transitioning through the lower frequencies.

498

20 Hz Generator
DC 1 2 11 3 6 Neutral Grounding Transformer 1A1 1A3 1A4 1A2 Bl 8 7 RN K 12 k 400/5 A 20 Hz CT High* Voltage Max. 200 V 44
59N

Supply Voltage 100-230 VAC** L1

Connection terminals for Model A00/EE shown.

UH+ UH-

20 Hz Band Pass Filter


1B1 1B4

L2

L3

+ _
External Block Error 9 5 4 Device Operative L+

400A 5A L l Wiring Shielded

M-3425A 45

Figure 4-72 64S Function Component Connection Diagram (Model A00/EE 20 Hz Signal Generator)
52 53

VN IN

* For applications with a transformer secondary rating that will result in 50/60 Hz phase ground fault voltages >200 V ac, use the "High Voltage" connection for the 59N Function. ** If 20 Hz Signal Generator is prior to Model EE a step down transformer is necessary for voltages >120 VAC.

System Setup and Setpoints 4

499

M3425A Instruction Book

RFilter = 8 Ohms

N X CP RStator RN
V

25 V 20 Hz

CT = 400:5
8 Ohms

XCS

RS

It
CT = 80:1

RN

25 V 20 Hz

XCS =

XCP N2 RStator N2

Capacitive reactance of stator windings and unit transformer (secondary) Insulation resistance (secondary)

RS = Where:

XCP = Capacitive reactance of stator windings and unit transformer (primary) RStator = Insulation resistance (primary) N = Turns ratio of grounding transformer RN = Neutral grounding resistance (secondary) Figure 4-73 Primary Transferred To Transformer Secondary

4100

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Calculate the total current measured by the current input IN as follows:

IT = 8+ 1+ RS

25 8 RN ZS

ZS =

= -900 - tan-1
IN = IT 80

2 2 eRS + XCS

XCS

-XCS R

Calculate the real component of the current measured by the current input I N with respect to the neutral voltage input as follows: Re(IT) = I T COS() Re(IN) = IT COS() 80 Where:

1+

ArcTAN

8 RN 8 RN

(ZS) sin (ZS) cos

8+ 1+

Re(ZS) is the real component of ZS and Im(ZS) is the imaginary component. Calculate the total current when the system is faulted and unfaulted to determine if there is adequate sensitivity for this pickup setting. Use the following two assumptions for the insulation resistance to calculate the current during normal operating conditions and a ground fault: RStator = 100 kilo-Ohms (normal operating conditions) RStator = 5 kilo-Ohms (ground fault)

There maybe only 2 to 3 milli-amps or less in difference for the total current when the system is faulted and unfaulted for applications that have a large value of capacitive coupling to ground (CO greater than 1.5 microFarads) when combined with a low value for the grounding resistor (RN less than 0.3 Ohms). Use the real component of the total current for these applications as there will be a larger margin in difference when the system is faulted and unfaulted.

4101

M3425A Instruction Book

Equipment Description 20 Hz Signal-Generator 20 Hz Band-pass Filter 20 Hz Measuring Current Transformer 400-5 A CT

Surface/Flush Mount Beco. Part No. 430-00426 430-00427 430-00428

OEM Part No. Siemens 7XT33 Siemens 7XT34 ITI CTWS-60-T50-401

Table 4-10 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment Part Number Cross Reference

140 %

64S Pickup Current

TRIP

I20

60 %

0V

5V

10 V

15 V

20 V

25 V

30 V

35 V

40 V

45 V

20 Hz Injection Voltage

Figure 4-74 Voltage Restraint Characteristic

Figure 4-75 100% Stator Ground Protection (64S) Setpoint Ranges

4102

System Setup and Setpoints 4

67N Residual Directional Overcurrent The Residual Directional Overcurrent function (67N) provides protection from ground faults. The 67N function can provide generator ground fault protection. It can also provide directional discrimination when multiple generators are bused together. The 67N Function is subject to the following configuration limitations: VX polarization cannot be selected if 25 (Sync) function is enabled. 3V0 polarization can only be used with Line-Ground VT configuration. 67N Function is not available if 87GD is enabled.

or 3V0 calculated using VA, VB and VC inputs. The function provides both definite time and inverse time elements. The inverse time element provides several curves. The curves available for use are shown in Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves. They cover a range from 1.5 to 20 times the pickup setting. An additional one cycle time delay should be added to these curves in order to obtain the relay operating time. Inverse time curves saturate beyond 20 times pickup. For currents in excess of 20 times pickup, operating times are fixed at the 20 time pickup level. To obtain maximum sensitivity for fault currents, the directional element is provided with a maximum sensitivity angle adjustment (MSA). This setting is common to both the 67NDT and 67NIT elements. The pickup sensitivity of the relay remains constant for 90 either side of the so-called Maximum Sensitivity Angle (MSA). At angles over 90 from MSA, the relay operation is blocked. Typical MSA setting for a generator internal ground fault protector is approximately 150.

The 67N Function operates on the residual current either from internal calculation (3I0) using IA, IB and IC or using a residual current input from IN input of the relay (this is preferred compared to 3I0). The relay can be polarized with the neutral voltage (VN), broken delta voltage connected at VX input

Figure 4-76 Residual Directional Overcurrent (67N) Trip Characteristics

4103

M3425A Instruction Book

67NDT PICKUP Amps 67NDT DIR ELEMENT disable ENABLE 67NDT DELAY Cycles 67NIT PICKUP Amps 67NIT DIR ELEMENT disable ENABLE 67NIT CURVE bdef binv bvinv beinvV 67NIT TIME DIAL

Pickup value for the 67N element.

Directional discrimination enable. When disabled, this function will work like a 50N.

Time Delay setting.

Inverse Time Pickup

Directional discrimination enabled. When disabled, this function will operate like 51N.

Select the inverse time curve.

Time dial setting

67N MAXSENSITIVITYANGLE Degrees 67N OPERATING CURRENT 3I0 in 67N POLARIZING QUANTITY 3V0vnvx

See Figure 4-76 for Max Sensitivity Angle (MSA) settings.

Select the operating current.

Select the polarization voltage. If 3V 0 is selected, VT configuration must be set to Line-Ground.

4104

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 4-77 Residual Directional Overcurrent (67N) Setpoint Ranges

4105

M3425A Instruction Book

78 Out-of-Step The Out-of-Step function (78) is used to protect the generator from out-of-step or pole slip conditions. This function uses one set of blinders, along with a supervisory MHO element. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-81. The pickup area is restricted to the shaded area in Figure 4-78, Out-of-Step Relay Characteristics, defined by the inner region of the MHO circle, the region to the right of the blinder A and the region to the left of blinder B. For operation of the blinder scheme, the operating point (positive sequence impedance) must originate outside either blinder A or B, and swing through the pickup area for a time greater than or equal to the time delay setting and progress to the opposite blinder from where the swing had originated. When this scenario happens, the tripping logic is complete. The contact will remain closed for the amount of time set by the seal-in timer delay. XT= Transformer Reactance XS=System Reactance Xd= Transient Reactance of the Generator 78 DIAMETER Ohms 78 OFFSET Ohms 78 BLINDER IMPEDANCE Ohms 78 IMPEDANCE ANGLE Degrees 78 DELAY Cycles 78 TRIP ON MHO EXIT disable enable 78 POLE SLIP COUNT slips 78POLESLIPRESETTIME Cycles

Consider, for example, Figure 4-78. If the Out-ofstep swing progresses to impedance Z0(t0), the MHO element and the blinder A element will both pick up. As the swing proceeds and crosses blinder B at Z1(t1), blinder B will pick up. When the swing reaches Z2(t2), blinder A will drop out. If TRIP ON MHO EXIT option is disabled and the timer has expired (t2t1>time delay), then the trip circuit is complete. If the TRIP ON MHO EXIT option is enabled and the timer has expired, then for the trip to occur the swing must progress and cross the MHO circle at Z3(t3) where the MHO element drops out. Note the timer is active only in the pickup region (shaded area). If the TRIP ON MHO EXIT option is enabled, a more favorable tripping angle is achieved, which reduces the breaker tripping duty. The relay can also be set with a Pole Slip Counter. The relay will operate when the number of pole slips are equal to the setting, provided the Pole Slip Reset Time was not expired. Typically, the Pole Slip Counter is set to 1, in which case the Pole Slip Reset Time is not applicable.

Typical setting is (1.5XT+2Xd)

Typical setting is 2Xd.

Typical setting is (1/2) (Xd+ XT + XS) tan((/2)). Typical value for is 120. Typical setting for is 90.

The time delay should be set based on the stability study. In the absence of such a study, it can be set between 3 and 6 cycles. This setting is typically enabled.

Typical setting is 1 pole slip.

Typical setting is 120 cycles.

4106

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Z3(t3) Z0(t0) Z1(t1)

Z2(t2)

Figure 4-78 Out-of-Step Relay Characteristics


X D

SYSTEM XS

1.5 XT
TRANS XT G

F H

d
GEN (X 'd) MHO ELEMENT

SWING LOCUS

' 2Xd

BLINDER ELEMENTS

Figure 4-79 Out-of-Step Protection Settings

4107

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 4-80 Out-of-Step (78) Setpoint Ranges

4108

System Setup and Setpoints 4

81 Frequency The Frequency function (81) provides either overfrequency or underfrequency protection of the generator. It has four independent pickup and time delay settings. The overfrequency mode is automatically selected when the frequency setpoint is programmed higher than the base frequency (50 or 60 Hz), and the underfrequency mode selected when the setpoint is programmed below the base frequency. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-82. The steam turbine is usually considered to be more restrictive than the generator at reduced frequencies because of possible natural mechanical resonance in the many stages of the turbine blades. If the generator speed is close to the natural frequency of any of the blades, there will be an increase in vibration. Cumulative damage due to this vibration can lead to cracking of the blade structure. Sample settings of the 81 function are shown in Figure 4-81. The frequency functions are automatically disabled when the input voltage (positive sequence) is very low (typically between 2.5 V and 15 V, based on the frequency.) The 81 function should be disabled using breaker contact when the unit is offline. These magnitude and time settings describe a curve (as shown in Figure 4-81, Example of Frequency (81) Trip Characteristics) which is to be coordinated with the capability curves of the turbine and generator as well as the system underfrequency load-shedding program. These capabilities are given by a description of areas of prohibited operation, restricted time operation, and continuous allowable operation. The underfrequency function is usually connected to trip the machine whereas the overfrequency function is generally connected to an alarm. In order to prevent misoperation during switching transients, the time delay should be set to greater than five (5) cycles.

81 #1 PICKUP Hz 81 #1 DELAY Cycles 81 #2 PICKUP Hz 81 #2 DELAY Cycles 81 #3 PICKUP Hz 81 #3 DELAY Cycles 81 #4 PICKUP Hz 81 #4 DELAY Cycles

4109

M3425A Instruction Book

Over Frequency Magnitude #1

81 Over Frequency (Hz)

61.0 60.8 60.6 60.4 60.2 60.0


Over Frequency Magnitude #2 Over Frequency Time Delay #1 Under Frequency Time Delay #4 Under Frequency Magnitude #3 Over Frequency Time Delay #2

Trip

81 Under Frequency (Hz)

59.8 59.6 59.4 59.2 59.0


Under Frequency Magnitude #4

Under Frequency Time Delay #3

Time (cycles)

Trip

Figure 4-81 Example of Frequency (81) Trip Characteristics

4110

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 4-82 Frequency (81) Setpoint Ranges

4111

M3425A Instruction Book

81A Frequency Accumulator Frequency Accumulation feature (81A) provides an indication of the amount of off frequency operation accumulated. Turbine blades are designed and tuned to operate at rated frequencies, operating at frequencies different than rated can result in blade resonance and fatigue damage. In 60 Hz machines, the typical operating frequency range for 18 to 25 inch blades is 58.5 to 61.5 Hz and for 25 to 44 inch blades is between 59.5 and 60.5 Hz. Accumulated operation, for the life of the machine, of not more than 10 minutes for frequencies between 56 and 58.5 Hz and not more than 60 minutes for frequencies between 58.5 and 59.5 Hz is acceptable on typical machines. The 81A function can be configured to track off nominal frequency operation by either set point or when the frequency is within a frequency band.

When using multiple frequency bands, the lower limit of the previous band becomes the upper limit for the next band, i.e., Low Band #2 is the upper limit for Band #3, and so forth. Frequency bands must be used in sequential order, 1 to 6. Band #1 must be enabled to use Bands #2#6. If any band is disabled, all following bands are disabled. When frequency is within an enabled band limit, accumulation time starts (there is an internal ten cycle delay prior to accumulation), this allows the underfrequency blade resonance to be established to avoid unnecessary accumulation of time. When accumulated duration is greater than set delay, then the 81A function operated the programmed output contact. The contact can be used to alert the operator or trip the machine. The accumulator status can be set to preserve the accumulated information from previous devices. This allows the relay to begin accumulating information at a pre-defined value. This setpoint is only available through IPScom Communications Software.

81A #1HIGH BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #1 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #1 DELAY Cycles 81A #2 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #2 DELAY Cycles 81A #3 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #3 DELAY Cycles

81A #4 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #4 DELAY Cycles 81A #5 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #5 DELAY Cycles

81A #6 LOW BAND PICKUP Hz 81A #6 DELAY Cycles

4112

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Example-Band Fn 81-1 HB #1 Band 81-1 LB #2 Band 81-2 LB #3 Band 81-3 LB #4 Band 81-4 LB #5 Band

10 Time (mins)

15

Figure 4-83 Frequency Accumulator (81A) Example Bands

Figure 4-84 Frequency Accumulator (81A) Setpoint Ranges

4113

M3425A Instruction Book

81R Rate of Change of Frequency The Rate of Change of Frequency function (81R) can be used for load shedding or tripping applications. The function also has an automatic disable feature which disables 81R function during unbalanced faults and other system disturbances. This feature uses negative sequence voltage to block the 81R function. When the measured negative sequence voltage exceeds the inhibit setting, the function 81R and metering are blocked. The time delay and magnitude settings of 81R should be based on simulation studies. The ranges and increments are shown in Figure 4-85.

81r #1 PICKUP 81R #1 DELAY 81R #2 PICKUP 81R #2 DELAY Cycles Hz/s Cycles Hz/s

81RNEGSEQVOLT INHIBIT %

Figure 4-85 Rate of Change of Frequency (81R) Setpoint Ranges

4114

System Setup and Setpoints 4

87 Phase Differential The Phase Differential function (87) is a percentage differential with an adjustable slope of 1100%. Although this protection is used to protect the machine from all internal winding faults, singlephase to ground faults in machines with high impedance grounding may have currents less than the sensitivity of the differential relay (typically between 3 and 30 primary amps). Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-87. Turn-to-turn faults are not detected by differential relays because the current into the generator equals the current out (see functions 50DT and 59X for turn-to-turn fault protection.) Even though the percentage differential relay is more tolerant of CT errors, all CTs should have the same characteristics and accuracies.

To provide restraint for CT saturation at high offset currents, the slope is automatically adjusted (at a restraining current equal to two times nominal current) to four times the slope setting, see Figure 4-86. For very high currents in large generators, the proximity of CTs and leads in different phases can cause unbalanced currents to flow in the secondaries. These currents must be less than the minimum sensitivity of the relay. There are two elements in this function. Element #2 is intended to provide phase differential protection for SFC (Static Frequency Converter) starting gas turbine generator applications. Element #1 should be disabled with a contact blocking input during a converter start operation (generator off-line), since the current is carried by only neutral side CTs and the resulting differential current may mis-operate 87#1 function. The 87#2 element, which is set with a higher current pickup, will still provide protection for this condition.

87 #1 PICKUP Amps 87 #1 SLOPE % 87 #1 DELAY Cycles 87 #2 PICKUP Amps 87 #2 SLOPE % 87 #2 DELAY Cycles

A typical setting is 0.3 amps.

A typical setting is 10%.

A typical setting is one cycle. Typical settings given above assume matched current transformer performance, and that transformer inrush of the unit transformer does not cause dc saturation of the generator CTs. If there is a significant difference in current transformer ratings (C800 vs C200, for example), or if saturation of the generator CTs is expected during energizing of the step up transformer, more appropriate settings might be 0.5 A pick up, 20% slope, and a delay of 5 to 8 cycles.

If line side and neutral side CTs do not have the same ratio, the ratio error can be corrected (the line side measured current is multiplied by the phase CT correction settings.) Line Side CTR Phase CT Correction = Neutral Side CTR

87 PHASE CT CORRECTION

4115

M3425A Instruction Book

Operating Current

((IA x CTC)-Ia), ((IB x CTC)-Ib), ((IC x CTC)-Ic)

TRIP

SLOPE (4xset)

BLOCK SLOPE (set) Restraint Current

MIN PU

@ IRES = 2 x INOM

((IA x CTC)+Ia)/2, ((IB x CTC)+Ib)/2, ((IC x CTC)+Ic)/2

Where IA and Ia are generator high side and neutral side currents respectively, and CTC is the CT Phase correction.

Figure 4-86 Differential Relay (87) Operating Characteristics

Figure 4-87 Phase Differential (87) Setpoint Ranges

4116

System Setup and Setpoints 4

87GD Ground (Zero Sequence) Differential The Zero Sequence Differential function (87GD) provides ground fault protection for low impedance grounded generator applications. High sensitivity and fast operation can be obtained using this function. Ranges and increments are presented in Figure 4-88. The relay provides a CT Ratio Correction Factor (RC) which removes the need for auxiliary CTs when the phase and neutral CT ratios are different. When the system can supply zero sequence current to the ground fault (such as when several generators are bussed together), the 87GD function operates directionally. The directional element calculates the product (3I0INCos) for directional indication. The relay will operate only if I0 (Zero sequence current derived from phase CTs) and IN (Neutral current from Neutral CT) have the opposite polarity, which is the case for internal generator faults.

The advantage of directional supervision is the security against ratio errors and CT saturation during faults external to the protected generator. The directional element is inoperative if the residual current (3I0 ) is approximately less than 0.2 A, in which case the algorithm automatically disables the directional element and the 87GD function becomes non-directional differential. The pickup quantity is then calculated as the difference between the corrected triple zero-sequence current (RC3I0) and the neutral current (IN). The magnitude of the difference (RC3I0IN) is compared to the relay pickup. For security purposes during external high phasefault currents causing CT saturation, this function is disabled any time the value of IN is less than approximately 0.20 amps. NOTE: When 87GD is enabled, 67N function is not available.

87GD PICKUP 87GD DELAY Cycles Amps

A typical setting is 0.2 amps. (Relay amps = primary amps CT ratio.) For higher values of RC, noise may create substantial differential current making higher pickup settings desirable. CAUTION: Do NOT set the Delay to less than 2 Cycles. In order to prevent mis-operation during external faults with CT saturation conditions, a time delay of 6 cycles or higher is recommended. CT Ratio Correction Factor = (Phase CT Ratio)/(Neutral CT Ratio)

87GD C.T. RATIO CORRECT

Figure 4-88 Ground Differential (87GD) Setpoint Ranges

4117

M3425A Instruction Book

Breaker Monitoring The Breaker Monitoring feature calculates an estimate of the per-phase wear on the breaker contacts by measuring and integrating the current (IT) or current squared (I2T) passing through the breaker contacts during the interruption period. The per-phase values are added to an accumulated total for each phase, and then compared to a userprogrammed threshold value. When the threshold is exceeded in any phase, the relay can operate a BM PICKUP kA-cycles

programmable output contact. The accumulated value for each phase can be displayed as an actual value. The accumulation starts after a set time delay from the trip initiate command to account for the time it takes for the breaker to start opening its contacts. The accumulation continues until the current drops below 10% of the nominal current setting or 10 cycles, whichever occurs first. NOTE: Preset Accumulator Setpoints are only available through IPScom.

Expanded Inputs IN7IN14 (if equipped) must be set using IPScom. Expanded Outputs OUT9OUT23 (if equipped) must be set using IPScom.

BM INPUT INITIATE i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 BM OUTPUT INITIATE 08 07 06 05 04 03 02 01 BM DELAY Cycles

BM TIMING METHOD it i2t

Figure 4-89 Breaker Monitor (BM) Setpoint Ranges

4118

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Trip Circuit Monitoring External connections for the Trip Circuit Monitoring function are shown in Figure 4-90. The default Trip Circuit Monitor input voltage is 250 V dc. See Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers, Table 53 for other available trip circuit input voltage selections. This function should be programmed to block when the breaker is open, as indicated by 52b contact input (IN1). If the TCM is monitoring a lockout relay, a 86 contact input (INx) should be used to block when the lockout relay is tripped. When the Output Contact is open, and continuity exists in the Trip Circuit, a small current flows that activates the Trip Circuit Monitoring Input. If the Trip Circuit is open, and the output contact is open, no current flows and the Trip Circuit Monitoring Input

is deactivated. An Output Contact that is welded closed would also cause the Trip Circuit Monitoring Input to deactivate, indicating failure of the Output Contact. When the Output Contact is closed, no current flows in the Trip Circuit Monitoring Input. If the M3425A has issued a trip command to close the Output Contact and Trip Circuit Monitoring Input remains activated, this is an indication that the Output Contact failed to close. The output of the Trip Circuit Monitoring function can be programmed as an alarm to alert maintenance personnel. TCM DELAY Cycles

M-3425A
52b or 86 Station Battery

2
Trip Circuit Monitoring Input

Aux Input

Output Contact

Other Contacts

52a 52 or 86 Trip Coil

Figure 4-90 Trip Circuit Monitoring Input

Figure 4-91 Trip Circuit Monitor (TC) Setpoint Ranges

4119

M3425A Instruction Book

IPSlogic The relay provides six logic functions and associated IPSlogic. The logic functions can be used to allow external devices to trip through the relay, providing additional target information for the external device. More importantly, these functions can be used in conjunction with IPSlogic to expand the capability of the relay by allowing the user to define customized operating logic. Programming the IPSlogic can only be implemented through IPScom Communications Software. The IPSlogic cannot be programmed using the HumanMachine Interface (HMI). IPS LOGIC USEIPSCOMTOCONFIGURE

4120

Initiating Outputs

Programmable Outputs 1-8 *Outputs 9-23

This section of the IPSlogic initiates the Function Output


Selectable And/Or Initiating Function Trip (includes external elements) Selectable And/Or

This section of the IPSlogic is used to activate the desired Output


Programmed Profile Setting Group 1-4

Programmable Function(s)

Timed Out

Programmed Outputs 1-8 *Outputs 1-23

Picked Up Selectable And/Or/Nor/Nand Initiating Intputs Selectable And/Or Programmed Time Delay 1- 65,500 Cycles (1091 sec) IPSlogic Activated Log Target

Programmable Inputs 1-6 *Inputs 7-14 Selectable And/Or

Initiate Via Communication Point

Figure 4-92 IPSlogic Function Setup


Blocking Intputs

Log Pickup

Programmable Inputs 1-6 *Inputs 7-14 Selectable And/Or

This section of the IPSlogic is used to Block the Function Output

Initiate Via Communication Point

* For units with Expanded I/O

System Setup and Setpoints 4

4121

M3425A Instruction Book

Settings and Logic Applicable when IPSlogic Function(s) programmed using IPScom There are four initiating input sources: Initiating Outputs, Initiating Function Trips, Function Pickup (including the IPSlogic Functions themselves), Initiating Inputs, and initiation using the Communication Port. The only limitation is that an IPSlogic Function may not be used to initiate itself. There are two blocking input sources: Blocking Inputs and blocking using the Communication Port. The activation state of the input function selected in the Initiating Function can be either timeout (Trip) or pickup. The desired time delay for security considerations can be obtained in the IPSlogic Function time delay setting.

The IPSlogic Function can be programmed to perform any or all of the following tasks: Change the Active Setting Profile Close an Output Contact Be activated for use as an input to another External Function

Since there are six IPSlogic Functions per setting profile, depending on the number of different relay settings defined, the scheme may provide up to 24 different logic schemes. The IPScom IPSlogic Function programming screen is shown in Figure 4-93.

NOTES: 1. This logic gate may be selected as either AND or OR. 2. This logic gate may be selected as AND, OR, NOR, or NAND.

Figure 4-93 IPSlogic Function Programming

4122

System Setup and Setpoints 4

Figure 4-94 Selection Screen for Initiating Function Pickup

Figure 4-95 Selection Screen for Initiating Function Timeout

4123

M3425A Instruction Book

DO/RST (Dropout/Reset) Timer Feature The DO/RST timer can be set as either Dropout or Reset mode. The operation of the Dropout Delay Timer and the Reset Delay Timer are described below.

Dropout Delay Timer The Dropout Delay Timer logic is presented in Figure 4-96. The Dropout Delay Timer feature allows the user to affect an output time delay that starts when the IPSlogic PU Status drops out (A) and can hold the Output (D) status true beyond the Output Seal In Delay value (C). However, the Seal In Delay (E) may hold the Output (B) true if the time after IPSlogic PU Status dropout (A) and Dropout Delay Timer value (D) are less than the Seal In Delay time (E).

Dropout Delay Timer Cycles IPSlogic Functions (1 - 6) PU Status PU Time Delay Setting (30) PU Time Delay Timing Output A C D
Seal in Delay Seal in Delay Dropout Delay

25

35

E B

Figure 4-96 Dropout Delay Timer Logic Diagram


Reset Delay Timer The Reset Delay Timer logic is presented in Figure 4-97. The Reset Delay Timer feature allows the user to delay the reset of the PU Time Delay Timer and hold the accumulated timer value (A) for the duration of the Reset Time Delay time period (B). The Reset Delay Timer starts when the IPSlogic PU Status drops out (C).
Reset Delay Timer Cycles IPSlogic Functions (1 - 6) PU Status PU Time Delay Setting (30) PU Time Delay Timing Output
25 12 25 8 5 10

If the IPSlogic PU Status remains dropped out (D) after the reset delay has timed out, then the IPSlogic PU timer value will be reset to zero (E). If the IPSlogic PU Status reasserts (F) while the Reset Delay Timer is still timing, then the PU Timer Delay begins timing from the accumulated value (G).

C
Reset Delay 10 Cycles

D B

F
Reset Delay Reset Delay

A E

Seal In Timer

Figure 4-97 Reset Delay Timer Logic Diagram

4124

Installation 5

5
5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 5.9

Installation

General Information................................................................. 51 Mechanical/Physical Dimensions............................................. 52 External Connections............................................................... 58 Commissioning Checkout....................................................... 514 Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers..................................... 520 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment........................... 524 IPScom Communications Software Installation.................... 530 Activating Initial Local Communications................................. 530 Initial Setup Procedure........................................................... 531

5.1

General Information
Maximum relative humidity 80% for temperatures up to 31 C, decreasing in a linear manner to 50% relative humidity at 40 C.

NOTE: Prior to installation of the equipment, it is essential to review the contents of this manual to locate data which may be of importance during installation procedures. The following is a quick review of the contents in the chapters of this manual. The person or group responsible for the installation of the relay will find herein all mechanical information required for physical installation, equipment ratings, and all external connections in this chapter. For reference, the ThreeLine Connection Diagrams are repeated from Chapter 4, System Settings and Setpoints. Further, a commissioning checkout procedure is outlined using the HMI option to check the external CT and VT connections. Additional tests which may be desirable at the time of installation are described in Chapter 6, Testing. Service Conditions and Conformity to CE Standard Stating conformance to CE Standard EN 61010-1 2001, operation of this equipment within the following service conditions does not present any known personnel hazards outside of those stated herein: 5 to 40 Centigrade

This equipment will function properly, and at stated accuracies beyond the limits of this CE Standard, as per the equipment's specifications, stated in this Instruction Book. It is suggested the terminal connections illustrated here be transferred to station one-line wiring and three-line connection diagrams, station panel drawings and station DC wiring schematics. If during the commissioning of the M3425A Generator Protection Relay, additional tests are desired, Chapter 6, Testing, may be consulted. Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints details the setup procedure. This includes details necessary for input of the communications data, unit setup data, configure relays data, the individual setpoints and time settings for each function, and oscillograph recorder setup information. Chapter 2 Operation, guides the operator through the status and metering screens, including monitoring the status and information on viewing the target history.

51

M3425A Instruction Book

5.2 Mechanical/Physical Dimensions


Figures 5-1 through 56 contain physical dimensions of the relay that may be required for mounting the unit on a rack.
17.50 [44.45] ACTUAL

5.21 [13.23] ACTUAL

17.50 [44.45]

10.20 [25.91]

19.00 [48.26]

19.00 [48.26] 18.31 [46.51] 0.35 [0.89] 0.40 [1.02] X 0.27 [0.68] Slot (4X) 2.25 [5.72] 1.48 [3.76]

Standard 19" Horizontal Mount Chassis NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

Figure 51 M-3425A Horizontal Chassis Mounting Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H1)

52

Installation 5

5.65 [14.40] 5.59 [14.20] Actual 2.25 [5.72] 0.03 [0.076] 1.67 [4.24]

0.35 [0.89]

2.25 [5.72]

1.67 [4.24] 0.28 [0.71] Dia. (4X)

TARGETS

19.00 [48.26]

OUTPUTS
OUT 1 OUT 3 OUT 4 OUT 5 OUT 6 OUT 7 OUT 8

18.31 [46.51]

OUT 2

17.5 [44.45] ACTUAL 17.68 [44.91]


EXIT ENTER

TARGET RESET PS 2 PS 1

TARGET

DIAG

BRKR CLOSED RELAY OK

OSC. TRIG TIME SYNC

COM 1

17.50 [44.45]

Recommended cutout when relay is not used as standard rack mount and is panel cut out mounted.

10.20 [25.91]

19.00 [48.26]

NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

Figure 52 M-3425A Vertical Chassis Mounting Dimensions Without Expanded I/O (H2)

53

M3425A Instruction Book

0.35 [0.89]

18.31 [46.51]

NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

Figure 53 M-3425A Mounting Dimensions Horizontal and Vertical Chassis With Expanded I/O

54

Installation 5

0.32 [0.81]

18.31 [46.51]

0.32 [0.81]

18.31 [46.51]

NOTE: Dimensions in brackets are in centimeters.

Figure 54 M-3425A Panel Mount Cutout Dimensions

55

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 55 Mounting Dimensions for GE L-2 Cabinet H3 and H4

56

Installation 5

.28 [ 0.71] 10 HOLES

9.70 [24.64]

20.78 [52.78] 19.89 [50.52]

3.53 [8.97] 17.72 [45.00]

3.53 [8.97]

9.94 [25.24]

9.70 [24.64]

2.15 [5.47]

.45 [1.13]

.41 [1.04]

1.13 [2.87]

6.69 [16.99] 8.63 [21.92]

7.81 [19.84]

FRONT VIEW (H5)

Figure 56 (H5) Mounting Dimensions

57

M3425A Instruction Book

5.3

External Connections
58

Ic

PS 2

PS 1

PS2 F1 F2

PS1

8 WARNING: The protective grounding terminal must be connected to an earthed ground anytime external connections have been made to the unit. 8WARNING: ONLY DRY CONTACTS must be connected to inputs (terminals 5 through 10 with 11 common and terminals 68 through 75 with 66 and 67 common) because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units. 8 WARNING: Do not open live CT circuits. Live CT circuits should be shorted prior to disconnecting CT wiring to the M3425A. Death or severe electrical shock may result. CAUTION: Mis-operation or permanent damage may result to the unit if a voltage is applied to Terminals 1 and 2 (aux) that does not match the configured Trip Circuit Monitoring input voltage. To fulfill requirements for UL and CSA listings, terminal block connections must be made with No. 12 AWG solid or stranded copper wire inserted in an AMP #324915 (or equivalent) connector, and wire insulation used must be rated at 60 C minimum. Power Supply When the M3425A without expanded I/O is equipped with the optional second power supply (Figure 57) , the power source may be the same or two different sources.
Ic PS 2 PS 1

3 A MP,2 5 0 V ( 3 A B)

59

60
18 5 6 85 265

61

62

63

18 5 6 85 265

F3

F4

+
Figure 58 Expanded I/O Power Supply
Grounding Requirements The M3425A is designed to be mounted in an adequately grounded metal panel, using grounding techniques (metal-to-metal mounting) and hardware that assures a low impedance ground. Unit Isolation Sensing inputs should be equipped with test switches and shorting devices where necessary to isolate the unit from external potential or current sources. A switch or circuit breaker for the M3425A's power shall be included in the building installation, and shall be in close proximity to the relay and within easy reach of the operator, and shall be plainly marked as being the power disconnect device for the relay. Insulation Coordination Sensing Inputs: 60 V to 140 V, Installation Category IV, Transient Voltages not to exceed 5,000 V. Torque Requirements Terminals 134 & 66105: 7.5 in-lbs, minimum, and 8.0 in-lbs, maximum Terminals 3565: 8.5 in-lbs, minimum, and 9.0 in-lbs, maximum

PS2 F1 F2

PS1

3 A MP,2 5 0 V ( 3 A B)

58

59

60
18 5 6 85 265

61

62

63

18 5 6 85 265

F3

F4

Figure 57 Optional Dual Power Supply


When the M3425A with expanded I/O is equipped with two (not redundant) power supplies, the power supplies must be powered from the same source.

Relay Outputs All outputs are shown in the de-energized state for standard reference. Relay standard reference is defined as protective elements in the non-trip, reconnection and sync logic in the non-asserted state, or power to the relay is removed. Output contacts #1 through #4 are high speed operation contacts. The power supply relay (P/S) is energized when the power supply is OK. The self-test relay is energized when the relay has performed all self-tests successfully. Replacement Fuses F1F4 replacement fuses must be fast-acting 3 Amp, 250 V (3AB) Beckwith Electric Part Number 42000885.

58

BECKW IT H ELECT RIC CO . INC.


MODEL: M-3425A 5 0 Hz 6 0 Hz S ERIA L NO . W A RNING! CO NT A CT W IT H T ERMINA L S MA Y CA US E EL ECT RIC S HO CK FO R CO NT A CT RA T INGS S EE INS T RUCT IO N MA NUA L U. S. PATENTS 5,592,393, 5,224,011 FIRMWARE: D-0150

6 19 0 118 t h AV E NO . 727- 5 4 4 - 23 26 L A RGO , FL 3 3 7 7 3


76 77 78 84 94 95 96 97 98 99 88 89 92 102 83 86 87 93 85 79 80 81 82 91 101 90 100 103

66 69 73 74 70 71 72 75

67

68

104

105

IN RT N

IN 14

IN 13

IN 12

IN 11

IN 10

IN 9

IN 8

IN 7

US

2
1 2 9 13 18 3 4 7 8 21 23 24 10 11 17 14 19 5 6 20 22 16 25 26 12 15 27

83F4 LIST ED IND. CONT . EQ .

INPUTS OUT PUTS

23 21 19
28

22 17 13 15

20 18 12

16 14

11
29 30 31

10
32 33

9
34

IRIG- B

1
!
A UX VB C VC A RS 4 8 5 COM 3 VA B
24 48 125 250

COM 2 RS 2 3 2

COM 2 ETHERNET

+
IN 6 IN 5 IN 4 IN 3 IN 2
V VN IN Ia Ib IA IB IC V C

+ INPUTS
IN 1 (5 2 b)

!
P/ S

IN RT N

F IE L D G N D COUPLER

V B

A LA RMS

S ELF- T EST 8
Ic

OUT PUTS

4
PS 2 PS 1

2 PS2

1 PS1

+
57 58 59

60
18 - 5 6 85 265

+
61

62 63
18 - 5 6 85 265

F1

F2
3 A MP,2 5 0 V ( 3 A B)

35 38 39 64
0 .0 1A NO M

36 40 42 43 49 64S 48 41 44 47 53

37

45 46 50 52 65

64F

VX

51 54

55

56

F3
5 A ,NO M

F4

4
RA T ED V O L T A GE 6 0 - 14 0 V A C,5 0 / 6 0 Hz 1A ,NO M

RAT ED CURRENT

Figure 59 External Connections

NOTES: !

1.

See Section 2.3, Setpoints and Time Settings, subsection for 64B/F Field Ground Protection.

2.

Before making connections to the Trip Circuit Monitoring input, see Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers, for the information regarding setting Trip Circuit Monitoring input voltage. Connecting a voltage other than the voltage that the unit is configured to may result in mis-operation or permanent damage to the unit.

3.

8WARNING: ONLY DRY CONTACTS must be connected to inputs (terminals 5 through 10 with 11 common and terminals 68 through 75 with 66 and 67 common) because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units.

Installation 5

4.

8 WARNING: The protective grounding terminal must be connected to an earthed ground any time external connections have been made to the unit.

59

M3425A Instruction Book

1 A B C Other Relays M-3425A 1 50 51 3 1 48 49 2

Wire to split phase differential CTs for use with 50DT split phase function. Required generator breaker status input (52b). Contact is closed when generator breaker is open. Use unit breaker contact if no generator breaker present. Output contact pairs designated by user.
M-3425A

4 5 6

Alarm output can be grouped to a single alarm at the discretion of user. Available control output to service other relays for VT Fuse Loss can be designated. Input contact number is designated by user.

46

47

39

38

41

40

43

42

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11 A B C Three VT Wye-Wye Alternate Connection

52 Gen

WARNING: ONLY dry contact inputs must be connected because these contact inputs are internally wetted. Application of external voltage on these inputs may result in damage to the units. NOTE: M-3425A current terminal polarity marks ( . ) indicate "entering" current direction when primary current is "from" the generator to the system. If CT connections differ from those shown, adjust input terminals.
A B C

42

43

40

41

38

39 Three VT Wye-Wye Connection

42

43

40

41

38

39 Two Vt Open-Delta Connection

M-3425A Generator M-3921 Field Ground Coupler Module a b c Other Relays M-3425A 58 59 a b c Other Relays

M-3425A

a M-3425A 59 58

c Other Relays M-3425A 59 58

56

57

OR

57

56

OR

57

56

55 54 55

54

55

54

M-3425A 45 R 44

M-3425A

OR
R

52

53

High Impedance Grounding

Low Impedance Grounding

Example of Control/Output Connections


+ DC: 24V 48V OR DC: 110V 125V 220V 250V AC: 110V 120V 230V 240V M-3425A Power Supply + 60 62 61 63 11 6 10 2 52b BREAKER FAILURE INITIATE 60FL OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER INITIATE EXTERNAL INPUTS TRIP ALARM SELFTEST FAILURE ALARM ALARM OUTPUTS 4 POWER OK STATUS ALARM 3 16 15 12 13 5 VT FUSE LOSS 3 3

52G

52Ga

TRIP CONTROL OUTPUTS OUTPUT

Figure 510 Three-Line Connection Diagram

510

Installation 5

M-3425A 65 VX 64

Used when Generator Side VTs are connected Line-Ground.

OR
M-3425A 65 VX 64

VX Used for Sync Check (25)


Used when Generator Side VTs are connected Line-Line

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen
A B C

M-3425A 39 38 41 40 43 42 Three VT Wye-Wye Connection

OR
M-3425A A B C 42 43 Two VT Open-Delta Connection

40 41

38 39

Generator

Figure 511 Function 25 Sync Check Three-Line Connection Diagram

511

M3425A Instruction Book

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen

A M-3425A VX 65 64 VX used for turn-to-turn fault protection (59X)

Generator

a Line to Neutral Voltage Rated Cable

M-3425A 52 53

OR

M-3425A 45 R 44

Low Impedance Grounding

High Impedance Grounding

NOTE: If 59X is enabled for Turn to Turn Fault Protection, then the 25 Function is not available.

Figure 512 Function 59X Turn to Turn Fault Protection Three-Line Connection Diagram

512

Installation 5

Bus Section

A B C

M-3425A 53 52 67N Connection

R M-3425A 65 64

Residual CT

I N input can be connected either at Neutral or as Residual.

59X Bus Ground

C 52b

M-3425A 10 11

52 Gen
A B C

M-3425A VX 65 64 67N, 59D Connection VX can be used for both 67N and 59D if connected in this manner.

Generator

M-3425A 52 53

I N input can be connected either at Neutral or as Residual.

Low Impedance Grounding

OR
M-3425A 45 R 44

High Impedance Grounding

Figure 513 Function 67N, 59D, 59X (Bus Ground) Three-Line Connection Diagram

513

M3425A Instruction Book

5.4

Commissioning Checkout

During field commissioning, check the following to ensure that the CT and VT connections are correct. 1. Press ENTER. After a short delay, the unit should display VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz pwr V 2. Press the right arrow button until the unit displays: STATUS config sys STAT V 3. Press ENTER. The unit should display: VOLTAGE STATUS VOLT curr freq v/hz V 4. Press ENTER. The unit should display either VA , V B , V C (line-to-ground connections) or VAB, VBC, VCA (line-to-line or lineground to line-line connections). PHASE VOLTAGE A= B= C= Compare these voltages with actual measurements using a voltmeter. If there is a discrepancy, check for loose connections to the rear terminal block of the unit. If lineground to lineline voltage selection is used, the voltages displayed are S3 times of the lineground voltages applied. Press ENTER to display the Neutral Voltage: NEUTRAL VOLTAGE Volts The neutral voltage should be near zero volts. 9. 8. Press ENTER to display Stator Low Frequency Injection (20 Hz) Voltage: STATORLOWFREQUENCYINJECT. Volts Display positive, negative and zero sequence voltages. Press ENTER until the unit displays: POS SEQUENCE VOLTAGE Volts The positive sequence voltage should be VPOSy VA y VB y VC or VAB y VBC y VCA. 7. 6. Press ENTER to display VX Voltage: V X VOLTAGE Volts Press ENTER to display Third Harmonic Differential Ratio: 3RD HARMONIC DIFF RATIO Press ENTER once more to display the line side Third Harmonic Voltage: 3RD HARMONIC 3V0 VOLT

5.

10. Press ENTER until the unit displays: NEG SEQUENCE VOLTAGE Volts The negative sequence voltage should be VNEGy 0.

514

Installation 5

11. Press ENTER until the unit displays: ZERO SEQUENCE VOLTAGE Volts The zero sequence voltage should be VZEROy0.

16. Press ENTER to display line currents (IA, IB, IC). The unit should display: PHASE CURRENT A= B= C= Compare these currents with the measured values using a meter. If there is a discrepancy, check the CT connections to the rear terminal block of the unit. Press ENTER for the unit to display: PHASE CURRENT a= b= c= Compare these currents with the measured values using a meter. If there is a discrepancy, check the CT connections to the rear terminal block of the unit. Press ENTER for the unit to display: DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT A= B= C= Differential current should be near zero amps. If a significant amount of differential current is present, check the CT polarities. Press ENTER for the unit to display: NEUTRAL CURRENT Amps

If the negative sequence voltage shows a high value and the positive sequence voltage is close to zero, the phase sequence is incorrect and proper phases must be reversed to obtain correct phase sequence. If the phase sequence is incorrect, frequency- and power-related functions will not operate properly and the Frequency Status menu will read DISABLE. If positive, negative and zero sequence voltages are all present, check the polarities of the VT connections and change connections to obtain proper polarities.

17.

12. Press ENTER until the unit displays: 3RD HARMONIC NTRL VOLT Volts 13. Press ENTER until the unit displays: FIELD GND MEAS. CIRCUIT mV 14. Press EXIT until the unit displays: VOLTAGE STATUS VOLT curr freq v/hz 15. Press the right arrow to display: CURRENT STATUS volt CURR freq v/hz 19. 18.

20. Press ENTER for the unit to display: GND DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT Amps 21. Press ENTER for the unit to display: STATOR LOW FREQ INJECT. I= mAmps

515

M3425A Instruction Book

22. Press ENTER to display: POS SEQUENCE CURRENT Amps 23. The positive sequence current should be IPOS y Iay Ib y Ic. Press ENTER to display: NEQ SEQUENCE CURRENT Amps Negative sequence current should near zero amperes. Press ENTER to display: ZERO SEQUENCE CURRENT Amps The zero sequence current should be IZEROy0 A. If a significant amount of negative or zero sequence current (greater than 25% of IA, IB, IC,) then either the phase sequence or the polarities are incorrect. Modify connections to obtain proper phase sequence and polarities. Press ENTER to display: F49 THERMAL CURRENT #1 Amps

28.

Press ENTER to display: RATE OF CHANGE FREQUENCY Hz/Sec

29.

Press EXIT, then right arrow to display: V/HZ STATUS volt curr freq V/HZ V

30.

Press ENTER to display: VOLTS PER HERTZ %

24.

31.

Press EXIT, then right arrow to display: POWER STATUS W POWR imped sync brkr V

32.

Press ENTER to display real power and check its sign. The unit should display: REAL POWER PU W

25.

The sign should be positive for forward power and negative for reverse power. If the sign does not agree with actual conditions, check the polarities of the three neutral-end CTs and/or the PTs. Press ENTER for the unit to display: REACTIVE POWER PU VAr

Press ENTER once more to display: F49 THERMAL CURRENT #2 Amps 26. Press EXIT, then the Right arrow to display: FREQUENCY STATUS volt curr FREQ v/hz V 27. Press ENTER to display: FREQUENCY Hz

33.

34.

Press ENTER for the unit to display: APPARENT POWER PU VA

35.

Press ENTER to display: POWER FACTOR Lag/Lead

516

Installation 5

36.

Press EXIT and then right arrow to display: IMPEDANCE STATUS W powr IMPED sync brkr V

43.

Press ENTER to display: DELTA FREQUENCY Hz HI

37.

Press ENTER to display: IMPEDANCEZab (Ohms) R= X=

44.

Press EXIT, then right arrow until unit displays: BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS W power imped sync BRKR V

Press ENTER once more to display: IMPEDANCEZbc (Ohms) R= X= Press ENTER once more to display: IMPEDANCEZca (Ohms) R= X= 38. Press ENTER to display: IMPEDANCE POS SEQ (Ohms) R= X= 39. Press ENTER to display: FIELD GND RESISTANCE Ohms 40. Press EXIT and then right arrow to display: SYNC CHECK STATUS W powr imped SYNC brkr V 41. Press ENTER to display: PHASE ANGLE DEGREES 42. Press ENTER to display: DELTA VOLTAGE Volts LO

45.

Press ENTER to display: BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS A= A-cycles

Press ENTER to cycle through Acc. Status screens for B and C. 46. Press EXIT, then right arrow until unit displays: 81A ACCUMULATORS STATUS W FREQ_ACCi/otimer V 47. Press ENTER to display: 81A #1 ACCUMULATORS STAT Cycles

Pressing ENTER will display a status screen for each of the six elements. 48. Press ENTER to display: 81A #1 ACC. STARTUP TIME 00-20XX 00:00:00:000 Pressing ENTER will display a status screen for each of the six elements. 49. Press EXIT, then right arrow until unit displays: IN/OUT STATUS W freq_acc I/O timer V

517

M3425A Instruction Book

50.

Press ENTER to display: FL I6 I5 I4 I3 I2 I1

58.

Press EXIT, then right arrow until unit displays: COUNTERS W temp COUNT powerup V

Press ENTER again to view outputs: o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1

59.

Press ENTER to display: OUTPUT COUNTER 1

51.

Press EXIT, then arrow button to display: TIMER STATUS W freq_acc i/o TIMER V

Pressing ENTER will display a status screen for each of the 23 outputs. 60. Press ENTER to display: ALARM COUNTER

52.

Press ENTER to display: 51V DELAY TIMER A=B=C=

53.

Press ENTER to display: 51N DELAY TIMER %

61. Press EXIT, then right arrow until the unit displays: TIME OF LAST POWER UP W temp count POWERUP V 62. Press ENTER to display: TIME OF LAST POWER UP 05-Jan-200320:39:29 NOTE: The CT and VT polarities can be easily verified by looking at the oscillographic waveforms, using M-3801D IPSplot PLUS analysis software. 63. Press EXIT, then right arrow until the unit displays: ERROR CODES W ERRORcheck 64. Press ENTER to display: ERROR CODES (LAST)

54.

Press ENTER to display: 46IT DELAY TIMER %

55.

Press ENTER to display: 24IT DELAY TIMER %

56.

Press EXIT, then right arrow until unit displays: RELAY TEMPERATURE W TEMP count powerup V

57.

Press ENTER to display: RELAY TEMPERATURE C

Pressing ENTER will display a status screen for three previous error codes.

518

Installation 5

65.

Press ENTER to display: RST LOCATION 0000CBR=___BBR=___

71.

Press ENTER to display: POWERLOSS COUNTER

66. Press ENTER to display: COMM ERROR CODE (LAST)

72.

Press EXIT, then right arrow until the unit displays: CHECKSUMS W error CHECK

67.

Press ENTER to display: COMM PACKET COUNTER

73.

Press ENTER to display: SETPOINTS CHECKSUM EECS=BBCS=CAL=

68.

Press ENTER to display: COMM RX ERROR COUNTER

74.

Press ENTER to display: CALIBRATION CHECKSUM EECS=BBCS=CAL=

69.

Press ENTER to display: SELFTEST COUNTER

75.

Press ENTER to display: ROM CHECKSUM

70.

Press ENTER to display: RESET COUNTER

519

M3425A Instruction Book

5.5

Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers

1. 2. 3.

De-energize the M3425A. Remove the screws that retain the front cover. Remove the "J" connectors from the corresponding plugs, P4, 5, 6, 7, 9 and 11. Loosen the two circuit board retention screws (captured). Remove the circuit board from the chassis. Jumpers J5, J18, J20, J21, J22, J46, J60, and J61 are now accessible. See Figure 514, M3425A Circuit Board for locations. Dipswitch SW1 is now accessible. See Figure 514 for location. Insert circuit board into chassis guides and seat firmly. Tighten circuit board retention screws. Reconnect "J" connectors corresponding plugs. Reinstall cover plate. to

See Figure 514, M3425A Circuit Board for Jumper and Switch locations. Accessing Switches and Jumpers 8 WARNING: Operating personnel must not remove the cover or expose the printed circuit board while power is applied. IN NO CASE may the circuit-based jumpers or switches be moved with power applied. 8 WARNING: The protective grounding terminal must be connected to an earthed ground any time external connections have been made to the unit. See Figure 59, Note #4. CAUTION: This unit contains MOS circuitry, which can be damaged by static discharge. Care should be taken to avoid static discharge on work surfaces and service personnel.

4. 5. 6.

7. 8. 9. 10. 11.

Jumper J5 J18 J46 J60 J61

Position A to B B to C A to B B to C A to B B to C A to B A to C B to C A to B

Description Demodulated IRIG-B TTL signal on Pin 6 COM2 Modulated IRIG-B signal BNC (Default) COM3 200 ohm termination resistor inserted COM3 no termination (Default) COM3 shares Baud Rate with COM1 COM3 shared Baud Rate with COM2 (Default) Connects DCD signal to Pin 1 of COM2 (Default) Connects +15V to Pin 1 of COM2 Connects -15V to Pin 9 of COM2 COM2 Pin 9 float (Default)

NOTE: Short circuit protection (100 ma limit) is incorporated on pins 1 and 9 when used for +/- 15V.

Table 51 Jumpers

520

Installation 5

Dipswitch SW1 1 2 X X 3 X 4 X Open (Up) Closed (Down) Switches should not be changed while unit is energized.

3 Up 3 Up 3 Down 3 Down 2 Up 2 Down 1 Up 1 Down

4 Up 4 Down 4 Up 4 Down

Run Mode Initialize EEPROM to default* See Caution Below Initialize Access Codes and Communication* Factory Use Flash Update Disable (Factory Default) Flash Update Enable Dual Power Supply Unit Single Power Supply Unit

* After power up, the OK LED light remains off and the Diagnostic LED will illuminate when operation has been satisfactorily completed.

CAUTION: A loss of calibration, setpoints, and configuration will occur when the EEPROM is initialized to default.

Table 52 Dip Switch SW-1

TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR INPUT VOLTAGE SELECT Input Voltage 24 V dc 48 V dc 125 V dc 250 V dc* Jumper J20 Position Jumper J21 Position Jumper J22 Position A to B B to C B to C B to C A to B A to B B to C B to C A to B A to B A to B B to C

* Default as shipped from factory.

Table 53 Trip Circuit Monitor Input Voltage Select Jumper Configuration

521

R21

R17

J52

SW2
C17

L14

L18

L15

L17

L16

L19

L20

M3425A Instruction Book

C45 R124
R141

Q11

R19

+
C99 C98

R76 Q3 26 25 2 P11 C253 R14 1 U10 U9 C213 R75 J80 C10 20 19

E158 E153 E154

R15

R16

E115

C13

R98

C199

E124

L32

E123

J82

C23

C22

E116

L33

C200

J1

R2

C219

CB

R131

J3

C201

C119

C30 C157 U45 U41 C113 J63 E178


E185

C29

D80 J56 U37 E183 C123 C216 E110 J102 U35 D42 U36 C9 C217 R92 U14 D41 R146
E107

J74

+ +
1 C118 C212 C15 C35 E119 C32 C265 R143 E187 E105 C B A
R205

C220 C24 C218 C148 D72

U19

E161 E126

R142

R65

R53

R45

R32

R41

R36

R34

C122

U15 C225
R33
A B

R44

R52

R40

R35

R64

R37

J45

J75

C66

C72

C62

C60

C56

C58

C54

C158 D5
U35A R208

R83 C305

J62

R209

C112

E132 E134

E166

E133

U51

J16 C211 U25A J76 C6

J17 R220 C300 U25 Q25 C301 Q2 C4

D3 C108 C303 C107 R91

D4 C159 E200 J48 E142 E143 C203 J46 B C C204 E145 C160 C26 C202 J68 J67 C114 C115 C304
C307 C308

R206

R114

C19

R46 R30 C154 R115 J60 RT1

R58

R28

R54

R86

C5 R23

C207 J96

J47

U18

C208

C210

R10

J2

U23

J15

C14

U5

E93

C161 C75 U20

D32 R78 R6 C48 E112


R57 R26

D38 C168 C42 R11 R27 R5 R133 R132 R7 R121


R122

D21 D36 D20

U22

R49

R60

R61

R56

R48

R140

J51 C B A

C64 C52 C68 C50

C70

R31
C

C41 D75 R79 D11 D9


R12

C34

J5
+
R8 D12 C27 D76 R123 R4 R9 Q8 J54

J50 C B A

J5

R134

R118

R119

C40

J53

C25

C65
R256
C53 C69 C51 A C B

J61
1 J79 2
C92 C145 C126 C165 C93 U29 U30 U31 C91 U32 C164 C163 C162 K10

C71

T1 RT2 R197 C167 C166 C95 U28 C94 D94 R190 D93 J18 R130 D43 C74
R68 R69 R67 R70

J61 C223 U44 Q1


R257

R152

R150

R185

R194

R184

D90

L9 R155
A B C

C97

C136

C134

C139

J21 J22 RT3 D18 R129 D44 C76 D69 D68 D67 C78 C80 D45 D46 D47 R127 R126 C47
R66

C131

C250

R183

D92
B B B

R24

L28

C37

C36

L12

C146

C127

C135

C138

C132

C141

C142

L38

VR18

VR17

VR16

VR21

VR15

VR14

VR13

VR12

VR22

VR19

C133

VR11

P2 C79 VR1 L27 VR4 L26 VR5 L25 VR6 L24

C83 C260

VR7

L23

VR8

L22

VR9 P3

J20 J21 J18 J22

J46
Figure 5-14 M-3425A Circuit Board

C137

C144

R182

VR20

VR3

L6

L10 L11 1

VR25

C143

J20 L37 D71 D70

D66

C128

L13 L5
C C C

L7 L8

D96 D95

L4 L3

C82

C149

R29
A A A

R1

C140

C130

C129

D91 R128

C96

C151 R153 R154

U34

B A E129

C39

+
J69

C43

1 2
C3 Y1 U8 D13

J78
J49

U2

L36

+
C206 Q10

C16 R22

E113 E47 E48

U26

C11

E120 C147 R120 J19 IC,SMT,SO-44 R72

U12 R71 U13 R25

1
TP5 K9 K8 D60 D59 D57 R117

E180 D61 D56 D55 K7 K6 K5 D54

J73 D62 C86 K4 K3

C85 D64 K2

C49 D63 K1

R151

C221

C222

U27

R125

D2

C21

C44 C170

BE#450-00226 P-1947 REV.


R210
E165

C81

C67

C73

C63 D48

C61

C57 C59 C55

R20

J60
U16 TP6 C205 E30

C125

BECKWITH
+ 1
U11 J14 C209 U24 C169

ELECTRIC
+ + + +

D6

R13

D34 C224

D40

D30

D28

D25

D27

D23

E2 E1
E131 E160 E130 E164 E111

Q12

JP1

C77

E135

U38

C124

R181 R180

U33 U21

R3

C228

U4

CO.INC.
E127

U3 BT1

R100

A B C

R147

C117

E163

C120

R156 C266

J71

+
TP3 C116

C150

R50

R62

R42

R38

R88

R89

R87

TP2

R144

J72

C20 J4

C38

C121

L30 L31 L34 L35 6 C84 U1 E147 E122 JP3

C8 J6 R145

R18

16

P6 5

8 J95

1 P8 10

18 10

C31 C252

E162

P7

P4

TP4

J70

J57 C7 R149 U7 1 E181 E182 R148 C214

R201

Q20

C33

R200

E159

1 4

9 5

P9

2 1

10

C102 C101

E150

TP1 P5 2

E149

U6

L21 C100 C12

C46

4 1

SW1

522

SW1
LED4 LED3 LED2 LED1 P1

+
E151 U17

C251

Installation 5

523

Figure 5-15 M-3425A Circuit Board (Expanded I/O)

M3425A Instruction Book

5.6

Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment

Figure 5-16 represents typical connections for the Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment. Figures 5-17 through 5-22 illustrate equipment mounting dimensions.

20 Hz Generator 20 Hz Band Pass Filter


1B1 1B4

DC 1 2 UH+ UH-

Supply Voltage 100-230 VAC** L1 L2

Connection terminals for Model A00/EE shown.

11 3 6 L3

+ _
External Block

Neutral Grounding Transformer

1A1

1A2

1A3

1A4

Bl 8 7

Error Device Operative L+

400A 5A L l K k

RN

Wiring Shielded

9 12 5 4

400/5 A 20 Hz CT High* Voltage Max. 200 V 44


59N

M-3425A 45

VN IN

52

53

* For applications with a transformer secondary rating that will result in 50/60 Hz phase ground fault voltages >200 V ac, use the "High Voltage" connection for the 59N Function. ** If 20 Hz Signal Generator is prior to Model EE a step down transformer is necessary for voltages >120 VAC.

Figure 5-16 Low Frequency Signal Injection Equipment Typical Connections

524

Installation 5

Figure 5-17 20 Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Surface Mount

525

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 5-18 20 Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Flush Mount

526

Installation 5

Figure 5-19 20 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Surface Mount

527

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure 5-20 20 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Flush Mount

528

Installation 5

Figure 5-21 20 Hz Measuring Current Transformer 400-5 A CT

529

M3425A Instruction Book

5.7 IPScom Communications and Analysis Software Installation


IPScom Installation and Setup IPScom runs with the Microsoft Windows 2000 operating system or later. IPScom is available on CD-ROM, or may be downloaded from our website at www.beckwithelectric.com The S-3400 IPScom Communications Software is not copy-protected. For more information on your specific rights and responsibilities, see the licensing agreement enclosed with your software or contact Beckwith Electric. Hardware Requirements IPScom will run on any IBM PC-compatible computer that provides at least the following: 8 MB of RAM Microsoft Windows 2000 or later CD-ROM drive one serial (RS-232) communication port pointing device (mouse)

5.8

Activating Initial Local Communications

The relay and IPScom Communications Software are shipped from the factory with the same default communication parameters. Therefore, it may not be necessary to set up communication parameters. In order for IPScom to communicate with the relay using direct serial connection, a serial null modem cable is required, with a 9-pin connector (DB9P) for the relay, and an applicable connector for the computer (usually DB9S or DB25S). Pin-outs for a null modem adapter are provided in Appendix B, Communications. Activating initial communications using default communication parameters is accomplished as follows: 1. Verify that a direct serial connection between the PC hosting IPScom and the target relay COM1 (front) is in place. 2. Select the IPScom icon (Figure 5-22) from the Becoware folder or Desktop. The IPScom Main Screen (Figure 3-2) is displayed. Select the Connect menu item. IPScom will display the Serial Port Dialog Screen (Figure 3-6). If the computer is connected through either an RS-232 port or RS-485 port perform the following: a. Select the PC Comm Port that is connected to the relay.

Installing IPScom 1. Insert software CD-ROM into your drive. An Auto-Install program will establish a program folder (Becoware) and subdirectory (IPScom). After installation, the IPScom program item icon (see Figure 5-22) is located in Becoware. The default location for the application files is on drive C:, in the new subdirectory IPScom (C:\Becoware\IPScom).

3.

4.

b. Select Connect. This action attempts to establish communication. 5. If IPScom returns a COM Opened and Level #(1, 2 or 3) access granted then communications have been established. Enter any valid IPScom command(s) as desired. To close the communication channel when connected locally, select the Communication/Disconnect from the main screen menu bar.

Figure 5-22 IPScom Program Icon


2. If the Auto-Install program does not launch when the CD-ROM is inserted into the drive then proceed as follows: a. Select Run from the Start Menu. b. In the Run dialog screen, locate the installation file (setup.exe) contained on the IPScom installation disk. c. Select Run to start the installation process.

530

Installation 5

6. If IPScom returns an error message, then determine the relay COM1 communication parameters as follows: a. From the relay Front Panel HMI press ENTER. The relay will display: VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz

5.9

Initial Setup Procedure

The M-3425A Generator Protection Relay is shipped from the factory with all functions disabled (user will only be able to enable purchased functions). The Setup Procedure provided below is a suggested setup procedure for initially entering settings into the relay. While it is written for HMI-equipped units, the same procedure is applicable when setting the relay through remote communication utilizing S-3400 IPScom Communications Software. Following the Setup Procedure are several sections which provide additional detail concerning the settings required for proper commissioning. Setup Procedure NOTE: Configuration Record forms are available in Appendix A, Configuration Record Forms, to record settings for future reference. 1. Connect power to the relays rear power terminals, as marked on the rear panels power supply label and as shown in Figures 5-7 and 5-8.

b.

Press the right arrow pushbutton until the relay displays:

COMMUNICATION W stat COMM setup V c. Press ENTER. The relay will display: COM1 SETUP COM1 com2 com3 com_adr V d. Press ENTER. The relay will display: COM1 BAUD RATE W baud_4800 baud_9600

Record the Baud Rate that is displayed in all Caps: __________

e. Pres EXIT as necessary to exit the HMI. f. g. Select the Connect menu item. IPScom will display the Serial Port Dialog Screen (Figure 3-6). Verify the IPScom COM Port Baud Rate is the same as relay COM1 Baud Rate.

2. When power is initially applied, the M3425A performs a number of self-tests to ensure its proper operation. During the self-tests, an X is displayed for each test successfully executed. If all tests are successful, the unit will briefly display the word PASS. Then, a series of status screens, including the model number, software version number, serial number, date and time as set in the system clock, and the user logo screen will be displayed. (Figure 2-2 illustrates this sequence of screens.) 3. If any test should fail, the DIAG LED will flash the error code, or the error code will be displayed on units equipped with the HMI and the relay will not allow operation to proceed. In such a case, the error code should be noted and the factory contacted. A list of error codes and their descriptions are provided in Appendix C, Error Codes. Assuming that various voltage functions are enabled, and there are no voltage inputs connected, various voltage targets will be identified as having operated 4. If remote communication is used, the baud rate, address, and other parameters for the communication ports must be set. Refer to the instructions in Section 5.8, Activating Initial Local Communications. Also refer to Chapter 3, IPScom, on S-3400 IPScom Communications Software.
531

h. Verify that the PC Comm Port that is connected to the relay is selected.

i. Select Connect. This action will attempt to establish communication. j. If IPScom returns a COM Opened and Level #(1, 2 or 3) access granted then communications have been established. Enter any valid ISScom command(s) as desired.

To close the communication channel when connected locally, select Communication/ Disconnect from the main screen menu bar.

M3425A Instruction Book

NOTE: UNIT SETUP settings are not considered part of the setpoint profiles. Unit Setup settings are common to all profiles. 5. To setup the unit with general information required, including altering access codes, setting date and time, installing user logos, and other adjustments, refer to Section 4.1, Unit Setup.

8.

Enable the desired protective functions for the relay application. The general information required to complete the input data on this section includes: Enable/disable function Output choices (OUT18) Input blocking choices (IN16)

NOTE: The relay has been fully calibrated at the factory using very precise and accurate test equipment. There is no need for recalibration before initial installation. Further calibration is only necessary if a component was changed and will be only as accurate as the test equipment used. 6. If desired, calibrate the unit following the calibration procedure described in subsection 6.3, Auto Calibration. For units without HMI, refer to Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches & Jumpers.

The relay is shipped with a certain group of standard functions, including other optional functions, as purchased. Both of these groups define a configurable set of functions. Only members of this set may be enabled/disabled by the end user. (Optional functions not purchased cannot be enabled.) Functions designated as DISABLED are inactive and will not be available for tripping. All menus associated with inactive functions will be unavailable. Enter the desired setpoints for the enabled functions. See Section 4.4, System Setpoints. The general information that is required to complete the input data in this section includes individual relay function: Pickup settings (converted to relay quantities) Time delay settings Time dials

NOTE: System Setup settings are not considered part of the setpoint profiles. System Setup settings are common to all profiles. 7. Setup the relay system parameters for the relay application. Section 4.2, System Setup includes the general system and equipment information required for the operation of the relay. This includes such items as CT and VT ratios, VT configurations, transformer connections and Nominal values.

9.

NOTE: Disabling unused functions improves the response time of the indicators and controls.

Input descriptions are detailed in Section 4.4, System Setpoints. Complete the System Setpoints and Settings Record Form in Appendix A before entering the setpoint and time setting data into the relay. Install the M3425A and connect external input and output contacts according to the rear panel terminal block markings as shown in Figures 5-9 through 5-13, External Connections as applicable.

10.

532

Testing 6

6
6.1

Testing

Equipment/Test Setup.............................................................. 62

6.2 Functional Test Procedures...................................................... 66 Power On Self Tests................................................................. 67 21 Phase Distance................................................................... 68 24 Volts per Hertz.................................................................... 69 25D/25S Sync Check............................................................. 612 27 Phase Undervoltage.......................................................... 616 27TN Third-Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral......................... 617 32 Directional Power, 3-Phase............................................... 621 40 Loss of Field..................................................................... 624 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Definite Time................. 626 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time.................. 627 49 Stator Overload................................................................. 628 50 Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent..................................... 630 50BF/50BF-N Breaker Failure................................................ 631 50/27 Inadvertent Energizing................................................. 633 50DT Definite Time Overcurrent for Split-Phase Differential.....634 50N Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent................................. 635 51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent................................... 636 51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Restraint....................................................... 637 59 Phase Overvoltage............................................................ 639 59D Third Harmonic Voltage Differential................................ 640 59N Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence.............. 641 59X Multipurpose Overvoltage............................................... 642 60FL VT Fuse Loss Detection................................................ 643 64F Field Ground Protection.................................................. 644 64B Brush Lift Off Detection.................................................. 646 64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Injection................... 647 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent.................................... 650 78 Out of Step....................................................................... 654 81 Frequency......................................................................... 656 81A Frequency Accumulator.................................................. 657 81R Rate of Change of Frequency........................................ 658 87 Phase Differential.............................................................. 660 87GD Ground Differential....................................................... 662 Breaker Monitoring................................................................. 664 Trip Circuit Monitoring............................................................ 666 IPSLogic................................................................................. 667 6.3 Diagnostic Test Procedures.................................................... 668

6.4 Auto-Calibration..................................................................... 678

61

M3425A Instruction Book

6.1

Equipment/Test Setup
6. For relays with the 64F/B option: a. Resistor decade box capable of 500 ohms to 150 kOhms, able to step in 100 ohm increments. b. Capacitors ranging from 0.15 mf to 10 mf. 7. For relays with the 64S option: a. 20 Hz Voltage Generator (variable) 0 to 40 V. b. 20 Hz Current Generator (variable) 0 to 40 mA. Connect system power to the power input terminals 62 (hot) and 63 (neutral). The relay can be ordered with a nominal input power supply of 110/120/230/240 Vac, 110/125/220/250 Vdc or 24/48 Vdc. An optional redundant power supply is available.

No calibration is necessary, as the M3425A Generator Protection Relay is calibrated and fully tested at the factory. If calibration is necessary because of a component replacement, follow the auto calibration procedure detailed in Section 6.4, Auto Calibration (or see Chapter 3, IPScom, Tool/Calibration subsection for units without an HMI). These test procedures are based on the prerequisite that the functions are enabled and have settings as described in Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints, and that the unit is fitted with the optional HMI module. Equipment Required The following equipment is required to carry out the test procedures: 1. 2. 3. Two Digital Multimeters (DMM) with 10 A current range. 120 V ac or 0 to 125 V dc variable supply for system power. Three-phase independent voltage sources (0 to 250 V) variable phase to simulate VT inputs. Three-phase independent current sources (0 to 25 A) variable phase to simulate CT inputs. Electronic timer accurate to at least 8 ms.

Setup 1.

NOTE: The proper voltage for the relay is clearly marked on the power supply label affixed to the rear panel. 2. For each test procedure, connect the voltage and current sources according to the configuration listed in the test procedure and follow the steps outlined.

4.

5.

62

Testing 6

NOTE: The phase angles shown here use leading angles as positive and lagging angles as negative. Some manufacturers of test equipment have used lagging angles as positive, in which case VB=120 V s120 and VC=120 V s240. Similarly other voltages and currents phase angles should be adjusted. These test configurations are for ABC phase rotation. They must be adjusted appropriately for ACB phase rotation.
39 38 41 40 43 42 45 44 65 64 VX VN VC = 120 V ac 120 VB = 120 V ac 120 VA = 120 V ac 0

Voltage Input 1

Hot Neutral

Voltage Input 2

Hot Neutral Hot Neutral Hot Neutral Hot Neutral

Voltage Input 3

Figure 6-1 Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1


Voltage Input 1 120 30 Hot Neutral 39 38 41 Neutral Hot 40 43 42 VCA = 120120 VBC = 120120 VAB = 1200

Voltage Input 2 120 90

Voltage Input 3 0 to 20 V ac 180 Hz

Hot Neutral

45 VN 44

Figure 6-2 Voltage Inputs: Configuration V2

63

M3425A Instruction Book

Polarity 55 Current Input 1 54 57 Current Input 2 56 59 Current Input 3 58 Ic 120 Ib 120 Ia 0

Figure 6-3 Current Inputs: Configuration C1


Polarity 47 Current Input 1 46 49 Current Input 2 48 51 50 Current Input 3 53 52 IN IC 120 IB 120 IA 0

Figure 6-4 Current Inputs: Configuration C2

64

Testing 6

Polarity 55

Current Input 1 a 54

57

I B 120
o

56

59

I C 240

58

Polarity 47

Current Input 2 A 46

49

I B 120
o

48

51

I C 240

50

Figure 65 Current Configuration C3

45 20 Hz Voltage Source (Variable) 44 53 20 Hz Current Source (Variable) 52

Figure 66 64S Test Configuration


65

M3425A Instruction Book

6.2

Functional Test Procedures


The tests are described in this section in ascending function number order as in Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints. During the lifetime of the relay, testing of individual functions due to changes in application settings will be more likely than an overall testing routine. An index of the individual test procedures is illustrated at the beginning of this chapter. It may be desirable to program all test settings in an alternate profile, or to save the relay settings in IPScom to preserve a desired setup. Many options for test sequences and methods are possible. As an example, the operation of the output contacts can be tested along with the operation of the LEDs in the Diagnostic Test Procedures. The operation of the output contacts may also be confirmed with the LED and function operation during Functional Test Procedures, if desired. If timer quantities are to be checked, the timer must be activated by the appropriate output contacts. The contact pin numbers are enumerated in Table 61, Output Contacts. It is suggested that copies of the following be made for easy referral during test procedures: Input Configurations pg 63 to 65 Output Contact Numbers pg 668 Relay Configuration Table pg A2 and A3 Setpoint & Timing Record Form pg A4 to A44

This section details the test quantities, inputs and procedures for testing each function of the relay. The purpose is to confirm the functions designated output operation, the accuracy of the magnitude pickup settings, and the accuracy of time delay settings. Whereas the first test described, Power On Self Test, does not require electrical quantity inputs, all other functional tests require inputs, and the necessary connection configurations are shown. IEEE Time Current equations are illustrated in the individual function tests where applicable. In all test descriptions, a process for calculating input quantities to test the actual settings of the function will be given if needed. CAUTION: Care must be taken to reset or reenable any functions that have been changed from the intended application settings when the test procedures are complete. When a function is re-enabled, both output arrangements and blocking input designations must be reestablished. In many test cases, it will be necessary to disable other functions not being tested at the time. This action is to prevent the operation of multiple functions with one set of input quantities which could cause confusion of operation of outputs or timers. The complete description of the method to disable/ enable functions and the method to enter setting quantities is found in detail in Section 4.4, System Setpoints. It is desirable to record and confirm the actual settings of the individual functions before beginning test procedures. Use the SETPOINTS AND SETTINGS RECORD FORM found in Appendix A to record settings.

66

Testing 6

Power On Self Tests

VOLTAGE INPUTS: none CURRENT INPUTS: none

1. 2.

Apply proper power to the power input terminals (60 HOT and 61 NEUTRAL). The following sequence of actions will take place in the following order: a. The unit will display the following:

OWER ON SELFTESTS P X XXXXXxxxxxxxxxxx b. d. All LEDs will illuminate for approximately 1 second. The unit will display the following:

c. The POWER and RELAY OK LEDs will remain illuminated, all other LEDs will extinguish.

POWER ON SELFTESTS PASS e. The unit will display the model number:

BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO. M -3425A Expanded f. The unit will display the firmware version.

B ECKWITH ELECTRIC D -0150xx.xx.xx g. The unit will display the serial number.

Beckwith electric co. SERIAL NUMBER xxx h. The POWER LED(s) will illuminate. i. The RELAY OK LED will flash (or stay on as programmed in the diagnostic menu). j. The BREAKER CLOSED LED will remain illuminated. If the relay breaker position contact IN1 is connected to a breaker position contact (52b) and the breaker is open the LED will be extinguished. 3. 4. The poweron selftests end with the unit displaying the system date, time and default logo. If there are any recorded targets they are then displayed.

67

M3425A Instruction Book

21 Phase Distance (#1, #2 or #3)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Diameter P Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Offset O Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Impedance Angle Time Delay A D Degrees Cycles (0.1 to 100) (0.5 to 500.0) (100 to 100) (500.0 to 500.0) (0 to 90) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs VT Configuration

Z Output Expanded I/O Line-Ground or Line-Line

NOTE: It would be efficient to disable the element with the higher reach (Diameter plus Offset) setting first (lower current), and test the lower reach setting operation, since the higher reach setting operation can be tested without disabling the lower setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Determine the Function 21 Phase Distance settings to be tested. Enter the Function 21 Phase Distance settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The level of current at which pickup operation is to be expected for an individual setting is determined as follows: a. Define reach as R ohms = (P ohms + O ohms) [O, usually set at zero ohms]. b. For Line-Ground configuration, define current as I =((Selected Voltage)I R ohms). The voltage level may be selected based on the desired test current level. For Line-Line configuration, define current as I =((Selected Voltage/S3) I R ohms). Set the threephase voltages to the Selected Voltage value from Step 6b above. Set the phase angle between the voltage and current inputs at (A) degrees from settings above (for Line-Line configuration, set the phase angle at (A30). Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the threephase input currents until the 21 PHASE DISTANCE LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level at which the 21 PHASE DISTANCE actuates should be equal to I calculated in Step 6 with the resulting impedance 0.1 ohms or 5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the threephase input currents. The assigned OUTPUT LEDs will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of the current (I) found in Step 6, and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

Pickup Test: 1. 2. 3.

4. 5. 1. 2.

Time Test:

68

Testing 6

24 Volts/Hz Definite Time (#1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 None Definite Time Pickup Time Delay P D % Cycles (100 to 200) (30 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z Output Expanded I/O

NOTE: It would be efficient to disable the 24 Definite Time element with the lower pickup setting first and test the higher setting operation, since the lower setting operation can be tested without disabling the higher setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 24 Volts/Hz Definite Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 24 Volts/Hz Definite Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. The Volts per Hertz pickup level at a percentage setting at Nominal Frequency (50 or 60 Hz) is: Pickup voltage = (P% 100) x (Nominal Voltage) where the Nominal Values have been programmed in the system setup data described in Section 4.2, System Setup and are recorded on Figure A2, System Setup Record Form.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the voltage on Phase A until the 24 VOLTS/Hz LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level of operation will equal to P volts 1%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the Phase A voltage. The assigned OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3.

Time Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately (P + 10 volts) volts, and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles 25 cycles. Repeat Pickup Test and Time Test for Phase B and C.

69

M3425A Instruction Book

24 Volts/Hz Inverse Time


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 None Inverse Time Pickup Inverse Time Curve Time Dial (Curve 1) P % (100 to 200) (1 to 4) (1 to 100) (0.0 to 9.0) (1 to 999) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

C K

Time Dial (Curves 2-4) Reset Rate R Seconds

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 24 Volts/Hz Inverse Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 24 Volts/Hz Inverse Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Enter a Function 24 Volts/Hz Definite Time Pickup #1 setting of 140%, with a Delay of 1200 cycles. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. The Volts/Hz pickup level of a percentage setting at nominal frequency (50 or 60 Hz) is: Pickup voltage = (P% 100) x (Nominal Voltage) where the Nominal Values have been programmed in the system setup data described in Section 4.2, System Setup and are recorded on Figure A2, System Setup Record Form. Test levels may be chosen at any percentages of Nominal Voltage which are a minimum of 5% higher than the pickup percentage, P%. (Suggest 4 or 5 test levels chosen and calculated in Step6.)

7.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the voltage on Phase A until the 24 VOLTS/Hz LED light illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level of operation will equal P volts 1%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the Phase A voltage. The assigned OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3.

610

Testing 6

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a voltage equal to the chosen test level calculated in Step 6 to Phase A and start timing. The operating time will be as read from the appropriate Inverse Curve Family and K (Time Dial) setting (refer to Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves). The measured time should be within the time corresponding to 1% of the pickup value. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Reduce the applied voltage and start timing when the voltage drops below the pickup value, stop timing when the TARGET LED extinguishes. The time should be the reset time within 1%. Repeat Pickup Test and Time Test for all chosen test levels. The curve portion extending to lower than P% V/Hz values are inactive and can be ignored. The tested points verify the operating times of the function.

3. 4. 5.

NOTE: If retesting is required, remove power from the unit or wait for the programmed reset time period before the next test to assure resetting of the timer.

611

M3425A Instruction Book

25D Dead Check


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 None Dead V1 Dead VX Dead V1 & VX See Below See Below See Below DIN Input Expanded I/O DD DVL Cycles Volts (1 to 6) (7 to 14) (1 to 8160) (0 to 60) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Dead Input Enable Dead Time Delay Dead Voltage Limit

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.

Z Output Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 25D Dead Check settings to be tested. Enter the Function 25D Dead Check settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. The 25D function requires positive sequence voltage and VX for testing. The following tests will reference the positive sequence voltage as V1. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set V1 and VX to the Nominal Voltage.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Dead V1 Hot VX Test: 1. 2. 3. Enable Dead V1 Hot VX and disable Dead VX Hot V1 (if enabled) utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.. Set V1 to DVL +5 V. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the voltage applied to V1 until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to DVL 0.5 V or 0.5 %. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the voltage applied to V1. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. Set V1 to the Nominal Voltage. Decrease VX to less than DVL, verify that the function does not operate.

4. 5. 6.

612

Testing 6

Dead VX Hot V1 Test: 1. 2. Enable Dead VX Hot V1 and disable Dead V1 Hot VX (if enabled) utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Set V1 to the Nominal Voltage.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 3. 4. Set VX to DVL +5 V. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the voltage applied to VX until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to DVL 0.5 V or 0.5 %. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the voltage applied to VX. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. Set VX to the Nominal Voltage. Decrease V1 to less than DVL, verify that the function does not operate.

5. 6. 7.

Dead V1 Dead VX Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Enable Dead V1 Dead VX utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable Dead VX Hot V1 and Dead V1 Hot VX (if enabled). Set V1 and VX to DVL +5 V. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the voltage applied to V1 and VX until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to DVL 0.5 V or 0.5 %. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the voltage applied to V1 and VX. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. Set V1 to Nominal Voltage. Decrease VX to less than DVL, then verify that the function does not operate. Set VX to Nominal Voltage. Decrease V1 to less than DVL, then verify that the function does not operate.

5. 6. 7. 8. 9.

Dead Input Enable Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Select one of the Dead Inputs (DIN) and activate it. Repeat the Dead VX Hot V1 Test and Dead V1 Hot VX Test, verify that the function operates as in Dead VX Hot V1 Test and Dead V1 Hot VX Testing. Deactivate the DIN and repeat the Dead VX Hot V1 Test and Dead V1 Hot VX Test once more. Verify that the function does not operate. Disable Dead Input feature.

Dead Timer Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Enable Dead V1 Dead VX , utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Set V1 and VX to DVL +5 V. Remove V1 and VX and start timing. The contacts will close within 1 to +3 cycles or 1%.

613

M3425A Instruction Book

25S Sync Check


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 None Phase Angle Limit Voltage Limits Upper Limit Lower Limit Sync Check Time Delay Delta Voltage Limit Delta Frequency Limit PA UL LL SD DV DF Degrees Volts Volts Cycles Volts Hz (0 to 90) (60 to 140) (40 to 120) (1 to 8160) (1.0 to 50.0) (0.001 to 0.500) (AB, BC, CA) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Phase Select Z Output Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4.

Determine the Function 25S Sync Check settings to be tested. Enter the Function 25S Sync Check settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. The 25 function requires only one phase voltage and VX for testing in the Line-to-Ground configuration. The phase voltage used for reference may be selected through the System Setup menu. The following tests will reference the phase voltage as V1, although any phase may be used for testing. Line-to-Line testing will follow the same procedures, with V1 representing the proper Line-to-Line phase input. Each test below can be performed using any of the three phases as a reference. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set V1 and VX to the Nominal Voltage.

5. 6.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Phase Angle Limit Test: 1. 2. Establish a phase angle difference of more than PA +5. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the phase angle difference until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The phase angle difference should be equal to PA 1. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the phase angle difference. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

3.

614

Testing 6

Upper Voltage Limit Test: 1. 2. Apply a voltage 5 V greater than UL to V1. Ensure VX voltage is less than UL but greater than LL. Slowly decrease the voltage applied to V1 until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage should be equal to UL 0.5 V or 0.5 %. Increase the voltage applied to V1. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. If desired, repeat this test using VX.

3.

Lower Voltage Limit Test: 1. 2. Apply a voltage 5 V less than LL to V1. Ensure VX voltage is greater than LL but less than UL. Slowly increase the voltage applied to V1 until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to LL 0.5 V or 0.5 %. Decrease the voltage applied to V1. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. If desired, repeat this test using VX.

3.

Sync Check Time Delay Test: 1. Set V1 and VX to the Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Establish a phase angle difference of more than PA +5. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Remove the phase angle difference and start timing. The contacts will close after SD cycles within 1 to +3 cycles or 1 %.

2. 3. 4.

Delta Voltage Test: 1. 2. 3. Set the Upper and Lower Voltage limits to their maximum and minimum values, respectively. Set VX to 140 V and V1 to 40 V. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the voltage applied to V1 until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage difference should be equal to DV 0.5 V. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the voltage applied to V1. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. If desired, repeat the test using VX with V1 at 140 volts.

4.

Delta Frequency Test: 1. Set V1 and VX to the Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Set the frequency of V1 to 0.05 less than Nominal Frequency DF. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the frequency of V1 until Output Z LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The frequency difference value should be equal to DF 0.0007 Hz or 5 %. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the frequency of V1. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish. If desired, repeat the test using VX with V1 at Nominal Frequency.

2. 3.

4.

615

M3425A Instruction Book

27 Phase Undervoltage, 3 Phase (#1, #2, #3)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1

CURRENT INPUTS: None Pickup Time Delay Programmed Outputs P D Z Volts Cycles OUT (5 to 180) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Expanded I/O

NOTE: If 27 #1 and 27 #2 have different pickup settings, it would be efficient to disable the one with the higher setting first and test the lower setting operation. The higher setting operation could then be tested without disabling the lower setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 27 Phase Undervoltage settings to be tested. Enter the Function 27 Phase Undervoltage settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the Phase A input voltage until the 27 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to P volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. When both RMS and Line-Ground to Line-Line is selected, the accuracy is 0.8V or 0.75%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the Phase A input voltage to the nominal voltage, the OUTPUT LEDs will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. The contacts will close after D cycles O20 cycles or 1%(RMS), or 1 cycle or 0.5% (DFT), whichever is greater. Repeat Pickup Test and Time Test for Phase B and C. Apply approximately (P 1) volts and start timing.

3.

616

Testing 6

27TN Third-Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral (#1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V2 See Below Pickup Positive Sequence Volt Block Forward Power Block Reverse Power Block Lead VAR Block Lag VAR Block Lead Power Factor Block Lag Power Factor Block High Band Forward Power Block Low Band Forward Power Block Time Delay Programmed Outputs P PSV FP RP VAR +VAR PFLead PFLag HFP LFP D Z Volts Volts PU PU PU PU PU PU PU PU Cycles OUT (0.10 to 14.0) (5 to 180) (0.01 to 1.00) (1.00 to 0.01) (1.00 to 0.01) (0.01 to 1.00) (0.01 to 1.00) (0.01 to 1.00) (0.01 to 1.00) (0.01 to 1.00) (1 to 8160) ( 1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Expanded I/O

NOTE: If 27TN #1 and 27 #2 have different pickup settings, it would be efficient to disable the one with the higher setting first and test the lower setting operation. The higher setting operation could then be tested without disabling the lower setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 27TN Third-Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral settings to be tested. Enter the Function 27TN Third-Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-2, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V2.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the neutral voltage input until the 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level should be equal to P volts 0.1 V or 1%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the neutral voltage to nominal voltage. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

2.

3. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately (P 1) volts and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

617

M3425A Instruction Book

Positive Sequence Voltage Block Test: 1. 2. Decrease the neutral voltage input to less than P volts. Apply a three phase voltage input greater than PSV volts.

The 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED will illuminate, then the OUTPUT LED will illuminate when the delay setting has timed out. 3. 4. 5. Enable the Positive Sequence Voltage Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Decrease the applied three phase voltage until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. The voltage level should be equal to PSV volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. Disable the Positive Sequence Voltage Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.

Forward/Reverse Power Block Test: 1. Apply a three phase nominal voltage input. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 2. Apply a nominal current input consistent with Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. NOTE: The POWER Real p.u. value can be obtained utilizing either the HMI (Status/Power Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Secondary Status). 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Adjust three phase voltage and current inputs to obtain a Power Real p.u. value greater than FP. Enable the Forward Power Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Decrease the applied three phase current until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software disable the Forward Power Block and then enable the Reverse Power Block. Adjust three phase voltage and current inputs to obtain a Power Real p.u. value greater than RP. Decrease the applied three phase current until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Enable the Reverse Power Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.

The Power Real p.u. value should be equal to FP 0.01 PU or 2%.

The Power Real p.u. value should be equal to RP 0.01 PU or 2%.

Lead/Lag VAr Block Test: 1. Apply a three phase nominal voltage input. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 2. Apply a nominal current input consistent with Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

618

Testing 6

NOTE: The POWER Reactive var value can be obtained utilizing either the HMI (Status/Power Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Secondary Status). 3. Adjust three phase voltage and current inputs to obtain a Power Reactive VAr value greater than VAR.

The 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED will illuminate, then the OUTPUT LED will illuminate when the delay setting has timed out. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Enable the Lead VAR Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Adjust the applied three phase current phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software disable the Lead VAR Block and then enable the Lag VAR Block. Adjust three phase voltage and current inputs to obtain a Power Reactive var value greater than +VAR. Adjust the applied three phase current phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Disable the Lag VAR Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.

The Power Reactive var value should be equal to VAR 0.01 PU or 2%.

The Power Reactive var value should be equal to +VAR 0.01 PU or 2%.

Lead/Lag Power Factor Block Test: 1. Apply a three phase nominal voltage input. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 2. Apply a nominal current input consistent with Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 3. Adjust three phase voltages and currents to obtain a Lead Power Factor Block value greater than PFLead.

The 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED will illuminate, then the OUTPUT LED will illuminate when the delay setting has timed out. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Enable the Power Factor Lead Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Adjust three phase voltage phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Disable the Power Factor Lead Block. Enable the Power Factor Lag Block. Adjust three phase voltages and currents to obtain a Lag Power Factor Block value greater than PFLag.

The Power Factor Lead Block value should be equal to PFLead 0.03 or 3%.

The 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED will illuminate, then the OUTPUT LED will illuminate when the delay setting has timed out. 9. 10. 11. Enable the Power Factor Lag Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Adjust three phase voltage phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. Disable the Power Factor Lag Block.

The Power Factor Lag Block value should be equal to PFLag 0.03 PU or 3%.

619

M3425A Instruction Book

Forward Power Block (Band) Test: 1. Apply a three phase nominal voltage input. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 2. Apply a nominal current input consistent with Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 3. 4. Enable the High/Low Band Forward Power Block utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.

Adjust three phase voltages and currents to obtain a High/Low Forward Power Block value either greater than the Low Band Forward Power Block LFP, or less than the High Band Forward Power Block HFP The 27TN/59D 100% STATOR GND LED will illuminate, then the OUTPUT LED will illuminate when the delay setting has timed out. 5. Adjust the three phase current until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguishes. The Power Real p.u. value should be within the High Band and Low Band setpoint band 0.1 PU or 2%. 6. Disable the High/Low Band Forward Power Block.

620

Testing 6

32 Directional Power, 3 Phase (#1, #2, #3)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Pickup Time Delay P D PU Cycles (3.000 to +3.000) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs VT Configuration

Z OUT Expanded I/O Line-Ground

Power Sensing #3 Directional Power Sensing

(Over/Under) (Real/Reactive)

NOTE: It would be efficient to disable the element with the lower pickup setting first and test the higher setting operation, since the lower setting operation can be tested without disabling the higher setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Determine the Function 32 Directional Power settings to be tested. Enter the Function 32 Directional Power settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. The level of current at which operation is to be expected for an individual power setting is given by multiplying the PU pickup value (P above) by the Nominal Current value previously input to the relay. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Set the three phase voltages to the Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

7.

Pickup Test, Positive/Forward Over Power Flow: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the three phase currents until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to that calculated in Step 6, 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

2. 3.

4. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

621

M3425A Instruction Book

Pickup Test, Negative/Reverse Over Power Flow: 1. 2. Set the phase currents at 180 degrees from the respective phase voltages. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the three phase currents until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to that calculated in Step 6, 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the three phase currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. 4. 5.

Pickup Test, Positive Forward Under Power Flow: 1. 2. 3. Set the phase currents in phase with the respective phase voltages. Select Underpower sensing utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the three phase currents until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to that calculated in Step 6, 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Increase the three phase currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

4. 4. 5.

Pickup Test, Negative/Reverse Under Power Flow: 1. 2. Set the phase currents at 180 degrees from the respective phase voltages. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the three phase currents until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to that calculated in Step 6, 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Increase the three phase currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. 4. 5.

Pickup Test, Reactive Over Power (Element #3 Only): 1. 2. Set the Three phase voltages, current magnitudes and phase angles to less than the Reactive p.u. pickup level. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly swing current angles until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to the Reactive Pickup 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Adjust phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. 4. 5.

622

Testing 6

Pickup Test, Reactive Under Power (Element #3 Only): 1. 2. Set the Three phase voltages, current magnitudes and phase angles to greater than the Reactive p.u. pickup level. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly swing current angles until the 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be equal to the Reactive Pickup 2% or 0.002 PU, whichever is greater. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Adjust phase angles until the OUTPUT LED(s) extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. 4. 5.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of the pickup current and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within +16 cycles or 1%.

623

M3425A Instruction Book

40 Loss of Field (#1 or #2, VC #1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Circle Diameter P Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Offset O Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Time Delay Voltage Control D V Cycles Volts Cycles Degrees (0.1 to 100) (0.5 to 500) (50 to 50) (250 to 250) (1 to 8160) (5 to 180) (1 to 8160) (0 to 20) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Delay with VC Directional Element E

Programmed Outputs VT Configuration

Z OUT Expanded I/O Line-Ground

NOTE: It would be efficient to disable the function with the higher reach (diameter minus offset) setting first (lower current) and test the lower reach setting operation. Since the higher setting operation can be tested without disabling the lower setting, the 40 functions will be enabled when the tests are complete. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 40 Loss of Field settings to be tested. Enter the Function 40 Loss of Field settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1.

NOTE: For proper testing, use I O 3 x CT rating. 6. 7.

The level of current at which operation is to be expected for an individual setting is as follows: a. Define reach as R ohms = (P - O ohms) where O is usually negative. b. c. Define trip current as I = (Selected Voltage R ohms). The voltage level may be selected based on the desired test current level. Define offset current as IO = (Selected Voltage O ohms).

Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Selected Voltage value from Step 6, and set the phase angle between the voltage and current inputs to 90 (current leading voltage).

624

Testing 6

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the three-phase currents until the 40 LOSS OF FIELD LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level will be equal to I calculated in Step 6 with the resulting impedance within 0.1 ohms or 5%. If the offset setting is negative, continue to increase the three-phase currents until the 40 LOSS OF FIELD LED light extinguishes, or the pickup indicator extinguishes on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level will be equal to IO calculated in Step 6 with the resulting offset impedance within 0.1 ohms or 5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the three-phase currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2.

3. 4. 5.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Selected Voltage value from Step 6, and set the phase angle between the voltage and current inputs to 90 (current leading voltage).

3. Apply I + 10% Amps and start timing. Contacts will close after D cycles 1 cycle or 1%. Time Test With Voltage Control: 1. 2. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Enable the Voltage Control setting utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to a voltage where the positive sequence voltage is less than the Voltage Control setting. Set phase currents and phase angles to establish the impedance value within the mho pickup and start timing. Contacts will close after D cycles 1 cycle or 1%.

625

M3425A Instruction Book

46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Definite Time


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C1 (MODIFIED) Pickup Def Time Time Delay P D % Cycles (3 to 100) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 46 function, it is suggested that Nominal Voltage be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Definite Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Definite Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1 (Modified). Modify Configuration C1 by exchanging Current Input 2 and 3 (Phase B current = Input 3 and Phase C current = Input 2).

NOTE: For proper testing, use I 3 x CT rating. 5. The level of current at which operation is to be expected for an individual setting is given by; Pickup current = (P% 100) x Nominal Current previously input to the relay. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the three-phase currents until the NEG SEQ OVERCURRENT 46 LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level will be equal to pickup current calculated in Step 5, 0.5% of 5 A. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the three-phase currents. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

Pickup Test: 1.

2. 3.

4. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply current of at least (1.1 x pickup) amps and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

626

Testing 6

46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C1 (MODIFIED) Pickup Inv Time Time Dial Setting Maximum Trip Time Reset Time P D R % Cycles Seconds (3 to 100) (1 to 95) (600 to 65,500) (1 to 600) (1 to 8) (9 to 23) K

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 46 function, it is suggested that Nominal Volts be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1 (Modified). Modify Configuration C1 by exchanging Current Input 2 and 3 (Phase B current = Input 3 and Phase C current = Input 2).

NOTE: For proper testing, use I 3 x CT rating. 5. The current pickup level at a percentage setting is: Pickup current = (P% 100) x Nominal Current previously input to the relay. a. Test levels may be chosen at any percentages of Nominal Current which are a minimum of 5% higher than the pickup percentage, P%. (Suggest 4 or 5 test levels chosen and calculated in amps.) b. The Nominal Current value is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply currents equal to the chosen test levels calculated in Step 5 and start timing. The operating time will be as read from Figure 4-47, Negative Sequence Inverse Time Curves, negative sequence current in % of Nominal Current and appropriate K (Time Dial) setting, or the maximum trip time (whichever is faster).

Time Test: 1. 2.

NOTE: If retesting is required, power should be removed from the unit or wait R seconds before the next test to assure resetting of the timer. 3. 1. 2. Repeat Step 2 for all test levels chosen. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Reduce the applied voltage and start timing when the voltage decreases to less than the pickup value, stop timing when the TARGET LED extinguishes, or the pickup indicator extinguishes on the IPScom Function Status screen. The time should be approximately equal to the reset time setting R.

Reset Time Test:

NOTE: If retesting is required, power should be removed from the unit or wait for the reset time before the next test to assure resetting of the timer.
627

M3425A Instruction Book

49 Stator Overload Protection (#1, #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C1 Time Constant

Minutes

(1.0 to 999.9) (1 to 10) (.2 to 2) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Max Overload Current Imax Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Z OUT Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1.

Determine the Function 49 Stator Overload settings to be tested. This test requires that the values for the following elements (described in detail in Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints) be determined: = time constant I0 = pre-load current Imax = maximum allowed continuous overload current

2. 3. 4.

Enter the Function 49 Stator Overload settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1.

5. Calculate t (time to trip in minutes) for the desired test settings as follows: Where:

t = t x In

IL2 w Imax2

IL2 w IPL2

Where: t = time to trip in minutes = time constant IL= relay current (applied) IPL = pre-load current Imax = maximum allowed continuous overload current Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the current until the STATOR OVERLOAD 49 LED illuminates or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. 2. The current level of operation will be (Imax) Amps 0.1 A (0.02 Amp for 1 A CT) or 3%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the current. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

3. Press TARGET RESET button to remove targets.

628

Testing 6

Time Test (Cold Start): 1. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. NOTE: The 49 Stator Overload 49 #1 and 49 #2 current values can be obtained utilizing either the HMI (Status/Current Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Secondary Status). 2. 3. Determine the 49 Stator Overload 49 #1 and 49 #2 current values. If the either value is greater than 0.00 A, then remove power from the relay and then reapply power to reset the current values. Apply a three phase current (I) to the relay greater than (Imax) Amps and start timing. The time to trip should be t minutes 5 %.

Time Test (Preload): 1. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. NOTE: The 49 Stator Overload 49 #1 and 49 #2 current values can be obtained utilizing either the HMI (Status/Current Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Secondary Status). 2. 3. 4. Determine the 49 Stator Overload 49 #1 and 49 #2 current values. If the either value is greater than 0.00 A, then remove power from the relay and then reapply power to reset the current values. Apply a three phase preload current to the relay equal to (IO) Amps and allow current readings to stabilize. Apply a three phase current (I) to the relay greater than (Imax) Amps and start timing. The time to trip should be t minutes 5 %.

629

M3425A Instruction Book

50 Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent (#1, #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C1 Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Delay Programmed Outputs Z Cycles OUT (0.1 to 240.0) (0.1 to 48.0) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Expanded I/O

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 50 function, it is suggested that Nominal Volts be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 50 Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent settings to be tested. Enter the Function 50 Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1.

Pickup Test: 1 Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input 3 (Phase C) until the PHASE OVERCURRENT 50 LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will be (P) amps 0.1 amps or 3%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the current input. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of P amps and start timing. The operating time will be 1 cycle or 1%. Reduce Current Input 3, to 0 amps. Test may be repeated using Current Inputs 1 (Phase A) and 2 (Phase B) individually.

630

Testing 6

50BF/50BF-N Breaker Failure


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C3 50BF-Ph Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating 50BF-N Pickup N Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Time Delay D Cycles (0.10 to 10.00) (0.02 to 2.00) (0.10 to 10.00) (.02 to 2.00) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (1 to 6) (7 to 14) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Breaker Failure Initiate Input Initiate Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2.

B OUT I IN Expanded I/O Z OUT Expanded I/O

Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-5, Current Inputs: Configuration C3. Current Input #2 only.

Test Setup for 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. Determine the Function 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure settings to be tested. Utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software enter the following settings: a. Enable the 50BF-Phase Element and disable the 50BF-Neutral Element b. 50BF-Ph Pickup Setting > P amps, Time delay setting = D cycles.

Testing 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. 3. Externally short any ONE set of contacts (I) IN shown above. Short IN1 (connect contacts 10 & 11) to simulate 52b contact closure (breaker open). Alternatively, the external contact may be operated if all connections are made. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input 3 until the 50BF BREAKER FAILURE LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will be (P) amps 0.1 amps or 2%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the current input. The OUTPUT LED(s) extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

4. 5. 6.

Time Test 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of P amps and start timing. The operating time will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Reduce Current Input 3, to 0 amps.

631

M3425A Instruction Book

Test Setup for 50BF-N Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. Determine the Function 50BF-Ph Generator Breaker Failure settings to be tested. Utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software enter the following settings: a. Enable the 50BF-Neutral Element and the 50BF-Phase Element b. 50BF-N Pickup Setting > N amps, 50BF-Ph Pickup Setting < P amps, Time delay setting = D cycles.

Testing 50BF-N Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 3. Short IN1 (connect contacts 10 & 11) to simulate 52b contact closure (breaker open). Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input 3 until the 50BF BREAKER FAILURE LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will be (N) amps 0.1 amps or 2%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the current input. The OUTPUT LED(s) extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

4. 5. 6.

Time Test 50BF-N Generator Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of N amps and start timing. The operating time will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Reduce Current Input 3, to 0 amps.

Test Setup for HV Breaker Failure Operation: 1. Utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software enter the following settings: a. Disable the 50BF-Neutral Element and 50BF-Phase Element. b. Select 1 input initiate from #2 to #6, utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. c. Time delay setting = D cycles d. Input 1 IN breaker closed state.

Testing HV Breaker Failure Operation: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Initiate operation by externally shorting any ONE set of contacts (I) IN except Input 1 above. Remove short from Input (1) IN. The operating time will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

632

Testing 6

50/27 Inadvertent Energizing


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 50 Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating 27 Pickup Pickup Delay Dropout Delay V D T Volts Cycles Cycles (0.50 to 15.00) (.01 to 3.00) (5 to 130) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 50/27 Inadvertent Energizing settings to be tested. Enter the Function 50/27 Inadvertent Energizing settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1.

50 Overcurrent Test and 27 Undervoltage Test: 1. 2. Set Voltage inputs to zero volts, then verify the Pickup Time Delay times out after a minimum of D cycles. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the Phase A current (Input 1) until the 50/27 INADVERTENT ENRGNG LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be (P) amps 0.1 A or 2%. If desired, set the dropout time delay (T) to minimum setting. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the voltage input in stages (waiting at least T cycles between each voltage change) until the 50/27 INADVERTENT ENRGNG LED extinguishes, or the pickup indicator extinguishes on the IPScom Function Status screen. The level of operation will be V volts 0.5 Volts.

3. 4.

27 Pickup Delay and Dropout Delay Test: 1. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Input approximately 110% of P amps (pickup setting). Reduce voltage to 0 volts and start timing. The operating time to close will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Input approximately 110% of V volts (pickup setting) and start timing. The operating time to open will be T cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. 2.

NOTE: When RMS (total waveform) is selected, timing accuracy is O20 cycles or 1%.

633

M3425A Instruction Book

50DT Definite Time Overcurrent (for split-phase differential), #1 or #2


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C2 Pickup A Phase A Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Pickup B Phase B Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Pickup C Phase C Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Delay Cycles Z OUT Expanded I/O (0.20 to 240.00) (0.04 to 48.00) (0.20 to 240.00) (0.04 to 48.00) (0.20 to 240.00) (0.04 to 48.00) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 50DT function, it is suggested that Nominal Volts be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. If other functions operate during these tests they will need to also be disabled for the test and enabled after the tests are complete. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 50DT Definite Time Overcurrent settings to be tested. Enter the Function 50DT Definite Time Overcurrent settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable the functions listed above. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-4, Current Inputs: Configuration C2. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the Phase A Current Input until the PHASE OVERCURRENT 50 LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will be (A) amps 0.1 amps or 3%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the Phase A Current Input. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of A amps and start timing. The operating time will be 1 cycle or 1%, whichever is greater. Reduce Phase A Current Input to 0 amps. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for Phase B & C. If testing is complete, enable any functions disabled for this test.

Pickup Test: 1.

2. 3. 4. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Time Test:

634

Testing 6

50N Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As described Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Time Delay D Cycles (0.1 to 240.0) (0.1 to 48.0) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 50N function, it is suggested that Nominal Volts be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. Determine the Function 50N Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent settings to be tested. Enter the Function 50N Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input IN (terminals 53 and 52) until the NEUTRAL O/C 50N/51N LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will be (P) amps 0.1 amps or 3%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease Current Input IN. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

Pickup Test: 1.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply approximately 110% of P amps to Current Input IN (terminals 53 and 52) and start timing. The operating time will be D cycles 1 Cycle or 1%. Reduce Current Input IN to 0 amps.

635

M3425A Instruction Book

51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As described Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating BECO Time Curves (definite time/inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse) Time Dial Setting
1

(0.25 to 12.00) (0.05 to 2.40)

(0.5 to 11.0)

IEC Inverse Time Curves: (inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse/long time inverse) IEEE Curves (moderately inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse) Time Dial Setting K Z OUT Expanded I/O (0.5 to 15.0) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs
1

Either a standard curve or an IEC curve must be selected.

NOTE: Although no voltage input is required for the testing of the 51N function, it is suggested that Nominal Volts be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent settings to be tested. Enter the Function 51N Inverse Time Neutral Overcurrent settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Refer to Appendix D, Figures D5D12, or Tables D1A and D1B. Test levels may be chosen in terms of multiples of pickup value and associated time in seconds. (Suggest 4 or 5 test levels chosen and calculated in amps.)

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply current equal to the chosen test level calculated in Step 6 to Current Input IN (Terminals 53 and 52) and start timing. Operating time will be within 3 cycles or 3% whichever is greater. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for all test levels chosen. The tested points verify the operating times of the function.

3.

636

Testing 6

51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent with Voltage Control/Restraint


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Pickup P Amps (0.50 to 12.00) (0.10 to 2.40)

1 Amp CT Rating BECO Time Curves (definite time/inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse) Time Dial Setting K

(0.5 to 11.0)

IEC Inverse Time Curves:1 (inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse/long time inverse) IEEE Curves (moderately inverse/very inverse/extremely inverse) Time Dial Setting K Z OUT Expanded I/O (0.5 to 15.0) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs
1

Either a standard curve or an IEC curve must be selected.

Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Determine the Function 51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent settings to be tested. Enter the Function 51V Inverse Time Phase Overcurrent settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1 Test levels may be chosen at any ampere values which are a minimum of 50% higher than the pickup amps, P Amps. It is suggested that the user select 4 or 5 test levels to verify curve.

Pickup Test: 1. 2. If Voltage Control or Voltage Restraint is enabled, then disable 51V Voltage Control/Restraint utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the Phase A Current Input until the PHASE OVERCURRENT 51V LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The current level of operation will equal P Amps 0.1A or 1%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Reduce the Phase A Current Input to 0 amps. The assigned OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. 4. 5.

637

M3425A Instruction Book

Time Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. If Voltage Control or Voltage Restraint is enabled, then disable 51V Voltage Control/Restraint utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Apply current equal to the chosen test level calculated in Step 6 to Phase A Current Input and start timing. The operating time will be as read from the appropriate Inverse Curve Family and K (Time Dial) setting in Appendix D, Figures D5 through D8, or Tables D1A through D1B. The accuracy specified is valid for currents above 1.5 times the pickup current. Reduce Phase A Current Input to 0 amps. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Repeat Steps 3, 4 and 5 for all test levels chosen.

4. 5. 6.

Voltage Control Test: 1. 2. If Voltage Control is disabled, then enable 51V Voltage Control utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the Phase A (B,C) Current Input until the PHASE OVERCURRENT 51V LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. When the assigned OUTPUT LED(s) illuminates, then increase the Phase A(B,C) Input Voltage to at least 0.5 Volts greater than V Volts. The assigned OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish at V Volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Reduce Phase A (B,C) Current Input to 0 amps. Decrease the Phase A (B,C) Input Voltage to Nominal Voltage.

3. 4.

5. 6. 7.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Voltage Restraint Test: 1. If Voltage Restraint is disabled, then enable 51V Voltage Restraint utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Apply current equal to 1.5 Amps to the Phase Current Input. Increase the Phase A (B,C) Input Voltage to 75% of Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

2. Set P Amps equal to 2 Amps utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. 3. 4.

The PHASE OVERCURRENT 51V LED will illuminate, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. 5. Repeat Steps 2, 3 and 4 with reduced input voltage values and current reduced by the same percentage as value (see Figure 460).

638

Testing 6

59 Phase Overvoltage, 3-Phase (#1, #2, #3)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: Configuration V1

CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Pickup Time Delay P D Volts Cycles (5 to 180) (1 to 8160)

Input Voltage Select (Phase, Positive or Negative Sequence) Z OUT Expanded I/O (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

NOTE: If 59 #1 and 59 #2 have different pickup settings, it would be efficient to disable the one with the lower setting first and test the higher setting operation. The lower setting operation could then be tested without disabling the higher setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 59 RMS Overvoltage settings to be tested. Enter the Function 59 RMS Overvoltage settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase the Phase A Voltage Input until the 59 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level of operation should be equal to P Volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. When both RMS and Line-Ground to Line-Line is selected, the accuracy is 0.8V or 0.75% Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the Phase A Voltage Input to Nominal Voltage. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply (P+1) Volts to the Phase A (B,C) Voltage Input and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles 1 cycle or 1% (DFT) or within O20 cycles or 1% (RMS). Reduce Phase A (B,C) Voltage Input to Nominal Voltage. Repeat Steps 2 and 3 for Phase B & C.

639

M3425A Instruction Book

59D Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential


VOLTAGE INPUTS: As described

CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Ratio Time Delay Line Side Voltage D Cycles (0.1 to 5.0) (1 to 8160) (VX or 3VO Calculated) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

LSV Z OUT Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4.

Determine the Function 59D Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential settings to be tested. Enter the Function 59D Third-Harmonic Voltage Differential settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a voltage input to VN at 180 Hz (150 Hz for 50 Hz unit) terminal numbers 44 and 45.

Pickup Test: NOTE: If 3VO is being used, then use anyone of the phase voltages or all three at zero sequence. 1. 2. Apply a voltage less than VN to the selected line side voltage (VX or 3VO ) at 180 Hz (150 Hz for 50 Hz unit). Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Voltage to the selected line side Input (VX or 3V0) until the 59D THIRD HARM VOLT DIFF LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the Voltage Input (VX or 3V0) to less than the ratio pickup level. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a voltage greater than the ratio pickup level and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

NOTE: When RMS (total waveform) is selected, timing accuracy is O20 cycles or 1%.

640

Testing 6

59N Overvoltage, Neutral Circuit or Zero Sequence (#1, #2, #3)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: As described

CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Pickup Time Delay P D Volts Cycles (5.0 to 180) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: If 59N #1 and 59N #2 have different pickup settings, it would be efficient to disable the one with the lower setting first and test the higher setting operation. The lower setting operation could then be tested without disabling the higher setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 59N RMS Overvoltage settings to be tested. Enter the Function 59N RMS Overvoltage settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a voltage input to VN terminal numbers 44 and 45.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Voltage Input VN until the 59N NEUT/GND OVERVOLT LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level of operation should be equal to P Volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the Voltage Input VN to 0 volts. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply (P+1) Volts and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. When 64S is purchased, the time delay accuracy is 1 to +5 cycles.

641

M3425A Instruction Book

59X Multi-purpose Overvoltage (#1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: As described

CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Pickup Time Delay P D Volts Cycles (5.0 to 180.0) (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: If 59X #1 and 59X #2 have different pickup settings, it would be efficient to disable the one with the lower setting first and test the higher setting operation. The lower setting operation could then be tested without disabling the higher setting. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 59X Overvoltage settings to be tested. Enter the Function 59X Overvoltage settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a voltage input to VX terminal numbers 64 and 65.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Voltage Input VX until the 59N NEUT/GND OVERVOLT LED illuminates, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The voltage level of operation should be equal to P Volts 0.5 V or 0.5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the Voltage Input VX to 0 volts. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply (P+1) Volts and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

642

Testing 6

60FL VT Fuse Loss Detection


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Time Delay D Cycles (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

NOTE: It is necessary for FL to be designated as an initiating input (see Section 4.4, System Setpoints) before this function can be tested. NOTE: Refer to Figure 2-52, Fuse Loss (60FL) Function Logic, for single phase and three phase fuse loss. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Determine the Function 60FL VT Fuse Loss Detection settings to be tested. Enter the Function 60FL VT Fuse Loss Detection settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. (FL initiate must be selected for this test.) Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-3, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Disconnect the Phase A (B,C) Voltage Input and start timing. The 60FL V.T. FUSE LOSS LED and Output Z LEDs will illuminate, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The operating time will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Reconnect the Phase A (B,C) Voltage Input. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Repeat Steps 2, 3 and 4 for Phase B and C.

3. 4. 5.

Time Test - Three Phase Fuse Loss: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Enable Three Phase Fuse Loss Detection utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disconnect Phase A, B and C Voltage Inputs and start timing. The 60FL V.T. FUSE LOSS LED and Output Z LEDs will illuminate, or the pickup indicator illuminates on the IPScom Function Status screen. The operating time will be D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Reconnect the Phase A, B and C Voltage Inputs. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

4. 5.

643

M3425A Instruction Book

64F Field Ground Protection (#1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Pickup Time Delay Injection Frequency P D IF kOhms Cycles Hz (5 to 100) (1 to 8160) (0.10 to 1.00) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 64F Field Ground Protection settings to be tested. Enter the Function 64F Field Ground Protection settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect an M-3921 Field Ground Coupler and decade box as described in Figure 67, Field Ground Coupler. Set decade box resistance to 10% greater than pickup P kOhms.

Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the resistance on the decade box until the FIELD GND/BRUSH LIFT 64F/B LED illuminates or the pickup indicator on the IPScom Function Status screen illuminates. The level of operation will be P kOhms 1 kOhms or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Increase the resistance on the decade box. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

2. 3. 4.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Set the resistance on the decade box to 90% of Pand start timing. The operating time will be after D cycles, within (2/IF + 1).

644

Testing 6

When the capacitance value and the operating frequency have been determined, the actual insulation resistance can be verified by installing a variable resistor (5 to 100 K) and a discrete capacitor to the coupler module (M3921). 8 WARNING: When auto-calibrating, the jumper used to short pins 2 & 3 must be removed when calibration is complete. Placing the M3921 in service with this jumper installed will result in serious damage.

M-3425A
PROCESSOR 60 to 100 V dc source - simulates Exciter Supply Voltage

DC Supply Field Ground Detection Squarewave Generator 37 35 Signal Measurement and Processing 36 Vf 1
Rear Terminal Block Pin No.

Vout

5 4

+ Test Switch
Rf Cf * Discrete Capacitor to simulate Field Winding Capacitance

Coupling Network M-3921

Decade Box or Discrete Resistor to simulate Fault Resistance

*The value of Cf should approximate the rotor capacitance.

Figure 67 Field Ground Coupler

645

M3425A Instruction Book

64B Brush Lift-Off Detection


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: Pickup Time Delay Injection Frequency P D IF mV Cycles Hz (0 to 5000) (1 to 8160) (0.10 to 1.00) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 64F Field Ground Protection settings to be tested. Enter the Function 64F Field Ground Protection settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a M-3921 Field Ground Coupler and the test equipment described in Figure 67, Field Ground Coupler. Set Rf to open (infinity) and Cf to 1 F.

Pickup Test: 1. Access the FIELD GND MEAS. CIRCUIT display under the VOLTAGE menu in STATUS. Set the pickup (P) to 110% of the displayed value. Refer to Section 2.2, Operation, for details that describe how to access the STATUS MENU which contains the FIELD GND MEAS. CIRCUIT value in mV. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then Open the Test Switch. The FIELD GND/BRUSH LIFT 64F/B LED will illuminate or the pickup indicator on the IPScom Function Status screen will illuminate. Close the Test Switch. The FIELD GND/BRUSH LIFT 64F/B LED will extinguish or the pickup indicator on the IPScom Function Status screen will extinguish.

2.

3.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Remove the capacitance connected to the decade box and start timing. The operating time will be after D cycles, within (2/IF + 1) sec.

646

Testing 6

64S 100% Stator Ground Protection by Low Frequency Injection


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Adjustable 20 Hz Voltage Source (0 to 40 V) Adjustable 20 Hz Current Source (0 to 100 mA) Total Current Pickup Real Component Pickup Time Delay P P/2 D mA mA Cycles (2 to 75) (2 to 75) (1 to 8160) (Enabled/Disabled) (Enabled/Disabled) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Voltage Restraint Under Frequency Inhibit Z OUT Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. Determine settings for F64S to be tested.

Enter the settings for F64S into the relay to be tested using either the HMI or IPScom Communications software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions.

Pickup Test (Voltage Restraint Disabled and Under Frequency Inhibit Disabled): 1. 2. 3. 4. Enable the Total Current Pickup. Disable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Adjust the 20 Hz voltage generator to apply 25 s0 volts across terminals 44 and 45.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to P mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Disable the Total Current Pickup. Enable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Adjust the 20 Hz Voltage Generator to apply 25 s0 Volts across terminals 44 and 45.

5 6. 7. 8. 9.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current at an angle of 60 degrees leading the 20 Hz voltage applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to P mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the applied 20 Hz current to 0 mA and the applied 20 Hz voltage to 0 Volts.

10. 11.

647

M3425A Instruction Book

Pickup Test (Voltage Restraint Enabled and Under Frequency Inhibit Disabled): 1. 2. 3. 4. Enable the Total Current Pickup. Disable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Adjust the 20 Hz voltage generator to apply 25 s0 volts across terminals 44 and 45.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to P mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Adjust the 20 Hz Voltage Generator to apply 35 s0 Volts across terminals 44 and 45.

5 6. 7.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current at an angle of 60 degrees leading the 20 Hz voltage applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to 1.4 P mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Disable the Total Current Pickup. Enable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Adjust the 20 Hz voltage generator to apply 25 s0 volts across terminals 44 and 45.

8. 9. 10. 11. 12.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current at an angle of 60 degrees leading the 20 Hz voltage applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to P mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Adjust the 20 Hz Voltage Generator to apply 35 s0 Volts across terminals 44 and 45.

13. 14. 15.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current at an angle of 60 degrees leading the 20 Hz voltage applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to 1.4(P) mA 2 mA or 10%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the applied 20 Hz test voltage and current to zero.

16. 17.

648

Testing 6

Pickup Test (Voltage Restraint Disabled and Under Frequency Inhibit Enabled): 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Apply balanced nominal three-phase voltage to VA (VAB), VB (VBC), and VC (VCA) at nominal frequency (that is, 50 or 60 Hz). Enable the Total Current Pickup. Disable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Adjust the 20 Hz voltage generator to apply 25 s0 volts across terminals 44 and 45.

Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The 20 Hz current level should be equal to P mA 2 mA or 10%. The functions should pickup and close the trip contact output. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the applied 20 Hz test voltage and current to zero. Enable under frequency inhibit. Decrease the frequency of the balanced nominal three-phase voltage to VA (VAB), VB (VBC), and VC (VCA) to 30 Hz. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the 20 Hz current applied to terminals 52 and 53 until the 20 Hz current level is equal to P mA. This function should not pick up. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the applied 20 Hz test voltage and current to zero. Adjust the 20 Hz Voltage Generator to apply 25 s0 Volts across terminals 44 and 45.

6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11.

12. 13.

Timer Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Enable the Total Current Pickup. Disable the Real Component of Current Pickup. Disable Voltage Restraint. Disable Under Frequency Inhibit. Adjust the 20 Hz Voltage Generator to apply 25 s0 Volts across terminals 44 and 45.

Step the 20 Hz current applied to terminals 52 and 53 to a value greater than P and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Time delay accuracy in cycles is based on 20 Hz frequency.

649

M3425A Instruction Book

67N Residual Directional Overcurrent, Definite Time


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: See Below See Below Pickup P Amps 1 Amp Directional Element Time Delay Max Sensitivity Angle Operating Current Polarization Type* See Below D MSA 3IO or IN VN, VX, 3VO (Calculated) Z Output Expanded I/O (1 to 8) (9 to 23) Cycles Degrees (1 to 8160) (0 to 359) (0.50 to 240.0) (0.1 to 48.0)

Programmed Outputs

* VX cannot be selected if Function 25 (Sync) is enabled. 3VO can only be used with Line-Ground VT. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 67NDT Residual Directional Overcurrent, Definite Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent, Definite Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Disable the Directional Element. Connect inputs for the polarization type and operating current selected for testing.

Pickup Test (non-directional): 1. 2. Apply current 10% less than pickup P to the operating current. If 3I0, use any one of IA, IB, or IC, or all three in zero sequence. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton in, then slowly increase the current applied to the selected operating current until the GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The level should be equal to PI3 Amps 0.1A or 3%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Decrease the current applied to all phases of the selected operating current. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

3 4.

650

Testing 6

Directional Test: 1. 2. 3. Enable the Directional Element utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Set the voltage of the selected polarization type to the Nominal Voltage (If 3V0 is selected, use any one of the phase voltages, or all three in zero sequence.) The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Set the current angle to an angle greater than 100 from MSA. Apply current 10% greater than P to the input of the selected operating current. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly swing the angle of the selected operating current applied towards the MSA until the GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The angle should be equal to A 90 or +90, depending to which side of MSA the current has been set. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Swing the current angle away from the MSA. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

4. 5. 6.

7. 8.

Timer Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Disable the Directional Element utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software.

3. Apply P +10% Amps to the input of the selected operating current, and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 to +3 cycles or 1%.

651

M3425A Instruction Book

67N Residual Directional Overcurrent, Inverse Time


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: See Below See Below Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Directional See Below (0.25 to 12.0) (0.05 to 2.40)

BECO Inverse Time Curves Definite Time\Inverse\Very Inverse\Extremely Inverse Time Dial TD (0.5 to 11.0) IEC Inverse Time Curves IECI / IECVI / IECEI / IECLTI Time Dial IEEE Inverse Time Curves IEEEI/IEEEVI/IEEEEI Time Dial Operating Current Max Sensitivity Angle Polarization Type

TD

(0.05 to 1.10)

TD 3IO or IN MSA Output

(0.5 to 15) (0 to 359)

VN, VX, 3VO (Calculated) Z Output Expanded I/O (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

* VX cannot be selected if Function 25 (Sync) is enabled. 3VO can only be used with Line-Ground VT. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent, Inverse Time settings to be tested. Enter the Function 67N Residual Directional Overcurrent, Inverse Time settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Disable Directional Element. Refer to Appendix D, Inverse Time Curves, and IEC equations below to calculate test times for levels represented on the graphs. It is suggested that 4 or 5 test levels be chosen.
IEC Class B Very Inverse t=TD x 13.5 [M-1 ] IEC Class C Extremely Inverse t=TD x 80 [M -1 ]
2

IEC Class A Standard Inverse t=TD x

IEC Class D Long Time Inverse t=TD x 120 [M-1 ]

[M

0.14
0.02

-1

Curve 5

Curve 6

Curve 7

Curve 8

t = time in seconds TD = Time Dial setting M = current in multiples of pickup

Time Delay Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply the input current used in the calculations from Step 5 to the input of the selected operating current, and start timing. The operating time will be 3 cycles or 5% of the calculated time. Repeat this step for each test level chosen. The points tested verify the operation of this function.

652

Testing 6

Directional Test: 1. 2. Enable Directional Element. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

3. Apply Nominal Voltage to the input of the selected Polarization Type. If 3V0, use any one of the phase voltages, or all three at zero sequence. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 4. 5. 6. Set the current angle to an angle greater than 100 from MSA. Apply current 10% greater than PI3, (for type 3, use P) to all three phases. Press and hold the Target Reset pushbutton, then slowly swing the angle of the selected operating current towards the MSA until the GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The angle should be equal to A 90 or +90, depending to which side of MSA the current has been set. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton. Swing the current angle away from the MSA. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

7. 8.

653

M3425A Instruction Book

78 Out of Step
VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1 Configuration C1 Circle Diameter P Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Offset O Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Impedance Angle Time Delay A D Degrees Cycles (0.1 to 100) (0.5 to 500) (100 to 100) (500 to 500) (0 to 90) (1 to 8160) (0.1 to 50.0) (0.5 to 250.0) (1 to 20) (1 to 8160)

Blinder Impedance B Ohms 1 Amp CT Rating Pole Slip Counter Pole Slip Reset Trip on MHO Exit See Below Z OUT Expanded I/O Cycles

Programmed Output Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. An accurate stopwatch is required for this test.

(1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Determine the Function 78 Out of Step settings to be tested. Establish communications with the relay utilizing IPScom Communications Software. Enter the Function 78 Out of Step settings to be tested utilizing IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-4, Current Inputs: Configuration C1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage.

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Pickup Test: 1. 2. 3. 4. Disable the Function 78 Out of Step TRIP ON MHO EXIT setting, then set the delay, D, to a minimal setting (23 cycles). Open the IPScom Out-of-Step Dialog Screen, Figure 4-81 (Relay/Monitor/Out of Step Dialog Screen). While monitoring the Positive Sequence Impedance, set the magnitude and phase angle of the Input Currents to a point similar to point Z0 in Figure 4-79. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then sweep the current angle towards point Z1. When the impedance passes through point Z1, verify that the 78 OUT OF STEP LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. Pause testing until the delay timer has time to expire, then continue to sweep the current angle to point Z2, and verify output Z operates as point Z2 is crossed, and resets after the sealin time delay. If testing is complete, then reduce voltages and currents to zero.


654

5. 6.

Testing 6

Blocking on Stable Swing Test: 1. 2. 3. While monitoring the Positive Sequence Impedance, set the magnitude and phase angle of the Input Currents to a point outside of the mho circle. While monitoring the Positive Sequence Impedance, set the magnitude and phase angle of the Input Currents to point Z0 in Figure 4-79. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then sweep past point Z1. When the impedance passes through point Z1, verify that the 78 OUT OF STEP LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. Pause testing until the delay timer has time to expire, then reverse the sweep direction and sweep the current angle to point Z1. As point Z1 is crossed, verify output Z does not operate and the 78 OUT OF STEP LED extinguishes or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has reset. If testing is complete, then reduce voltages and currents to zero.

4.

6.

Pickup Test (Trip on mho Exit): 1. 2. 3. Enable the TRIP ON MHO EXIT setting. While monitoring the Positive Sequence Impedance, set the magnitude and phase angle of the Input Currents to point Z0 in Figure 4-79. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then sweep the current angle towards point Z1. When the impedance passes through point Z1, verify that the 78 OUT OF STEP LED illuminates or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. Pause testing until the delay timer has time to expire, then continue to sweep the current angle to beyond point Z2. Verify that output Z does not operate as point Z2 is crossed. Sweep the impedance further towards point Z3. Verify output Z operates as point Z3 is crossed, and resets after the sealin time delay has timed out. If testing is complete, then reduce voltages and currents to zero.

4. 5. 6.

655

M3425A Instruction Book

81 Frequency (#1, #2, #3, #4)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1

CURRENT INPUTS: None Pickup P Hz 50 Hz Relay Time Delay D Cycles 50 Hz Relay Z OUT Expanded I/O (50.00 to 67.00) (40.00 to 57.00) (3 to 65,500) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs

NOTE: It would be efficient to disable the elements with the settings nearest to nominal frequency first (testing over or underfrequency functions). Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Determine the Function 81 Frequency settings to be tested. Enter the Function 81 Frequency settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage (nominal frequency). The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase/decrease the Input Voltage (VA, VB, and VC ) Frequency until the FREQUENCY/ROCOF 81/81R LED illuminates or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The frequency level will be equal to P Hz 0.02 Hz only if P is within 3 Hz of Fnom, otherwise, 0.1Hz. Increase/decrease the Input Voltage (VA, VB, and VC ) Frequency to nominal input frequency. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

Pickup Test: 1.

2.

3. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply (P + or 0.5) Hz and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 2 cycles or 1%, whichever is greater.

656

Testing 6

81A Frequency Accumulator (Band #1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6)
VOLTAGE INPUTS: V1 CURRENT INPUTS: None TEST SETTINGS: High Pickup (#1 only) P Hz 50 Hz Relay Low Pickup P Hz 50 Hz Relay Delay D Cycles Cycles (50.00 to 67.00) (40.00 to 57.00) (50.00 to 67.00) (40.00 to 57.00) (3 to 360,000) (0 to 360,000) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Acc Status

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Function 81A Frequency Accumulator settings to be tested. Enter the Function 81A Frequency Accumulator settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage (nominal frequency). The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

Output Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Set the frequency to a value between the upper and lower limits of the selected band under test and start timing. Utilizing either the HMI (Status/81A Accumulator Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Accumulator Status), verify that the Accumulator Status value for the band under test is incrementing. Output Contacts Z will close after D cycles within 2 cycles or 1%. Repeat Steps 1 to 3 for the remaining bands if desired.

4.

657

M3425A Instruction Book

81R Rate of Change of Frequency (#1, #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration V1

CURRENT INPUTS: None Pickup Time Delay Negative Sequence Voltage Inhibit P D N Hz/Sec Cycles % (0.10 to 20.00) (3 to 8160) (0 to 99) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs Test Setup:

Z OUT Expanded I/O

1. It is recommended that the 81 Function be used to establish a window of operation for the 81R Function which is smaller than the actual sweep range of the frequency applied. This is accomplished as follows:

NOTE: The frequencies given are suggested for testing rates below 10 Hz/Sec. Higher rates will require consideration of the capabilities of the test equipment involved. a. Enable the 81#1 with a unique Output assigned, a Pickup Setting of 1 Hz greater than the minimum frequency of the ramp and a time delay and sealin time setting at minimum (This will result in an operational window that is free of erroneous Hz/Sec measurements when the voltage source begins or ends the sweep.). b. Enable the 81#2 with a unique Output assigned, a Pickup Setting of 1 Hz less than the maximum frequency of the ramp and a time delay and sealin time setting at minimum (This will result in an operational window that is free of erroneous Hz/Sec measurements when the voltage source begins or ends the sweep.).

NOTE: Using this setup, it is important to remember that the 81 elements being used will be operating in the 81R blocking regions, and the 81R contact operation must be distinguished from the 81 contacts.

F81#1 Block
56.5 Hz 57.5 Hz

81R Active Region


60 Hz

F81#2 Block
62.5 Hz 63.5 Hz

2. 3. 4.

c. Utilizing a jumper, connect the 81#1 and 81#2 assigned Outputs to a unique Input. d. Set the 81R Function to block on this input. Determine the Function 81R Rate of Change of Frequency settings to be tested. Enter the Function 81R Rate of Change of Frequency settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing with the exception of Function 81. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions.

NOTE: Testing of the 81R function requires a 3phase voltage source capable of smoothly sweeping the frequency of all voltages at a variable rate, continuously. 5. 6. Connect test voltage inputs as shown in Figure 6-1, Voltage Inputs: Configuration V1. Set the three-phase voltages VA, VB, and VC to the Nominal Voltage (nominal frequency).

The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form.

658

Testing 6

Pickup Test: 1. 2. Calculate the time for the pickup setting, then apply a sweep rate of 25% less than the Pickup (P) to all three phases. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly decrease the sweep time until the FREQUENCY/ROCOF 81/81R LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The level should be equal to P 0.05 Hz/Sec. or 5 %. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then increase the sweep time. The OUTPUT LED will extinguish.

3.

Negative Sequence Voltage Inhibit Test: 1. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. 2. Apply Nominal Voltage to all three phases at a sweep rate 25% above P. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 3. Verify that the FREQUENCY/ROCOF 81/81R LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. Swing the phase angle of a Phase Voltage and monitor the Positive and Negative Sequence Voltage levels. The 81R OUTPUT should reset when the negative sequence voltage is N %, 0.5% of the positive sequence voltage.

Timer Test: 1. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. 2. Apply Nominal Voltage to all three phases at a sweep rate 25% below P. The Nominal Voltage value previously input to the relay is described in Section 4.2, Setup System and should be recorded on Figure A-2, Setup System Record Form. 3. 4. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a sweep rate 25% above P and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within +20 cycles.

659

M3425A Instruction Book

87 Phase Differential (#1 or #2)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: Configuration C3 Minimum Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating Percent Slope Time Delay S D % Cycles (0.20 to 3.00) (0.04 to 0.60) (1 to 100) (1 to 8160) (0.5 to 2.0) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

CT Correction Z OUT Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs

NOTE: Although a voltage input is not required for the testing of the 87 function, it is suggested that Nominal Voltage be applied to restrain the functions which use both voltage and current inputs for operation. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4. Determine the Function 87 Phase Differential settings to be tested. Enter the Function 87 Phase Differential settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect test current inputs as shown in Figure 6-5, Current Inputs: Configuration C3.

Minimum Pickup Test: 1. 2. Set Current Input 1(Ia) to 0 Amps. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input 2 (IA) until the PHASE DIFF CURRENT 87 LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The current level of operation will be equal to P amps 0.1 A or 5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the Current Input 2 (IA). The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish. Repeat Steps 1,2,3 and 4 for each remaining phase exchanging IA(B,C) and Ia(b,c) as appropriate.

3.

4. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. 5.

Timer Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a current level to Current Input 2 (IA) at least 10% greater than the minimum current pickup level and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. When the Time Delay is set to 1 cycle, the relay operation is less than 11/2 cycles.

660

Testing 6

Slope Test: 1. 2. Define a representative number of testing points to verify the trip curve. For each Ia (Current Input 1) test point defined in Step 1, calculate the expected operating current IA (Current Input 2) as follows:

(IA-Ia) > (IA+Ia) x Slope/100 2 Difference in currents is greater than sum of the currents times the per unit slope 2

or IA = [(1+K) (1-K)] x Ia where K = S/200 and where S is % slope input above. NOTE: For tests above the restraint current {(IA+Ia)/2} value of 2X Nominal Current; use a slope % value equal to 4 times the input slope value (S) for these computations. 3. 4. Set Current Input 1 (Ia) and Current Input 2 (IA) to the values chosen in Step 1 and calculated in Step 2 respectively. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase either Current Input 1 or 2 until the PHASE DIFF CURRENT 87 LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The current level of operation will be equal to IA 0.1 A or 2% slope calculation. The difference in current must be greater than minimum pickup current for proper operation. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the larger CURRENT. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

5.

6. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets.

661

M3425A Instruction Book

87GD Ground Differential


VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As described Pickup P Amps 1 Amp CT Rating CAUTION: Do NOT set the delay to less than 2 Cycles Time Delay D Cycles (1 to 8160) (0.10 to 7.99) (1 to 8) (9 to 23) (0.20 to 10.00) (0.04 to 2.00)

CT Ratio Correction Z OUT Expanded I/O

Programmed Outputs

Test Setup: 1. Determine the Function 87GD Ground Differential settings to be tested. 2. 3. 4. 5. Enter the Function 87GD Ground Differential settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a current input to IN terminals 53 and 52. Connect a current input to IA terminals 46 and 47, or IB terminals 48 and 49.

NonDirectional Pickup Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then slowly increase Current Input IN (terminals 53 and 52) until the GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N LED illuminates, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The current level of operation will be equal to P amps 0.1 A or 5%. Release the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then decrease the Current Input IN to 0 Amps. The OUTPUT LED(s) will extinguish.

2.

3. Press TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Timer Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a current level to Current Input IN at least 10% greater than the minimum current pickup level and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within +1 to -2 cycles or 1%. Decrease the Current Input IN to 0 Amps.

662

Testing 6

Directional Time Test: 1. 2. 3. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Apply a current of 1.0 Amp with a phase angle of 0 degrees to Current Input IN (terminals 53 and 52). Apply a current of P 0.9 amps with a phase angle of 180 degrees to either Current Input IA or IB and start timing. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Decrease the applied currents to 0 Amps. Press the TARGET RESET pushbutton to reset targets. Set the phase angle of the Current Input selected in Step 3, to 0 degrees, the Current Inputs are now in phase. Reapply a current of 1.0 Amp to Current Input IN (terminals 53 and 52). Reapply a current of P 0.9 Amps to the Current Input selected in Step 3, and start timing. The relay will not operate. If the IA or IB current input value is reduced to 140 ma or less and the difference current exceeds the pickup value, the relay will operate regardless of polarities of the currents. Decrease the applied currents to 0 Amps.

4. 5. 6. 7. 8.

9.

663

M3425A Instruction Book

BM Breaker Monitoring
VOLTAGE INPUTS: None CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As Described Pickup Delay P D kAmps (kA2)* Cycles (0 to 50,000) (0.1 to 4095.9) ( IT or I2T)

Timing Method Preset Accumulators

Phase A, B, or C kAmp (kA2) Cycles* (0 to 50,000) Programmed Outputs Z OUT (1 to 8) (1 to 6) (7 to 14) (1 to 8) (9 to 23) (1 to 6) (7 to 14)

Blocking Inputs Expanded I/O Output Initiate Expanded I/O Input Initiate Expanded I/O * kA/kA cycles or kA2/kA2 cycles is dependent on the Timing Method that is selected. Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4.

Determine the Breaker Monitoring Function settings to be tested (Input Initiate or Output Initiate). Enter the Breaker Monitoring Function settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Connect a current input to IA terminals 46 and 47, IB terminals 48 and 49, and IC terminals 50 and 51. Connect inputs for the polarization type selected for testing.

Accumulator Test: 1. 2. 3. Apply a current value that considers Timing Method and Pickup Setting to current input IA. Place a jumper between the designated input and/or energize output contact selected as initiate. Utilizing either the HMI (Status/Breaker Monitor Accumulator Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Accumulator Status), verify that the Accumulator Status value for Phase A increments in D cycles 1 cycles or 1%. De-energize the output and/or remove the jumper placed in Step 2. Decrease applied IA current to 0 amps. If desired, repeat test for IB and IC.

4. 5. 6.

664

Testing 6

Pickup Test: 1. Apply a current value that considers Timing Method and Pickup Setting to current input IA. NOTE: If the target pickup setting is a large value (0 to 50,000) the Preset Accumulator Settings feature can be used to pre-set the accumulator values to just below the target setting. 2. Utilizing either the HMI (Status/Breaker Monitor Accumulator Status) or IPScom Communications Software (Relay/Monitor/Accumulator Status) to monitor the accumulator value, place a jumper between the designated input or energize the output contact selected as initiate and then remove the jumper and/or de-energize the output. Following the time out of the Delay the accumulator will increment, repeat the placement and removal of the jumper as necessary to increment the accumulator to a point where the pickup setting is exceeded. When the accumulator value exceeds the pickup value the OUTPUT LED(s) will illuminate, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The output contacts Z will operate in D cycles 1 cycle or 1% from the last initiate. If desired, repeat test for IB and IC.

3.

4.

665

M3425A Instruction Book

Trip Circuit Monitoring


VOLTAGE INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As Described

CURRENT INPUTS: None Delay D Cycles (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23)

Programmed Outputs Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. 4.

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Determine the Trip Circuit Monitoring function settings to be tested. Disable all other functions prior to testing. Refer to Section 4.4 System Setpoints, for details that describe disabling/enabling functions. Connect a DC voltage supply capable of supplying 24/48/125/250 V dc (marked on the rear of the relay) to terminals 1 () and 2 (+) on the relay. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close.

Pickup Test: 1. 2. 3. Apply the applicable DC voltage (24/48/125/250 V dc marked on the rear of the relay) to terminals 1 and 2. Enable the Trip Circuit Monitoring function and then enter the settings to be tested utilizing either the HMI or IPScom Communications Software. Remove the DC voltage applied in Step 1. The OUTPUT LED will illuminate, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen will indicate that the Trip Circuit Monitoring function has actuated. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%. Simulate a 52b contact open by connecting a jumper between terminal 11 (INRTN) and terminal 10 (IN1) which the BRKR CLOSED and OUTPUT LEDs on the front of the relay should extinguish. Also, the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen will indicate that the Trip Circuit Monitoring function has cleared and the Secondary Status screen will indicate that the breaker is closed. Remove the jumper installed in Step 4. The contacts will close after D cycles within 1 cycle or 1%.

4.

5.

666

Testing 6

IPSlogicTM (#1, #2, #3, #4, #5, #6)


VOLTAGE INPUTS: CURRENT INPUTS: TEST SETTINGS: As Needed As Needed Time Delay D Cycles (1 to 8160) (1 to 8) (9 to 23) (1 to 6) (7 to 14) (1 to 8) (9 to 23) (All Available Functions)

Programmed Outputs

Z OUT Expanded I/O

Blocking Inputs Expanded I/O Output Initiate Expanded I/O Function Initiate Pickup Function Initiate Time Out Initiate by Communication

Input Initiate Expanded I/O Test Setup: 1. 2. 3. Refer to Figure 4-93, IPSlogic Function Setup, for logic gate configurations. Block from Communication

(1 to 6) (7 to 14)

Select gate configuration (AND/OR/NAND/NOR) for Output Initiate, Function Initiate, Blocking Inputs and Inputs Main. Select Initiating Inputs for each gate (if AND gate is selected, ensure at least two outputs are chosen). It will be necessary to enable and operate other functions to provide inputs for the Function Initiate and Output Initiate gates.

Time Test: 1. 2. Connect a timer to output contacts (Z) so that the timer stops timing when the contacts (Z) close. Connect a jumper from IN RTN (Terminal 11) to the designated Inputs (Terminals 16) for the IPSlogic gates and start timing. The IPS LOGIC LED and the OUTPUT LED will illuminate, or the function status indicator on the Monitor Function Status screen indicates that the function has picked up. The operating time will be D cycles 1 cycle or 1%.

Blocking Input Test: 1. Press and hold the TARGET RESET pushbutton, then place a jumper from IN RTN (terminal 11) to the designated Blocking Inputs (terminals 1-6) to be tested. The EXTERNAL #1 EXT 1 LED will extinguish. Repeat Step 1 for each designated external triggering contact.

2.

667

M3425A Instruction Book

6.3

Diagnostic Test Procedures

Overview The diagnostic test procedures perform basic functional relay tests to verify the operation of the front-panel controls, inputs, outputs, and communication ports. 8 WARNING: Do not enter DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service. Entering DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service removes all protective functions of the relay. The diagnostic menu includes the following tests: OUTPUT (Output Test Relay) INPUT (Input Test Status) LED (Status LED Test) TARGET (Target LED Test) EX_IO (Expanded I/O Test, Not Available at this time) BUTTON (Button Test) DISP (Display Test) COM1 (COM1 Loopback Test) COM2 (COM2 Loopback Test) COM3 (COM3 Echo Test 2-Wire)

Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode 8 WARNING: Do not enter DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service. Entering DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service removes all protective functions of the relay. 1. Press ENTER to access the main menu. 2. Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: S ETUP UNIT W SETUP exit

3. Press ENTER, the following will be displayed: S OFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number V 4. Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed: D IAGNOSTIC MODE W time error DIAG

5. Press ENTER, the following warning will be displayed: PROCESSOR WILL RESET! ENTER KEY TO CONTINUE 8 WARNING: Do not enter DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service. Entering DIAGNOSTIC MODE when protected equipment is in service removes all protective functions of the relay. 6. Press ENTER, the relay will reset and DIAGNOSTIC MODE will be temporarily displayed followed by: OUTPUT TEST (RELAY) OUTPUT input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led cal factory

Each test is described individually in this section. The diagnostic menu also provides access to the following relay feature settings: CLOCK (Clock On/Off) LED (Relay OK LED Flash/Solid) CAL (Auto Calibration) FACTORY (Factory Use Only)

Auto Calibration is described in detail in Section 6.4, Auto Calibration.

This marks the beginning of the diagnostic menu. The left arrow and right arrow pushbuttons are used to navigate within the diagnostic menu. Exiting the diagnostic menu is accomplished by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then pressing EXIT a second time.

668

Testing 6

Output Relay Test (Output Relays 123 and 25) NOTE: This test does not include testing of Power Supply Relay (Output Relay 24). 1. Ensure the protected equipment is in a configuration/state that can support relay output testing. Confirm the positions of the outputs in the unoperated or OFF position. This can be accomplished by connecting a DMM (Digital Multimeter) across the appropriate contacts and confirming open or closed. The de-energized or OFF position for outputs 1 through 25 are listed in Table 61.
Normally Normally Closed Open Contact Contact* 33-34 31-32 29-30 27-28 25-26 23-24 21-20 17-18 104-105 102-103 100-101 98-99 96-97 94-95 92-93 90-91 88-89 86-87 84-85 82-83 80-81 78-79 76-77 -14-15 ------21-22 18-19 ---------------12-13 15-16

4.

Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to OUTPUT (Upper Case).

OUTPUT TEST (RELAY) OUTPUT input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led cal factory If OUTPUT is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select OUTPUT.

2.

Relay Output Number 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 Power Supply (24) Self-Test (25)

5. Press ENTER, the relay will display the following: R ELAY NUMBER 1 6. Select the Output Relay (from Table 61) to be tested, utilizing the Up/Down arrow pushbuttons.

7. Press ENTER . The following will be displayed for the selected relay: RELAY NUMBER 1 O FF on 8. Select ON (Upper Case) utilizing the Right arrow pushbutton. The relay will respond as follows: a. Output relay energizes (On position) b. Appropriate red OUTPUT LED illuminates, if equipped. If testing all output relays, then press EXIT to return to the output relay selection menu, then repeat Steps 6, 7 and 8 for each output relay. The DMM can now be used to verify that the output relay contact is in the operated or ON position. The readings should be the opposite of the initial reading determined in Step 2. When output relay testing is complete then restore all output relays to their de-energized or OFF positions listed in Table 61 and press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

9.

10.

* Normal position of the contact corresponds to the OFF (de-energized) state of the relay.

Table 61 Output Contacts


3. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 4. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step4. 11.

669

M3425A Instruction Book

Output Relay Test (Power Supply Relay 24) The power supply output relay can be tested by performing the following: NOTE: For this test the relay is not required to be in the Diagnostic Mode. 1. Ensure the protected equipment is in a configuration/state that can support relay output testing. Confirm the position of output relay 24 in the unoperated or OFF position. This can be accomplished by connecting a DMM (Digital Multimeter) across the appropriate contacts and confirming open or closed. The de-energized or OFF position for Output 24 is listed in Table 61. Remove power from the relay. The DMM can now be used to verify that output relay 24 contact is in the operated or ON position. The reading should be the opposite of the initial reading determined in Step 2. Restore power to the relay.

Input Test (Control/Status) The INPUT TEST menu enables the user to determine the status of the individual control/status inputs. Individual inputs can be selected by number using the up and down arrow pushbuttons. The status of the input will then be displayed.
Input Number 1 (52b) 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 Common Terminal 11 11 11 11 11 11 Expanded I/O Inputs 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 66 or 67 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 Terminal 10 9 8 7 6 5

2.

3.

4.

Table 62 Input Contacts


1. Ensure the protected equipment is in a configuration/state that can support relay input testing. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 3. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step3. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to INPUT (Upper Case).

2.

3.

INPUT TEST (RELAY) output INPUT led target V W button disp V W com1 com2 com3 clock V W led cal factory If INPUT is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select INPUT.

670

Testing 6

4. Press ENTER. The following is displayed: I NPUT NUMBER 1 5. Select the Input Relay (from Table 62) to be tested utilizing the Up/Down arrow pushbuttons.

Status LED Test The STATUS LED TEST menu enables the user to check the front-panel LEDs individually.

6. Press ENTER. The following is displayed for the selected relay: INPUT NUMBER 1 C IRCUIT OPEN 7. If no external control/status inputs are connected to the relay, then place a jumper between the IN RTN terminal (terminal #11 for Inputs 16, and either terminal #66 or #67 for Inputs 714) and the IN1 terminal (terminal #10). See Table 62 for terminals for inputs 2 through 14. Alternatively, if this specific input is being used in this application and the external wiring is complete, the actual external control/status input contact can be manually closed. This will test the input contact operation and the external wiring to the input contacts. The following is immediately displayed: INPUT NUMBER 1 C IRCUIT CLOSED 8. Remove the jumper between the IN RTN terminal (terminal #11 for Inputs 16, and either terminal #66 or #67 for Inputs 714) and the IN1 terminal (terminal #10). The following is immediately displayed: INPUT NUMBER 1 C IRCUIT OPEN 9. If testing all inputs, press EXIT to return to the input selection menu, then repeat Steps 5, 6, 7 and 8 for each input. When input testing is complete then insure all jumpers have been removed and press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time. 4.

Figure 68 Status LED Panel


1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to LED (Upper Case).

2.

STATUS LED TEST output input LED target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led cal factory If LED is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select LED.

3. Press ENTER. LED #1 (RELAY OK) illuminates and the following is displayed: STATUS LED TEST LED NUMBER 1 = ON If testing all Status LEDs, press the right arrow pushbutton to toggle through the remaining LEDs illustrated in Figure 68, with the exception of the PS1 and PS2 LEDs. When Status LED testing is complete press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.
671

10.

11.

5. 6.

M3425A Instruction Book

Target LED Test The TARGET LED TEST menu allows the user to check the M3925A Target Module LEDs individually.

3. Press ENTER. Target LED #1 lights and the following is displayed: TARGET LED TEST LED NUMBER 1 = ON

TARGETS
24 VOLTS/Hz PHASE OVERCURRENT NEUTRAL O/C SPLIT PHASE DIFF STATOR OVERLOAD 50

4.

27 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE 59 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE 27TN/59D/64S STATOR GND 59N/59X NEUT/GND OVERVOLT 32 21 40 78 50BF 60FL DIRECTIONAL POWER PHASE DISTANCE LOSS OF FIELD OUT OF STEP BREAKER FAILURE V.T. FUSE LOSS

PHASE OVERCURRENT 51V 50N/51N 50DT 49

If testing all Target LEDs, press the right arrow pushbutton to toggle through the remaining Target LEDs illustrated in Figure 69. When Target LED testing is complete press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

NEG SEQ OVERCURRENT46 FIELD GND/BRUSH LIFT64F/B FREQUENCY 81/81R/81A 87 PHASE DIFF CURRENT

5.

GND DIFF/DIR O/C 87GD/67N TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR TC IPS LOGIC LOGIC

50/27INADVERTENT ENRGNG

6.

OUTPUTS
OUT 1 OUT 2 OUT 3 OUT 4 OUT 5 OUT 6 OUT 7 OUT 8

Figure 69 M3925A Target Module Panel


1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to TARGET (Upper Case).

2.

TARGET LED TEST output input led TARGET V W button disp V W com1 com2 com3 clock V W led cal factory

If TARGET is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select TARGET.

672

Testing 6

Button Test The BUTTON TEST menu selection allows the user to check the M3931 HMI Module buttons. As each pushbutton is pressed, its name is displayed.

3. Press ENTER. The following is displayed: B UTTON TEST 0 NOTE: Pressing the EXIT pushbutton will exit from this test, and therefore should be last pushbutton tested. If it is pushed before this test sequence is completed, the test may be restarted by pushing ENTER. Notice that the word EXIT is displayed temporarily before the test sequence is exited. 4. Press each pushbutton for test. As each button is pressed, the display will briefly show the name for each key (RIGHT ARROW, UP ARROW, etc). When pushbutton testing is complete press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO. M-3425A

a
a
ENTER

EXIT

Figure 6-10 M3931 Human-Machine Interface Module


1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to BUTTON (Upper Case).

2.

B UTTON TEST output input led target V W BUTTON disp V W com1 com2 com3 clock V W led cal factory If BUTTON is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select BUTTON.

5.

6.

673

M3425A Instruction Book

Display Test The DISPLAY TEST menu selection enables the user to check the display. This test cycles through varying test patterns until EXIT is pressed. 1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to DISPLAY TEST (Upper Case).

COM1/COM2 Loopback Test The COM1 LOOPBACK TEST menu allows the user to test the front-panel RS232 port. COM2 LOOPBACK TEST menu tests the rear panel RS232 port. A loopback plug is required for this test. The required loopback plug consists of a DB9P connector (male) with pin 2 (RX) connected to pin 3 (TX) and pin 7 (RTS) connected to pin 8 (CTS). No other connections are necessary. M-3425A COM1/COM2 DB9P 1 RX 2 TX 3 4 SGND 5 6 RTS 7 CTS 8 9

2.

D ISPLAY TEST output input led target V W button DISP V W com1 com2 com3 clock V W led cal factory If DISP is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select DISP.

3. Press ENTER, the unit will display a sequence of test characters until EXIT is pushed. 4. After the test has cycled through completely, press EXIT to return to the Diagnostic Menu. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

Figure 611 COM1/COM2 Loopback Plug


1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to COM1 LOOPBACK TEST (Upper Case).

5.

2.

COM1 LOOPBACK TEST output input led target V W button disp V W COM1 com2 com3 clock V W led cal factory If COM1 is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select COM1.

3. Press ENTER. The following is displayed: com1 loopback test CONNECT LOOPBACK PLUG

674

Testing 6

4.

Connect the loopback plug to COM1, the front-panel RS232C connector.

5. Press ENTER, the relay will initiate the loopback test. If the COM Port passes the loopback test the following will be displayed: COM1 LOOPBACK TEST DONE If the COM Port fails the loopback test the following will be displayed: COM1 LOOPBACK TEST R XTX FAIL 6. Press EXIT to return to the DIAGNOSTIC Menu. 7. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to COM2 LOOPBACK TEST (Upper Case).

COM3 Test (2Wire) The COM3 Echo Test 2-Wire allows the user to test the RS485 rear terminal connections for proper operation. NOTE: This test requires a PC with an RS485 converter and terminal emulator software installed. 1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to COM3 ECHO TEST 2 WIRE (Upper Case).

2.

COM3 ECHO TEST 2 WIRE output input led target V W button disp V W com1 com2 COM3 clock V W led cal factory If COM3 is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select COM3.

8.

COM2 LOOPBACK TEST output input led target V W button disp V W com1 COM2 com3 clock V W led cal factory If COM2 is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select COM2. 4.

3. Press ENTER. The following is displayed: COM3 ECHO TEST 2WIRE IDLING...9600, N, 8, 1 From the rear of the unit, connect a PC to the relay at terminals 3(-) and 4(+) using an RS485 converter set for 2wire operation. See Figure 612 for diagram.
4
RS-485 RS-232

9. Press ENTER , then repeat Steps 3 through 6 for COM2.

+ RS-232 to RS-485 -

converter or PC card (2 wire)

RS-485 COM3

Computer

Figure 612 RS485 2Wire Testing

675

M3425A Instruction Book

5.

Set the following PC communications parameters: Baud Rate Data Bits Stop Bits 9600 8 1 Parity None

Clock ON/OFF This feature provides the user with the ability to either start or stop the clock. 1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to CLOCK ON/OFF (Upper Case).

Duplex Half 6. Open the terminal emulator program on the PC, then open the COM port for the RS485 converter. Press a key on the PC keyboard, then verify the following: a. The character pressed is displayed temporarily on the relay display. b. The character pressed is displayed on the PC monitor. 8. When communication has been verified, press EXIT, the following is displayed: COM3 ECHO TEST 2WIRE DONE 9. Press EXIT to return to the DIAGNOSTIC Menu. 10. 11. Close the COM port on the PC, and exit the terminal program. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

2.

7.

C LOCK START/STOP output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 CLOCK led cal factory If CLOCK is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select CLOCK.

NOTE: 80 will be displayed in the seconds place when the clock is stopped. 3. Press ENTER, the following is displayed: a. If the clock is already running the following will be displayed and will continue to update. C LOCK TEST 0 1-Jan-2003 01:01:01 b. If the clock was NOT running the following will be displayed: C LOCK TEST 0 1-Jan-2003 01:01:80

676

Testing 6

4.

To start or stop the clock press ENTER, the following is displayed: a. If the clock is already running the following will be displayed: C LOCK TEST C LOCK STOP C LOCK TEST 0 1-Jan-2003 01:01:80

2.

Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to FLASH RELAY OK LED (Upper Case).

FLASH RELAY OK LED output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock LED cal factory If LED (to the left of cal) is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select LED.

b. If the clock was NOT running the following will be displayed: C LOCK TEST C LOCK START C LOCK TEST 0 1-Jan-2003 01:01:01

3. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: FLASH RELAY OK LED O FF on 4. Select (upper case) either ON (to flash) or OFF (to Illuminate) by pressing the right/ left arrow pushbutton once.

NOTE: To preserve battery life the clock should be OFF if the unit is to be left de-energized for a long period of time. 5. The clock can be toggled ON or OFF by pressing any arrow pushbutton or ENTER. To exit the Clock ON/OFF mode press EXIT, the following will be displayed: C LOCK TEST DONE 6. 7. To exit the CLOCK ON/OFF Diagnostic Menu press EXIT. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

5. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: FLASH RELAY OK LED DONE 6. 7. To exit the FLASH RELAY OK LED Diagnostic Menu press EXIT. If all Diagnostic Testing is complete, then exit the diagnostic menu by pressing EXIT, PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed, then press EXIT a second time.

Auto Calibration Refer to the following Section 6.4, Auto Calibration, for more information on that function. A UTO CALIBRATION clock led CAL factory Factory Use Only This function is provided to allow access by factory personnel. FACTORY USE ONLY clock led cal FACTORY

Relay OK LED Flash/Illuminated This feature provides the user with the ability to set the relay OK LED to either Flash or be Illuminated when the relay is working properly. 1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step2.

677

M3425A Instruction Book

6.4

Auto Calibration

7. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: CONNECT REFERENCE INPUTS PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE 8. 9. Connect VA = VB = VC = VN = VX =120.0 (0.01) V at 0 phase. (See Figure 614.) Connect Ia=Ib=Ic=IA=IB=IC=IN=5.00** Amps at 0 (see Figure 613).

NOTE: The M3425A Generator Protection Relay has been fully calibrated at the factory. There is no need to recalibrate the unit prior to initial installation. However, in-system calibration of the 64F function may be needed for units purchased with the 64F Field Ground option. Calibration can be initiated using the HMI or IPSutil program. Phase and Neutral Fundamental Calibration 1. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to CAL (upper case).

** For a 1 A CT rating, use 1 A.


If 64S is purchased, do not put nominal current in the IN channel. The IN input is calibrated separately (see 64S procedure.)

The calibration can be verified by exiting from the Diagnostic menu and reading status: VA=VB=VC=VN=VX=120V V1=V2=0 V0=120V IA=IB=IC=5 A** Ia=Ib=Ic=5 A** Real=1 pu Reactive=0.0 pu Power Factor = 1.0 Idiffa = Idiffb = Idiffc = 0 Where subscript 0, 1, and 2 represent zero, positive, and negative sequence quantities, respectively. ** For a 1 A CT rating, use 1 A. NOTE: The phase angle difference between voltage and current input source should be 0, 0.05, and an accurate lowdistortion source should be used. (THD less than 1%). 10. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed while the relay is being calibrated: C ALIBRATING WAIT When the calibration is complete, the following will be displayed: C ALIBRATING DONE 11. Remove the calibration source inputs. I1=I2=0 I0=5 A**

2.

FLASH RELAY OK LED output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led CAL factory If CAL is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select CAL.

3. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd 4. Ensure that the 60 HZ Calibration Menu is selected to 60_HZ (Upper Case). If 60_HZ is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select 60_HZ.

5. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION NOM_F 6. 3rdh_F 64s_f

Ensure that NOM_F is selected (Upper Case). If NOM_F is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select NOM_F.

678

Testing 6

Third Harmonic Calibration 1. If it is desired to calibrate the third harmonic only and the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If it is desired to calibrate the third harmonic only and the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to CAL (upper case).

6.

Ensure that 3RDH_F is selected (Upper Case). If 3RDH_F is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select 3RDH_F.

7. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: INPUT 180 HZ PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE 8. (150 Hz for 50 Hz units) Connect Voltage Inputs as follows: a. Connect VN= VX =10.0 V, 180 Hz (150 Hz for 50 Hz units). See Figure 615. b. Connect VA=VB=VC=120.0 V, 180 Hz (150 Hz for 50 Hz units). See Figure 616.

2.

FLASH RELAY OK LED output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led CAL factory If CAL is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select CAL.

9. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed while the Third Harmonic is calibrated: C ALIBRATING WAIT When the calibration is complete, the following will be displayed: A UTO CALIBRATION DONE 10. 11. Remove the voltage from VN and VX. Remove the calibration source inputs.

3. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd 4. Ensure that the 60 HZ Calibration Menu is selected to 60_HZ (Upper Case). If 60_HZ is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select 60_HZ.

5. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION nom_f 3RDH_F 64s_f

679

M3425A Instruction Book

64S 100% Stator Ground by Low Frequency Injection Calibration 1. If it is desired to calibrate the 64S 100% Stator Ground by Low Frequency Injection only and the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 2. If it is desired to calibrate the 64S 100% Stator Ground by Low Frequency Injection only and the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 2. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to CAL (upper case).

6.

Ensure that 64S_F is selected (Upper Case). If 64S_F is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select 64S_F.

7. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: INPUT 20 HZ PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE 8. Connect VN=20.0 V (0.01 V) 20 Hz, IN=20.0 mA (0.01 mA) 20 Hz. See Figure 66.

2.

FLASH RELAY OK LED output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led CAL factory If CAL is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select CAL.

9. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed while the 64S is calibrated: C ALIBRATING WAIT When the calibration is complete, the following will be displayed: C ALIBRATING DONE 10. 11. Remove the voltage from VN and IN. Remove the calibration source inputs.

3. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd 4. Ensure that the 60 HZ Calibration Menu is selected to 60_HZ (Upper Case). If 60_HZ is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select 60_HZ.

5. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION nom_f 3rdh_f 64S_F

680

Testing 6

Field Ground Calibration Field Ground Calibration only applies to units purchased with the 64F Field Ground option. Calibration is necessary for long cable lengths (greater than 100 feet) to compensate for cabling losses from the M3425A and the M3921 Coupler module, and therefore should be accomplished in system, after all wiring is complete. 1. Connect the M-3921 Field Ground Coupler box as shown in Figure 67, Field Ground Coupler. If the relay is already in the Diagnostic Mode, then go to Step 3. If the relay is NOT in the Diagnostic Mode, then enter the relay diagnostic mode by performing the steps described in the Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode section of this chapter, then go to Step 3. Ensure that the Diagnostic Menu is selected to CAL (upper case).

6. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: CONNECT 1 KOHM REF. PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE 7. Set the decade box for 1 k resistance, then press ENTER, the following will be displayed: C ALIBRATING WAIT 8. When the calibration is complete the following will be displayed:

2.

C ALIBRATING DONE 9. Press ENTER, the unit will display the next resistance in the calibration sequence to be tested. 10. Set the decade box to the resistance specified by the HMI, then press ENTER. When the display shows DONE press ENTER. Repeat Step 10 until the calibration is complete for 100 k.

3.

FLASH RELAY OK LED output input led target button disp com1 com2 com3 clock led CAL factory If CAL is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right/Left arrow pushbuttons to select CAL.

11.

12. Press EXIT twice to exit the Diagnostic Mode.


Polarity 55 54 57 56 Current Input 59 58 53 52 IN Ic IC 50 Ib IB 48 51 Ia IA 46 49 47

4. Press ENTER , the following will be displayed: 60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd 5. Ensure that the 60 HZ Calibration Menu is selected to FIELD_GND (Upper Case). If FIELD_GND is not selected (Upper Case), then use the Right arrow pushbutton to select FIELD_GND.

Figure 613 Current Input Configuration

681

M3425A Instruction Book

Voltage Input

Hot Neutral

39 38 41 40 43 42 65 64 VX VC VB VA

Voltage Input

Hot Neutral

45 44 VN

Figure 6-14 Voltage Input Configuration


Hot Neutral Hot Neutral 65 64 45 44 VN VX

Voltage Input

Figure 615 Voltage Input Configuration

Voltage Input

Hot Neutral

39 38 41 VB 40 43 VC 42 VA

Figure 616 Voltage Input Configuration

682

Appendix A

Configuration Record Forms

This Appendix contains forms for copying, and recording the configuration and setting of the M3425A Generator Protection Relay, and to file the data for future reference. Examples of the suggested use of these forms are illustrated in Chapter 4, System Setup and Setpoints and Chapter 2, Operation. Page A-2 contains a copy of the Relay Configuration Table and is herein provided to define and record the blocking inputs and output configuration for the relay. For each function, check if DISABLED or check the output contacts to be operated by the function. Also check the inputs designated to block the function operation. The Communication Record Form reproduces the Communication and Setup unit menus. This form records definition of the parameters necessary for communication with the relay, as well as access codes, user logo (identifying) lines, date & time setting, and front panel display operation.

The functional Configuration Record Form reproduces the Configure Relay menus including the Setup Relay submenu which is accessible via S-3400 IPScom Communication Software or the optional M3931 HMI front panel module. For each function or setpoint, refer to the configuration you have defined using the Relay Configuration Table, and circle whether it should be enabled or disabled by the output contacts it will activate, and the inputs that will block its operation. The Setpoint & Timing Record Form allows recording of the specific values entered for each enabled setpoint or function. The form follows the main menu selections of the relay. The AS SHIPPED settings are included in brackets [ ] to illustrate the factory settings of the relay.

A1

M3425A Instruction Book

Function 21 24 Def Time 24 Inv Time 25S 25D 27 27TN 32 40 46 Def Time 46 Inv Time 49 50 50BF 50DT 50N 50/27 51N 51V 59 59D 59N 59X 1 2 3 1 2

OUTPUTS D 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

BLOCKING INPUTS 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

1 2 3 1 2 1 2 3 1 2

1 2 1 2 1 2

1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2

NOTE: The M-3425A is shipped with all functions disabled.

Table A1

Relay Configuration (page 1 of 2)

A2

Appendix A

Function 60FL 64F 64B 64S 67N Def Time 67N Inv Time 78 81 1 2

OUTPUTS D 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

BLOCKING INPUTS 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1

81A

81R 87 87GD

1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6

IPS

BM TCM

NOTE: The M-3425A is shipped with all functions disabled.

Table A1

Relay Configuration (page 2 of 2)

A3

M3425A Instruction Book

System Communication Setup


Communication Setup COM 1 (COM1 Communication Parameters are fixed except "Comm Response Time Delay") Baud Rate: 9600 Data Bit: 8 Parity: None Stop Bit: 1 Protocol: BECO

Comm Response Time Delay: _____ 0 msec250 msecs [100] COM 2 Baud Rate: o 1200 COM 3 Baud Rate: [9600] (Fixed) Data Bit: [8] (Fixed) Parity: [NONE] (Fixed) Data Bit: [8] (Fixed) Parity: o [NONE] o ODD o EVEN o 2400 o 4800 o [9600]

Stop Bit: _____ [1] or 2 Protocol: o BECO o [MODBUS]

Dead Sync Time: _____ 1 msec3000 msecs [50] Comm Response Time Delay: _____ 0 msec250 msecs [100]

Stop Bit: [1] (Fixed) Protocol: o [BECO] o MODBUS

Dead Sync Time: _____ 1 msec3000 msecs [50] Comm Response Time Delay: _____ 0 msec250 msecs [100]

Communication Address: _____ [1] Communication (COMM) Access Code: __________ [9999]

ETHERNET Ethernet Board: o [Enable] o Disable DHCP Protocol: o [Enable] o Disable IP Address: __________ [192.168.1.43] Net Mask: __________ [255.255.255.0] Gateway: __________ [192.168.1.1] Protocol: o BECO (SERCONV) o [MODBUS]

NOTE: As Shipped settings are contained in brackets [ ] where applicable.

Figure A-1 System Communication Setup


A4

Appendix A

Setup System
SYSTEM Nominal Voltage: Nominal Current: _____ _____ 50.0 V 140.0 V [115.0] 0.50 A 6.00 A [5.00]

Phase Rotation: o ACB o [ABC] 59/27 Magnitude Select: 50DT Split Phase Diff: o [RMS] o DFT o Disable o [Enable] o Delta-AB o Delta-AC o Line-to-Ground to Line-to-Line

Delta-Y Transform: o [Disable]

V.T. Configuration: o [Line-to-Line] V.T. Phase Ratio: V.T. Neutral Ratio: V.T. Vx Ratio: ________:1 ________:1

o Line-to-Ground [120.0]

1.0 6550.0

1.0 6550.0 [50.0]

________:1

1.0 6550.0 [1.0] 1 65500 1 65500 [1600.0] [1600.0]

C.T. Phase Ratio: C.T. Neutral Ratio: I/O SETUP

________:1 ________:1

Input Active State (Open): o #1 o #10 o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #13 o #14

Input Active State (Close): o [#1] o [#2] o [#3] o [#4] o [#5] o [#6] o [#7] o [#8] o [#9] o [#10] o [#11] o [#12] o [#13] o [#14] Latched Outputs: o #1 o #9 o #17 o #2 o #10 o #18 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Pulsed Outputs: o #1 o #9 o #17 o #2 o #10 o #18 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

NOTE: As Shipped settings are contained in brackets [ ] where applicable.

Figure A-2 Setup System (page 1 of 2)


A5

M3425A Instruction Book

OUTPUT SEAL-IN TIME Relay Output Seal-in Time: Output 1: Output 2: Output 3: Output 4: Output 5: Output 6: Output 7: Output 8: Output 9: Output 10: Output 11: Output 12: _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 13: _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ _____ 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 14: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 15: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 16: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 17: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 18: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 19: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 20: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 21: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 22: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30] Output 23: 2 8160 (Cycles) [30]

NOTE: As Shipped settings are contained in brackets [ ] where applicable.

Figure A-2 Setup System (page 2 of 2)


A6

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings


21Phase Distance 21 #1 o Disable o Enable 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [10.0] 090 (Degree) [45] 190 (Degree) [45] o [Disable] o Enable 0.1100 (Ohm) [10.0] -100.0100.0 (Ohm) [0.0] Circle Diameter: _____ Offset: _____ Impedance Angle: _____ Load Encr. Angle: _____ Load Encr. R Reach: _____ Time Delay: _____ Overcurrent SV: _____

1 8160 (Cycles) [30] 0.120.0 (A) o [Disable] o Enable

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 21 #2

o Disable o Enable 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [10.0] 090 (Degree) [45] 190 (Degree) [45] o [Disable] o Enable 0.1100 (Ohm) [10.0] -100.0100.0 (Ohm) [0.0]

Circle Diameter: _____ Offset: _____ Impedance Angle: _____ Load Encr. Angle: _____

Load Encr. R Reach: _____ Time Delay: _____ Overcurrent SV: _____

1 8160 (Cycles) [30] 0.120.0 (A) o [Disable] o Enable

o [Out of Step Block Disable] o Out of Step Block Enable I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 1 of 38)


A7

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


21Phase Distance (Cont.'d) 21 #3 o Disable o Enable 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [10.0] 090 (Degree) [45] 190 (Degree) [45] o [Disable] o Enable 0.1100 (Ohm) [10.0] -100.0100.0 (Ohm) [0.0] Circle Diameter: _____ Offset: _____ Impedance Angle: _____ Load Encr. Angle: _____ Load Encr. R Reach: _____ Time Delay: _____ Overcurrent SV: _____ Out of Step Delay: _____

1 8160 (Cycles) [30] 0.120.0 (A) o [Disable] o Enable 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 24Volts/Hz Overexcitation Definite Time #1 Definite Time #1 Pickup: _____

o Disable o Enable 100200 (%) [120] 30 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 2 of 38)


A8

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


24 Volts/Hz Overexcitation (Cont.'d) Definite Time #2 Definite Time #2 Pickup: _____ o Disable o Enable 100200 (%) [120] 30 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 Inverse Time

Inverse Time o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 100200 (%) [120] 30 8160 (Cycles) [30] 1999 (Sec) [10] o #1 o #2 o #3 o #4 Time Delay: _____ Reset Rate: _____

Inverse Time Curves I/O Selection:

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 25Sync Check

25S o Disable o Enable Phase Angle Window: _____ Upper Voltage Limit: _____ Lower Voltage Limit: _____ Sync Check Delay: _____ Delta Voltage: _____ Delta Frequency: _____ 090 (Degrees) [45] 60140 (V) [140] 40120 (V) [120] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] o [Disable] o Enable o [Disable] o Enable 0.001 0.500 (Hz) [0.100]

1.0 50.0 (V) [2.0]

Sync Check Phase

o [Phase AB] o Phase BC o Phase CA

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 3 of 38)


A9

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


25Sync Check (Cont.'d) I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

25D o Disable o Enable Dead Voltage Limit: _____ Dead Time Delay: _____ Enable Dead Input Enable: o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 060 (V) [10] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

o Dead V1 Hot VX o Hot V1 Dead VX o Dead V1 Dead VX

o #1 o #2 o #10 I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 27Phase Undervoltage 27 #1 o #11

o #3 o #12

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

o Disable o Enable 5180 (V) [120] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Pickup: _____

Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 4 of 38)


A10

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


27Phase Undervoltage (Cont.'d) Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 27 #2

o Disable o Enable 5180 (V) [120] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Pickup: _____

Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 27 #3

o Disable o Enable 5180 (V) [120] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Pickup: _____

Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

27TN Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral 27TN #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1014.00 (V) [10.00] 5180 (V) [120] o [Disable] o Enable o [Disable] o Enable o [Disable] o Enable 0.011.00 (PU) [0.50] Pos. Seq. Voltage Block: _____ Forward Power Block: _____ Reverse Power Block: _____ Lead VAr Block: _____ Lag VAr Block: _____

-1.00 -0.01 (PU) [-0.50]

-1.00 -0.01 (PU) [-0.50] 0.01 1.00 (PU) [0.50]

o [Disable] o Enable

o [Disable] o Enable

Lead Power Factor Block: _____ 0.01 1.0 (Lead) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable Lag Power Factor Block: _____ 0.01 1.0 (Lag) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 5 of 38)


A11

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


27TN Third Harmonic Undervoltage, Neutral (Cont.'d) Hi Band Forward Power Block: _____ 0.011.0 (PU) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable Lo Band Forward Power Block: _____ 0.011.0 (PU) [0.50] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

27TN #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1014.00 (V) [10.00] 5180 (V) [120] o [Disable] o Enable o [Disable] o Enable o [Disable] o Enable 0.011.00 (PU) [0.50] Pos. Seq. Voltage Block: _____ Forward Power Block: _____ Reverse Power Block: _____ Lead VAr Block: _____ Lag VAr Block: _____

-1.00 -0.01 (PU) [-0.50]

-1.00 -0.01 (PU) [-0.50] 0.01 1.00 (PU) [0.50]

o [Disable] o Enable

o [Disable] o Enable

Lead Power Factor Block: _____ 0.01 1.0 (Lead) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable Lag Power Factor Block: _____ 0.01 1.0 (Lag) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable Hi Band Forward Power Block: _____ 0.011.0 (PU) [0.50] o [Disable] o Enable Lo Band Forward Power Block: _____ 0.011.0 (PU) [0.50] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 6 of 38)


A12

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


32Directional Power 32 #1 o Disable o Enable -3.0003.000 (PU) [0.100] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] o [Over] o Under Pickup: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Time Delay: _____ Over/Under Power Target LED

o [Disable] o Enable

o #1 o #2 o #10 32 #2

o Disable o Enable -3.0003.000 (PU) [0.100] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] o [Over] o Under

Pickup: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12

Time Delay: _____ Over/Under Power Target LED

o [Disable] o Enable

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 32 #3 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

o Disable o Enable -3.0003.000 (PU) [0.100] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] o [Over] o Under o [Real] o Reactive

Pickup: _____

Time Delay: _____ Over/Under Power Target LED

o [Disable] o Enable

Directional Power Sensing

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 7 of 38)


A13

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


32Directional Power (Cont.'d) I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 40Loss of Field 40 #1

o Disable o Enable 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [50.0] -50.0 50.0 (Ohm) [0.0] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

Circle Diameter: _____ Offset: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 Time Delay: _____ Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

40 #1 VC o Disable o Enable 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Time Delay: _____ Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 8 of 38)


A14

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


40Loss of Field (Cont.'d) 40 #2 o Disable o Enable 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [50.0] -50.0 50.0 (Ohm) [0.0] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Circle Diameter: _____ Offset: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 Time Delay: _____ Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

40 #2 VC o Disable o Enable 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Time Delay: _____ Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 40 Setting o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Directional Element: _____ Voltage Control: _____

0 20 (Degree) [0]

5 180 (V) [120]

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 9 of 38)


A15

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


46 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Definite Time o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 3100 (%) [50] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Time Delay: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Inverse Time o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ Time Dial: _____ Reset Time: _____ 3100 (%) [50] 1 95 [50] 60065500 (Cycles) [1000] 1 600 (Second) [10]

Maximum Time: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 10 of 38)


A16

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


49Stator Overload Protection 49 #1 o Disable o Enable Time Constant: _____ 1.0999.9 (min) [10.0] 1.00 10.00 (A) [5.00] Max Overload Current: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

49 #2 o Disable o Enable Time Constant: _____ 1.0999.9 (min) [10.0] 1.00 10.00 (A) [5.00] Max Overload Current: _____

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

50Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent 50 #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1240.0 (A) [5.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 11 of 38)


A17

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


50Instantaneous Phase Overcurrent (Cont.'d) 50 #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1240.0 (A) [5.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 50BFBreaker Failure

50BF o Disable o Enable Phase Current: _____ Phase Current Select: Neutral Current: _____ Neutral Current Select: Time Delay: _____ 0.1010.00 (A) [5.0] o [Disable] o Enable 0.1010.00 (A) [5.0] o [Disable] o Enable

1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 12 of 38)


A18

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


50DTDefinite Time Overcurrent 50DT #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup (A): _____ Pickup (B): _____ Pickup (C): _____ Time Delay: _____ 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

50DT #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup (A): _____ Pickup (B): _____ Pickup (C): _____ Time Delay: _____ 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 0.20240.00 (A) [5.0] 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 13 of 38)


A19

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


50NInstantaneous Neutral Overcurrent 50N o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1240.0 (A) Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

50/27Inadvertent Energizing 50/27 o Disable o Enable 0.5015.0 (A) [5.00] (50) Overcurrent Pickup: _____

(27) Undervoltage Pickup: _____ 5 130 (V) [100] Pickup Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Drop-out Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 14 of 38)


A20

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


51NInverse Time Neutral Overcurrent 51N o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.2512.00 (A) [5.00] Time Dial: _____ 0.5 11.0 [5.0] Inverse Time Curves: o BECO Inverse o IEC Inverse o BECO Very Inverse o IEC Very Inverse o IEEE Moderately Inverse

o [BECO Definite Time] o BECO Extremely Inverse o IEEE Very Inverse I/O Selection: o #3 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12

o IEC Extremely Inverse o IEC Long Time Inverse o IEEE Extremely Inverse

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

51VInverse Time Phase Overcurrent 51V o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.5012.00 (A) [5.00] Time Dial: _____ 0.5 11.0 [5.0] Inverse Time Curves: o BECO Inverse o IEC Inverse o BECO Very Inverse o IEC Very Inverse o IEEE Moderately Inverse

o [BECO Definite Time] o BECO Extremely Inverse o IEEE Very Inverse

o IEC Extremely Inverse o IEC Long Time Inverse o IEEE Extremely Inverse

Voltage Control: _____ 5 180 (V) [100] o [Disable] o Voltage Control o Voltage Restraint I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 15 of 38)


A21

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


59Phase Overvoltage 59 #1 o Disable o Enable Input Voltage Selection: o Phase o Positive Sequence o Negative Sequence Pickup: _____ 5180 (V) [120] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

59 #2 o Disable o Enable

Input Voltage Selection: o Phase o Positive Sequence o Negative Sequence Pickup: _____ 5180 (V) [120] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

59 #3 o Disable o Enable

Input Voltage Selection: o Phase o Positive Sequence o Negative Sequence Pickup: _____ 5180 (V) [120] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 16 of 38)


A22

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


59D Third Harmonic Voltage Differential 59D o Disable o Enable Line Side Voltage: o [3V0] o VX Ratio (VX/VN): _____ 0.15.0 [1.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Pos. Seq. Voltage Block: _____ 5 180 (V) [100] o [Disable] o Enable I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 59NNeutral Overvoltage

59N #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 5.0180.0 (V) [120.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Neg. Seq. Voltage Inhibit (>): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable Zero Seq. Voltage Inhibit (<): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable o [3V0] o VX

Zero Seq. Voltage Selection: I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 17 of 38)


A23

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


59NNeutral Overvoltage (Cont.'d) 59N #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 5.0180.0 (V) [120.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Neg. Seq. Voltage Inhibit (>): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable Zero Seq. Voltage Inhibit (<): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable o [3V0] o VX

Zero Seq. Voltage Selection: I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

59N #3 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 5.0180.0 (V) [120.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Neg. Seq. Voltage Inhibit (>): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable Zero Seq. Voltage Inhibit (<): _____ 1.0100.0 (%) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable o [3V0] o VX

Zero Seq. Voltage Selection: I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 18 of 38)


A24

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


59X Multi-purpose Overvoltage 59X #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 5180 (V) [100] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

59X #2 o Disable o Enable

Pickup: _____ 5180 (V) [100] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 60FL Fuse Loss Detection

60FL o Disable o Enable Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Three Phase Fuse Loss Detection: o [Disable] o Enable Input Initiate: o FL o #1 o #2 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #8 o #9 o #10 o #11 o #12

o #6

o #7

I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs

o #13 o #14

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11

o #3 o #12

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 19 of 38)


A25

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


64F/BField Ground Protection 64F #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 5100 (KOhm) [50] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

64F #2 o Disable o Enable

Pickup: _____ 5100 (KOhm) [50] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

64B o Disable o Enable

Pickup: _____ 05000 (mV) Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Injection Frequency: _____ 0.101.00 (Hz) [0.20]

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 20 of 38)


A26

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


64S100% Stator Ground 64S o Disable o Enable Underfrequency Inhibit(40 Hz): o [Disable] o Enable Voltage Restraint: o [Disable] o Enable Total Current Pickup: _____ 2.075.0 (mA) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable Real Component Current: _____ 2.075.0 (mA) [10.0] o [Disable] o Enable Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30]

I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

67N Residual Directional Overcurrent 67N Definite Time o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.5240 (A) [5.0] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Directional Element: o [Disable] o Enable I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

o #1 o #2 o #10

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 21 of 38)


A27

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


67N Residual Directional Overcurrent (Cont.'d) 67N Inverse Time o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.2512.00 (A) [5.00] Time Dial: _____ 0.5 11.0 [5.0] Directional Element: o [Disable] o Enable Inverse Time Curves: o BECO Inverse o IEC Inverse o BECO Very Inverse o IEC Very Inverse o IEEE Moderately Inverse

o [BECO Definite Time] o BECO Extremely Inverse o IEEE Very Inverse I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11 o #3

o IEC Extremely Inverse o IEC Long Time Inverse o IEEE Extremely Inverse

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23 o #7

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #4

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #5 o #6

o #15 o #16

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Setting Max Sensitivity Angle: _____ 0 359 (Degree) [0] Operating Current: o [3I0] o IN Polarizing Quantity: o [#V0 (Calculated)] o VN o VX 78Out of Step 78 o Disable o Enable Circle Diameter: _____ 0.1100.0 (Ohm) [10.0] Offset: _____ -100.0 100.0 (Ohm) [0.0] Blinder Impedance: _____ 0.1 50.0 (Ohm) [10.0] Impedance Angle: _____ 0 90 (Degree) [45] Pole Slip Counter: _____ 120 [5] Pole Slip Reset Time: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] Trip on MHO Exit: o [Disable] o Enable I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #8 Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 22 of 38)


A28

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


81Over/Under Frequency 81 #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 65500 (Cycles) I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81 #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 65500 (Cycles) I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81 #3 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 65500 (Cycles) I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 23 of 38)


A29

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


81Over/Under Frequency (Cont.'d) 81 #4 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 65500 (Cycles) I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81AFrequency Accumulator 81A #1 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81A #2 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 24 of 38)


A30

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


81AFrequency Accumulator (Cont.'d) 81A #3 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81A #4 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81A #5 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 25 of 38)


A31

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


81AFrequency Accumulator (Cont.'d) 81A #6 o Disable o Enable High Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Low Band Pickup: _____ 50.0067.00 (Hz) [65.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 360000 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 81RRate of Change of Frequency 81R #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1020.00 (Hz) [1.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

81R #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.1020.00 (Hz) [1.00] Time Delay: _____ 3 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 81R Setting Negative Sequence Voltage Inhibit: _____ 0 99 (%) [10] o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 26 of 38)


A32

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


87Phase Differential Current 87 #1 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.203.00 (A) [1.0] Time Delay: _____ Percent Slope: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #8 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] 1 100 (%) [50]

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

87 #2 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.203.00 (A) [1.0] Time Delay: _____ Percent Slope: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #8 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] 1 100 (%) [50]

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #11 o #13 o #14 0.50 2.0 [1.00] o #1 o #2 o #10 87 Setting Phase CT Correction: _____ o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 27 of 38)


A33

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


87GDGround Differential Current 87 o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 0.2010.0 (A) [1.00] Pickup Delay: _____ I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #8 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] CT Ratio Correction: _____ 0.107.99 [1.00]

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #11 o #13 o #14 o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 28 of 38)


A34

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSlogic IPSLogic #1 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2

o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1

o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2

o 25D

o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT

Initiating Inputs: o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #1 o #10

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 29 of 38)


A35

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #1 (Cont.'d) Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #10 o #11

o #2 o #12

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7

o #8

o #9

o #13 o #14

Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4 o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

IPSLogic #2 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 30 of 38)


A36

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #2 (Cont.'d) Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT

Initiating Inputs: o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #1 o #10

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #11 o #2 o #12 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #10

o #13 o #14

Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4 o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 31 of 38)


A37

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #3 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2

o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1

o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2

o 25D

o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT

Initiating Inputs: o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #1 o #10

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #11 o #2 o #12 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #10

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 32 of 38)


A38

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #3 (Cont.'d) Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/FunctionTimeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4 o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

IPSLogic #4 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 33 of 38)


A39

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #4 (Cont.'d) Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT

Initiating Inputs: o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #1 o #10

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #11 o #2 o #12 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #10

o #13 o #14

Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/FunctionTimeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4 o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 34 of 38)


A40

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #5 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2

o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1

o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2

o 25D

o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT

Initiating Inputs: o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #1 o #10

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #11 o #2 o #12 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #10

o #13 o #14

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 35 of 38)


A41

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #5 (Cont.'d) Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/FunctionTimeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4 o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

IPSLogic #6 o Disable o Enable Initiating Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18

o #3

o #4

o #5

o #6

o #7 o #23

o #8

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22

o #15 o #16

Initiating Outputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup: o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 21 #1

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 36 of 38)


A42

Appendix A

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


IPSLogic #6 (Cont.'d) Initiating Function Timeout: o 21 #1 o 25S o 32 #2 o 46IT o 59 #3 o 64S o 81 #4 o 81R #1 o 21 #2 o 27 #1 o 32 #3 o 49 #1 o 59X #1 o 67N DT o 81A #1 o 81R #2 o 21 #3 o 24DT #1 o 24DT #2 o 24IT o 27 #2 o 27 #3 o 40 #1 o 40 #2 o 49 #2 o 50 #1 o 50/27 o 51N o 59X #2 o 60FL o 67N IT o 78 o 81A #2 o 81A #3 o 87 #1 o 87 #2 o 25D o 27TN #1 o 27TN #2 o 32 #1 o 40VC #1 o 40VC #2 o 46DT o 50 #2 o 51V o 64B o 81 #1 o 81A #4 o 87GD o 50BF o 59 #1 o 64F #1 o 81 #2 o 81A #5 o TC o 50DT #1 o 59 #2 o 64F #2 o 81 #3 o 81A #6

o 50DT #2 o 50N

o IPSL #1 o IPSL #2

o IPSL #3 o IPSL #4 o IPSL #5 o IPS #6 o BM

Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Function Pickup/Timeout Logic Gate: o [None] o NOT Initiating Inputs: o #1 o #10 o #2 o #11 o #3 o #12 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #13 o #14 o #7 o #8 o #9

Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiate via Communication Point: o Blocking Inputs: o FL o #1 o #11 o #2 o #12 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #9

o #10

o #13 o #14

Blocking Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Block via Communication Point: o Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Initiating Outputs/Function Pickup/Function Timeout and Initiating Inputs Logic Gate: o [OR] o AND Delay: _____ 18160 (Cycles) [30] 0 65500 (Cycles) [30] o [Reset] o Dropout o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #8

Reset/Dropout Delay: _____ Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Profile Switch: o #1 Reset/Dropout Delay: _____ o #3

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #2 o #3

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #4

o #15 o #16

o [Not Activated]

0 65500 (Cycles)

o Reset o Dropout o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8

Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #3 o #4 o #9 o #10 o #11 o #12 o #2 o #3 Reset Latched Outputs o Profile Switch: o #1

o #13 o #14 o #4

o #15 o #16

o Not Activated

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 37 of 38)


A43

M3425A Instruction Book

System Setpoints and Settings (Cont.'d)


BMBreaker Monitor BM o Disable o Enable Pickup: _____ 05000 (kA Cycles) [0] Time Delay: _____ 0.1 4095.9 (Cycles) [3.0] 0 50000 (kA Cycles) 0 50000 (kA Cycles) 0 50000 (kA Cycles) Timing Method Selection o [IT] o I^2T Preset Accumulator Phase A: _____ Preset Accumulator Phase B: _____ Preset Accumulator Phase C: _____ Outputs Initiate: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #23 o #7 o #8 o #9 o #8 o #8 o #10 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #3 o #4 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #5 o #6 o #15 o #16

I/O Selection:

o #1 o #2 o #9 o #17 o #18 Outputs: o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Input Initiate: o #1 o #2 o #10 o #11 Blocking Inputs:

o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #3 o #12 o #2 o #11 o #4

o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #5 o #6

o #15 o #16

o #13 o #14 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #8

o FL o #1 o #9 o #10

o #12 o #13 o #14

TC Trip Circuit Monitoring TC o Disable o Enable Time Delay: _____ 1 8160 (Cycles) [30] I/O Selection: o #3 o #4 o #5 o #6 o #7 o #23 o #6 o #7 o #8 o #8

Outputs o #1 o #2 o #9 o #10 o #17 o #18 Blocking Inputs o #2 o #11 o #3 o #4 o #5 o #9 o #10 o #12 o #13 o #14 o FL o #1 o #11 o #12 o #19 o #20 o #13 o #14 o #21 o #22 o #15 o #16

Figure A-3 System Setpoints and Settings (page 38 of 38)


A44

Communications: Appendix B

Appendix BCommunications
Serial Ports The relay has both front and rear panel RS232 ports and a rear RS485 port. The front and rear panel RS232 ports are 9-pin (DB9S) connector configured as DTE (Data Terminal Equipment) per the EIA-232D standard. Signals are defined in Table B1, Communication Port Signals . The 2-wire RS485 port is assigned to the rear panel terminal block pins 3 () and 4 (+). Each communication port may be configured to operate at any of the standard baud rates (300, 600, 1200, 2400, 4800, and 9600). The RS485 port shares the same baud rate with COM 2 (for COM1 see Section 5.4, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers). A null modem cable is also shown in Figure B1, Null Modem Cable: M-0423, if direct connection to a PC (personal computer) is desired. Optional Ethernet Port The M3425A, when equipped with the optional Ethernet port can be accessed from a local network. When the ethernet port is enabled, the COM2 serial port (RS232) is unavailable for communications. The demodulated IRIG-B may still be used via the COM2 Port when ethernet is enabled. Although the ethernet connection speed is faster than the RS232 port (can be up to 10 Mbps), the ethernet module connects internally through the COM2 serial connection and is therefore limited to connection speeds up to 9600 bps. Either port COM2 (Ethernet) or COM3 may be used to remotely set and interrogate the relay using a local area network, modem or other direct serial connection.

The M3425A Generator Protection Relay incorporates three serial ports and an optional RJ45 Ethernet port for intelligent, digital communication with external devices. Equipment such as RTU's, data concentrators, modems, or computers can be interfaced for direct, on-line, real time data acquisition and control. Generally, all data available to the operator through the front panel of the relay with the optional M3931 Human-Machine Interface module is accessible remotely through the BECO 2200 or MODBUS data exchange protocol. These protocol documents and the databasespecific protocol document are available from the factory or from our website at www.beckwithelectric.com. The S-3400 IPScom Communication Software package has been supplied for communication to any IBM compatible computer running under Microsoft Windows 2000 or higher. The communication protocols implement serial, byte oriented, asynchronous communication and can be used to fulfill the following communications functions: Real time monitoring of line status. Interrogation and modification of setpoints. Downloading of recorded oscillograph data. Reconfiguration of relay functions.

NOTE: The following restrictions apply for MODBUS protocol use: 1. MODBUS protocol is not supported on COM1. 2. Parity is supported on COM2 and COM3; valid selections are 8,N,2; 8,O,1; 8,E,1; 8,N,1; 8,O,2 or 8,E,2. 3. ASCII mode is not supported (RTU only). 4. Standard baud rates from 300 to 9600 are supported. 5. Only the following MODBUS commands are supported: a. read holding register (function 03) b. read input register (function 04) c. force single coil (function 05) d. preset single register (function 06) For detailed information on IPScom communications, refer to Chapter 3, IPScom.

B1

M3425A Instruction Book

Signal RX TX RTS CTS DTR DCD GND +15 V -15 V TTL IRIG-B (+) Receive Data Transmit Data Request to Send Clear to Send Data Terminal Ready Data Carrier Detect Signal Ground

COM1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 7 Pin 4 Pin 5

COM2 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 7 Pin 8 Pin 4 Pin 1* Pin 5 Pin 1* Pin 9* Pin 6*

* Optional: See Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers. +15 V (+15%) @ 100 mA maximum.

Table B1 Communication Port Signals


NOTE: Also see Tables 51, 52 and Figure 512.

M-3425A COM1/COM2 DB9P 1 RX 2 TX 3 4 SGND 5 6 RTS 7 CTS 8 9


Figure B1 Null Modem Cable: M-0423

PC DB9S 1 DCD 2 RX 3 TX

4 DTR 5 SGND 6 DSR 7 RTS 8 CTS 9 RI

B2

Communications: Appendix B

PC Master

Echo Cancel On

25 pin or 9-25 pin Straight-Through Cable DYMEC Fiber Optic Link / Repeater
DCE DTE REP OFF

T
FOC

R
FOC

FOC

FOC

DCE DTE REP OFF

DCE DTE REP OFF

DCE DTE REP OFF

Slave #1 Address 1

Slave #2 Address 2

Slave #3 Address 3

RS-232

RS-232

RS-232

9-25 pin "Straight-Through" Cables

Figure B2 RS-232 Fiber Optic Network

B3

M3425A Instruction Book

RS-485 2-Wire Network


Slave #1 Address 6 Slave #2 Address 8 Slave #3 Address 1

- +

- +

PC Master

B(-) A(+)

200 *

Twisted RS-232 to RS-485 2-wire converter or RS-485 PC Card

CAUTION: Due to the possibility of ground potential difference between units, all units should be mounted in the same rack. If this is not possible, fiber optics with the appropriate converters should be used for isolation. NOTE: Each address on the network must be unique. Only the last physical slave on the network should have the termination resistor installed. This may be completed externally or using a jumper internal to the unit. See Section 5.5, Circuit Board Switches and Jumpers.

Figure B3 RS-485 Network

IRIG-B TTL Source

COM2 Pin 6 Pin 5

Figure B4 COM Pinout for Demodulated TTL Level Signal

B4

Self-Test Error Codes Appendix C

C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 26 27

Appendix CSelf-test Error Codes

28 Battery backed RAM test fail EEPROM write power-up fail EEPROM read back power-up fail Dual port RAM test fail EEPROM write calibration checksum fail EEPROM write setpoint checksum fail loss of power EEPROM write setpoint checksum fail loss of battery backed RAM DMA checksum/physical block fail Oscillograph Memory Test fail DSP external program RAM fail DSP A/D convert fail DSP ground channel fail DSP reference channel fail DSP PGA gain fail DSP DSP<-> HOST interrupt 1 fail DSP DSP -> HOST interrupt 2 set fail DSP DSP -> HOST interrupt 2 reset fail DSP program load fail DSP not running run mode code DSP not running primary boot code DSP DPRAM pattern test fail EEPROM write verify error WARNING calibration checksum mismatch warning WARNING setpoint checksum mismatch warning 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52

WARNING low battery (BBRAM) warning Supply/mux PGA running test fail External DSP RAM test fail Unrecognized INT1 code Values update watchdog fail Abort Error Restart Error Interrupt Error Trap Error Calibration running check fail Ethernet Board not running (Warning) Not used Interrupt noise INT2 Interrupt noise INT1 Not used Not used Oscillograph buffer overflow Oscillograph buffer underflow Failure of DSP to calculate calibration phasors Unable to calibrate input (gain) Unable to calibrate input (phase) Not used Stack Overflow Setpoint Write Overflow Field Ground Error

Table C1 Self-Test Error Codes


C1

M3425A Instruction Book

Error Code

Description

Comm Channel An incorrect pass word supplied to the control will result in this message. Lock Control in Local This message indicates that the control is being operated locally and serial Mode communication is suspended. Echo Timeout This error results if there are problems with the communication link or if the echo cancel function is used incorrectly. This error results if incorrect or out-of-range data is entered. This message is displayed when attempting to communicate with a device other than the M-3425 series. This error results if an incompatible version of IPScom software is used. This is a communication protocol error. Contact a Beckwith Electric Co. factory representative. This error results if an incompatible version of IPScom software is used. This is a communication protocol error. Contact a Beckwith Electric Co. factory representative. This error results if there are problems with the communication link or if the echo cancel function is used incorrectly. This error results when communication with the control is lost while attempting to read data to the control. This error results when communication with the control is lost while attempting to read data from the control. This error could be caused by a malfunction of the control.

Invalid Data

Invalid ID Invalid Number of Points Invalid Point Number Read Invalid Checksum Read Packet Timeout Response Timeout Unknown System Error User Cancel Write Invalid Checksum Write Packet Timeout

This message displays when the escape (ESC) key is pressed. This error results if there are problems with the communication link or if the echo cancel function is used incorrectly. This error results when communication with the control is lost while attempting to write data to the control. Table C2 IPScom Error Messages

C2

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

This Appendix contains two sets of Inverse Time Curve Families. The first set is used for Volts per Hertz func tions (Figures D1 through D4), and the second set is for the M3425A functions which utilize the Inverse Time Overcurrent curves (Figures D5 through D12). NOTE: Table D1A and D1B on pages D6 and D7 contains a list of the data that characterizes Definite Time, Inverse Time, Very Inverse Time, and Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves.

Appendix D Inverse Time Curves

Expression for Time Delay Setting Operating time defined by IEC and ANSI/IEEE: t = TD A MP - 1 IEC Equation t = TD A +B 5 MP - 1 IEEE Equation (IEEE Equation Constants are defined at TD of 5)

Where t = Relay operating time in seconds TD = Time dial, or time multiplier setting I = Fault current level in secondary amps IP = Tap or pickup current selected B = Constant p = Slope constant A = Slope constant M= I IP

Setting Time Delay on Overcurrent Relays ANSI/IEEE and IEC Constants for Overcurrent Relays IDMT Curve Description Moderately Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inverse Standard Inverse Very Inverse Extremely Inverse Standard IEEE IEEE IEEE IEC IEC IEC p 0.02 2 2 0.02 1.0 2.0 A 0.0515 19.61 28.2 0.14 13.5 80.0 B 0.114 0.491 0.1217 -

D1

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure D1 Volts/Hz (24) Inverse Curve Family #1 (Inverse Square)


D2

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

Figure D2 Volts/Hz (24) Inverse Family Curve #2


D3

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure D3 Volts/Hz (24IT) Inverse Curve Family #3


D4

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

Figure D4 Volts/Hz (24IT) Inverse Curve Family #4


D5

M3425A Instruction Book

Multiple of Tap Setting 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 1.95 2.00 2.05 2.10 2.15 2.20 2.30 2.40 2.50 2.60 2.70 2.80 2.90 3.00 3.10 3.20 3.30 3.40 3.50 3.60 3.70 3.80 4.00 4.20 4.40 4.60 4.80 5.00 5.20 5.40

Definite Time 0.69899 0.64862 0.60539 0.56803 0.53558 0.50725 0.48245 0.46068 0.44156 0.42477 0.41006 0.39721 0.38606 0.37648 0.36554 0.35293 0.34115 0.33018 0.31999 0.31057 0.30189 0.29392 0.28666 0.28007 0.27415 0.26889 0.26427 0.26030 0.25697 0.25429 0.25229 0.24975 0.24572 0.24197 0.23852 0.23541 0.23266 0.23029 0.22834

Inverse Time 4.53954 4.15533 3.81903 3.52265 3.25987 3.02558 2.81566 2.62673 2.45599 2.30111 2.16013 2.03139 1.91348 1.80519 1.72257 1.54094 1.39104 1.26561 1.15945 1.06871 0.99049 0.92258 0.86325 0.81113 0.76514 0.72439 0.68818 0.65591 0.62710 0.60135 0.57832 0.53904 0.50641 0.47746 0.45176 0.42894 0.40871 0.39078 0.37495

Very Inverse Time 3.46578 3.11203 2.81228 2.55654 2.33607 2.14431 1.97620 1.82779 1.69597 1.57823 1.47254 1.37723 1.29093 1.21249 1.12812 1.01626 0.92207 0.84190 0.77301 0.71334 0.66127 0.61554 0.57515 0.53930 0.50733 0.47870 0.45297 0.42977 0.40879 0.38977 0.37248 0.34102 0.31528 0.29332 0.27453 0.25841 0.24456 0.23269 0.22254

Extremely Inverse Time 4.83520 4.28747 3.83562 3.45706 3.13573 2.85994 2.62094 2.41208 2.22822 2.06529 1.92006 1.78994 1.67278 1.56686 1.47820 1.32268 1.19250 1.08221 0.98780 0.90626 0.83527 0.77303 0.71811 0.66939 0.62593 0.58700 0.55196 0.52032 0.49163 0.46554 0.44175 0.40129 0.36564 0.33460 0.30741 0.28346 0.26227 0.24343 0.22660

NOTE: The above times are in seconds and are given for a time dial of 1.0. For other time dial values, multiply the above by the time dial value.

Table D1A M3425A Inverse Time Overcurrent Relay Characteristic Curves (1 of 2)

D6

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

Multiple of Tap Setting 5.60 5.80 6.00 6.20 6.40 6.60 6.80 7.00 7.20 7.40 7.60 7.80 8.00 8.20 8.40 8.60 8.80 9.00 9.50 10.00 10.50 11.00 11.50 12.00 12.50 13.00 13.50 14.00 14.50 15.00 15.50 16.00 16.50 17.00 17.50 18.00 18.50 19.00 19.50 20.00

Definite Time 0.22684 0.22583 0.22534 0.22526 0.22492 0.22360 0.22230 0.22102 0.21977 0.21855 0.21736 0.21621 0.21510 0.21403 0.21300 0.21203 0.21111 0.21025 0.20813 0.20740 0.20667 0.20594 0.20521 0.20449 0.20378 0.20310 0.20243 0.20179 0.20119 0.20062 0.20009 0.19961 0.19918 0.19881 0.19851 0.19827 0.19811 0.19803 0.19803 0.19803

Inverse Time 0.36102 0.34884 0.33828 0.32771 0.31939 0.31150 0.30402 0.29695 0.29027 0.28398 0.27807 0.27253 0.26734 0.26251 0.25803 0.25388 0.25007 0.24660 0.23935 0.23422 0.22923 0.22442 0.21979 0.21536 0.21115 0.20716 0.20341 0.19991 0.19666 0.19367 0.19095 0.18851 0.18635 0.18449 0.18294 0.18171 0.18082 0.18029 0.18014 0.18014

Very Inverse Time 0.21394 0.20673 0.20081 0.19511 0.19044 0.18602 0.18187 0.17797 0.17431 0.17090 0.16773 0.16479 0.16209 0.15961 0.15736 0.15534 0.15354 0.15197 0.14770 0.14473 0.14180 0.13894 0.13615 0.13345 0.13084 0.12833 0.12593 0.12364 0.12146 0.11941 0.11747 0.11566 0.11398 0.11243 0.11102 0.10974 0.10861 0.10762 0.10679 0.10611

Extremely Inverse Time 0.21151 0.19793 0.18567 0.17531 0.16586 0.15731 0.14957 0.14253 0.13611 0.13027 0.12492 0.12003 0.11555 0.11144 0.10768 0.10422 0.10105 0.09814 0.09070 0.08474 0.07943 0.07469 0.07046 0.06667 0.06329 0.06026 0.05755 0.05513 0.05297 0.05104 0.04934 0.04784 0.04652 0.04539 0.04442 0.04362 0.04298 0.04250 0.04219 0.04205

NOTE: The above times are in seconds and are given for a time dial of 1.0. For other time dial values, multiply the above by the time dial value.

Table D1B M3425A Inverse Time Overcurrent Relay Characteristic Curves (2 of 2)


D7

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure D5 BECO Definite Time Overcurrent Curve


D8

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

Figure D6 BECO Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve


D9

M3425A Instruction Book

Figure D7 BECO Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve


D10

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

Figure D8 BECO Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve


D11

M3425A Instruction Book

100

10

0.6

1.1 1 0.9 0.8

Time in Seconds

0.4

0.2

0.1

.05

0.01 1

Class Current in IEC Multiples ofA Pickup Standard Inverse t=TD x

10

IEC Class B Very Inverse t=TD x 13.5 [M-1 ]

100

[M

0.14
0.02

-1

Curve 5
Figure D9 IEC Curve #1 Inverse
D12

Curve 6

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

100

10

Time in Seconds

0.6 0.4

1.1 1 0.9 0.8

0.2

0.1

.05

0.01 1 10 Current in Multiples of Pickup 100

IEC Class A Standard Inverse t=TD x

IEC Class B Very Inverse

IEC Class C Extremely Inverse t=TD x 80 [M -1 ]


2

[M

0.14
0.02

-1

t=TD x

13.5 [M-1 ]

Curve 5

Curve 6 Very Inverse Figure D10 IEC Curve #2

Curve 7
D13

M3425A Instruction Book

100

10

Time in Seconds

1.1 1 0.9 0.8

0.1

0.6 0.4

0.2

0.01 1 10 Current in Multiples of Pickup

.05

100

sA verse

IEC Class B Very Inverse t=TD x 13.5 [M-1 ]

IEC Class C Extremely Inverse 80 [M -1 ]


2

IEC Class D Long Time Inverse t=TD x 120 [M-1 ]

t=TD x

Curve 6
D14

Curve 7 Figure D11 IEC Curve #3 Extremely Inverse

Curve 8

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

1000

100

Time in Seconds

10

0.6 0.4

1.1 1 0.9 0.8

0.2

.05

0.1 1 10 Current in Multiples of Pickup 100

B e

IEC Class C Extremely Inverse t=TD x 80 [M -1 ]


2

IEC Class D Long Time Inverse 120 [M-1 ]

t=TD x

Curve 7

Curve 8 Figure D12 IEC Curve #4 LongTime Inverse


D15

M3425A Instruction Book

100

10

15 12 10 8

Time in Seconds

6 5 4 3

0.1

0.01 1
Current in Multiples of Pickup

10

100

t = TD 5

0.0515 M
0.02

-1

+ 0.114

Figure D13 IEEE (Moderately) Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves

D16

Inverse Time Curves: Appendix D

100

10

Time in Seconds

15 12 10 8 5 6 6 5 4 3
2 1

0.1

0.5

0.01 1 Current in Multiples of Pickup


t = TD 5 19.61 M -1
2

10

100

+ 0.491

Figure D14 IEEE Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves

D17

M3425A Instruction Book

100

10

Time in Seconds

1
15 15 12 12 10 10 8 8 5 6 5 4

0.1

3 2

0.5

0.01 1 Multiple of Pickup


t = TD 5

10

100

28.2 M -1
2

+ 0.1217

Figure D15 IEEE Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves

D18

Appendix E Layup and Storage

Appendix Layup and Storage

Appendix E includes the recommended storage parameters, periodic surveillance activities and layup configuration for the M3425A Generator Protection Relay. Storage Requirements (Environment) The recommended storage environment parameters for the M-3425A are: The ambient temperature where the M3425A is stored is within a range of 5 C to 40 C The maximum relative humidity is less than or equal to 80% for temperatures up to 31 C, decreasing to 31 C linearly to 50% for relative humidity at 40 C. The storage area environment is free of dust, corrosive gases, flammable materials, dew, percolating water, rain and solar radiation.

Layup Configuration The M-3425A includes a removable lithium battery backed TIMEKEEPER module (Beckwith Electric component U25, Figure 5-14). The TIMEKEEPER module is the M-3425A real-time clock and also provides power to the units nonvolatile memory when power is not applied to the unit. Layup of the M-3425A requires verifying that the system clock is stopped. The steps necessary to verify system clock status are as follows: CAUTION: Do not use the diagnostic mode in relays that are installed in an active protection scheme. For units with the optional HMI panel: 1. 2. Verify that the Power Supply (PS) fuses are installed. Determine the unit power supply rating by observing the check box below the PS terminals on the rear of the unit. Apply power to the unit consistent with the rating determined in Step 2 (see Section 5.3 , External Connections). The unit will enter the selftest mode.

Storage Requirements (Periodic Surveillance During Storage) The M-3425A power supply contains electrolytic capacitors. It is recommended that power be applied to the relay (PS1 and optional PS2 redundant power supply when installed and PS2 on extended output units) every three to five years for a period of not less than one hour to help prevent the electrolytic capacitors from drying out.

3.

4. When the selftests are complete, then press ENTER to begin main menu. 5. 6. 7. 8. Press the right arrow pushbutton until SETUP UNIT is displayed. Press ENTER to access the SETUP UNIT menu. Press the right arrow pushbutton until DIAGNOSTIC MODE is displayed. Press ENTER. A reset warning will be displayed:

PROCESSOR WILL RESET! ENTER KEY TO CONTINUE 8 WARNING: All relay functions and protection will be inoperative while the relay is in diagnostic mode.

E1

M3425A Instruction Book

9.

Press ENTER. Unit will now reset and DIAGNOSTIC MODE will be temporarily displayed, followed by OUTPUT TEST (RELAY). This is the beginning of the diagnostic menu. Press the right arrow pushbutton until the following is displayed:

For units without the optional HMI panel: 1. 2. Verify that the Power Supply (PS) fuses are installed. Determine the unit power supply rating by observing the check box(s) below the PS terminals on the rear of the unit. Apply power to the unit consistent with the rating determined in Step 2 (see Section 5.3 , External Connections). The unit will enter the selftest mode. Install IPScom Communications Software (see Section 5.7 IPScom Communication Software Installation) on a PC that includes the following:

10.

C LOCK TEST com1 com2 com3 CLOCK 11. Press ENTER. The following is displayed:

3.

4.

C LOCK TEST 0 3-JAN-1998 09:00:00.000 12. If the clock is running, press ENTER to stop the clock. The following is displayed:

Microsoft WindowsTM 95 Operating System or above 5. 6. Equipped with a serial port

C LOCK TEST CLOCK STOPNOTE: When the relay clock is stopped, the sec onds will be displayed as 80. 13. Press ENTER and verify the relay clock is stopped. A display similar to the following is shown with the seconds stopped:

Connect a null modem cable from COM1 of the relay to the PC serial port. Open communications with the relay (see Section 5.8 Activating Initial Local Communications).

7. Select Relay/Setup/Set Date/Time from the menu bar. IPScom will display the Date/ Time Dialog Screen Figure 3-24. 8. Verify that Start Clock is displayed, then proceed as follows:

C LOCK TEST 0 3-JAN-09:01:80.000 14. When the clock has been verified to be stopped, then press EXIT until the following message appears:

a. If Start Clock is displayed, then select Save and go to Step 9. b. If Stop Clock is displayed, then select Stop Clock and then select Save. 9. Close communications with the unit by selecting Comm from the menu bar and then select Exit.

PRESS EXIT TO EXIT DIAGNOSTIC MODE 15. Press EXIT again to exit DIAGNOSTIC MODE. The relay will reset and normal running mode will resume.

10. Disconnect the null modem cable and then remove power from the unit. The unit can now be placed in storage. Storage of the M-3425A greater than five years may require replacement of the lithium battery prior to placing the unit in service. Contact Beckwith Electric Customer Service for replacement procedure.

NOTE: Pressing any button other than EXIT will return the user to DIAGNOSTIC MODE. 16. Remove power from the unit. The unit can now be placed in storage.

E2

Appendix F

Appendix HMI Menu Flow

F.1 HMI Menu Overview................................................................. F4 Figure F-1 M-3931 Human-Machine Interface Module...... F4 Figure F-2 HMI Menu Flow Overview................................ F5 F.2 HMI Menu Flow........................................................................ F6 Figure F3 Voltage Relay Menu Flow.................................. F6 Figure F4 Current Relay Menu Flow (1 of 2)..................... F7 Figure F5 Frequency Relay, Volts Per Hertz Relay Menu Flow.............................................. F9 Figure F-6 Power Relay, Loss-of Field Relay and V.T. Fuse Loss Relay Menu Flow.................... F10 Figure F-7 Phase Distance and Field Ground Relay Menu Flow............................................ F11 Figure F-8 Sync Check Relay and Breaker Monitor Menu Flow...................................................... F12 Figure F-9 Configure Relay Menu Flow............................ F13 Voltage Relay.................................................. F13 Current Relay.................................................. F14 Frequency Relay............................................. F15 Volts-Per-Hz Relay.......................................... F15 Power Relay.................................................... F15 Loss-of Field Relay......................................... F15 V.T. Fuse Loss Relay....................................... F16 Phase Distance Relay..................................... F16 Field Ground Relay......................................... F16 Sync Check Relay........................................... F16 Breaker Monitor............................................... F16 Trip Circuit Monitor Relay................................ F17 IPSlogic Relay................................................. F17

F1

M-3425A Instruction Book

F.2 HMI Menu Flow (Cont'd) Figure F-11 Setup System Menu Flow.............................. F18 Input Activated Profiles................................... F18 Active Setpoint Profile..................................... F18 Copy Active Profile.......................................... F18 Nominal Voltage.............................................. F18 Nominal Current.............................................. F18 V.T. Configuration............................................ F18 Delta-Y Transform........................................... F18 Phase Rotation............................................... F18 59/27 Magnitude Select.................................. F19 59DT Split-Phase Differential.......................... F19 Pulse Relay..................................................... F19 Latched Outputs.............................................. F19 Relay Seal-in-Time.......................................... F19 Active Input State............................................ F19 V.T. Phase Ratio.............................................. F19 V.T. Neutral Ratio............................................ F19 V.T. VX Ratio................................................... F19 C.T. Phase Ratio............................................. F19 C.T. Neutral Ratio............................................ F19 Figure F-12 Status............................................................ F20 Voltage Status................................................. F20 Current Status................................................. F20 Frequency Status............................................ F20 V/Hz Status..................................................... F20 Power Status................................................... F20 Impedance Status........................................... F20 Sync Check Status.......................................... F21 Breaker Monitor Accumulator Status............... F21 81A Accumulators Status................................ F21 In/Out Status................................................... F21 Timer Status.................................................... F21 Relay Temperature.......................................... F22 Counters......................................................... F22 Time of Last Power Up.................................... F22 Error Codes..................................................... F22 Checksums..................................................... F22 Figure F-13 View Target History........................................ F23 Clear Target History........................................ F23 Figure F-13 Oscillograph Recorder................................... F23 View Record Status......................................... F23 Clear Records................................................. F23 Recorder Setup............................................... F23

F2

Appendix F

F.2 HMI Menu Flow (Cont'd) Figure F-14 Communication.............................................. F24 COM1 Setup................................................... F24 COM2 Setup................................................... F24 COM3 Setup................................................... F24 Communication Address................................. F24 Response Time Delay..................................... F24 Comm Access Code....................................... F25 Ethernet Setup................................................ F25 Ethernet IP Address........................................ F25 Figure F-15 Setup Unit...................................................... F26 Software Version............................................. F26 Serial Number................................................. F26 Alter Access Codes......................................... F26 User Control Number...................................... F26 User Logo Line 1............................................ F27 User Logo Line 2............................................ F27 Clear Output Counters.................................... F27 Clear Alarm Counters..................................... F27 Date & Time.................................................... F27 Clear Error Codes........................................... F27 Ethernet Firmware Update.............................. F27 Figure F-16 Diagnostic Mode............................................ F28 Output Test (Relay)......................................... F28 Input Test (Status)........................................... F28 Status LED Test.............................................. F28 Target LED Test............................................... F28 Button Test...................................................... F28 Display Test..................................................... F28 COM1 Loopback Test...................................... F28 COM2 Loopback Test...................................... F28 COM3 Echo Test 2-Wire.................................. F28 Clock Test........................................................ F28 Flash Relay OK LED....................................... F29 Auto Calibration............................................... F29

F3

M-3425A Instruction Book

F.1

HMI Menu Overview

Appendix F illustrates the Human Machine Interface (HMI) menu flow that is presented on the M-3931 HumanMachine interface module. Key to Input Data A. All heavily bordered with right - left arrows). screens are MENU screens which have horizontal choices (made

B. Gray boxes enclose screens which bound areas that pushbutton ENTER will move in. In order to move out of one of the gray boxes it is necessary to either push EXIT or make a menu choice change using the Right - Left arrow. C. D. The Up/Down arrows only adjust value or letter (lower/upper case) inputs; they do not move within the menus or between menu displays. The Right/Left arrows are used only to make horizontally displayed choices. These can be either menu choices or input value digit choices. The previous choice or location in a menu is highlighted immediately.

E. The ENTER pushbutton records the setting change (whatever is in that screen when ENTER is pressed will be installed in memory) and moves down within a menu. The operator will notice that after the last menu item, ENTER moves to the top of the same menu but does not change menu positions. F. Pressing EXIT at any time will exit the display screen to the last screen containing a horizontal choice. (Return to the preceding menu).

BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO. M-3425A

a
a
ENTER

EXIT

Figure F-1 M-3931 Human-Machine Interface Module


G. The Left or Right arrow symbol in a screen indicates additional horizontal menu choices are available in the indicated direction. As previously described, the Right and Left arrows will move the operator to those additional choices.

F4

Appendix F

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz


27 Phase Undervoltage 59 Phase Overvoltage 27TN Neutrl Undervolt 59X Overvoltage 59N Neutral Overvoltage 59D Volt. Diff. 3rd Har.

SYNC CHECK RELAY field stator SYNC


25S Sync Check 25D Dead Volt

STATUS config sys STAT


Voltage Status Current Status Frequency Status V/Hz Status Power Status Impedance Status Sync Check Status Breaker Mon Acc Status 81A Accumulators Status In/Out Status Timer Status Relay Temperature Counters Time of Last Power Up Error Codes Checksums

BREAKER MONITOR BRKR trpckt ipslog


Set Breaker Monitoring Preset Accumulators Clear Accumulators

CURRENT RELAY volt CURR freq v/hz


46 Neg Seq Overcurrent 50 Inst Overcurrent 50/27 Inadvertent Energing 50BF Breaker Failure 50DT Def. Time Overcurr 50N Inst Overcurrent 51N Inv Time Overcurrent 49 Stator Overload 51V Inv Time Overcurrent 87 Differential Overcurr 87GD Gnd Diff Overcurr 67N Res Dir Overcurr

TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR brkr TRPCKT ipslog


Trip Circuit Monitoring

IPS LOGIC brkr trpckt IPSLOG


IPS Logic

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TARGETS osc_rec comm


View Target History Clear Target History

FREQUENCY RELAY volt curr FREQ v/hz


81 Frequency 81R Rate of Change Freq 81A Frequency Accum.

CONFIGURE RELAY CONFIG sys stat


Voltage Relay Current Relay Frequency Relay Volts per Hertz Relay Power Relay Loss of Field Relay V.T. Fuse Loss Relay Phase Distance Relay Field Gnd Relay Stator Gnd Relay Sync Check Relay Breaker Mon Relay Trip Ckt Mon Relay IPSLogic Relay

OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER targets OSC_REC comm


View Record Status Clear Records Recorder Setup

VOLTS PER HERTZ RELAY volt curr freq V/HZ


24 Definite Time Volts/Hertz 24 Inverse Time Volts/Hertz

COMMUNICATION targets osc_rec COMM


COM1 Setup COM2 Setup COM3 Setup Communication Address Response Time Delay Communication Access Code Ethernet Setup Ethernet IP Address

POWER RELAY PWR lof fuse dist


32 Directional Power

LOSS OF FIELD RELAY pwr LOF fuse dist


40 Loss of Field

SETUP SYSTEM config SYS stat


Input Activated Profiles Active Setpoint Profile Copy Active Profile Nominal Voltage Nominal Current V. T. Configuration Delta-Y Transform Phase Rotation 59/27 Magnitude Select 50DT Split-phase Diff. Pulse Relay Latched Outputs Relay Seal-in Time Active Input State V.T. Phase Ratio V.T. Neutral Ratio V.T. VX Ratio C.T. Phase Ratio C.T. Neutral Ratio

SETUP UNIT SETUP exit


Software Version Serial Number Alter Access Codes User Control Number User Logo Line 1 User Logo Line 2 Clear Output Counters Clear Alarm Counter Date & Time Clear Error Codes Ethernet Firmware Ver. Diagnostic Mode

V. T. FUSE LOSS RELAY pwr lof FUSE dist


60 FL V.T. Fuse Loss

PHASE DISTANCE RELAY pwr lof fuse DIST


21 Phase Distance 78 Out of Step

FIELD GROUND RELAY FIELD stator sync


64B/F Field Ground

EXIT LOCAL MODE setup EXIT

STATOR GROUND RELAY field STATOR sync


64S Stator Ground

Note: Depending on which functions are purchased, some menus may not be displayed.

Figure F-2 HMI Menu Flow Overview

F5

F6
VOLTAGE RELAY ELEMENTS CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE 59 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE PHASE_OVER 27TN NEUTRL UNDERVOLT NUTRL_UNDR vx_over

F.2

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz

M-3425A Instruction Book

27 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE PHASE_UNDER

HMI Menu Flow

27 #1 PICKUP XXX Volts

59 #1 INPUT VOLTAGE SEL. PHASE pos_seq neg_seq

59 #1 INPUT VOLTAGE SEL. phase POS_SEQ neg_seq

59#1 INPUT VOLTAGE SEL. phase pos_seq NEG_SEQ

27TN #1 PICKUP XX.XX Volts

27 #1 INHIBIT DISABLE enable

59 #1 PICKUP XXX Volts

59 #1 PICKUP XXX Volts

59 #1 PICKUP XXX Volts

27TN #1 POS SEQ VOLT BLK disable ENABLE

27 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

59 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

59 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

59 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

27TN #1 POS SEQ VOLT BLK XXX Volts

27 #2 and #3 same as above

59 Phase Volt #2 and #3 same as above

59 Pos Seq Volt #2 and #3 same as above

59 Neg Seq Volt #2 and #3 same as above

27TN #1 FWD POWER BLK disable ENABLE

27TN #1 LEAD PF BLK disable ENABLE

27TN #1 FWD POWER BLK X.XX PU

27TN #1 LEAD PF BLK X.XX LEAD

27TN #1 REV POWER BLK disable ENABLE

27TN #1 LAG PFR BLK disable ENABLE

Figure F3 Voltage Relay Menu Flow


27TN #1 LEAD VAR BLK disable ENABLE 27TN #1 LEAD VAR BLK -X.XX PU 27TN #1 LAG VAR BLK disable ENABLE 27TN #1 LAG VAR BLK X.XX PU

27TN #1 REV POWER BLK -X.XX PU

27TN #1 LAG PF BLK X.XX LAG

27TN #1 BAND FWD PWR BLK disable ENABLE

27TN #1 LO B FWD PWR BLK X.XX PU

27TN #1 HI B FWD PWR BLK X.XX PU

27TN #1 DELAY XXXX CYCLES 27TN NEUTRL UNDERVOLT #2 same as above

VOLTAGE RELAY ELEMENTS CONTINUED ON PREVIOUS PAGE CURRENT RELAY volt CURR freq v/hz

CURRENT RELAY ELEMENTS CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE

VOLTAGE RELAY VOLT curr freq v/hz

59X OVERVOLTAGE nutrl_undr VX_OVER


59N NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE NUTRL_OVER vol_diff 59D VOLT. DIFF. 3RD HAR nutrl_over VOL_DIFF 46 NEG SEQ OVERCURRENT NEG_SEQ inst

50 INST OVERCURRENT neg_seq INST

50/27 INADVERTENT ENRGNG INADVNT_ENG brk_fail

59X #1 PICKUP XXX Volts 59D RATIO X.X 46DT DELAY XXXX Cycles

59N #1 PICKUP XXX.X Volts

46DT PICKUP XXX %

50 #1 PICKUP XXX.X Amps

50/27 PICKUP XX.XX Amps

59X #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles 59D LINE SIDE VOLTAGE 3V0 VX 46IT PICKUP XXX %

59N #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

50 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

50/27 VOLTAGE CONTROL XXX Volts

59X #2 PICKUP XXX Volts 59D POS SEQ VOLT BLK Disable enable

59N #2 PICKUP XXX.X Volts

50 #2 PICKUP XXX.X Amp

50/27 PICKUP DELAY XXXX Cycles

59X #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles 59D POS SEQ VOLT BLK XXX volts

59N #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles

46IT MAX DELAY XXXXX Cycles

50 #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles

50/27 DROPOUT DELAY XXXX Cycles

59N #3 PICKUP XXX.X Volts 59D DELAY XX cycles

46IT RESET TIME XXX Seconds

Figure F4 Current Relay Menu Flow (Page 1 of 2)


59N #3 DELAY XXXX Cycles 46IT TIME DIAL XX 59N 20 Hz INJECTION MODE disable ENABLE

Appendix F

F7

M-3425A Instruction Book

CURRENT RELAY ELEMENTS CONTINUED ON PREVIOUS PAGE

CURRENT RELAY volt CURR freq v/hz

FREQUENCY RELAY ELEMENTS START ON NEXT PAGE

50 BF BREAKER FAILURE inadvnt_eng BRK_FAIL

50DT DEF. TIME OVERCURR P_INST st_ovl v_inv

50N INST OCERCURRENT p_inst N_INST n_inv

51N INV TIME OCERCURRENT LC_inst n_inst N_INV

49 STATOR OVERLOAD p_inst ST_OVL v_inv

50BF PHASE ELEMENT disable ENABLE

50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE A XXX.XX Amps

50N PICKUP X.X Amps

51N PICKUP X.XX Amps

49 #1 TIME CONSTANT XXX.X Min

50BF PICKUP PHASE XX.XX Amps

50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE B XXX.XX Amps

50N DELAY XX Cycles

51N CURVE BEDEF beinv bevinv

49 #1 MAX. OVERLOAD CURR XX.XX Amps

50BF NEUTRAL ELEMENT disable ENABLE

50DT #1 PICKUP PHASE C XXX.XX Amps

49 #2 TIME CONSTANT XXX.X Min

50BF PICKUP NEUTRAL XX.XX Amps

50DT #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles 50DT DEF. TIME OVERCURR #2 same as above

49 #2 MAX. OVERLOAD CURR XX.XX Amps

50BF INPUT INITIATE i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50BF OUTPUT INITIATE o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

50BF DELAY XXXX Cycles

51V INV TIME OVERCURRENT p_inst st_ovl V_INV

87 DIFFERENTIAL OVERCURR DIFF res_dir_oc

87 GD GND DIFF OVERCURR G_DIFF res_dir_oc

67N RES DIR OVERCURR diff RES_DIR_OC

51V PICKUP XX.XX Amps

87 #1 PICKUP X.XX Amps

87 GD PICKUP X.XX Amps

67NDT PICKUP XXX.X Amps

51V CURVE BEDEF beinv bevinv

87 #1 SLOPE XXX %

87 GD DELAY X Cycles

67NDT DIR ELEMENT disable ENABLE

51V TIME DIAL XX.X

87 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

87 GD C.T. RATIO CORRECT X.XXn

67NDT DELAY XXXX Cycles

51V VOLTAGE CONTROL disable V_CNTL v_rstrnt

87 #2 PICKUP X.XX Amps

67NIT PICKUP XX.XX Amps

51V VOLTAGE CONTROL XXX Volts

87 #2 SLOPE XXX %

67NIT DIR ELEMENT disable ENABLE

87 #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles

67NIT CURVE BEDEF beinv bevinv

87 PHASE CT CORRECTION X.XX

67NIT TIME DIAL XX.X

67N MAX SENSITIVITY ANGL XXX Degrees

67N OPERATING CURRENT 3I0 in

67N POLARIZING QUANTITY 3v0 vn VX

Figure F4 Current Relay Menu Flow (Page 2 of 2)

F8

CURRENT RELAY ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

POWER RELAY ELEMENTS START ON NEXT PAGE VOLTS PER HERTZ RELAY volt curr freq V/HZ

FREQUENCY RELAY volt curr FREQ v/hz

81 FREQUENCY FREQ rcfreq freq_acc

81R RATE OF CHANGE FREQ freq RCFREQ freq_acc 81A FREQUENCY ACCUM. freq rcfreq FREQ_ACC

24 DEF TIME VOLTS/HERTZ DEF_V/HZ inv_v/hz

24 INV TIME VOLTS/HERTZ def_v/hz INV_V/HZ

81 #1 PICKUP XX.XX Hz

81R #1 PICKUP XX.XX Hz

81A SET FREQUENCY ACC. SET reset

24DT #1 PICKUP XXX %

24IT PICKUP XXX %

81 #1 DELAY XXXXX Cycles 81A #1 HIGH BAND PICKUP XX.XX Hz

81R #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

24DT #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

24IT CURVE CRV#1 crv#2 crv#3 crv#4

81 FREQUENCY #2, #3, #4 same as above 81R #2 PICKUP XX.XX Hz 81A #1 LOW BAND PICKUP XX.XX Hz 81R #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles 81A #1 DELAY XXXXXX Cycles

24DT #2 PICKUP XXX %

24IT TIME DIAL XXX

Figure F5 Frequency Relay, Volts Per Hertz Relay Menu Flow


24DT #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles 81R NEG SEQ VOLT INHIBIT XX %

24IT RESET RATE XXX Seconds

Appendix F

F9

M-3425A Instruction Book

VOLTS PER HERTZ RELAY ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

PHASE DISTANCE RELAY ELEMENTS START ON NEXT PAGE

POWER RELAY PWR lof fuse dist

LOSS OF FIELD RELAY pwr LOF fuse dist

V.T. FUSE LOSS RELAY pwr lof FUSE dist

32 DIRECTIONAL POWER PWR

40 LOSS OF FIELD LOF

60FL V.T. FUSE LOSS FUSE

32 #1 PICKUP X.XXX PU

40 #1 DIAMETER XXX.X Ohms

60FL INPUT INITIATE fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 60FL 3 PHASE DETECT disable ENABLE

32 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

40 #1 OFFSET XX.X Ohms

32 #1 TARGET LED disable ENABLE

40 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

60FL DELAY XXXX Cycles

32 #1 UNDER/OVER POWER OVER under

32 #3 PICKUP X.XXX PU

40VC #1 DELAY WITH VC XXXX Cycles

32 #2 PICKUP X.XXX PU

32 #3 DELAY XXXX Cycles

40 VOLTAGE CONTROL XXX Volts

32 #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles

32 #3 TARGET LED disable ENABLE

40 DIRECTIONAL ELEMENT XX Degrees

32 #2 TARGET LED disable ENABLE

32 #3 UNDER/OVER POWER OVER under

32 #2 UNDER/OVER POWER OVER under

32 #3 DIR POWER SENSING real REACTIVE

Figure F6 Power Relay, Loss of Field Relay and V.T. Fuse Loss Relay Menu Flow

F10

Appendix F

V.T. FUSE LOSS RELAY ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

SYNC CHECK RELAY ELEMENTS START ON NEXT PAGE

PHASE DISTANCE RELAY pwr lof fuse DIST

FIELD GROUND RELAY FIELD sync brkr

21 PHASE DISTANCE DIST ostp

78 OUT OF STEP dist OSTP

64B/F FIELD GROUND FIELD

64S STATOR GROUND

21 #1 DIAMETER XXX.X Ohms

78 DIAMETER XXX.X Ohms

64F #1 PICKUP XXX kOhm

64S TOTAL CURRENT disable ENABLE

21 #1 OFFSET XXX.X Ohms

78 OFFSET XXX.X Ohms

64F #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles

64S TOTAL CURR PU XXX mAmps

21 #1 IMPEDANCE ANGLE XX Degrees

78 BLINDER IMPEDANCE XX.X Ohms

64F #2 PICKUP XXX kOhm

64S REAL COMP CURRENT disable ENABLE

21 #1 LOAD ENCROACHMENT disable ENABLE 21 #1 LOAD ENCR ANGLE XX Degrees

78 IMPEDANCE ANGLE XX Degrees

64F #2 DELAY XXXX Cycles

64S DELAY XXXX Cycles

78 DELAY XXXX Cycles

64B PICKUP XXXX mV

64S VOLT RESTRAINT disable ENABLE

21 #1 LOAD ENCR R REACH XXX.X Ohms

78 TRIP ON MHO EXIT disable ENABLE

64B DELAY XXXX Cycles

64S UNDERFREQ INHIBIT disable ENABLE

21 #1 OC SUPERVISION disable ENABLE 21 #1 OC SUPERVISION XX.X Amps

78 POLE SLIP COUNT XX slips

64B/F FREQUENCY X.XX Hz

78 POLE SLIP RESET TIME XXXX Cycles

21 #1 OUT OF STEP BLOCK disable ENABLE

21 #1 DELAY XXXX Cycles 21 PHASE DISTANCE #2 and #3 same as above

Figure F7 Phase Distance and Field Ground Relay Menu Flow

F11

F12
BREAKER MONITOR RELAY ELEMENTS CONTINUE ON NEXT PAGE BREAKER MONITOR field sync BRKR
25D DEAD VOLT sync DEAD SET BREAKER MONITORING BRKR prst clr PRESET ACCUMULATORS brkr PRST clr CLEAR ACCUMULATORS brkr prst CLR

FIELD GROUND RELAY ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

M-3425A Instruction Book

SYNC CHECK RELAY field SYNC brkr

25S SYNC CHECK SYNC dead

25S PHASE LIMIT XX Degrees BM PICKUP XXXXX kA-cycles ACC. PHASE A SET PH_A ph_b ph_c

25D DEAD VOLT LIMIT XX Volts

ACC. PHASE A CLEAR PH_A ph_b ph_c

25S UPPER VOLT LIMIT XXX Volts 25D DEAD V1 HOT VX disable ENABLE BM INPUT INITIATE i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

BRKR. ACCUMULATOR XXXXX kA-cycles PRESET ACCUMULATORS Phase B & C same as above

ACC. PHASE A CLEAR -ACCUMULATOR CLEAREDCLEAR ACCUMULATORS Phase B & C same as above

25S LOWER VOLT LIMIT XXX Volts 25D DEAD VX HOT V1 disable ENABLE

25S SYNC CHECK DELAY XXXX Cycles 25D DEAD V1 & VX disable ENABLE

BM OUTPUT INITIATE o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

25S DELTA VOLT disable

ENABLE

25S DELTA VOLT LIMIT XX.X Volts 25D DEAD DELAY XXXX Cycles

25D DEAD INPUT ENABLE i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 BM DELAY XXXX.X Cycles

BM TIMING METHOD IT i2t

Figure F8 Sync Check Relay and Breaker Monitor Menu Flow

25S DELTA FREQUENCY disable ENABLE

25S DELTA FREQ LIMIT X.XXX Hz

25S SYNC-CHECK PHASE AB bc ca

Appendix F

IPS LOGIC ELEMENTS START ON PREVIOUS PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY CURRENT ELEMENTS CONTINUED ON NEXT PAGE

TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR TRPCKT ipslog config

IPS LOGIC trpckt IPSLOG config

CONFIGURE RELAY trpckt ipslog CONFIG

TRIP CIRCUIT MONITOR TRPCKT

IPS LOGIC USE IPSCOM TO CONFIGURE

CONFIGURE RELAY VOLTAGE_RELAY

TCM DELAY XXXX Cycles

27 #1 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE disable ENABLE

27TN #1 NEUTRL UNDERVOLT disable ENABLE

59N #1 NEUTRAL OVERVOLT disable ENABLE

27 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 27 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 27 PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE #2 & #3 same as above
59 #1 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE disable ENABLE

27TN #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 27TN #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 27TN NEUTRL UNDERVOLT #2 same as above
59X #1 OVERVOLTAGE disable ENABLE

59N #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 59N #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 59N NEUTRAL OVERVOLT #2 & #3 same as above
59D VOLTAGE DIFF. disable ENABLE

59 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 59 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 59 PHASE OVERVOLTAGE #2 & #3 same as above

59X #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 59X #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 59X OVERVOLTAGE #2 same as above

59D BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 59D RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

Figure F9 Configure Relay Menu Flow (1 of 5)

F13

M-3425A Instruction Book

CONFIGURE RELAY VOLTAGE ELEMENTS START ON PREVIOUS PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY FREQUENCY ELEMENTS START ON NEXT PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY CURRENT_RELAY

49DT NEG SEQ CURRENT DEF

50BF BREAKER FAILURE

49 #1 STATOR OVERLOAD

87GD GND DIFFERENTIAL

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

49DT BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50BF BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

49 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

87GD BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

49DT RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

50BF RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

49 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 49 STATOR OVERLOAD #2 same as above

87GD RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

46IT NEG SEQ CURRENT INV

50DT#1 DEF TIME OVERCURR

67NDT RES DIR OVERCURR

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

46IT BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50DT#1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

51V OVERCURRENT INV

disable

ENABLE

46IT RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

50DT#1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 50DT DEF TIME OVERCURR #2 same as above

51V BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

67NDT BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50 #1 INST OVERCURRENT

disable

ENABLE

51V RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

67NDT RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

67NIT RES DIR OVERCURR

disable

ENABLE

50 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50N NTRL INST OVERCURRNT

87 #1 DIFF. CURRENT

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

50 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 50 INST OVERCURRENT #2 same as above

50N BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

87 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

67NIT BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50N RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

87 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 87 DIFF. CURRENT #2 same as above

67NDT RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

50/27 INADVERTENT ENRGNG

51N NTRL OVERCURRENT INV

disable

ENABLE

disable

ENABLE

50/27 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

51N BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

50/27 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

51N RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

Figure F9 Configure Relay Menu Flow (2 of 5)

F14

Appendix F

CONFIGURE RELAY CURRENT ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY trpckt ipslog CONFIG

CONFIGURE RELAY V.T. FUSE LOSS RELAY STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY FREQUENCY_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY VOLTS_PER_HZ_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY POWER_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY LOSS_OF_FIELD_RELAY

81 #1 FREQUENCY disable ENABLE

24DT #1 VOLTS/HZ DEF disable ENABLE

32 #1 DIRECTIONAL POWER disable ENABLE

40 #1 LOSS OF FIELD disable ENABLE

81 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 81 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 81 FREQUENCY #2, #3, #4 same as above
81R #1 RATE OF CHNG FREQ disable ENABLE

24DT #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 24DT #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 24DT VOLTS/HZ DEF #2 same as above
24IT VOLTS/HZ INV disable ENABLE

32 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 32 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 32 DIRECTIONAL POWER #2 & #3 same as above

40 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 40 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20
40VC #1 LOF WITH VC disable ENABLE

81R #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 81R #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 81R RATE OF CHNG FREQ #2 same as above
81A #1 FREQ ACCUMULATOR disable ENABLE

24IT BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 24IT RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

40VC #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 40VC #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20
40 #2 LOSS OF FIELD disable ENABLE

40 #2 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 40 #2 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20
40VC #2 LOF WITH VC disable ENABLE

81A #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 81A #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 81A FREQ ACCUMULATOR #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 same as above

40VC #2 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 40VC #2 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

Figure F9 Configure Relay Menu Flow (3 of 5)

F15

F16
CONFIGURE RELAY trpckt ipslog CONFIG

CONFIGURE RELAY LOSS OF FIELD ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE CONFIGURE RELAY TRIP CKT MON STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

M-3425A Instruction Book

CONFIGURE RELAY V.T. FUSE_LOSS_RELAY CONFIGURE RELAY STATOR_GND_RELAY CONFIGURE RELAY SYNC_CHECK_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY PHASE DISTANCE_RELAY CONFIGURE RELAY FIELD_GROUND_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY BREAKER_MON_RELAY

60FL V.T. FUSE LOSS disable ENABLE 64S 100% STATOR GROUND disable ENABLE 25S SYNC CHECK disable ENABLE

21 #1 PHASE DISTANCE disable ENABLE 64F #1 FIELD GROUND disable ENABLE

BM BREAKER MONITOR disable ENABLE

60FL BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 64S BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 64S RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 25S BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 21 #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 64F #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 64F FIELD GROUND #2 same as above
64B BRUSH LIFTOFF disable ENABLE

21 #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 64F #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

BM BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 BM RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

60FL RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 21 PHASE DISTANCE #2 and #3 same as above
78 OUT OF STEP disable ENABLE

25S RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20
25D DEAD CHECK disable ENABLE

Figure F9 Configure Relay Menu Flow (4 of 5)


78 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 64B BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 64B RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 78 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 25D BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12

25D RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

Appendix F

CONFIGURE RELAY BREAKER MONITOR ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY trpckt ipslog CONFIG

SETUP SYSTEM STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

CONFIGURE RELAY TRIP_CKT_MON_RELAY

CONFIGURE RELAY IPS_LOGIC_RELAY

TCM TRIP CIRCUIT MON. disable ENABLE

IPSL #1 IPS LOGIC disable ENABLE

TCM BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 TCM RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

IPSL #1 BLOCK INPUT fl i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 IPSL #1 RELAY OUTPUT o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20 IPS LOGIC #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 same as above

Figure F9 Configure Relay Menu Flow (5 of 5)

F17

F18
SETUP SYSTEM 59/27 MAGNITUDE SELECT STARTS ON NEXT PAGE SETUP SYSTEM SYS stat targets INPUT ACTIVATED PROFILES IN ap cpy volt curr vt ACTIVE SETPOINT PROFILE in AP cpy volt curr vt COPY ACTIVE PROFILE in ap CPY volt curr vt
INPUT ACTIVATED PROFILES disable ENABLE ACTIVE SETPOINT PROFILE X COPY ACTIVE PROFILE TO_PROFILE_X COPY ACTIVE PROFILE -WAIT-

M-3425A Instruction Book

CONFIGURE RELAY IPS LOGIC ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

Figure F10 Setup System (1 of 2)


NOMINAL CURRENT in ap cpy volt CURR vt V.T. CONFIGUTATION in ap cpy volt curr VT DELTA-Y TRANSFORM D_YTX rot mag splt
NOMINAL CURRENT X.XX Amps V.T. CONFIGUTATION LINE-LINE line-ground line-gnd-to-line-line DELTA-Y TRANSFORM DIS delta_ab delta_ac

NOMINAL VOLTAGE in ap cpy VOLT curr vt

PHASE ROTATION d_ytx ROT mag splt

NOMINAL VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

PHASE ROTATION a-b-c A-B-C

SETUP SYSTEM PHASE ROTATION ELEMENTS START ON PREVIOUS PAGE SETUP SYSTEM SYS stat targets

STATUS STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

59/27 MAGNITUDE SELECT d_ytx rot MAG splt

50DT SPLIT-PHASE DIFF d_ytx rot mag SPLT

PULSE RELAY PLSE latch seal in

LATCHED OUTPUTS plse LATCH seal in

RELAY SEAL-IN TIME plse latch SEAL in

59/27 MAGNITUDE SELECT 50DT SPLIT-PHASE DIFF disable ENABLE

RELAY SEAL-IN TIME OUT1

RMS dft

PULSE RELAY o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

LATCHED OUTPUTS o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

XXXX Cycles RELAY SEAL-IN TIME OUT 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23 same as above

ACTIVE INPUT STATE plse latch seal IN

V.T. PHASE RATIO VT vt-n vt_x ct ct_n

V.T. NEUTRAL RATIO vt VT_N vt_x ct ct_n

V.T. VX RATIO vt vt_n VT_X ct ct_n

C.T. PHASE RATIO vt vt_n vt_x CT ct_n

C.T. NEUTRAL RATIO vt vt_n vt_x ct CT_N

Figure F10 Setup System (2 of 2)


V.T. PHASE RATIO V.T. NEUTRAL RATIO V.T. VX RATIO C.T. PHASE RATIO

ACTIVE INPUT OPEN/close

C.T. NEUTRAL RATIO

i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 XXXX.X :1 XXXX.X :1

XXXX.X :1

XXXX.X :1

XXXX.X :1

A lower case "i" in this screen indicates that the Active Input State for that Input is "Open". An upper case "I" indicates that the Input Active Input State is "Close".

Appendix F

F19

F20
RELAY STATUS CONTINUES ON NEXT PAGE CURRENT STATUS volt CURR freq v/hz FREQUENCY STATUS volt curr FREQ v/hz V/HZ STATUS volt curr freq V/HZ POWER STATUS POWR imped sync brkr IMPEDANCE STATUS powr IMPED sync brkr
PHASE CURRENT A=XXX.X B=XXX.X C=XXX.X FREQUENCY XX.XX Hz VOLTS PER HERTZ X.X % REAL POWER X.XXX PU X.XXX W IMPEDANCE Zab (Ohms) R= XXX.XX X= XXX.XX PHASE CURRENT a=XXX.X b=XXX.X c=XXX.X RATE OF CHANGE FREQUENCY X.XX Hz/Sec REACTIVE POWER X.XXXX PU X.XXX VAr IMPEDANCE Zbc (Ohms) R= XXX.XX X= XXX.XX DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT A=XXX.X B=XXX.X C=XXX.X APPARENT POWER X.XXXX PU X.XXX VA IMPEDANCE Zca (Ohms) R= XXX.XX X= XXX.XX NEUTRAL CURRENT XXX.X Amps POWER FACTOR X.XX Lag IMPEDANCE POS SEQ (Ohms) R= XXX.XX X= XXX.XX GND DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT XXX.X Amps FIELD GND RESISTANCE < a kOhm

SETUP SYSTEM ELEMENTS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

M-3425A Instruction Book

STATUS sys STAT targets

VOLTAGE STATUS VOLT curr freq v/hz

PHASE VOLTAGE AB=XXX.X BC=XXX.X CA=XXX.X

NEUTRAL VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

VX VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

3RD HARMONIC DIFF RATIO XX.XX

Figure F11 Status (1 of 3)


POS SEQUENCE CURRENT XXX.X Amps NEG SEQUENCE CURRENT XXX.X Amps ZERO SEQUENCE CURRENT XXX.X Amps F49 THERMAL CURRENT #1 XXX.X Amps F49 THERMAL CURRENT #2 XXX.X Amps

3RD HARMONIC VX VOLTAGE XX.XX

POS SEQUENCE VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

NEG SEQUENCE VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

ZERO SEQUENCE VOLTAGE XXX.X Volts

3RD HARMONIC NTRL VOLT XXX.XX Volts

FIELD GND MEAS. CIRCUIT XXX.XX mV

RELAY STATUS CONTINUES ON PREVIOUS PAGE STATUS sys STAT targets

RELAY STATUS CONTINUES ON NEXT PAGE

SYNC CHECK STATUS powr imped SYNC brkr

BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS powr imped sync BRKR

81A ACCUMULATORS STATUS FREQ_ACC i/o timer

IN/OUT STATUS freq_acc I/O timer

TIMER STATUS freq_acc i/o TIMER

PHASE ANGLE +/- XX.X Degrees BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS A=XXXXX A-cycles 81A #1 ACCUMULATOR STAT X Cycles

Figure F11 Status (2 of 3)


BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS B=XXXXX A-cycles

DELTA VOLTAGE X.X Volts LO

81A ACCUMULATORS STATUS #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 same as above


81A #1 ACC STARTUP TIME XX--XXXX XX:XX:XX.XXX

fl i6 i5 i4 X X X X i11 i10 i9 i8 X X X X i14 i13 i12 X X X

i3 i2 i1 X X X i7 X

51V DELAY TIMER A=XXX% B=XXX% C=XXX%

51N DELAY TIMER XXX%

DELTA FREQUENCY X.XXXX Hz HI BREAKER MON ACC. STATUS C=XXXXX A-cycles

46IT DELAY TIMER XXX%

81A ACC STARTUP TIME #2, #3, #4, #5, #6 same as above

o8 o7 o6 o5 X X X X o14 o13 o12 X X X o19 o18 o17 X X X o23 o22 o21 X X X

o4 o3 o2 o1 X X X X o11 o10 o9 X X X o16 o15 X X o20 X

24IT DELAY TIMER XXX%

Appendix F

F21

F22
VIEW TARGETS HISTORY STARTS ON NEXT PAGE STATUS sys STAT targets COUNTERS temp COUNT powerup TIME OF LAST POWER UP temp count POWERUP ERROR CODES ERROR check CHECKSUMS error CHECK OUTPUT COUNTER 1 XX TIME OF LAST POWER UP XX-XXX-XXXX XX:XX:XX ERROR CODE (LAST) XX SETPOINTS CHECKSUM EECS=XX BBCS=XX CAL=XX
"Includes Self-Test Output"

RELAY STATUS CONTINUES ON PREVIOUS PAGE

M-3425A Instruction Book

RELAY TEMPERATURE TEMP count powerup

RELAY TEMPERATURE XX 'C

OUTPUT COUNTER 2 to 24 same as above ERROR CODE -1 XX ERROR CODE -2 and -3 same as above RST LOCATION XXXX CBR=XX BBR=XX

CALIBRATION CHECKSUM EECS=XX BBCS=XX CAL=XX

ALARM COUNTER XX

ROM CHECKSUM XXXX

DSP STATE TIMING #0 XXXXX DSP STATE TIMING 1 to 15 same as above

Figure F11 Status (3 of 3)


RESET COUNTER XX

COMM ERROR CODE (LAST) XXXX

COMM PACKET COUNTER XXXX

COMM RX ERROR COUNTER XXXX

SELFTEST COUNTER XXXX

POWERLOSS COUNTER XX

RELAY STATUS ON PREVIOUS PAGE

COMMUNICATION STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

VIEW TARGET HISTORY sys stat TARGETS OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER OSC_REC comm setup

VIEW TARGET HISTORY TRGT clear

CLEAR TARGET HISTORY trgt CLEAR

VIEW RECORD STATUS STAT clear setup

CLEAR RECORDS stat CLEAR setup

RECORDER SETUP stat clear SETUP

VIEW TARGET HISTORY XX Target number CLEAR TARGET HISTORY TARGETS CLEARED OR RECORD #X --RECORD CLEARED--

RECORD #X ACTIVE XX-XXX-XXXX XX:XX:XX

CLEAR RECORDS RECORDS CLEARED

RECORDER PARTITIONS X
TRIGGER INPUTS i6 i5 i4 i3 i2 i1 i11 i10 i9 i8 i7 i14 i13 i12 TRIGGER OUTPUTS o8 o7 o6 o5 o4 o3 o2 o1 o14 o13 o12 o11 o10 o9 o19 o18 o17 o16 o15 o23 o22 o21 o20

Figure F12 View Target History and Oscillograph Explorer

Selected Target will cycle through the following information: Date Time Ouputs Inputs Operate Targets Pickup Targets Current Status

POST TRIGGER DELAY XX %

Appendix F

F23

F24
COMMUNICATION CONTINUES ON NEXT PAGE COM2 SETUP com1 COM2 com3 com_adr COM3 SETUP com1 com2 COM3 com_adr COMMUNICATION ADDRESS com1 com2 com3 COM_ADR RESPONSE TIME DELAY DLY accss eth eth_ip COM2 BAUD RATE baud_4800 BAUD_9600 COM3 DEAD SYNC TIME XX ms COMMUNICATION ADDRESS X RESPONSE TIME DELAY XXX ms COM2 DEAD SYNC TIME XX ms COM3 PROTOCOL BECO2200 modbus COM2 PROTOCOL beco2200 MODBUS COM2 PARITY NONE odd even COM2 STOP BITS X

M-3425A Instruction Book

OSCILLOGRAPH RECORDER ON PREVIOUS PAGE

COMMUNICATION osc_rec COMM setup

COM1 SETUP COM1 com2 com3 com_adr

Figure F13 Communication (1 of 2)

COM1 BAUD RATE baud_4800 BAUD_9600

COMMUNICATION ON PREVIOUS PAGE

SETUP UNIT STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

COMM ACCESS CODE dly ACCSS eth eth_ip

ETHERNET SETUP dly accss ETH eth_ip

ETHERNET IP ADDRESS dly accss eth ETH_IP

COMM ACCESS CODE XXXX

ETHERNET disable ENABLE

ETHERNET IP ADDRESS X.X.X.X

TCP/IP SETTINGS TCP prot

TCP/IP SETTINGS tcp PROT

DNCP PROTOCOL disable ENABLE

SELECT PROTOCOL IEC61850

Figure F13 Communication (2 of 2)


IP ADDRESS X.X.X.X NET MASK XXX.XXX.XXX.X GATEWAY XXX.XXX.X.X

Appendix F

F25

F26
SETUP UNIT CONTINUES ON NEXT PAGE SERIAL NUMBER vers SN access number ALTER ACCESS CODES vers sn ACCESS number USER CONTROL NUMBER vers sn access NUMBER SERIAL NUMBER XXX ENTER ACCESS CODE LEVEL#1 level#2 level#3 ENTER ACCESS CODE level#1 LEVEL#2 level#3 ENTER ACCESS CODE level#1 level#2 LEVEL#3 USER CONTROL NUMBER XXXX LEVEL #1 XXXX LEVEL #2 XXXX LEVEL #3 XXXX

M-3425A Instruction Book

COMMUNICATION ON PREVIOUS PAGE

SETUP UNIT osc_rec comm SETUP

SOFTWARE VERSION VERS sn access number

Figure F14 Setup Unit (1 of 2)

SOFTWARE VERSION D-XXXXVXX.XX.XX

XXX

SETUP UNIT CONTINUES ON PREVIOUS PAGE

DIAGNOSTIC MODE STARTS ON NEXT PAGE

USER LOGO LINE 1 LOGO1 logo2 out alrm USER LOGO LINE 2 logo1 LOGO2 out alrm

CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS logo1 logo2 OUT alrm

CLEAR ALARM COUNTER logo1 logo2 out ALRM

USER LOGO LINE 1


XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

USER LOGO LINE 2


PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR

CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS

CLEAR ALARM COUNTER

CLEAR OUTPUT COUNTERS


-OUT COUNTERS CLEARED-ALARM COUNTER CLEARED-

CLEAR ALARM COUNTER

DATE & TIME TIME error eth_ver

CLEAR ERROR CODES time ERROR eth_ver

ETHERNET FIRMWARE VER. time error ETH_VER

DATE & TIME


XX-XXX-XXXX XX:XX:XX

CLEAR ERROR CODES PRESS ENTER KEY TO CLEAR

ETHERNET FIRMWARE VER. X-XXXXVXX.XX.XX

DATE & TIME XX Year

CLEAR ERROR CODES

-ERROR CODES CLEARED-

Figure F14 Setup Unit (2 of 2)


DATE & TIME jun jul aug sep oct DATE & TIME XX Date DATE & TIME sun mon tue wed thu DATE & TIME XX Hour DATE & TIME XX Minutes DATE & TIME XX Seconds

Appendix F

F27

F28
DIAGNOSTIC MODE DIAG DIAGNOSTIC MODE CONTINUES ON NEXT PAGE INPUT TEST (STATUS) output INPUT led target TARGET LED TEST output input led TARGET BUTTON TEST BUTTON disp com1 com2 STATUS LED TEST output input LED target INPUT NUMBER X TARGET LED TEST LED NUMBER 1 = ON STATUS LED TEST LED NUMBER 1 = ON BUTTON TEST X INPUT NUMBER XX CIRCUIT OPEN INPUT TEST (STATUS) 2 to 14 same as above STATUS LED TEST 2 to 6 same as above STATUS LED TEST 2 to 32 same as above Pressing any of the following will display the button name if the button is working properly: EXIT ENTER Up Arrow Down Arrow Left Arrow Right Arrow Target Reset COM1 LOOPBACK TEST button disp COM1 com2 COM2 LOOPBACK TEST button disp com1 COM2 COM3 ECHO TEST 2WIRE COM3 clock led cal CLOCK TEST com3 CLOCK led cal COM1 LOOPBACK TEST CONNECT LOOPBACK PLUG COM2 LOOPBACK TEST CONNECT LOOPBACK PLUG COM3 ECHO TEST 2WIRE IDLING...9600,N,8,1 CLOCK TEST 29-XXX-XXXX XX:XX:XX COM1 LOOPBACK TEST RX/TX (Fail or Pass) COM2 LOOPBACK TEST CHARACTER TX/RX (Fail or Pass) COM3 ECHO TEST 2WIRE -DONECLOCK TEST -CLOCK STOPCOM1 LOOPBACK TEST DONE COM2 LOOPBACK TEST DONE CLOCK TEST -CLOCK STARTCLOCK TEST -DONE-

SETUP UNIT CONTINUES ON PREVIOUS PAGE

PROCESSOR WILL RESET! ENTER KEY TO CONTINUE

M-3425A Instruction Book

DIAGNOSTIC MODE

OUTPUT TEST (RELAY) OUTPUT input led target

RELAY NUMBER X

RELAY NUMBER XX OFF on

Figure F15 Diagnostic Mode (1 of 2)

OUTPUT TEST (RELAY) 2 to 25 same as above

DISPLAY TEST button DISP com1 com2

Pressing ENTER will initiate an automatic test of each display character.

DIAGNOSTIC MODE CONTINUES ON PREVIOUS PAGE DIAGNOSTIC MODE DIAG

FLASH RELAY OK LED com3 clock LED cal

AUTO CALIBRATION com3 clock led CAL

FACTORY USE ONLY FACTORY

FLASH RELAY OK LED off ON

60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd

60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd

60 HZ CALIBRATION 60_HZ field_gnd

CALIBRATE FIELD_GND 60_hz FIELD_GND

FLASH RELAY OK LED -DONE-

60 HZ CALIBRATION NOM_F 3rdh_f 64s_f

60 HZ CALIBRATION nom_f 3RDH_F 64s_f

60 HZ CALIBRATION nom_f 3rdh_f 64S_F

CONNECT 1 K REF. PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE

CONNECT REFERENCE INPUTS PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE

INPUT 180 HZ PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE

INPUT 20 HZ PRESS ENTER TO CALIBRATE

CALIBRATING -WAIT-

Figure F15 Diagnostic Mode (2 of 2)


AUTO CALIBRATING -WAITAUTO CALIBRATING -WAITCALIBRATING -WAITCALIBRATING -DONECALIBRATING -DONEAUTO CALIBRATION -DONECALIBRATING -DONE-

Appendix F

F29

M-3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

F30

Appendix G

G
A
Accessing Switches, 5-20 Accessories, 1-1, 1-4

Appendix G Index

Monitoring, SP-3, SP-11, 4-3, 4-119, 6-1, 6-64 Brush Lift-Off Detection, SP-12, 4-3, 4-95, 6-46 Bus Ground, SP-8, 4-3, 4-38, 4-53, 4-89, 5-13 Bus Ground Protection, SP-8, 4-3, 4-38, 4-53, 4-89 Button Test, 6-68, 6-73, F-3

Accumulator Status, 3-7, 3-11, 4-112, 6-57, 6-64-665, F-2 Activating Initial Local Communications, 2-5, 3-1, 4-14, 5-1, 5-30-5-31, E-2 Alarm Counters, 2-1-2-2, 2-26-2-27, 3-34, F-3 All Setpoints, 3-25, 4-44-4-45 Alphanumeric Display, 1-2, 2-2-2-4 Alter Access Codes, 2-2, 2-6, 2-22-2-23, 4-7, F-3 Alter User Access Codes, 2-1-2-2, 2-24 Alternative One-Line Functional Diagram, 4-34 Analysis Software Installation, 5-30 Arrow Pushbuttons, 2-2-2-3, 2-23, 4-5, 4-7, 4-9-4-11, 4-13, 4-16, 4-19-4-21, 6-68-6-81 Auto Calibration, 1-3, 4-93, 5-32, 6-2, 6-68, 6-77-679, F-3

C
Calibration Data, 3-35 CE Standard, 5-1 Change Comm Access Code, 2-24, 3-31, 4-4 Change User Access Code, 2-25, 3-31-3-32, 4-6 Circuit Board Switches, SP-19-SP-20, 4-12, 4-15, 4-119, 5-1, 5-9, 5-20, 5-32, B-1, B-4 Clear Alarm Counters, 2-1-2-2, 2-27, F-3 Error Codes, 1-2, 2-1-2-2, 2-28, F-3 Oscillograph Records, 2-2, 2-20 Output Counters, 2-1-2-2, 2-26-2-27, F-3 Clock ON, 6-68, 6-76-6-77 Close Command, 3-4 COM Port Security, 4-2, 4-17 COM1, 1-3-1-5, 2-5, 4-5, 4-14, 4-16-4-17, 4-19, 4-21, 5-30-5-31, 6-68-6-81, A-4, B-1, E-2, F-3 COM2 Loopback Plug, 6-74 Loopback Test, 6-68, 6-74-6-75, F-3 Pinout, 4-12 COM3 Test, 6-75 Comm Access Code, 2-24, 3-31, 4-1-4-2, 4-4-4-5, A-4, F-3 Commissioning Checkout, 1-1, 5-1, 5-14 Communication Address, 3-33, 4-2, 4-14-4-15, 4-22, A-4, F-3

B
BECO Definite Time Overcurrent Curve, D-8 Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve, D-11 Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve, D-9 Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curve, D-10 Blocking Regions, 4-58-4-59, 6-58 Breaker Closed, 2-2-2-3, 6-7, 6-32 Failure, SP-2, 4-3, 4-40, 4-47, 4-68, 4-73, 4-75-476, 6-1, 6-31-6-32, A-18 Failure Logic Diagram, 4-75 Monitor, SP-11, 4-119, 6-64-6-65, A-44, F-1-F-2, F-12 Monitor Menu Flow, F-1, F-12

G1

M3425A Instruction Book

Communication Menu, 3-5, 3-33, 4-18-4-19 Ports, 1-3, 5-31, 6-68 Setup, 3-33, 4-2, 4-14-4-15, A-4 Configuration C1, 6-4, 6-8, 6-18-6-21, 6-24, 6-26-6-28, 6-30, 6-33, 6-37, 6-43, 6-54 C2, 6-4, 6-34 Record Forms, 1-2, 4-40, 5-31, A-1 V1, 4-83, 6-3, 6-8-6-10, 6-12, 6-14, 6-16, 6-21, 6-24, 6-33, 6-37, 6-39, 6-43, 6-54, 6-56-6-58 V2, 6-3, 6-17 Conformity, 1-2, 5-1, H-1 Connect, 3-1, 3-5, 4-21-4-23, 5-30-5-32, 6-2, 6-8-617, 6-21, 6-23-6-44, 6-46, 6-49-6-52, 6-54, 6-56-660, 6-62-6-64, 6-66-6-67, 6-74-6-75, 6-78-6-81, E-2 Control, SP-1-SP-2, SP-5-SP-7, SP-9, SP-11-SP-14, SP-16, SP-18, SP-33, 1-2, 2-31, 3-29, 3-32, 4-1-4-3, 4-8, 4-10, 4-40, 4-50, 4-53, 4-65-4-66, 4-78, 4-81-482, 4-91, 5-29, 6-1, 6-24-6-25, 6-37-6-38, 6-70-6-71, A-15, A-21, B-1, F-3 Control Transformer, 5-29 Counters, 2-1-2-2, 2-8, 2-26-2-27, 2-29, 3-34, 5-18, F-2-F-3 Coverage, 4-47-4-48 Current Configuration, 6-5 Input Configuration, 6-81 Inputs, SP-14, 4-91, 6-4, 6-7-6-10, 6-12, 6-14, 6-16-6-21, 6-24-6-28, 6-30-6-31, 6-33-6-37, 6-39-6-44, 6-46-6-47, 6-50, 6-52, 6-54, 6-56-6-58, 6-60, 6-62-6-64, 6-66-6-67 Relay Menu Flow, F-1, F-7-F-8

Device Address, 4-2, 4-14, 4-16 DHCP, 1-3, 4-2, 4-18-4-19, A-4 DHCP Protocol, 1-3, 4-2, 4-18-4-19, A-4 DIAG, 2-2-2-3, 4-11-4-13, 5-31, 6-68 Diagnostic LED, 2-2-2-3 Mode, 1-2, 4-11-4-12, 6-68-6-81, E-1-E-2, F-3, F-28-F-29 Test Procedures, 6-1, 6-6, 6-68 Differential, SP-1-SP-2, SP-6, SP-10, SP-13, SP-21SP-22, 2-8, 3-18, 4-3, 4-29, 4-34, 4-68, 4-77, 4-854-86, 4-89, 4-115-4-117, 5-14-5-15, 6-1, 6-34, 6-40, 6-60, 6-62, A-23, A-33-A-34, F-2 Differential Relay, 4-77, 4-85, 4-115-4-116 Dip Switch SW-1, 5-21 Direct Connection, 1-5, 3-5, 4-2, 4-14, B-1 Directional Power, SP-2, 4-2, 4-61-4-62, 4-64, 6-1, 6-21-6-23, A-13-A-14 Disabling COM Ports, 4-2, 4-17 Display All Setpoints, 3-19, 3-21, 3-24-3-25 Display Test, 6-68, 6-74, F-3 Dropout, SP-7, 3-27, 4-3, 4-27, 4-29, 4-78, 4-124, 6-33, A-20, A-36-A-37, A-39-A-40, A-42-A-43 Dropout Delay Timer, 4-3, 4-124 Dual Slope, 3-18

E
Enter Pushbutton, 2-2-2-3, 2-5, 2-8, 2-13-2-15, 2-172-18, 2-21-2-22, 2-26-2-28, 4-5, 4-7-4-8, 4-10-4-12, 4-16-4-17, 4-26, F-4 Entering Relay Diagnostic Mode, 6-68-6-81 Equipment Required, 1-2, 6-2 Error Codes, 1-2, 2-1-2-2, 2-5, 2-8, 2-26, 2-28-2-29, 3-34, 5-18, 5-31, C-1, F-2-F-3 Error Messages, C-2 Ethernet Communication Settings, 4-2, 4-18 Port Setup, 4-2, 4-18-4-19 Protocols, 4-2, 4-18 Example Bands, 4-113 Example of Capability, 4-51 Example of Frequency, 4-109-4-110 Excessive Reactive Power, 4-3, 4-61 Exit Command, 3-4

D
Date, SP-18, SP-28, 1-2, 2-2, 2-5, 2-13, 2-15, 2-30, 3-19, 3-23, 3-26, 4-1-4-2, 4-12-4-13, 5-31-5-32, 6-7, A-1, E-2, F-3 Dead-Sync Time, 4-15 Declaration of Conformity, 1-2, H-1 Default Message Screens, 2-2, 2-5 Definite Time Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-3, 4-29, 4-77, 6-1, 6-34, A-19, D-8 Delta Frequency Check, 4-2, 4-53 Delta Voltage, SP-12, 4-2, 4-53-4-54, 4-103, 5-17, 6-14-6-15, A-9

G2

Appendix G

Exit Pushbutton, 2-2-2-3, 2-8, 2-14-2-15, 2-17-2-18, 2-21-2-23, 4-7, 6-73 External Connections, SP-18-SP-20, 1-1, 2-5, 4-93, 4-119, 5-1, 5-8-5-9, 5-20, 5-32, E-1-E-2 External Fuse-Loss Function, 4-3, 4-91 Extremely Inverse, SP-7, SP-9, 6-36-6-37, 6-52, A-21, A-28, D-1, D-11, D-14, D-18

G
GE L-2 Cabinet H3, 5-6 General Information, 2-16, 4-24, 4-39, 5-1, 5-32 General Unit Setup, 4-1-4-2 Generator Breaker Failure, SP-2, 4-3, 4-75-4-76, 6-31-6-32 Ground Fault Protection, 4-86, 4-103 Motoring, 4-2, 4-61 Overload, 4-2, 4-61 Ground, SP-1-SP-2, SP-4, SP-8, SP-12-SP-13, SP17, SP-19-SP-20, SP-28-SP-31, 2-8, 4-3, 4-28, 4-38, 4-53, 4-58, 4-75, 4-80, 4-85-4-87, 4-89, 4-93-4-96, 4-101-4-103, 4-115, 4-117, 5-8-5-9, 5-13-5-14, 5-20, 6-1, 6-44-6-47, 6-62, 6-78, 6-80-6-81, A-26-A-27, A-34, B-4, C-1, F-1, F-11 Ground Differential, 2-8, 4-117, 6-1, 6-62, A-34 Grounding Requirements, 5-8

F
Fiber Optic Network, 4-15, B-3 Field Ground Calibration, 6-81 Coupler, SP-2, SP-12, SP-28-SP-30, 4-93-4-95, 6-44-6-46, 6-81 Detection, 4-3, 4-93, 4-95 Protection, SP-12, SP-19-SP-20, SP-28, 4-3, 4-93, 4-95, 5-9, 6-1, 6-44, 6-46, A-26 Relay Menu Flow, F-1, F-11 File Menu, 3-4 Firmware Update, 3-35, F-3 Firmware Version, 1-2, 3-1, 3-4, 3-35, 4-2, 4-51, 6-7 Frequency Accumulator, 3-11, 4-3, 4-112-4-113, 6-1, 6-57, A-30-A-32 Frequency Relay, F-1, F-9 Front Panel Controls, 1-1, 1-5, 2-1-2-3 Function Component Connection Diagram, SP-12, SP-32, 4-98-4-99 Dual Slope Display, 3-18 Logic, 4-78-4-79, 4-92, 6-43 Overload Curves, 4-71 Setup, 4-91, 4-121, 6-67 Status, SP-2, SP-15, 2-15, 3-7, 3-17, 3-26, 6-8-610, 6-12-6-17, 6-21-6-23, 6-25-6-28, 6-30-6-35, 6-37-6-44, 6-46-6-51, 6-53-6-56, 6-59-6-62, 6-656-67 Test Procedures, 6-1, 6-6 Fuse Loss, SP-2, SP-8, 4-3, 4-39-4-40, 4-81, 4-91-492, 6-1, 6-43, A-25, F-1, F-10

H
Hardware Requirements, 5-30 Help Menu, 3-1, 3-35 HMI Blanking, 4-2, 4-8 COM Port Definitions, 4-2, 4-16 Comm Access Code Setup, 4-2, 4-5 Ethernet Port Setup, 4-2, 4-19 Menu Flow, 1-2, 2-7, F-1-F-6 Menu Flow Overview, F-1, F-5 Operation Overview, 2-2, 2-5 Security, 2-2, 2-6 Set Date, 4-2, 4-12 Setup Oscillograph Recorder, 4-2, 4-26 System OK LED Setup, 4-2, 4-11 User Access Codes Setup, 4-2, 4-7 User Control Number Setup, 4-2, 4-10 User Logo Line Setup, 4-2, 4-8 Human, SP-1, 1-1-1-2, 1-5, 2-3, 4-1, F-4 HV Breaker Flashover, 4-3, 4-75 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Flush Mount, 5-28 Hz Band Pass Filter Housing Panel Surface Mount, 5-27 Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Flush Mount, 5-26
G3

M3425A Instruction Book

Hz Frequency Generator Housing Panel Surface Mount, 5-25 Hz Measuring Current Transformer, SP-31, SP-36, 4-97, 5-29 Hz Signal Generator, SP-2, SP-32-SP-33, 4-97, 4-99-4-100

Time Overcurrent Relay Characteristic Curves, D-6-D-7 Time Phase Overcurrent, 4-3, 4-81, 6-1, 6-37, A-21 IPScom COM Port Definitions, 4-2, 4-14 Comm Access Code Setup, 4-2, 4-4 Ethernet Port Setup, 4-2, 4-18 Functional Description, 3-1 Installation, 3-1, 4-14, 5-30 Main Screen, 2-9, 2-11, 2-24-2-25, 2-29-2-31, 3-1-3-2, 3-4, 3-19, 3-21, 4-4, 4-6, 4-8, 4-12, 4-15, 4-18, 4-25, 4-27, 4-42, 5-30 Main Screen Menu Bar, 2-29, 3-1 Main Screen Status Line, 3-1 Program Icon, 3-1, 5-30 Set Date, 4-2, 4-12 Setup Oscillograph Recorder, 4-2, 4-25 Setup Sequence of Events Recorder, 4-2, 4-27 TCP, 3-5 User Access Code Setup, 4-2, 4-6 User Logo Line, 4-2, 4-8 IPSlogic, SP-2, SP-11, SP-14-SP-16, 4-3, 4-39, 4-120-4-122, 4-124, 6-1, 6-67, A-35-A-43, F-1 IPSplot, SP-3, 1-3, 1-5, 2-16, 3-29, 4-24, 5-18

I
IEC Curve, 6-36-6-37, D-12-D-15 IEEE Extremely Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves, D-18 Very Inverse Time Overcurrent Curves, D-17 Impedance Calculation, 4-49 Inadvertent Energizing, SP-1-SP-2, 4-3, 4-78-4-79, 6-1, 6-33, A-20 Indicators, SP-15, 1-1, 1-5, 2-1-2-3, 5-32 Initial Setup Procedure, 5-1, 5-31 Initializing, 4-2, 4-22 Initiating Function Pickup, 4-123, A-35-A-43 Initiating Function Timeout, 4-123, A-35, A-37-A-38, A-40-A-41, A-43 Input Activated Profile Logic, 4-28 Contacts, SP-8, 4-39, 4-53, 6-70-6-71 Test, 6-67-6-68, 6-70, F-3 Installation, SP-34, SP-36, 1-1, 2-5, 3-1, 4-14, 4-894-90, 4-96-4-97, 5-1, 5-8, 5-30, 5-32, 6-78, E-2 Installing IPScom, 5-30 Instantaneous Neutral Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-74, 6-1, 6-35, A-20 Instantaneous Overcurrent, 4-3, 4-73-4-75, 4-78 Insulation Coordination, 5-8 Internal Fuse Loss Detection Logic, 4-3, 4-91 Introduction, 1-1 Inverse Square, D-2 Time Curves, 1-2, 4-50, 4-68-4-69, 4-80-4-81, 4-103, 6-11, 6-27, 6-36-6-37, 6-52, A-9, A-21, A-28, D-1 Time Neutral Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-3, 4-80, 6-1, 6-36, A-21 Time Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-81-4-82, D-1, D-6-D-7, D-9-D-11, D-16-D-18

J
Jumpers, SP-19-SP-20, 4-12, 4-15, 4-120, 5-1, 5-9, 5-20, 5-32, 6-71, B-1, B-4

L
Layup, SP-18, 1-2, E-1 LED, SP-5, SP-14-SP-15, 2-2-2-4, 2-13, 2-16, 3-23, 3-26, 3-32, 4-1-4-2, 4-8, 4-11, 4-24, 4-53, 4-62, 4-94, 5-31, 6-6-6-23, 6-25-6-28, 6-30-6-35, 6-37-6-44, 6-46-6-51, 6-53-6-56, 6-59-6-62, 6-65-6-81, A-13, F-3 Local Modem, 4-2, 4-21, 4-23 Logic Applicable, 4-3, 4-123 Long Time Inverse, 6-36-6-37, A-21, A-28, D-15 Loss of Field, SP-2, 3-7, 3-14, 4-3, 4-65-4-67, 6-1, 6-24-6-25, A-14-A-15, F-10 Loss of Field Diagram, 3-14 Loss of Field Relay, F-10 Low Forward Power, SP-2, 4-58, 4-61-4-63, 6-20

G4

Appendix G

Low Frequency Injection Calibration, 6-80 Signal Injection, SP-31, 4-3, 4-97, 4-102, 5-1, 5-24 Signal Injection Equipment, 4-97, 4-102, 5-1, 5-24 Signal Injection Equipment Part Number Cross Reference, 4-102 Signal Injection Equipment Typical Connections, 5-24

O
One-Line Functional Diagram, SP-13, 4-33-4-34, 4-75 Open Command, 3-4 Open Terminal Window, 3-6 Operating Characteristics, 4-116 Optional Dual Power Supply, 5-8 Oscillograph, SP-3, SP-13-SP-14, 1-2-1-3, 1-5, 2-12-3, 2-16-2-20, 3-19, 3-29, 4-1-4-2, 4-12, 4-24-4-26, 4-40, 5-1, B-1, C-1, F-2, F-23 Recorder, SP-14, 1-2, 2-1-2-2, 2-16-2-19, 3-29, 4-2, 4-24-4-26, 4-40, 5-1, F-2 Recorder Data, 2-2, 2-16 Setup, 4-2, 4-24-4-25 Triggered LED, 2-2-2-3 Out-of-Step, SP-1-SP-2, SP-4, 4-3, 4-46-4-47, 4-106-4-108, 6-54 Out-of-Step Protection Settings, 4-107 Out-of-Step Relay Characteristics, 4-106-4-107 Output Contacts, SP-1, SP-6, SP-14, SP-16-SP-17, 2-8, 3-24, 4-40-4-42, 4-65, 4-75, 5-8, 5-32, 6-6, 6-8-69, 6-11, 6-13, 6-15-6-17, 6-23, 6-25-6-27, 6-29-636, 6-38-6-44, 6-46, 6-49, 6-51-6-52, 6-56-6-57, 6-59-6-60, 6-62-6-63, 6-65-6-67, 6-69, A-1 Relay Test, 6-69-6-70 Relays, SP-15-SP-16, 6-69 Seal-in Time, 3-20, 4-32, A-6 Test, 3-33, 4-11, 6-57, 6-68-6-69, E-2, F-3 Over Power, 4-61-4-64, 6-21-6-22 Over Reactive Power, 4-61, 4-64 Overexcitation Volts, 4-2, 4-50 Overpower, SP-2, SP-5, 4-63 Overvoltage, SP-2, 4-3, 4-58, 4-83-4-84, 4-87-4-90, 6-1, 6-39, 6-41-6-42, A-22-A-25

M
M-0331, 5-29 M-3925A Target Module, SP-15, 2-2-2-4 M-3931 Human-Machine Interface Module F, F-1 Main HMI Menu Flow, 2-7 Manual Configuration of Ethernet Board, 4-2, 4-19-420 Mechanical, SP-17, 1-1, 4-110, 5-1-5-2 Modems, 4-2, 4-14, 4-21, B-1 Monitor Frequency Accumulator Status, 3-11 Monitor Menu, 3-7, F-1, F-12 Mounting Dimensions, SP-12, SP-30, 5-2-5-4, 5-6-57, 5-24 Multi-purpose Overvoltage Setpoint Ranges, 4-90 Multipurpose Overvoltage, SP-2, 4-3, 4-89-4-90, 6-1, 6-42, A-25

N
Negative Pickup, 4-61 Negative Sequence Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-3, 4-43, 4-68-4-69, 6-1, 6-26-6-27, A-16 Negative Sequence Overcurrent Inverse Time Curves, 4-68-4-69 Neutral Circuit, 4-3, 4-59, 4-87-4-88, 6-1, 6-41 Neutral Fundamental Calibration, 6-78 New Command, 3-4 Null Modem Cable, 4-14, 5-30, B-1-B-2, E-2

G5

M3425A Instruction Book

P
Phase Angle Check, 4-2, 4-53 Differential, SP-2, SP-6, SP-13, SP-21, 3-18, 4-3, 4-77, 4-115-4-116, 6-1, 6-60, A-33 Distance, SP-2, 3-7, 3-13, 4-2, 4-46-4-49, 6-1, 6-8, A-7-A-8, F-1, F-11 Distance Diagram, 3-13 Overvoltage, SP-2, 4-3, 4-83-4-84, 6-1, 6-39, A-22 Undervoltage, SP-2, 2-14, 4-2, 4-40, 4-57, 6-1, 6-16, A-10-A-11 Phasor Diagram, 3-1, 3-7, 3-12-3-13 Physical Dimensions, 5-1-5-2 Power Supply, SP-3, SP-13-SP-15, 1-3, 1-5, 2-2, 2-4-2-5, 5-8, 5-31, 6-2, 6-69-6-70, E-1-E-2 Power Supply Relay, 5-8, 6-69-6-70 Primary Metering, 2-2, 2-9-2-11, 3-7-3-9 Primary Transferred To Transformer Secondary, 4-101 Profile, SP-13, 2-16, 3-19, 3-30, 4-23-4-24, 4-28, 4-39, 4-122, 6-6, A-36-A-37, A-39-A-40, A-42-A-43, F-2 Protection Characteristics, 4-58 Curves, 4-51 PS1, SP-15, 2-2, 2-4, 6-71, E-1 PS2, SP-15, 2-2, 2-4, 6-71, E-1

Relay Communication, 3-33, 4-15 Front Panel, 1-3, 2-2, 2-8, 2-21-2-22, 2-26-2-28, 3-26, 5-31 Menu, 2-13, 2-30, 3-4, 3-19, 4-42-4-45, F-1, F6-F-11, F-13-F-17 OK LED, SP-15, 2-2-2-3, 6-7, 6-68, 6-77-6-81, F-3 OK LED Flash, 6-68, 6-77 Outputs, 5-8 Setpoints, 3-19, 3-21, 3-24, 4-42-4-43 Replacement Fuses, 5-8 Reset Delay Timer, 4-3, 4-124 Resetting Counters, 2-2, 2-29 Residual Directional Overcurrent, SP-2, 4-3, 4-53, 4-104, 4-106, 6-1, 6-50, 6-52, A-27-A-28 Restraint, SP-2, SP-7, 3-18, 4-3, 4-81-4-82, 4-98, 4-102, 4-115, 6-1, 6-37-6-38, 6-47-6-49, 6-61, A-21, A-27 Retrieve, 2-1-2-2, 2-19, 2-30, 3-27, 3-29, 3-35 Retrieve Oscillograph Records, 2-2, 2-19 Reverse Power Flow, 4-61 RS-232, SP-3, SP-15, SP-17, SP-29, 2-5, 4-2, 4-144-15, 4-18, 4-23, 5-30, B-3 RS-485, SP-3, SP-15-SP-16, SP-29, 4-2, 4-14, 5-30, B-4

S
Save As Command, 3-4 Scheme, SP-31, 4-40, 4-53, 4-85-4-86, 4-91, 4-97, 4-106, 4-122, E-1 Screen Blanking, 2-2-2-3 Screen Message Menu Flow, 2-6 Secondary Metering, 2-2, 2-11-2-12, 3-1, 3-7, 3-9-310, 3-12-3-13 Security, SP-1, SP-15, 1-4, 2-2, 2-6, 2-24-2-25, 3-313-32, 4-1-4-2, 4-4, 4-6, 4-17, 4-117, 4-122 Sequence of Events, SP-3, SP-14-SP-15, 2-1-2-2, 2-30-2-31, 3-19, 3-27-3-28, 4-1-4-2, 4-27 Serial Number, 1-2, 2-1-2-2, 2-5, 2-21-2-22, 5-31, 6-7, F-3 Serial Port, 2-5, 3-1, 3-5, 4-2, 4-14, 4-18, 4-21, 4-23, 5-30-5-31, B-1, E-2 Set Date, 1-2, 2-13, 2-30, 3-19, 3-23, 4-2, 4-12, E-2 Setpoint Profiles, SP-13, 4-2, 4-39, 4-41, 5-32 Setting Groups, 4-2, 4-39

R
Rate of Change of Frequency, SP-2, 2-8, 4-3, 4-114, 6-1, 6-58, A-32 Ratio, SP-2, SP-8, SP-10, 4-3, 4-28, 4-30, 4-46, 4-60, 4-65, 4-73, 4-80-4-81, 4-85-4-86, 4-97, 4-100, 4-115, 4-117, 5-14, 6-40, 6-62, A-5, A-23, A-34, F-2 Reactive, SP-5, SP-13, 2-8-2-9, 2-11, 3-7, 3-9, 4-3, 4-61-4-62, 4-64, 5-16, 6-19, 6-21-6-23, 6-78, A-13 Read Data From Relay, 3-4, 3-19, 3-31 Recorder Partitions, 2-16, 4-24, 4-26 Redundant High Voltage Power Supply, 1-5 Redundant Low Voltage Power Supply, 1-5

G6

Appendix G

Setup Date, 3-23, 4-12 Oscillograph Recorder, 2-18, 3-29, 4-2, 4-25-4-26 Procedure, 5-1, 5-31 Unit, 2-6, 2-21-2-22, 2-26-2-28, 4-7-4-8, 4-10-412, 6-68, A-1, E-1, F-3, F-26-F-27 Shortcut Command Buttons, 3-1 Software Version, 2-1-2-2, 2-5, 2-21-2-22, 2-26-2-28, 4-7-4-8, 4-10-4-11, 5-31, 6-68, F-3 Special Considerations, 4-2, 4-41 Stator Ground, SP-1-SP-2, SP-8, SP-12-SP-13, SP-31, 4-3, 4-85, 4-87, 4-89, 4-97, 4-102, 6-1, 6-47, 6-80, A-27 Stator Ground Protection, SP-2, SP-8, SP-12, SP31, 4-3, 4-87, 4-97, 4-103, 6-1, 6-47 Stator Overload Protection, 4-3, 4-70, 6-28, A-17 Stator Thermal Protection, 4-72 Status LED Panel, 6-71 Status LED Test, 6-68, 6-71, F-3 Status Monitoring, 1-4, 2-1-2-2, 2-8-2-9 Storage, SP-3, SP-13, SP-18, 1-2-1-3, 4-58, E-1-E-2 Sync Check, SP-1-SP-2, SP-12, 2-8, 3-16, 4-2, 4-36, 4-53-4-56, 5-11, 5-17, 6-1, 6-14-6-15, A-9-A-10, F1-F-2, F-12 Sync Check Relay, F-1, F-12 Sync Scope, 3-7, 3-16 System Backup, SP-1, 4-47-4-48 Clock, 2-5, 3-23, 4-2, 4-12, 5-31, E-1 Diagrams, 4-1-4-2, 4-33, 4-77 Error Codes, 2-2, 2-26, 2-29, 3-34 OK LED, 3-32, 4-2, 4-8, 4-11 OK LED Setup, 4-2, 4-8, 4-11 Setup, 1-1, 2-1, 2-16, 2-19, 3-4, 3-27, 3-29-3-30, 4-1-4-2, 4-28, 4-68, 5-1, 5-32, 6-2, 6-6, 6-9-6-10, 6-14, 6-28, A-1

T
Target LED, SP-5, SP-15, 2-2, 2-4, 2-13, 4-62, 6-11, 6-27, 6-68, 6-72, A-13, F-3 LED Test, 6-68, 6-72, F-3 Module, SP-1, SP-3, SP-13, SP-15, 1-3-1-4, 2-22-4, 2-13, 6-72 Module Panel, 6-72 Reset Pushbutton, SP-15, 2-2, 2-4, 4-30, 6-8-617, 6-21-6-23, 6-25-6-28, 6-30-6-35, 6-37-6-44, 6-46-6-51, 6-53-6-56, 6-59-6-63, 6-67 Terminal Window, 3-5-3-6, 4-23 Test Configuration, 6-5 Error Codes, 1-2 Setup, 6-1-6-2, 6-8-6-10, 6-12, 6-14, 6-16-6-17, 6-21, 6-24, 6-26-6-28, 6-30-6-37, 6-39-6-44, 6-466-47, 6-50, 6-52, 6-54, 6-56-6-58, 6-60, 6-62, 6-64, 6-66-6-67 Testing, 1-1-1-2, 2-4, 3-33, 5-1, 6-1, 6-6, 6-8-6-10, 6-12-6-14, 6-16-6-17, 6-21, 6-24, 6-26-6-28, 6-306-37, 6-39-6-44, 6-46-6-47, 6-50, 6-52, 6-54-6-58, 6-60-6-62, 6-64, 6-66, 6-69-6-77 Third Harmonic Calibration, 6-79 Undervoltage, 4-58-4-59, A-11-A-12 Harmonic Voltage Differential, SP-2, 4-3, 4-85-486, 6-1, A-23 Three-Line Connection Diagram, 4-28, 4-35-4-38, 5-10-5-13 Time Constant, SP-6, 4-70, 6-28, A-17 Time Sync LED, SP-15, 2-2-2-3, 3-23 Timer Feature, 4-3, 4-125 Tools Menu, 3-31 Torque Requirements, 5-8 Trigger Oscillograph, 2-1-2-2, 2-20 Trip Characteristics, 4-103, 4-109-4-110 Circuit Monitor, 4-119, 5-21, F-1 Circuit Monitor Input Voltage Select Jumper Configuration, 5-21 Circuit Monitoring, SP-3, SP-19-SP-20, 4-3, 4-119, 5-8-5-9, 6-1, 6-66, A-44 Circuit Monitoring Input, SP-19-SP-20, 4-119, 5-8-5-9

G7

M3425A Instruction Book

Tripping, SP-2, SP-14, SP-17, 4-30, 4-39, 4-50, 4-58, 4-61-4-65, 4-68, 4-73, 4-78, 4-81, 4-93, 4-98, 4-106, 4-114, 5-32 Turn Fault Protection Three-Line Connection Diagram, 4-37, 5-12 Turn-to-Turn Stator Fault Protection, 4-3, 4-89 Turn-to-Turn Stator Winding Fault Protection, 4-90 Typical Brush Lift-Off Pickup Setting, 4-96 Typical Frequency Settings, 4-93, 4-95-4-96

VT Fuse Loss, SP-2, SP-8, 4-3, 4-91, 6-1, 6-43 VT Fuse Loss Alarm Function, 4-3, 4-91

W
Wire, 4-14, 5-8, 6-75 Wire Testing, 6-75 Write File, 3-19, 3-31 Wye Transformer Voltage-Current Pairs, 4-81-4-82

U
Under Power, SP-5, 4-61, 4-63, 6-22-6-23, A-13 Unit Isolation, 5-8 Unit Setup, 2-21-2-22, 2-26-2-28, 3-31-3-33, 4-1-4-2, 4-7-4-8, 4-10, 5-1, 5-32 User Access Codes, 2-1-2-2, 2-22, 2-24-2-25, 3-31, 4-1-4-2, 4-6-4-7 Control Number, 1-2, 3-32, 4-1-4-2, 4-8, 4-10, F-3 Information, 3-32, 4-8 Logo Line, 3-32, 4-2, 4-8-4-9, F-3

Z
Zero Sequence, SP-2, 2-8-2-9, 2-11, 3-7, 3-9, 4-3, 4-80, 4-86-4-89, 4-117, 5-14-5-16, 6-1, 6-40-6-41, 6-50-6-51, 6-53

V
V. T. Fuse Loss Relay Menu Flow, F-1, F-10 Vertical Chassis, 5-3-5-4 Very Inverse, SP-7, SP-9, 6-36-6-37, 6-52, A-21, A-28, D-1, D-10, D-13, D-17 View Target History, 2-1-2-2, 2-4, 2-6, 2-13-2-15, F-2, F-23 Targets, 2-2, 2-15, 3-26 Voltage Control, SP-2, SP-5, SP-7, 4-3, 4-65-4-66, 4-78, 4-81-4-82, 4-91, 6-1, 6-24-6-25, 6-37-6-38, A-15, A-21 Control Time Settings, 4-66 Input Configuration, 6-82 Inputs, SP-14, 5-31, 6-3, 6-7-6-10, 6-12, 6-14, 6-16-6-17, 6-21, 6-24, 6-26-6-28, 6-30-6-31, 6-33-6-37, 6-39-6-44, 6-46-6-47, 6-50, 6-52, 6-54, 6-56-6-58, 6-60, 6-62, 6-64, 6-66-6-67, 6-79 Relay Menu Flow, F-1, F-6 Restraint, SP-2, SP-7, 4-81-4-82, 4-98, 4-102, 6-37-6-38, 6-47-6-49, A-21, A-27 Volts-Per-Hertz Relay Menu Flow, F-1, F-9 Volts-Per-Hertz, 4-50, 4-52
G8

Declaration of Conformity: Appendix H

Appendix HDeclaration of Conformity


DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY ( in accordance to ISO/IEC 17050-1:2004 )

No. M-3425A

Manufacturers Name: Manufacturers Address:

Beckwith Electric CO, INC. 6190 118th Avenue North Largo, FL 33773-3724

The manufacturer hereby declares under our sole responsibility that the M-3425A product conforms to the following product standard as of January 14th, 2004 in accordance to Directive 2004/108/EC for equipment incorporated into stationary installations: BS EN 50263:2000

Electromagnetic compatibility ( EMC ) Product standard for measuring relays and protection equipment
Electromagnetic Emissions: EN 60255-25:2000 Conducted 150 kHz to 30MHz Radiated 30MHz to 1000MHz Class A Limits

Electromagnetic Immunity 1 MHz Disturbance EN 60255-22-1:1988 ( ANSI C37.90.1:2002 ) Electrostatic Discharge 8kV Contact; 15kV Air EN 60255-22-2:1997 Radiated RF 80MHz to 1000MHz 10V/m, 80% AM ( 1kHz ) EN 60255-22-3:2001 Fast Transients 5ns/50ns Bursts @ 5kHz for 15ms 300ms for 1 min. 2kV power supply lines and earth 2kV signal data and control lines EN 60255-22-4:2002 Surge 1Kv Line to Line coupling, 2Kv Line to Earth coupling power supply lines 12 source impedance

EN 61000-4-5:1995
Conducted RF 150KHz to 80MHz 10V emf EN 60255-22-6:2001

Power frequency magnetic field immunity test 30 A/m continuous EN 61000-4-8:1994 Voltage dips, short interruptions and voltage variations immunity tests EN 61000-4-11:1994 EN 61010-1: 2001 Safety requirements for electrical equipment for measurement, control, and laboratory use Part 1. General requirements European Safety Directive Manufacturers Contact: Engineering Manager 6190 118th Ave North Largo, FL 33773-3724 Tel ( 727 ) 544-2326

H1

M3425A Instruction Book

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

H2

Legal Information
Patent
The units described in this manual are covered by U.S. Patents, with other patents pending. Buyer shall hold harmless and indemnify the Seller, its directors, officers, agents, and employees from any and all costs and expense, damage or loss, resulting from any alleged infringementof United States Letters Patent or rights accruing thereform or trademarks, whether federal, state, or common law, arising from the Sellers compliance with Buyers designs, specifications, or instructions.

Indemnification
The Seller shall not be liable for any property damages whatsoever or for any loss or damage arising out of, connected with, or resulting from this contract, or from the performance or breach thereof, or from all services covered by or furnished under this contract. In no event shall the Seller be liable for special, incidental, exemplary, or consequential damages, including but not limited to, loss of profits or revenue, loss of use of the equipment or any associated equipment, cost of capital, cost of purchased power, cost of substitute equipment, facilities or services, downtime costs, or claims or damages of customers or employees of the Buyer for such damages, regardless of whether said claim or damages is based on contract, warranty, tort including negligence, or otherwise. Under no circumstances shall the Seller be liable for any personal injury whatsoever. It is agreed that when the equipment furnished hereunder are to be used or performed in connection with any nuclear installation, facility, or activity, Seller shall have no liability for any nuclear damage, personal injury, property damage, or nuclear contamination to any property located at or near the site of the nuclear facility. Buyer agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Seller against any and all liability associated therewith whatsoever whether based on contract, tort, or otherwise. Nuclear installation or facility means any nuclear reactor and includes the site on which any of the foregoing is located, all operations conducted on such site, and all premises used for such operations.

Warranty
Seller hereby warrants that the goods which are the subject matter of this contract will be manufactured in a good workmanlike manner and all materials used herein will be new and reasonably suitable for the equipment. Seller warrants that if, during a period of five years from date of shipment of the equipment, the equipment rendered shall be found by the Buyer to be faulty or shall fail to peform in accordance with Sellers specifications of the product, Seller shall at his expense correct the same, provided, however, that Buyers shall ship the equipment prepaid to Sellers facility. The Sellers responsibility hereunder shall be limited to replacement value of the equipment furnished under this contract. Seller makes no warranties expressed or implied other than those set out above. Seller specifically excludes the implied warranties of merchantibility and fitness for a particular purpose. There are no warranties which extend beyond the description contained herein. In no event shall Seller be liable for consequential, exemplary, or punitive damages of whatever nature. Any equipment returned for repair must be sent with transportation charges prepaid. The equipment must remain the property of the Buyer. The aforementioned warranties are void if the value of the unit is invoiced to the Seller at the time of return.

Notice:
Any illustrations and descriptions by Beckwith Electric Co., Inc. are for the sole purpose of identification. The drawings and/or specifications enclosed herein are the proprietary property of Beckwith Electric Co., Inc., and are issued in strict confidence; therefore, shall not be used as a basis of reproduction of the apparatus described therein without written permission of Beckwith Electric Co., Inc. No illustration or description contained herein shall be construed as an express warranty of affirmation, promise, description, or sample, and any and all such express warranties are specifically excluded nor shall such illustration or description imply a warranty that the product is merchantable or fit for a particular purpose. There shall be no warranties which extend beyond those contained in the Beckwith Electric Co., Inc. terms of sale.

All rights reserved by Beckwith Electric Co., Inc. No reproduction may be made without prior written approval of the Company.

This Page Left Intentionally Blank

6190 - 118th Avenue North Largo, Florida 33773-3724 U.S.A. PHONE (727) 544-2326 FAX (727) 546-0121 EMAIL [email protected] WEB PAGE www.beckwithelectric.com ISO 9001:2008

BECKWITH ELECTRIC CO., INC.

2004 Beckwith Electric Co. All Rights Reserved. Printed in USA

8003425AIB09 07/12

You might also like